2021 Toyota Corolla Hybrid Owner Manual

Download 2021 Toyota Corolla Hybrid Owner’s Manual | Automobile Garage Technique

PDF preview unavailable. Download the PDF instead.

2021 Toyota Corolla-Hybrid
Pictorial index

Search by illustration

For safety and security

Make sure to read through them
(Main topics: Child seat, theft deterrent system)

1

Vehicle status information and indicators

Reading driving-related information
(Main topics: Meters, multi-information display)

2

Opening and closing the doors and windows,

Before driving

adjustment before driving

3

(Main topics: Keys, doors, seats)

Driving

Operations and advice which are necessary for

driving

4

(Main topics: Starting hybrid system, refueling)

Audio

Operating the Audio
(Main topics: Audio/visual, phone)

5

Interior features
Maintenance and care When trouble arises Vehicle specifications
For owners
Index

Usage of the interior features
(Main topics: Air conditioner, storage features)

6

Caring for your vehicle and maintenance

procedures

7

(Main topics: Interior and exterior, light bulbs)

What to do in case of malfunction and emergency
(Main topics: 12-volt battery discharge, flat tire)

8

Vehicle specifications, customizable features
(Main topics: Fuel, oil, tire inflation pressure)

9

Reporting safety defects for U.S. owners, and seat

belt and SRS airbag instructions for Canadian

10

owners

Search by symptom

Search alphabetically

COROLLA HV_U

2

TABLE OF CONTENTS

For your information ........................ 6 Reading this manual ......................11 How to search................................12 Pictorial index ................................13

1 For safety and security

1-1. For safe use Before driving ........................24 For safe driving .....................25 Seat belts ..............................27 SRS airbags ..........................31 Front passenger occupant classification system..................41 Exhaust gas precautions.......46
1-2. Child safety Riding with children ...............47 Child restraint systems..........48
1-3. Emergency assistance Safety Connect .....................73
1-4. Hybrid system Hybrid system features .........80 Hybrid system precautions....83
1-5. Theft deterrent system Immobilizer system ...............88 Alarm.....................................90

2

Vehicle status information and indicators

2-1. Instrument cluster
Warning lights and indicators ............................................94
Gauges and meters ..............98 Multi-information display .... 103 Energy monitor/consumption
screen .............................. 109

3 Before driving
3-1. Key information Keys ................................... 116
3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors Doors ................................. 119 Trunk .................................. 123 Smart key system .............. 125
3-3. Adjusting the seats Front seats ......................... 133 Rear seats.......................... 134 Head restraints................... 136
3-4. Adjusting the steering wheel and mirrors Steering wheel ................... 138 Inside rear view mirror ....... 139 Outside rear view mirrors... 140
3-5. Opening and closing the windows Power windows .................. 142
4 Driving
4-1. Before driving Driving the vehicle.............. 146 Cargo and luggage ............ 152 Vehicle load limits .............. 155 Trailer towing...................... 155 Dinghy towing .................... 156
4-2. Driving procedures Power (ignition) switch ....... 157 EV drive mode ................... 162 Hybrid transmission ........... 164 Turn signal lever................. 166 Parking brake..................... 167 Brake Hold ......................... 170

COROLLA HV_U

4-3. Operating the lights and wipers Headlight switch ................. 173 Automatic High Beam ........ 175 Windshield wipers and washer ......................................... 178
4-4. Refueling Opening the fuel tank cap .. 180
4-5. Using the driving support systems Toyota Safety Sense 2.0 .... 183 PCS (Pre-Collision System) ......................................... 189 LTA (Lane Tracing Assist)... 197 Dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range........ 207 RSA (Road Sign Assist) ..... 218 BSM (Blind Spot Monitor)... 221 RCTA (Rear Cross Traffic Alert) function ............................ 226 Rear view monitor system.. 231 Driving mode select switch ......................................... 239 Driving assist systems........ 240
4-6. Driving tips Hybrid vehicle driving tips .. 245 Winter driving tips............... 247
5 Audio
5-1. Basic function Buttons overview................ 253 Menu screen ...................... 255 Status icon ......................... 256 "Setup" screen ................... 258
5-2. Basic information before operation Initial screen ....................... 259 Touch screen...................... 260 Home screen...................... 262

TABLE OF CONTENTS

3

Entering letters and num-

bers/list screen operation ......................................... 263

Screen adjustment ............. 266

Linking multi-information display and the system ................ 267

5-3. Connectivity settings

Registering/Connecting a Blue-

1

tooth® device ................... 268

Setting Bluetooth® details .. 272 2 Wi-Fi® Hotspot ................... 280

Apple CarPlay/ Android Auto .................... 284 3
5-4. Other settings

General settings................. 291

Voice settings..................... 295 4

Vehicle settings .................. 296

5-5. Using the audio/visual system

Quick reference.................. 298 5

Some basics ...................... 299

5-6. Radio operation

AM radio/FM radio/SiriusXM®

6

Satellite Radio(SXM) ....... 303

Internet radio...................... 308 5-7. Media operation

7

USB memory...................... 309

iPod/iPhone (Apple CarPlay) ......................................... 311

8

Android Auto ...................... 314

Bluetooth® audio ................ 315 9 5-8. Audio/visual remote controls

Steering switches............... 319

5-9. Audio settings

10

Setup.................................. 321

5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system

Operating information ........ 322

5-11. Voice command system operation

Voice command system ..... 334

COROLLA HV_U

4

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Command list ..................... 337
5-12. Mobile Assistant operation
Mobile Assistant ................. 341
5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones)
Quick reference.................. 343 Some basics ...................... 344 Placing a call using the Blue-
tooth® hands-free system 348 Receiving a call using the Blue-
tooth® hands-free system 351 Talking on the Bluetooth®
hands-free system ........... 352 Bluetooth® phone message
function ............................ 354
5-14. Phone settings
Setup.................................. 358
5-15. What to do if... (Bluetooth®)
Troubleshooting ................. 368
5-16. Connected Services Overview
Functional overview ........... 372 Type A: Function achieved by
using a smart phone or DCM ......................................... 373 Type B: Function achieved by using DCM and the system ......................................... 376 Type C: Function achieved by using DCM ....................... 377 Type D: Function achieved by using DCM and a smartphone ......................................... 377
5-17. Connected Services Operation
Toyota apps........................ 379
5-18. Toyota apps settings
Setup.................................. 383

6 Interior features
6-1. Using the air conditioning system and defogger Automatic air conditioning system ................................... 386 Heated steering wheel/seat heaters ............................. 393
6-2. Using the interior lights Interior lights list ................. 395
6-3. Using the storage features List of storage features ...... 397 Trunk features .................... 400
6-4. Other interior features Other interior features ........ 401 Garage door opener........... 411
7 Maintenance and care
7-1. Maintenance and care Cleaning and protecting the vehicle exterior................. 420 Cleaning and protecting the vehicle interior.................. 422
7-2. Maintenance Maintenance requirements ......................................... 425 General maintenance......... 426 Emission inspection and maintenance (I/M) programs ...... 429
7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance Do-it-yourself service precautions ................................. 430 Hood .................................. 432 Positioning a floor jack ....... 433 Engine compartment.......... 434 Tires ................................... 441 Tire inflation pressure......... 450 Wheels ............................... 452 Air conditioning filter........... 454

COROLLA HV_U

Cleaning the hybrid battery (traction battery) air intake vent and filter .................................. 455
Electronic key battery......... 459 Checking and replacing fuses
......................................... 461 Light bulbs.......................... 463
8 When trouble arises
8-1. Essential information Emergency flashers ........... 470 If your vehicle has to be stopped in an emergency .............. 471 If the vehicle is trapped in rising water ................................ 472
8-2. Steps to take in an emergency If your vehicle needs to be towed ......................................... 473 If you think something is wrong ......................................... 476 If a warning light turns on or a warning buzzer sounds .... 478 If a warning message is displayed .............................. 487 If you have a flat tire (vehicles without spare tire) ............ 490 If you have a flat tire (vehicles with a spare tire) .............. 501 If the hybrid system will not start ......................................... 509 If you lose your keys .......... 510 If the fuel filler door cannot be opened ............................. 511 If the electronic key does not operate properly............... 511 If the 12-volt battery is discharged ............................ 513 If your vehicle overheats .... 517 If the vehicle becomes stuck ......................................... 520

TABLE OF CONTENTS

5

9 Vehicle specifications

9-1. Specifications

Maintenance data (fuel, oil level, etc.) .................................. 524

Fuel information ................. 531 Tire information .................. 533

1

9-2. Customization

Customizable features ....... 544 2 9-3. Initialization

Items to initialize ................ 552

3
10 For owners

10-1. For owners

4

Reporting safety defects for U.S.

owners ............................. 554

Seat belt instructions for Cana-

5

dian owners (in French) ... 554

SRS airbag instructions for

Canadian owners (in French)

6

......................................... 556

Index

7

What to do if... (Troubleshooting) ......................................... 564 8
Alphabetical Index.............. 567
9

10

COROLLA HV_U

6
For your information
Main Owner's Manual
Please note that this manual applies to all models and explains all equipment, including options. Therefore, you may find some explanations for equipment not installed on your vehicle.
All specifications provided in this manual are current at the time of printing. However, because of the Toyota policy of continual product improvement, we reserve the right to make changes at any time without notice.
Depending on specifications, the vehicle shown in the illustrations may differ from your vehicle in terms of equipment.
Noise from under vehicle after turning off the hybrid system
Approximately five hours after the hybrid system is turned off, you may hear sound coming from under the vehicle for several minutes. This is the sound of a fuel evaporation leakage check and, it does not indicate a malfunction.

Accessories, spare parts and modification of your Toyota
A wide variety of non-genuine spare parts and accessories for Toyota vehicles are currently available in the market. You should know that Toyota does not warrant these products and is not responsible for their performance, repair, or replacement, or for any damage they may cause to, or adverse effect they may have on, your Toyota vehicle.
This vehicle should not be modified with non-genuine Toyota products. Modification with non-genuine Toyota products could affect its performance, safety or durability, and may even violate governmental regulations. In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from the modification may not be covered under warranty.
Installation of a mobile two-way radio system
The installation of a mobile two-way radio system in your vehicle could affect electronic systems such as:
 Multiport fuel injection system/sequential multiport fuel injection system
 Toyota Safety Sense 2.0

COROLLA HV_U

 Anti-lock brake system
 SRS airbag system
 Seat belt pretensioner system
Be sure to check with your Toyota dealer for precautionary measures or special instructions regarding installation of a mobile two-way radio system.
High voltage parts and cables on the hybrid vehicles emit approximately the same amount of electromagnetic waves as the conventional gasoline powered vehicles or home electronic appliances despite of their electromagnetic shielding.
Unwanted noise may occur in the reception of the mobile two-way radio.
Vehicle data recording
The vehicle is equipped with sophisticated computers that will record certain data, such as: · Engine speed/Electric motor
speed (traction motor speed) · Accelerator status · Brake status · Vehicle speed · Operation status of the driving
assist systems · Images from the cameras
Your vehicle is equipped with cameras. Contact your Toyota dealer for the location of recording cameras.
The recorded data varies

7
according to the vehicle grade level and options with which it is equipped.
These computers do not record conversations or sounds, and only record images outside of the vehicle in certain situations.
 Data Transmission
Your vehicle may transmit the data recorded in these computers to Toyota without notification to you.
 Data usage
Toyota may use the data recorded in this computer to diagnose malfunctions, conduct research and development, and improve quality.
Toyota will not disclose the recorded data to a third party except:
· With the consent of the vehicle owner or with the consent of the lessee if the vehicle is leased
· In response to an official request by the police, a court of law or a government agency
· For use by Toyota in a lawsuit
· For research purposes where the data is not tied to a specific vehicle or vehicle owner
 Recorded image information can be erased by your Toyota dealer.
The image recording function can be disabled. However, if the function is disabled, data from when the system operates will not be available.
 To learn more about the vehicle data collected, used and

COROLLA HV_U

8
shared by Toyota, please visit www.toyota.com/privacyvts/.
Usage of data collected through Safety Connect (U.S. mainland only)
If your Toyota has Safety Connect and if you have subscribed to those services, please refer to the Safety Connect Telematics Subscription Service Agreement for information on data collected and its usage.
To learn more about the vehicle data collected, used and shared by Toyota, please visit www.toyota.com/privacyvts/.
Event data recorder
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle's systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of time, typically 30 seconds or less.
The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record such data as: · How various systems in your

vehicle were operating; · Whether or not the driver and
passenger safety belts were buckled/fastened; · How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal; and, · How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.
NOTE: EDR data are recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash investigation. To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can read the information if they have access to the vehicle or the EDR.
 Disclosure of the EDR data
Toyota will not disclose the data

COROLLA HV_U

recorded in an EDR to a third party except when:
· An agreement from the vehicle's owner (or the lessee for a leased vehicle) is obtained
· In response to an official request by the police, a court of law or a government agency
· For use by Toyota in a lawsuit
However, if necessary, Toyota may:
· Use the data for research on vehicle safety performance
· Disclose the data to a third party for research purposes without disclosing information about the specific vehicle or vehicle owner
Scrapping of your Toyota
The SRS airbag and seat belt pretensioner devices in your Toyota contain explosive chemicals. If the vehicle is scrapped with the airbags and seat belt pretensioners left as they are, this may cause an accident such as fire. Be sure to have the systems of the SRS airbag and seat belt pretensioner removed and disposed of by a qualified service shop or by your Toyota dealer before you scrap your vehicle.

9
that may contain perchlorate. These components may include the airbags, seat belt pretensioners, wireless remote control batteries, and the batteries in the tire pressure warning valve and transmitters.
WARNING
 General precautions while driving
Driving under the influence: Never drive your vehicle when under the influence of alcohol or drugs that have impaired your ability to operate your vehicle. Alcohol and certain drugs delay reaction time, impair judgment and reduce coordination, which could lead to an accident that could result in death or serious injury. Defensive driving: Always drive defensively. Anticipate mistakes that other drivers or pedestrians might make and be ready to avoid accidents. Driver distraction: Always give your full attention to driving. Anything that distracts the driver, such as adjusting controls, talking on a cellular phone or reading can result in a collision with resulting death or serious injury to you, your occupants or others.

Perchlorate Material
Special handling may apply, See www.dtsc.ca.gov/ hazardouswaste/perchlorate. Your vehicle has components

COROLLA HV_U

10
WARNING  General precaution regarding
children's safety Never leave children unattended in the vehicle, and never allow children to have or use the key. Children may be able to start the vehicle or shift the vehicle into neutral. There is also a danger that children may injure themselves by playing with the windows, or other features of the vehicle. In addition, heat build-up or extremely cold temperatures inside the vehicle can be fatal to children.
COROLLA HV_U

Reading this manual
Explains symbols used in this manual.

Symbols in this manual

Symbols

Meanings
WARNING:
Explains something that, if not obeyed, could cause death or serious injury to people.
NOTICE:
Explains something that, if not obeyed, could cause damage to or a malfunction in the vehicle or its equipment.
Indicates operating or working procedures. Follow the steps in numerical order.

Symbols in illustrations

11

Symbols

Meanings
Indicates the action (pushing, turning, etc.) used to operate switches and other devices.
Indicates the outcome of an operation (e.g. a lid opens).

Symbols

Meanings
Indicates the component or position being explained.
Means Do not, Do not do this, or Do not let this happen.

COROLLA HV_U

12
How to search
 Searching by name  Alphabetical index: P.567

 Searching by title  Table of contents: P.2

 Searching by installation position
 Pictorial index: P.13

 Searching by symptom or sound
 What to do if... (Troubleshooting): P.564

COROLLA HV_U

Pictorial index
Exterior

Pictorial index

13

Doors................................................................................... P.119 Locking/unlocking ................................................................ P.119 Opening/closing the side windows ....................................... P.142 Locking/unlocking by using the mechanical key .................. P.511 Warning messages .............................................................. P.122 Trunk ................................................................................... P.123 Opening from inside ............................................................. P.124 Opening from outside........................................................... P.124 Warning messages .............................................................. P.125 Outside rear view mirrors ................................................. P.140 Adjusting the mirror angle .................................................... P.140 Folding the mirrors ............................................................... P.141 Defogging the mirrors .......................................................... P.387 Windshield wipers.............................................................. P.178 Precautions for winter season.............................................. P.247 To prevent freezing (windshield wiper de-icer)*.................... P.390

14

Pictorial index

Fuel filler door .................................................................... P.180 Refueling method ................................................................. P.181 Fuel type/fuel tank capacity ................................................. P.525 Tires..................................................................................... P.441 Tire size/inflation pressure ................................................... P.529 Winter tires/tire chains ......................................................... P.247 Checking/rotation/tire pressure warning system* ................. P.441 Coping with flat tires..................................................... P.490, 501 Hood .................................................................................... P.432 Opening ............................................................................... P.432 Engine oil ............................................................................. P.526 Coping with overheating ...................................................... P.517
Light bulbs of the exterior lights for driving (Replacing method: P.463, Watts: P.530)
Headlights/daytime running lights ................................... P.173 Turn signal lights/parking lights....................................... P.173 Parking lights* .................................................................... P.173 Front side marker lights .................................................... P.173 Stop lights/tail lights/rear side marker lights/turn signal lights P.173 License plate lights............................................................ P.173 Back-up lights Shifting the shift position to R .............................................. P.164 *: If equipped

COROLLA HV_U

Instrument panel

Pictorial index

15

Power switch ...................................................................... P.157 Starting the hybrid system/changing the modes .................. P.157 Emergency stop of the hybrid system .................................. P.471 When the hybrid system will not start .................................. P.509 Warning messages .............................................................. P.487 Shift lever............................................................................ P.164 Changing the shift position................................................... P.164 Precautions for towing ......................................................... P.473 When the shift lever does not move..................................... P.165 Meters ................................................................................... P.98 Reading the meters/adjusting the instrument panel light ....... P.98 Warning lights/indicator lights ................................................ P.94 When a warning light turns on ............................................. P.478 Multi-information display .................................................. P.103 Display ................................................................................. P.103 Energy monitor..................................................................... P.109
COROLLA HV_U

16

Pictorial index

When a warning message is displayed................................ P.487
Turn signal lever................................................................. P.166 Headlight switch ................................................................ P.173 Headlights/parking lights/tail lights/side marker lights/daytime running lights ............................................................................. P.173
Windshield wiper and washer switch............................... P.178 Usage................................................................................... P.178 Adding washer fluid.............................................................. P.440
Emergency flasher switch................................................. P.470
Hood lock release lever ..................................................... P.432
Tilt and telescopic steering lock release lever................ P.138
Air conditioning system .................................................... P.386 Usage................................................................................... P.386 Rear window defogger ......................................................... P.387
Audio ................................................................................... P.253 Audio Plus* *: Refer to "NAVIGATION AND MULTIMEDIA SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL".

COROLLA HV_U

Switches

Pictorial index

17

Instrument panel light control dial ................................... P.101 Automatic High Beam switch ........................................... P.175 Heated steering wheel switch*.......................................... P.394 Windshield wiper de-icer switch* ..................................... P.390 Fuel filler door opener switch ........................................... P.181 Outside rear view mirror switch ....................................... P.140 Door lock switches ............................................................ P.121 Power window switches .................................................... P.142 Window lock switch ........................................................... P.144 *: If equipped

COROLLA HV_U

18

Pictorial index

Meter control switches ...................................................... P.103
Vehicle-to-vehicle distance switch ................................... P.213
Cruise control switches Dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range ............. P.207 Audio remote control switches* ....................................... P.319
LTA (Lane Tracing Assist) switch ..................................... P.197 Phone switch*..................................................................... P.346 Talk switch*......................................................................... P.334 *: Vehicles with Audio Plus, refer to "NAVIGATION AND MULTIMEDIA SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL".

COROLLA HV_U

Pictorial index

19

Seat heater switches* ........................................................ P.394 Wireless charger switch*................................................... P.402 Brake hold switch .............................................................. P.170 Parking brake switch ......................................................... P.167 Precautions for winter season.............................................. P.248 EV drive mode switch ........................................................ P.162 VSC OFF switch ................................................................ P.241 Driving mode select switch............................................... P.239 *: If equipped

COROLLA HV_U

20

Pictorial index

Interior

SRS airbags .......................................................................... P.31 Floor mats............................................................................. P.24 Front seats.......................................................................... P.133 Head restraints ................................................................... P.136 Seat belts .............................................................................. P.27 Console box ....................................................................... P.399 Inside lock buttons ............................................................ P.121 Cup holders ........................................................................ P.398 Rear seats ........................................................................... P.134 Rear seat heater switches*................................................ P.394 *: If equipped
COROLLA HV_U

Ceiling

Pictorial index

21

Inside rear view mirror ...................................................... P.139 Sun visors........................................................................... P.409 Vanity mirrors ..................................................................... P.409 Vanity lights ........................................................................ P.409 Interior lights/personal lights ........................................... P.395 "SOS" button*....................................................................... P.73 Assist grips ........................................................................ P.410 *: If equipped

COROLLA HV_U

22

Pictorial index

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

1 For safety and security
.1-1. For safe use Before driving.................24 For safe driving ..............25 Seat belts .......................27 SRS airbags ...................31 Front passenger occupant classification system ....41 Exhaust gas precautions ..................................... 46
1-2. Child safety Riding with children ........47 Child restraint systems... 48
1-3. Emergency assistance Safety Connect ..............73
1-4. Hybrid system Hybrid system features ..80 Hybrid system precautions ..................................... 83
1-5. Theft deterrent system Immobilizer system ........88 Alarm.............................. 90

23
1

COROLLA HV_U

24

1-1. For safe use

1-1.For safe use
Before driving

Observe the following before starting off in the vehicle to ensure safety of driving.

Floor mat
Use only floor mats designed specifically for vehicles of the same model and model year as your vehicle. Fix them securely in place onto the carpet.
1 Insert the retaining hooks (clips) into the floor mat eyelets.

2 Turn the upper knob of each retaining hook (clip) to secure
the floor mats in place.

The shape of the retaining hooks (clips) may differ from that shown in the illustration.
WARNING Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may cause the driver's floor mat to slip, possibly interfering with the pedals while driving. An unexpectedly high speed may result or it may become difficult to stop the vehicle. This could lead to an accident, resulting in death or serious injury.
 When installing the driver's floor mat
 Do not use floor mats designed for other models or different model year vehicles, even if they are Toyota Genuine floor mats.
 Only use floor mats designed for the driver's seat.
 Always install the floor mat securely using the retaining hooks (clips) provided.
 Do not use two or more floor mats on top of each other.
 Do not place the floor mat bottom-side up or upside-down.

Always align the marks . COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

WARNING
 Before driving Check that the floor mat is
securely fixed in the correct place with all the provided retaining hooks (clips). Be especially careful to perform this check after cleaning the floor.

1-1. For safe use

25

For safe driving

For safe driving, adjust the seat and mirror to an appropriate position before driving.
1
Correct driving posture

With the hybrid system stopped and the shift lever in P, fully depress each pedal to the floor to make sure it does not interfere with the floor mat.

Adjust the angle of the seatback so that you are sitting straight up and so that you do not have to lean forward to steer. (P.133)
Adjust the seat so that you can depress the pedals fully and so that your arms bend slightly at the elbow when gripping the steering wheel. (P.133)
Lock the head restraint in place with the center of the head restraint closest to the top of your ears. (P.136)
Wear the seat belt correctly. (P.27)

COROLLA HV_U

26

1-1. For safe use

WARNING  For safe driving Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury. Do not adjust the position of the
driver's seat while driving. Doing so could cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Do not place a cushion between the driver or passenger and the seatback. A cushion may prevent correct posture from being achieved, and reduce the effectiveness of the seat belt and head restraint. Do not place anything under the front seats. Objects placed under the front seats may become jammed in the seat tracks and stop the seat from locking in place. This may lead to an accident and the adjustment mechanism may also be damaged. Always observe the legal speed limit when driving on public roads. When driving over long distances, take regular breaks before you start to feel tired. Also, if you feel tired or sleepy while driving, do not force yourself to continue driving and take a break immediately. Take care when adjusting the seat position to ensure that other passengers are not injured by the moving seat. When adjusting the seat position, do not put your hands under the seat or near the moving parts to avoid injury. Fingers or hands may become jammed in the seat mechanism.

Correct use of the seat belts
Make sure that all occupants are wearing their seat belts before driving the vehicle. (P.27) Use a child restraint system appropriate for the child until the child becomes large enough to properly wear the vehicle's seat belt. (P.48)
Adjusting the mirrors
Make sure that you can see backward clearly by adjusting the inside and outside rear view mirrors properly. (P.139, 140)

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

Seat belts
Make sure that all occupants are wearing their seat belts before driving the vehicle.
WARNING Observe the following precautions to reduce the risk of injury in the event of sudden braking, sudden swerving or an accident. Failure to do so may cause death or serious injury.  Wearing a seat belt Ensure that all passengers wear
a seat belt. Always wear a seat belt prop-
erly. Each seat belt should be used
by one person only. Do not use a seat belt for more than one person at once, including children. Toyota recommends that children be seated in the rear seat and always use a seat belt and/or an appropriate child restraint system. To achieve a proper seating position, do not recline the seat more than necessary. The seat belt is most effective when the occupants are sitting up straight and well back in the seats. Do not wear the shoulder belt under your arm. Always wear your seat belt low and snug across your hips.

1-1. For safe use

27

 Pregnant women

1

Obtain medical advice and wear the seat belt in the proper way.
(P.28)
Women who are pregnant should position the lap belt as low as possible over the hips in the same manner as other occupants, extending the shoulder belt completely over the shoulder and avoiding belt contact with the rounding of the abdominal area. If the seat belt is not worn properly, not only the pregnant woman, but also the fetus could suffer death or serious injury as a result of sudden braking or a collision.
 People suffering illness Obtain medical advice and wear the seat belt in the proper way.
(P.28)
 When children are in the vehicle
P.63
 Seat belt damage and wear  Do not damage the seat belts
by allowing the belt, plate, or buckle to be jammed in the door.

COROLLA HV_U

28

1-1. For safe use

WARNING Inspect the seat belt system
periodically. Check for cuts, fraying, and loose parts. Do not use a damaged seat belt until it is replaced. Damaged seat belts cannot protect an occupant from death or serious injury. Ensure that the belt and plate are locked and the belt is not twisted. If the seat belt does not function correctly, immediately contact your Toyota dealer. Replace the seat assembly, including the belts, if your vehicle has been involved in a serious accident, even if there is no obvious damage. Do not attempt to install, remove, modify, disassemble or dispose of the seat belts. Have any necessary repairs carried out by your Toyota dealer. Inappropriate handling may lead to incorrect operation.

Correct use of the seat belts

 Position the lap belt as low as possible over the hips.
 Adjust the position of the seatback. Sit up straight and well back in the seat.
 Do not twist the seat belt.
 Child seat belt usage The seat belts of your vehicle were principally designed for persons of adult size.  Use a child restraint system
appropriate for the child, until the child becomes large enough to properly wear the vehicle's seat belt. (P.48)  When the child becomes large enough to properly wear the vehicle's seat belt, follow the instructions regarding seat belt usage. (P.27)  Seat belt extender If your seat belts cannot be fastened securely because they are not long enough, a personalized seat belt extender is available from your Toyota dealer free of charge.

 Extend the shoulder belt so that it comes fully over the shoulder, but does not come into contact with the neck or slide off the shoulder.

WARNING
 Using a seat belt extender  Do not wear the seat belt
extender if you can fasten the seat belt without the extender.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

WARNING Do not use the seat belt
extender when installing a child restraint system because the belt will not securely hold the child restraint system, increasing the risk of death or serious injury in the event of an accident. The personalized extender may not be safe on another vehicle, when used by another person, or at a different seating position other than the one originally intended.
NOTICE  When using a seat belt
extender When releasing the seat belt, press on the buckle release button on the extender, not on the seat belt. This helps prevent damage to the vehicle interior and the extender itself.
Fastening and releasing the seat belt

1-1. For safe use

29

 Emergency locking retractor (ELR)

The retractor will lock the belt during

a sudden stop or on impact. It may

also lock if you lean forward too

quickly. A slow, easy motion will

allow the belt to extend so that you

can move around fully.

1

 Automatic locking retractor (ALR)

When a passenger's shoulder belt is completely extended and then retracted even slightly, the belt is locked in that position and cannot be extended. This feature is used to hold the child restraint system (CRS) firmly. To free the belt again, fully retract the belt and then pull the belt out once more. (P.48)

 Rear seat belt

Use the seat belt after passing it through the guide if the seat belt comes free from the guide.

Adjusting the seat belt shoulder anchor height (front seats)

1 To fasten the seat belt, push the plate into the buckle until a click sound is heard.
2 To release the seat belt,
press the release button .

1 Push the seat belt shoulder

COROLLA HV_U

30

1-1. For safe use

anchor down while pressing
the release button .
2 Push the seat belt shoulder anchor up while pressing the
release button .
Move the height adjuster up and down as needed until you hear a click.

WARNING
 Adjustable shoulder anchor Always make sure the shoulder belt is positioned across the center of your shoulder. The belt should be kept away from your neck, but not falling off your shoulder. Failure to do so could reduce the amount of protection in an accident and cause death or serious injuries in the event of a sudden stop, sudden swerve or accident.

Seat belt pretensioners (front seats)

in the event of a minor frontal impact, a minor side impact or a rear impact.
 Replacing the belt after the pretensioner has been activated
If the vehicle is involved in multiple collisions, the pretensioner will activate for the first collision, but will not activate for the second or subsequent collisions.
WARNING  Seat belt pretensioners  Do not place anything, such as
a cushion, on the front passenger's seat. Doing so will disperse the passenger's weight, which prevents the sensor from detecting the passenger's weight properly. As a result, the seat belt pretensioner for the front passenger's seat may not activate in the event of a collision.  If the pretensioner has activated, the SRS warning light will come on. In that case, the seat belt cannot be used again and must be replaced at your Toyota dealer.

The pretensioners help the seat belts to quickly restrain the occupants by retracting the seat belts when the vehicle is subjected to certain types of severe frontal or side collision or a vehicle rollover.
The pretensioners do not activate
COROLLA HV_U

SRS airbags

1-1. For safe use

31

The SRS airbags inflate when the vehicle is subjected to certain types of severe impacts that may cause significant injury to the occupants. They work together with the seat belts to help reduce the risk of death or serious injury.
1
SRS airbag system
 Location of the SRS airbags

For safety and security

 SRS front airbags SRS driver airbag/front passenger airbag
Can help protect the head and chest of the driver and front passenger from impact with interior components
SRS knee airbag
Can help provide driver protection
SRS seat cushion airbag
Can help restrain the front passenger
 SRS side and curtain shield airbags SRS front side airbags
Can help protect the torso of the front seat occupants
COROLLA HV_U

32

1-1. For safe use

SRS rear side airbags
Can help protect the torso of occupants in the rear outer seats
SRS curtain shield airbags
· Can help protect primarily the head of occupants in the outer seats · Can help prevent the occupants from being thrown from the vehicle in the
event of vehicle rollover
 SRS airbag system components

Seat cushion airbag Front passenger occupant classification system (ECU and sensors) "AIR BAG ON" and "AIR BAG OFF" indicator lights Front passenger airbag Curtain shield airbags Side impact sensors (front doors) Front side airbags Seat belt pretensioners and force limiters Rear side airbags Side impact sensors (rear) Side impact sensors (front) Driver airbag Driver's seat belt buckle switch Driver's seat position sensor Driver's knee airbag
COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

1-1. For safe use

33

SRS warning light

Front impact sensors

Airbag sensor assembly

Your vehicle is equipped with ADVANCED AIRBAGS designed based on the US motor vehicle safety standards (FMVSS208). The airbag sensor assembly (ECU) controls airbag deployment based on 1 information obtained from the sensors etc. shown in the system components diagram above. This information includes crash severity and occupant information. As the airbags deploy, a chemical reaction in the inflators quickly fills the airbags with non-toxic gas to help restrain the motion of the occupants.

 If the SRS airbags deploy (inflate)
 Slight abrasions, burns, bruising etc., may be sustained from SRS airbags, due to the extremely high speed deployment (inflation) by hot gases.
 A loud noise and white powder will be emitted.
 Parts of the airbag module (steering wheel hub, airbag cover and inflator) as well as the front seats, parts of the front and rear pillars, and roof side rails, may be hot for several minutes. The airbag itself may also be hot.
 The windshield may crack.  The hybrid system will be stopped
and fuel supply to the engine will be stopped. (P.87)  The brakes and stop lights will be controlled automatically. (P.241)  The interior lights will turn on automatically. (P.396)  The emergency flashers will turn on automatically. (P.470)  For Safety Connect subscribers, if any of the following situations occur, the system is designed to send an emergency call to the response center, notifying them of the vehicle's location (without needing to push the "SOS" button)

and an agent will attempt to speak with the occupants to ascertain the level of emergency and assistance required. If the occupants are unable to communicate, the agent automatically treats the call as an emergency and helps to dispatch the necessary emergency services. (P.73) · An SRS airbag is deployed. · A seat belt pretensioner is activated. · The vehicle is involved in a severe rear-end collision.  SRS airbag deployment conditions (SRS front airbags)  The SRS front airbags will deploy in the event of an impact that exceeds the set threshold level (the level of force corresponding to an approximately 12 - 18 mph [20 - 30 km/h] frontal collision with a fixed wall that does not move or deform). However, this threshold velocity will be considerably higher in the following situations: · If the vehicle strikes an object, such as a parked vehicle or sign pole, which can move or deform on impact · If the vehicle is involved in an underride collision, such as a collision in which the front of the vehicle "underrides", or goes under, the bed of a truck

COROLLA HV_U

34

1-1. For safe use

 Depending on the type of collision, it is possible that only the seat belt pretensioners will activate.
 The SRS front airbags for the front passenger will not activate if there is no passenger sitting in the front passenger seat. However, the SRS front airbags for the front passenger may deploy if luggage is put in the seat, even if the seat is unoccupied.
 The SRS seat cushion airbag on the front passenger seat will not operate if the occupant is not wearing a seat belt.
 SRS airbag deployment conditions (SRS side and curtain shield airbags)
 The SRS side and curtain shield airbags will deploy in the event of an impact that exceeds the set threshold level (the level of force corresponding to the impact force produced by an approximately 3300 lb. [1500 kg] vehicle colliding with the vehicle cabin from a direction perpendicular to the vehicle orientation at an approximate speed of 12 - 18 mph [20 30 km/h]).
 Both SRS curtain shield airbags may deploy in the event of a severe side collision.
 Both SRS curtain shield airbags will deploy in the event of vehicle rollover.
 Both SRS curtain shield airbags may also deploy in the event of a severe frontal collision.
 Conditions under which the SRS airbags may deploy (inflate), other than a collision
The SRS front airbags and SRS side and curtain shield airbags may also deploy if a serious impact occurs to the underside of your vehicle. Some examples are shown in the illustration.  Hitting a curb, edge of pavement
or hard surface

 Falling into or jumping over a deep hole
 Landing hard or falling
The SRS curtain shield airbags may also deploy under the situations shown in the illustration.  The angle of vehicle tip-up is mar-
ginal.  The vehicle skids and hits a curb
stone.
 Types of collisions that may not deploy the SRS airbags (SRS front airbags)
The SRS front airbags do not generally inflate if the vehicle is involved in a side or rear collision, if it rolls over, or if it is involved in a low-speed frontal collision. But, whenever a collision of any type causes sufficient forward deceleration of the vehicle, deployment of the SRS front airbags may occur.  Collision from the side  Collision from the rear  Vehicle rollover

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

1-1. For safe use

35

involved in a rear collision, if it pitches end over end, or if it is involved in a low-speed side or low-speed frontal collision.  Collision from the rear  Pitching end over end

 Types of collisions that may not

1

deploy the SRS airbags (SRS

side and curtain shield airbags)

The SRS side and curtain shield airbags may not activate if the vehicle is subjected to a collision from the side at certain angles, or a collision to the side of the vehicle body other than the passenger compartment.

 When to contact your Toyota dealer

 Collision from the side to the vehicle body other than the passenger compartment
 Collision from the side at an angle

In the following cases, the vehicle will require inspection and/or repair. Contact your Toyota dealer as soon as possible.  Any of the SRS airbags have
been inflated.

 The front of the vehicle is damaged or deformed, or was involved in an accident that was not severe enough to cause the SRS front airbags to inflate.

The SRS side airbags do not generally inflate if the vehicle is involved in a frontal or rear collision, if it rolls over, or if it is involved in a low-speed side collision.  Collision from the front  Collision from the rear  Vehicle rollover

 A portion of a door or its surrounding area is damaged, deformed or has had a hole made in it, or the vehicle was involved in an accident that was not severe enough to cause the SRS side and curtain shield airbags to inflate.

The SRS curtain shield airbags do not generally inflate if the vehicle is

COROLLA HV_U

36

1-1. For safe use

scratched, cracked, or otherwise damaged.

 The pad section of the steering wheel, dashboard near the front passenger airbag or lower portion of the instrument panel is scratched, cracked, or otherwise damaged.
 The seat cushion surface is scratched, cracked, or otherwise damaged.
 The surface of the seats with the SRS side airbag is scratched, cracked, or otherwise damaged.
 The portion of the front pillars, rear pillars or roof side rail garnishes (padding) containing the SRS curtain shield airbags inside is

WARNING  SRS airbag precautions Observe the following precautions regarding the SRS airbags. Failure to do so may cause death or serious injury.
 The driver and all passengers in the vehicle must wear their seat belts properly. The SRS airbags are supplemental devices to be used with the seat belts.
 The SRS driver airbag deploys with considerable force, and can cause death or serious injury especially if the driver is very close to the airbag. The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) advises:
Since the risk zone for the driver's airbag is the first 2 - 3 in. (50 - 75 mm) of inflation, placing yourself 10 in. (250 mm) from your driver airbag provides you with a margin of safety. This distance is measured from the center of the steering wheel to your breastbone. If you sit less than 10 in. (250 mm) away now, you can change your driving position in several ways: · Move your seat to the rear as
far as you can while still reaching the pedals comfortably.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

WARNING · Slightly recline the back of the
seat. Although vehicle designs vary, many drivers can achieve the 10 in. (250 mm) distance, even with the driver seat all the way forward, simply by reclining the back of the seat somewhat. If reclining the back of your seat makes it hard to see the road, raise yourself by using a firm, non-slippery cushion, or raise the seat if your vehicle has that feature. · If your steering wheel is adjustable, tilt it downward. This points the airbag toward your chest instead of your head and neck. The seat should be adjusted as recommended by NHTSA above, while still maintaining control of the foot pedals, steering wheel, and your view of the instrument panel controls.

1-1. For safe use

37

 If the seat belt extender has

been connected to the front

seat belt buckles but the seat

belt extender has not also been

fastened to the latch plate of the

seat belt, the SRS front airbags

will judge that the driver and

front passenger are wearing the

seat belt even though the seat

1

belt has not been connected. In

this case, the SRS front airbags

may not activate correctly in a

collision, resulting in death or

serious injury in the event of a

collision. Be sure to wear the

seat belt with the seat belt

extender.

 The SRS front passenger airbag also deploys with considerable force, and can cause death or serious injury especially if the front passenger is very close to the airbag. The front passenger seat should be as far from the airbag as possible with the seatback adjusted, so the front passenger sits upright.

COROLLA HV_U

38

1-1. For safe use

WARNING Improperly seated and/or
restrained infants and children can be killed or seriously injured by a deploying airbag. An infant or child who is too small to use a seat belt should be properly secured using a child restraint system. Toyota strongly recommends that all infants and children be placed in the rear seats of the vehicle and properly restrained. The rear seats are safer for infants and children than the front passenger seat.
(P.48)
Do not sit on the edge of the seat or lean against the dashboard.

 Do not lean against the door, the roof side rail or the front, side and rear pillars.
 Do not allow anyone to kneel on the passenger seats toward the door or put their head or hands outside the vehicle.

Do not allow a child to stand in front of the SRS front passenger airbag unit or sit on the knees of a front passenger.

 Do not attach anything to or lean anything against areas such as the dashboard, steering wheel pad and lower portion of the instrument panel. These items can become projectiles when the SRS driver, front passenger and knee airbags deploy.

Do not allow the front seat occupants to hold items on their knees.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

WARNING Do not attach anything to areas
such as a door, windshield, side windows, front or rear pillar, roof side rail and assist grip. (Except for the speed limit label
P.492)
Do not hang hangers or other hard objects on the coat hooks. All of these items could become projectiles and may cause death or serious injury, should the SRS curtain shield airbags deploy.
If a vinyl cover is put on the area where the SRS driver's knee airbag will deploy, be sure to remove it.
Do not use seat accessories which cover the parts where the SRS side airbags and SRS seat cushion airbag inflate as they may interfere with inflation of the SRS airbags. Such accessories may prevent the side airbags and seat cushion airbag from activating correctly, disable the system or cause the side airbags and seat cushion airbag to inflate accidentally, resulting in death or serious injury.
Do not strike or apply significant levels of force to the area of the SRS airbag components or the front doors. Doing so can cause the SRS airbags to malfunction.

1-1. For safe use

39

 Do not touch any of the component parts immediately after the SRS airbags have deployed (inflated) as they may be hot.

 If breathing becomes difficult

after the SRS airbags have

deployed, open a door or win-

dow to allow fresh air in, or leave the vehicle if it is safe to

1

do so. Wash off any residue as

soon as possible to prevent skin

irritation.

 If the areas where the SRS airbags are stored, such as the steering wheel pad and front and rear pillar garnishes, are damaged or cracked, have them replaced by your Toyota dealer.

 Do not place anything, such as a cushion, on the front passenger's seat. Doing so will disperse the passenger's weight, which prevents the sensor from detecting the passenger's weight properly. As a result, the SRS front airbags for the front passenger may not deploy in the event of a collision.

 Modification and disposal of SRS airbag system components
Do not dispose of your vehicle or perform any of the following modifications without consulting your Toyota dealer. The SRS airbags may malfunction or deploy (inflate) accidentally, causing death or serious injury.

 Installation, removal, disassembly and repair of the SRS airbags

COROLLA HV_U

40

1-1. For safe use

WARNING Repairs, modifications, removal
or replacement of the steering wheel, instrument panel, dashboard, seats or seat upholstery, front, side and rear pillars, roof side rails, front door panels, front door trims or front door speakers Modifications to the front door panel (such as making a hole in it) Repairs or modifications of the front fender, front bumper, or side of the occupant compartment Installation of a grille guard (bull bars, kangaroo bar, etc.), snow plows, winches or roof luggage carrier Modifications to the vehicle's suspension system Installation of electronic devices such as mobile two-way radios and CD players Modifications to your vehicle for a person with a physical disability

COROLLA HV_U

1-1. For safe use

41

Front passenger occupant classification system

Your vehicle is equipped with a front passenger occupant

classification system. This system detects the conditions of

the front passenger seat and activates or deactivates the front

passenger airbag and seat cushion airbag in the front passen-

ger side.

1

System components

For safety and security

SRS warning light Front passenger seat belt reminder light "AIR BAG OFF" indicator light "AIR BAG ON" indicator light

WARNING  Front passenger occupant
classification system precautions Observe the following precautions regarding the front passenger occupant classification system. Failure to do so may cause death or serious injury.
Wear the seat belt properly.

 Make sure the front passenger's seat belt latch plate has not been left inserted into the buckle before someone sits in the front passenger seat.

COROLLA HV_U

42

1-1. For safe use

WARNING Make sure the "AIR BAG OFF"
indicator light is not illuminated when using the seat belt extender for the front passenger seat. If the "AIR BAG OFF" indicator light is illuminated, disconnect the extender tongue from the seat belt buckle, and reconnect the seat belt. Reconnect the seat belt extender after making sure the "AIR BAG ON" indicator light is illuminated. If you use the seat belt extender while the "AIR BAG OFF" indicator light is illuminated, the SRS airbags for the front passenger may not activate, which could cause death or serious injury in the event of a collision. Do not apply a heavy load to the front passenger seat or equipment (e.g. seatback pocket). Do not put weight on the front passenger seat by putting your hands or feet on the front passenger seat seatback from the rear passenger seat. Do not let a rear passenger lift the front passenger seat with their feet or press on the seatback with their legs. Do not put objects under the front passenger seat.

 Do not recline the front passenger seatback so far that it touches the rear seat. This may cause the "AIR BAG OFF" indicator light to be illuminated, which indicates that the SRS airbags for the front passenger will not activate in the event of a severe accident. If the seatback touches the rear seat, return the seatback to a position where it does not touch the rear seat. Keep the front passenger seatback as upright as possible when the vehicle is moving. Reclining the seatback excessively may lessen the effectiveness of the seat belt system.
 If an adult sits in the front passenger seat, the "AIR BAG ON" indicator light is illuminated. If the "AIR BAG OFF" indicator is illuminated, ask the passenger to sit up straight, well back in the seat, feet on the floor, and with the seat belt worn correctly. If the "AIR BAG OFF" indicator still remains illuminated, either ask the passenger to move to the rear seat, or if that is not possible, move the front passenger seat fully rearward.
 When it is unavoidable to install a forward-facing child restraint system on the front passenger seat, install the child restraint system on the front passenger seat in the proper order.
(P.50)
 Do not modify or remove the front seats.
 Do not kick the front passenger seat or subject it to severe impact. Otherwise, the SRS warning light may come on to indicate a malfunction of the front passenger occupant classification system. In this case, contact your Toyota dealer immediately.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

WARNING Child restraint systems installed
on the rear seat should not contact the front seatbacks. Do not use a seat accessory, such as a cushion and seat cover, that covers the seat cushion surface. Do not modify or replace the upholstery of the front seat.

1-1. For safe use

43

1

Condition and operation in the front passenger occupant classification system

 Adult*1

Indicator/warning light
Devices

"AIR BAG ON" and "AIR BAG OFF" indicator lights
SRS warning light
Front passenger's seat belt reminder light
Front passenger airbag
Seat cushion airbag in the front passenger side

"AIR BAG ON"
Off
Off*2 or flashing*3
Activated Activated*2 or deactivated*3

 Child*4

Indicator/warning light
Devices

"AIR BAG ON" and "AIR BAG OFF" indicator lights SRS warning light
Front passenger's seat belt reminder light
Front passenger airbag
Seat cushion airbag in the front passenger side

"AIR BAG OFF" or "AIR BAG ON"*4
Off
Off*2 or flashing*3
Deactivated or activated*4
Deactivated or activated*4, 2

COROLLA HV_U

44

1-1. For safe use

 Child restraint system with infant*5

Indicator/warning light
Devices

"AIR BAG ON" and "AIR BAG OFF" indicator lights
SRS warning light
Front passenger's seat belt reminder light
Front passenger airbag
Seat cushion airbag in the front passenger side

"AIR BAG OFF"*6 Off
Off*2 or flashing*3
Deactivated

 Unoccupied

Indicator/warning light
Devices

"AIR BAG ON" and "AIR BAG OFF" indicator lights
SRS warning light
Front passenger's seat belt reminder light
Front passenger airbag
Seat cushion airbag in the front passenger side

"AIR BAG OFF" Off
Deactivated

 There is a malfunction in the system

Indicator/warning light

"AIR BAG ON" and "AIR BAG OFF" indicator lights
SRS warning light
Front passenger's seat belt reminder light

"AIR BAG OFF" On

Devices

Front passenger airbag
Seat cushion airbag in the front passenger side

Deactivated

*1: The system judges a person of adult size as an adult. When a smaller adult sits in the front passenger seat, the system may not recognize him/her as an adult depending on his/her physique and posture.
*2: In the event the front passenger is wearing a seat belt.
*3: In the event the front passenger does not wear a seat belt.
*4: For some children, child in seat, child in booster seat or child in convert-

COROLLA HV_U

1-1. For safe use

45

ible seat, the system may not recognize him/her as a child. Factors which may affect this can be the physique or posture.

*5: Never install a rear-facing child restraint system on the front passenger seat. A forward-facing child restraint system should only be installed on the front passenger seat when it is unavoidable. (P.48)

*6: In case the indicator light is not illuminated, consult this manual on how

to install the child restraint system properly. (P.48)

1

For safety and security

COROLLA HV_U

46

1-1. For safe use

Exhaust gas precautions

Harmful substance to the human body is included in exhaust gases if inhaled.

WARNING Exhaust gases include harmful carbon monoxide (CO), which is colorless and odorless. Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may cause exhaust gases enter the vehicle and may lead to an accident caused by light-headedness, or may lead to death or a serious health hazard.
 Important points while driving Keep the trunk lid closed. If you smell exhaust gases in
the vehicle even when the trunk lid is closed, open the windows and have the vehicle inspected at your Toyota dealer as soon as possible.
 When parking If the vehicle is in a poorly venti-
lated area or a closed area, such as a garage, stop the hybrid system.
Do not leave the vehicle with the hybrid system on for a long time. If such a situation cannot be avoided, park the vehicle in an open space and ensure that exhaust fumes do not enter the vehicle interior.

 Do not leave the hybrid system operating in an area with snow build-up, or where it is snowing. If snowbanks build up around the vehicle while the hybrid system is operating, exhaust gases may collect and enter the vehicle.
 Exhaust pipe The exhaust system needs to be checked periodically. If there is a hole or crack caused by corrosion, damage to a joint or abnormal exhaust noise, be sure to have the vehicle inspected and repaired by your Toyota dealer.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

1-2.Child safety
Riding with children
Observe the following precautions when children are in the vehicle. Use a child restraint system appropriate for the child, until the child becomes large enough to properly wear the vehicle's seat belt.
 It is recommended that children sit in the rear seats to avoid accidental contact with the shift lever, wiper switch, etc.
 Use the rear door child-protector lock or the window lock switch to avoid children opening the door while driving or operating the power window accidentally. (P.122, 144)
 Do not let small children operate equipment which may catch or pinch body parts, such as the power window, hood, trunk, seats, etc.

1-2. Child safety

47

WARNING

 When children are in the vehicle

Never leave children unattended in the vehicle, and never allow children to have or use the key.

Children may be able to start the vehicle or shift the vehicle into

1

neutral. There is also a danger

that children may injure them-

selves by playing with the win-

dows or other features of the

vehicle. In addition, heat build-up

or extremely cold temperatures

inside the vehicle can be fatal to

children.

COROLLA HV_U

48

1-2. Child safety

Child restraint systems

Before installing a child restraint system in the vehicle, there are precautions that need to be observed, different types of child restraint systems, as well as installation methods, etc., written in this manual.
Use a child restraint system when riding with a small child that cannot properly use a seat belt. For the child's safety, install the child restraint system to a rear seat. Be sure to follow the installation method that is in the operation manual enclosed with the restraint system.

Table of contents
Points to remember: P.48
Child restraint system: P.50
When using a child restraint system: P.52
Child restraint system compatibility for each seating position (for Puerto Rico): P.54
Child restraint system installation method · Fixed with a seat belt: P.59 · Fixed with a child restraint
LATCH anchor (except for Puerto Rico): P.64 · Fixed with an ISOFIX lower

anchorage (for Puerto Rico): P.66 · Using an anchor bracket (for top tether strap) (except for Puerto Rico): P.68 · Using a top tether anchorage (for Puerto Rico): P.70
Points to remember
The laws of all 50 states of the U.S.A. as well as Canada now require the use of child restraint systems.
 Prioritize and observe the warnings, as well as the laws and regulations for child restraint systems.
 Use a child restraint system until the child becomes large enough to properly wear the vehicle's seat belt.
 Choose a child restraint system that suits your vehicle and is appropriate to the age and size of the child.
WARNING
 When a child is riding Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

WARNING For effective protection in auto-
mobile accidents and sudden stops, a child must be properly restrained, using a seat belt or child restraint system which is correctly installed. For installation details, refer to the operation manual enclosed with the child restraint system. General installation instruction is provided in this manual. Toyota strongly urges the use of a proper child restraint system that conforms to the weight and size of the child, installed on the rear seat. According to accident statistics, the child is safer when properly restrained in the rear seat than in the front seat. Holding a child in your or someone else's arms is not a substitute for a child restraint system. In an accident, the child can be crushed against the windshield or between the holder and the interior of the vehicle.  Handling the child restraint system If the child restraint system is not properly fixed in place, the child or other passengers may be seriously injured or even killed in the event of sudden braking, sudden swerving, or an accident. If the vehicle were to receive a strong impact from an accident, etc., it is possible that the child restraint system has damage that is not readily visible. In such cases, do not reuse the restraint system.

1-2. Child safety

49

 For Puerto Rico: Depending on

the child restraint system, instal-

lation may be difficult or impos-

sible. In those cases, check

whether the child restraint sys-

tem is suitable for installment in

the vehicle. (P.54) Be sure to

install and observe the usage

rules after carefully reading the

1

child restraint system fixing

method in this manual, as well

as the operation manual

enclosed with the child restraint

system.

 Except for Puerto Rico: Make sure you have complied with all installation instructions provided with the child restraint system manufacturer and that the system is properly secured.

 Keep the child restraint system properly secured on the seat even if it is not in use. Do not store the child restraint system unsecured in the passenger compartment.

 If it is necessary to detach the child restraint system, remove it from the vehicle or store it securely in the trunk.

COROLLA HV_U

50

1-2. Child safety

Child restraint system

 Types of child restraint system installation methods
Confirm with the operation manual enclosed with the child restraint system about the installation of the child restraint system.

Installation method

Page

Seat belt attachment

P.59

COROLLA HV_U

Installation method

1-2. Child safety

51

Page

Except for Puerto Rico: Child restraint LATCH anchors attachment
For Puerto Rico: ISOFIX lower anchor-
age attachment
Except for Puerto Rico For Puerto Rico

1 P.64, 66

For safety and security

COROLLA HV_U

52

1-2. Child safety

Installation method
Seats with an adjustable type head restraint:

Page

Except for Puerto Rico:

Anchor brackets (for top tether strap) attach-

Except for Puerto Rico

ment

For Puerto Rico

Seats with an integrated type head

For Puerto Rico: restraint:

Top tether anchorage

attachment

P.68, 70

Except for Puerto Rico For Puerto Rico

When using a child restraint system
 When installing a child restraint system to a front passenger seat
For the safety of a child, install a child restraint system to a rear seat. When installing a child restraint system to a front passenger seat is unavoidable, adjust the seat as follows and

install the child restraint system:
 Move the front seat fully rearward.
 If the passenger seat height can be adjusted, Adjust the seat height to the upper most position.
 Adjust the seatback angle to the most upright position.
If there is a gap between the child seat and the seatback, adjust the

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

seatback angle until good contact is achieved.
 If the head restraint interferes with the child restraint system installation and the head restraint can be removed, remove the head restraint.
Otherwise, put the head restraint in the upper most position.
WARNING  When using a child restraint
system Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury. Never install a rear-facing child
restraint system on the front passenger seat even if the "AIR BAG OFF" indicator light is illuminated. In the event of an accident, the force of the rapid inflation of the front passenger airbag can cause death or serious injury to the child if the rear-facing child restraint system is installed on the front passenger seat.

1-2. Child safety

53

 A forward-facing child restraint

system may be installed on the

front passenger seat only when

it is unavoidable. A child

restraint system that requires a

top tether strap should not be

used in the front passenger seat

since there is no top tether strap

anchor for the front passenger

1

seat.

 A forward-facing child restraint system may be installed on the front passenger seat only when it is unavoidable. When installing a forward-facing child restraint system on the front passenger seat, adjust the seatback angle to the most upright position, move the seat to the rearmost position, and raise the seat to the upper most position, even if the "AIR BAG OFF" indicator light is illuminated. If the head restraint interferes with the child restraint system installation and the head restraint can be removed, remove the head restraint.

COROLLA HV_U

54

1-2. Child safety

WARNING Do not allow the child to lean
his/her head or any part of his/her body against the door or the area of the seat, front or rear pillars, or roof side rails from which the SRS side airbags or SRS curtain shield airbags deploy even if the child is seated in the child restraint system. It is dangerous if the SRS side and curtain shield airbags inflate, and the impact could cause death or serious injury to the child.

 If the driver's seat interferes with the child restraint system and prevents it from being attached correctly, attach the child restraint system to the right-hand rear seat.
 Adjust the front passenger seat so that it does not interfere with the child restraint system.

When a booster seat is installed, always ensure that the shoulder belt is positioned across the center of the child's shoulder. The belt should be kept away from the child's neck, but not so that it could fall off the child's shoulder.
Use child restraint system suitable to the age and size of the child and install it to the rear seat.

Child restraint system compatibility for each seating position (for Puerto Rico)
 Child restraint system compatibility for each seating position
Compatibility of each seating position with child restraint systems (P.56) displays the type of child restraint systems that can be used and possible seating positions for installation using symbols. Also, the recommended child restraint system that is suitable for your child can be selected. Otherwise, check [Recommended child restraint systems and Compatibility table] for recommended child restraint systems. (P.58) Check the selected child

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

restraint system together with the following [Before confirming the compatibility of each seating position with child restraint systems].
 Before confirming the compatibility of each seating position with child restraint systems
1 Checking the child restraint system standards. Use a child restraint system that conforms to UN(ECE) R44*1 or UN(ECE) R129*1, 2. The following approval mark is displayed on child restraint systems which are conformed. Check for an approval mark attached to the child restraint system.

1-2. Child safety

55

who is applicable for an UN(ECE) R44 approval mark is indicated.

UN(ECE) R129 approval

mark*3

The height range of the child

who is applicable as well as

1

available weights for an

UN(ECE) R129 approval

mark is indicated.

2 Checking the category of the child restraint system. Check the approval mark of the child restraint system for which of the following categories the child restraint system is suitable. Also, if there are any uncertainties, check the user's guide included with the child restraint system or contact the retailer of the child restraint system.
· "universal" · "semi-universal" · "restricted" · "vehicle specific"

Example of the displayed regulation number
UN(ECE) R44 approval mark*3 The weight range of the child

*1: UN(ECE) R44 and UN(ECE) R129 are U.N. regulations for child restraint systems.
*2: The child restraint systems men-

COROLLA HV_U

56

1-2. Child safety

tioned in the table may not be available outside of the EU area.
*3: The displayed mark may differ depending on the product.
 Compatibility of each seating position with child restraint systems

*1, 2, 3 *3

Suitable for "universal" category child restraint system fixed with the seat belt. Suitable for child restraint systems given on recommended child restraint systems and compatibility table (P.58).
Suitable for i-Size and ISOFIX child restraint system.
Includes a top tether anchorage point.
*1: Move the front seat fully rearward. If the passenger seat height can be adjusted, move it to the upper most position.
*2: Adjust the seatback angle to the most upright position. When installing a forward-facing child seat, if there is a gap between the child seat and the seatback, adjust the seatback angle until good contact is achieved.

*3

*3: If the head restraint interferes

with your child restraint system,

and the head restraint can be

removed, remove the head

restraint.

Otherwise, put the head restraint

in the upper most position.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

1-2. Child safety

57

 Detail information for child restraint systems installation

Seating position

Vehicle with front pas-

Seat position number

senger occupant detection system

1

Passenger airbag indicator light

ON

OFF*

Yes

Seating position suitable for universal belted (Yes/No) Forward fac-

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

ing only

i-Size seating position (Yes/No)

No

No Yes No Yes

Seating position suitable for lateral fixture (L1/L2/No)

No

No No No No

Suitable rearward facing fixture (R1/R2X/R2/R3/No)

No

R1,

R1,

No R2X, No R2X,

R2

R2

Suitable forward facing fixture (F2X/F2/F3/No)

No

No

F2X, F2, F3

No

F2X, F2, F3

Suitable junior seat fixture (B2/B3/No)

No

No B2, B3 No B2, B3

*: When it is unavoidable to install a rear-facing child restraint system on the front passenger seat, a child restraint system can be installed it the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is lit.
ISOFIX child restraint systems are divided into different "fixture". The child restraint system can be used in the seating positions for "fixture" mentioned in the table above. For kind of "fixture" relation, confirm the following table. If your child restraint system has no kind of "fixture" (or if you cannot find information in the table below), please refer to the child restraint system "vehicle list" for compatibility information or ask the retailer of your child seat.

COROLLA HV_U

58

1-2. Child safety

Fixture F3 F2 F2X R3 R2 R2X R1 L1 L2 B2 B3

Description Full-height, forward-facing child restraint systems Reduced-height forward-facing child restraint systems Reduced-height forward-facing child restraint systems Full-size, rearward-facing child restraint systems Reduced-size, rearward-facing child restraint systems Reduced-size, rearward-facing child restraint systems Rearward-facing infant seat Left lateral-facing (carrycot) infant seat Right lateral-facing (carrycot) infant seat Junior seat Junior seat

 Recommended child restraint systems and Compatibility table

Seating position

Mass groups

Recommended
Child Restraint System

Vehicle with front passenger occupant detection system
Passenger airbag indicator light

ON

OFF*

0, 0+ Up to 28 lb. (13 kg)

MIDI 2 (Yes/No)

No

No

Yes No Yes

I 20 to 39 lb. (9 to 18 kg)

MIDI 2 (Yes/No)

No

No

Yes No Yes

*: When it is unavoidable to install a rear-facing child restraint system on the front passenger seat, a child restraint system can be installed it the PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF indicator lamp is lit.
The child restraint systems mentioned in the table may not be avail-

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

able outside the LATIN area.
When securing some types of child restraint systems in rear seat, it may not be possible to properly use the seat belts in positions next to the child restraint without interfering with it or affecting seat belt effectiveness. Be sure your seat belt fits snugly across your shoulder and low on your hips. If it does not, or if it interferes with the child restraint, move to a different position. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.
 When installing a child restraint in the rear seats, adjust the front seat so that it does not interfere with the child or child restraint system.
 When installing a child seat with support base, if the child seat interferes with the seatback when latching it into the support base, adjust the seatback rearward until there is no interference.
 If the seat belt shoulder anchor is ahead of the child seat belt guide, move the seat cushion forward.

1-2. Child safety

59

1
 When installing a junior seat, if the child in your child restraint system is in a very upright position, adjust the seatback angle to the most comfortable position. And if the seat belt shoulder anchor is ahead of the child seat belt guide, move the seat cushion forward.
Child restraint system fixed with a seat belt
A child restraint system for a small child or baby must itself be properly restrained on the seat with the lap portion of the lap/shoulder belt.
 Installing child restraint system using a seat belt (child restraint lock function belt)
Install the child restraint system in accordance to the operation manual enclosed with the child restraint system. For Puerto Rico: If the child restraint system on hand is not within the "universal" category

COROLLA HV_U

60

1-2. Child safety

(or the necessary information is not in the table), refer to the "Vehicle List" provided by the child restraint system maker for various possible installation positions, or check the compatibility after asking the retailer of the child seat. (P.55, 56)
 Rear-facing  Infant seat/convertible seat
1 Place the child restraint system on the rear seat facing the rear of the vehicle.

in lock mode. In lock mode, the belt cannot be extended.
4 While pushing the child restraint system down into the rear seat, allow the shoulder belt to retract until the child restraint system is securely in place.
After the shoulder belt has retracted to a point where there is no slack in the belt, pull the belt to check that it cannot be extended.

2 Run the seat belt through the child restraint system and
insert the plate into the
buckle. Make sure that the
belt is not twisted.

3 Fully extend the shoulder belt and allow it to retract to put it

5 After installing the child restraint system, rock it back and forth to ensure that it is installed securely. (P.63)
 Forward-facing  Convertible seat
1 If installing the child restraint system to the front passenger seat is unavoidable, refer to P.52for the front passenger seat adjustment.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

2 If the head restraint interferes with your child restraint system, and the head restraint can be removed, remove the head restraint. Otherwise, put the head restraint in the upper most position. (P.136)

1-2. Child safety

61

buckle. Make sure that the belt is not twisted.

1

5 Fully extend the shoulder belt and allow it to retract to put it in lock mode. In lock mode, the belt cannot be extended.
3 Place the child restraint system on the seat facing the front of the vehicle.

4 Run the seat belt through the child restraint system and
insert the plate into the

6 While pushing the child restraint system into the rear seat, allow the shoulder belt to retract until the child restraint system is securely in place.
After the shoulder belt has retracted to a point where there is no slack in the belt, pull the belt to

COROLLA HV_U

62

1-2. Child safety

check that it cannot be extended.

3 Place the child restraint system on the seat facing the front of the vehicle.
 Booster type

7 If the child restraint has a top tether strap, follow the child restraint manufacturer's operation manual regarding the installation, using the top tether strap to latch onto the top tether strap anchor. (P.68)
8 After installing the child restraint system, rock it back and forth to ensure that it is installed securely. (P.63)
 Booster seat
1 If installing the child restraint system to the front passenger seat is unavoidable, refer to P.52for the front passenger seat adjustment.
2 High back type: If the head restraint interferes with your child restraint system, and the head restraint can be removed, remove the head restraint. Otherwise, put the head restraint in the upper most position. (P.136)

 High back type
4 Sit the child in the child restraint system. Fit the seat belt to the child restraint system according to the manufacturer's instructions and insert the plate into the buckle. Make sure that the belt is not twisted.
Check that the shoulder belt is correctly positioned over the child's shoulder and that the lap belt is as

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

low as possible. (P.27)
 Removing a child restraint system installed with a seat belt
Press the buckle release button and fully retract the seat belt.
When releasing the buckle, the child restraint system may spring up due to the rebound of the seat cushion. Release the buckle while holding down the child restraint system. Since the seat belt automatically reels itself, slowly return it to the stowing position.
WARNING  When installing a child
restraint system Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.

1-2. Child safety

63

 Do not allow children to play

with the seat belt. If the seat belt

becomes twisted around a

child's neck, it may lead to

choking or other serious injuries

that could result in death.

If this occurs and the buckle

cannot be unfastened, scissors

should be used to cut the belt.

1

 Ensure that the belt and plate are securely locked and the seat belt is not twisted.

 Shake the child restraint system left and right, and forward and backward to ensure that it has been securely installed.

 After securing a child restraint system, never adjust the seat.

 When a booster seat is installed, always ensure that the shoulder belt is positioned across the center of the child's shoulder. The belt should be kept away from the child's neck, but not so that it could fall off the child's shoulder.

 Follow all installation instructions provided by the child restraint system manufacturer.

 When securing some types of child restraint systems in rear seats, it may not be possible to properly use the seat belts in positions next to the child restraint without interfering with it or affecting seat belt effectiveness. Be sure your seat belt fits snugly across your shoulder and low on your hips. If it does not, or if it interferes with the child restraint, move to a different position. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.

COROLLA HV_U

64

1-2. Child safety

WARNING
 When installing a booster seat
To prevent the belt from going into ALR lock mode, do not fully extend the shoulder belt. ALR mode causes the belt to tighten only. This could cause injury or discomfort to the child. (P.29)
 Do not use a seat belt extender
If a seat belt extender is used when installing a child restraint system, the seat belt will not securely hold the child restraint system, which could cause death or serious injury to the child or other passengers in the event of sudden braking, sudden swerving or an accident.

Child restraint system fixed with a child restraint LATCH anchor (except for Puerto Rico)
 Child restraint LATCH anchors
LATCH anchors are provided for the outboard rear seat. (Marks displaying the location of the anchors are attached to the seats.)

 When installing in the rear outboard seats
Install the child restraint system in accordance to the operation manual enclosed with the child restraint system.
1 If the head restraint interferes with your child restraint system, and the head restraint can be removed, remove the head restraint. Otherwise, put the head restraint in the upper most position. (P.136)
 With flexible lower attachments
2 Remove the anchor covers, and install the child restraint system to the seat.
The bars are installed behind the anchor covers.
For owners in Canada: The symbol on a child restraint system indicates the presence of a lower connector system.

COROLLA HV_U

Canada only

For safety and security

 With rigid lower attachments
2 Remove the anchor covers, and install the child restraint system to the seat.
The bars are installed behind the anchor covers. For owners in Canada: The symbol on a child restraint system indicates the presence of a lower connector system.

1-2. Child safety

65

However, the inboard LATCH

anchors of the outboard seats,

which are 15.6 in. (396 mm)

apart, can be used if the child

restraint system manufacturer's

instructions permit use of those

anchors with the anchor spacing stated.

1

Child restraint systems with rigid lower attachments cannot be installed in the center seat. This type of child restraint system can only be installed in the outboard seat.

Canada only
3 If the child restraint has a top tether strap, follow the child restraint manufacturer's operation manual regarding the installation, using the top tether strap to latch onto the top tether strap anchor. (P.68)
4 After installing the child restraint system, rock it back and forth to ensure that it is installed securely. (P.63)
 When installing in the rear center seat
There are no LATCH anchors behind the rear center seat.

 Laws and regulations pertaining to anchors
The LATCH system conforms to FMVSS225 or CMVSS210.2. Child restraint systems conforming to FMVSS213 or CMVSS213 specifications can be used. This vehicle is designed to conform to SAE J1819.
WARNING  When installing a child
restraint system Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.  When using the LATCH
anchors, be sure that there are no foreign objects around the anchors and that the seat belt is not caught behind the child restraint system.  Follow all installation instructions provided by the child restraint system manufacturer.

COROLLA HV_U

66

1-2. Child safety

WARNING Never attach two child restraint
system attachments to the same anchor. In a collision, one anchor may not be strong enough to hold two child restraint system attachments and may break. If the LATCH anchors are already in use, use the seat belt to install a child restraint system in the center seat. When securing some types of child restraint systems in rear seats, it may not be possible to properly use the seat belts in positions next to the child restraint without interfering with it or affecting seat belt effectiveness. Be sure your seat belt fits snugly across your shoulder and low on your hips. If it does not, or if it interferes with the child restraint, move to a different position. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury. If the seat is adjusted, reconfirm the security of the child restraint system.

Child restraint system fixed with an ISOFIX lower anchorage (for Puerto Rico)
 ISOFIX lower anchorages (ISOFIX child restraint system)
Lower anchorages are provided for the outboard rear seats. (Marks displaying the location of the anchorages are attached to the seats.)

 When installing in the rear outboard seats
Install the child restraint system in accordance to the operation manual enclosed with the child restraint system. If the child restraint system on hand is not within the "universal" category (or the necessary information is not in the table), refer to the "Vehicle List" provided by the child restraint system maker for various possible installation positions, or check the compatibility after asking the retailer of the child seat. (P.55, 56)
1 If the head restraint interferes with your child restraint system, and the head restraint can be removed, remove the head restraint. Otherwise, put the head restraint in the upper most position. (P.136)
 With flexible lower attachments
2 Remove the anchorage covers, and install the child restraint system to the seat.
The bars are installed behind the

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

anchorage covers.
 With rigid lower attachments 2 Remove the anchorage cov-
ers, and install the child restraint system to the seat.
The bars are installed behind the anchorage covers.

1-2. Child safety

67

4 After installing the child restraint system, rock it back and forth to ensure that it is installed securely. (P.63)
 When installing in the rear center seat
There are no lower anchorages 1 behind the rear center seat. However, the inboard lower anchorages of the outboard seats, which are 15.6 in. (396 mm) apart, can be used if the child restraint system manufacturer's instructions permit use of those anchorages with the anchorage spacing stated.
Child restraint systems with rigid lower attachments cannot be installed in the center seat. This type of child restraint system can only be installed in the outboard seat.

 When using a "MIDI 2" Adjust the support leg and ISOFIX connectors as follows:

3 If the child restraint has a top strap, follow the child restraint manufacturer's operation manual regarding the installation, using the top strap to latch onto the top strap anchorage. (P.68)

1 Lock the ISOFIX connectors where number 3 can be seen.
2 Lock the support leg where 6 holes can be seen.

COROLLA HV_U

68

1-2. Child safety

WARNING  When installing a child
restraint system Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury. When using the lower anchor-
ages, be sure that there are no foreign objects around the anchorages and that the seat belt is not caught behind the child restraint system. Follow all installation instructions provided by the child restraint system manufacturer. Never attach two child restraint system attachments to the same anchorage. In a collision, one anchorage may not be strong enough to hold two child restraint system attachments and may break. If the lower anchorages are already in use, use the seat belt to install a child restraint system in the center seat. When securing some types of child restraint systems in rear seats, it may not be possible to properly use the seat belts in positions next to the child restraint without interfering with it or affecting seat belt effectiveness. Be sure your seat belt fits snugly across your shoulder and low on your hips. If it does not, or if it interferes with the child restraint, move to a different position. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury. If the seat is adjusted, reconfirm the security of the child restraint system.

Using an anchor bracket (for top tether strap) (except for Puerto Rico)
 Anchor brackets (for top tether strap)
Anchor brackets are provided for each rear seat. Use anchor brackets when fixing the top tether strap.  Seats with an adjustable type
head restraint
Anchor brackets Top tether strap  Seats with an integrated type head restraint
Anchor brackets Top tether strap

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

 Fixing the top tether strap to the anchor bracket
Install the child restraint system in accordance to the operation manual enclosed with the child restraint system.
 Rear outboard seats
1 Adjust the head restraint to the upmost position.
If the head restraint interferes with your child restraint system, and the head restraint can be removed, remove the head restraint. Otherwise, put the head restraint in the upper most position. (P.136)
2 Open the anchor bracket cover, latch the hook onto the anchor bracket and tighten the top tether strap.
Make sure the top tether strap is securely latched. (P.63) When installing the child restraint system with the head restraint being raised, be sure to have the top tether strap pass underneath the head restraint.
 Seats with an adjustable type head restraint

1-2. Child safety

69

 Seats with an integrated type head restraint

1
Hook Top tether strap  Rear center seat Latch the hook onto the anchor bracket and tighten the top tether strap.
Make sure the top tether strap is securely latched. (P.63)

Hook Top tether strap

Hook Top tether strap
 Laws and regulations pertaining to anchors
The LATCH system conforms to FMVSS225 or CMVSS210.2. Child restraint systems conforming to FMVSS213 or CMVSS213 specifications can be used. This vehicle is designed to conform to SAE J1819.

COROLLA HV_U

70

1-2. Child safety

WARNING  When installing a child
restraint system Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury. Firmly attach the top tether
strap and make sure that the belt is not twisted. Do not attach the top tether strap to anything other than the anchor bracket. After securing a child restraint system, never adjust the seat. Follow all installation instructions provided by the child restraint system manufacturer. Outboard rear seats: When installing the child restraint system with the head restraint being raised, after the head restraint has been raised and then the anchor bracket has been fixed, do not lower the head restraint.

NOTICE  Anchor brackets (for top
tether strap) When not in use, make certain to close the lid. If it remains open, the lid may be damaged.
Using a top tether anchorage (for Puerto Rico)
 Top tether anchorages Top tether anchorages are provided for each rear seat. Use top tether anchorages when fixing the top strap.

 Seats with an adjustable type head restraint
Top tether anchorages Top strap  Seats with an integrated type head restraint
Top tether anchorages Top strap  Fixing the top strap to the top tether anchorages Install the child restraint system in accordance to the operation manual enclosed with the child restraint system.  Rear outboard seats 1 Adjust the head restraint to the upmost position.
If the head restraint interferes with your child restraint system, and the head restraint can be removed, remove the head restraint.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

Otherwise, put the head restraint in the upper most position. (P.136)
2 Open the top tether anchorage cover, latch the hook onto the top tether anchorage and tighten the top strap.
Make sure the top strap is securely latched. (P.63) When installing the child restraint system with the head restraint being raised, be sure to have the top strap pass underneath the head restraint.
 Seats with an adjustable type head restraint

1-2. Child safety

71

 Rear center seat
Latch the hook onto the top tether anchorage and tighten the top strap.
Make sure the top strap is securely latched. (P.63)
1

Hook Top strap  Seats with an integrated type head restraint
Hook Top strap

Hook Top strap
WARNING  When installing a child
restraint system Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.  Firmly attach the top strap and
make sure that the belt is not twisted.  Do not attach the top strap to anything other than the top tether anchorages.  After securing a child restraint system, never adjust the seat.  Follow all installation instructions provided by the child restraint system manufacturer.

COROLLA HV_U

72

1-2. Child safety

WARNING Outboard rear seats: When
installing the child restraint system with the head restraint being raised, after the head restraint has been raised and then the top tether anchorage has been fixed, do not lower the head restraint.

NOTICE
 Top tether anchorages When not in use, make certain to close the lid. If it remains open, the lid may be damaged.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

1-3. Emergency assistance

Safety Connect* 1-3.Emergency assistance

System components

*: If equipped
Safety Connect is a subscription-based telematics service that uses Global Positioning System (GPS) data and embedded cellular technology to provide safety and security features to subscribers. Safety Connect is supported by Toyota's designated response center, which operates 24 hours per day, 7 days per week.
Safety Connect service is available by subscription on select, telematics hardware-equipped vehicles.
By using the Safety Connect service, you are agreeing to be bound by the Telematics Subscription Service Agreement and its Terms and Conditions, as in effect and amended from time to time, a current copy of which is available at Toyota.com in the United States, Toyotapr.com in Puerto Rico and Toyota.ca in Canada. All use of the Safety Connect service is subject to such then-applicable Terms and Conditions.

Microphone LED light indicators "SOS" button

73
1

COROLLA HV_U

74

1-3. Emergency assistance

 Certification

COROLLA HV_U

1-3. Emergency assistance

75

1

For safety and security

COROLLA HV_U

76

1-3. Emergency assistance

Services
Subscribers have the following Safety Connect services available:
 Automatic Collision Notification*
Helps drivers receive necessary response from emergency service providers. (P.78) *: U.S. Patent No. 7,508,298 B2
 Stolen Vehicle Location
Helps drivers in the event of vehicle theft. (P.78)
 Emergency Assistance Button

("SOS")
Connects drivers to response-center support. (P.78)
 Enhanced Roadside Assistance
Provides drivers various on-road assistance. (P.78)
Subscription
After you have signed the Telematics Subscription Service Agreement and are enrolled, you can begin receiving services. A variety of subscription terms

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

1-3. Emergency assistance

77

are available for purchase. Con-

Emergency Assistance, Stolen

tact your Toyota dealer, call the following appropriate Customer

Vehicle and Enhanced Road Assistance are not available in the U.S. Virgin Islands.

Experience Center or push the

For vehicles first sold in the U.S.

"SOS" button in your vehicle for further subscription details.

Virgin Islands, no Safety Connect services will function in or outside the U.S. Virgin Islands.

· The United States
1-800-331-4331
· Canada

 Safety Connect services are not

1

subject to section 255 of the Tele-

communications Act and the

device is not TTY compatible.

1-888-869-6828
· Puerto Rico
1-877-855-8377
 Safety Connect Services Information
 Phone calls using the vehicle's Bluetooth® technology will not be possible when Safety Connect is active and in use.

 Languages The Safety Connect response center will offer support in multiple languages. The Safety Connect system will offer voice prompts in English, Spanish, and French. Please indicate your language of choice when enrolling.  When contacting the response
center

 Safety Connect is available beginning Fall 2009 on select Toyota models (in the contiguous United States only). Contact with the Safety Connect response center is dependent upon the telematics device being in operative condition, cellular connection availability, and GPS satellite signal reception, which can limit the ability to reach the response center or receive emergency service support. Enrollment and Telematics Subscription Service Agreement are required. A variety of subscription terms are available; charges vary by subscription term selected and location.
 Automatic Collision Notification, Emergency Assistance and Stolen Vehicle Location are available in the United States, including Hawaii and Alaska, Puerto Rico and Canada, and Enhanced Roadside Assistance are available in the United States, Puerto Rico and Canada.

You may be unable to contact the response center if the network is busy.
Safety Connect LED light Indicators
When the power switch is turned to ON, the red indicator light comes on for 2 seconds then turns off. Afterward, the green indicator light comes on, indicating that the service is active. The following indicator light patterns indicate specific system usage conditions:
 Green indicator light on = Active service
 Green indicator light flashing = Safety Connect call in process

 Automatic Collision Notification,

COROLLA HV_U

78

1-3. Emergency assistance

 Red indicator light (except at vehicle start-up) = System malfunction (contact your Toyota dealer)
 No indicator light (off) = Safety Connect service not active
Safety Connect services
 Automatic Collision Notification
In case of either airbag deployment or severe rear-end collision, the system is designed to automatically call the response center. The responding agent receives the vehicle's location and attempts to speak with the vehicle occupants to assess the level of emergency. If the occupants are unable to communicate, the agent automatically treats the call as an emergency, contacts the nearest emergency services provider to describe the situation, and requests that assistance be sent to the location.
 Stolen Vehicle Location
If your vehicle is stolen, Safety Connect can work with local authorities to assist them in locating and recovering the vehicle. After filing a police report, call the Customer Experience Center at 1-800-331-4331 in the United States, 1-877-855-8377 in Puerto Rico

or 1- 888-869-6828 in Canada, and follow the prompts for Safety Connect to initiate this service. In addition to assisting law enforcement with recovery of a stolen vehicle, Safety-Connect-equipped vehicle location data may, under certain circumstances, be shared with third parties to locate your vehicle. Further information is available at Toyota.com in the United States, Toyotapr.com in Puerto Rico and Toyota.ca in Canada.
 Emergency Assistance Button ("SOS")
In the event of an emergency on the road, push the "SOS" button to reach the Safety Connect response center. The answering agent will determine your vehicle's location, assess the emergency, and dispatch the necessary assistance required.
If you accidentally press the "SOS" button, tell the response-center agent that you are not experiencing an emergency.
 Enhanced Roadside Assistance
Enhanced Roadside Assistance adds GPS data to the already included warranty-based Toyota roadside service.
Subscribers can press the "SOS" button to reach a Safety Connect response-center agent, who can help with a wide range

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

1-3. Emergency assistance

79

of needs, such as: towing, flat

Measurement) Report 86

tire, fuel delivery, etc. For a

[1986]

description of the Enhanced

 ICNIRP (International Com-

Roadside Assistance services

mission on Non-Ionizing Radi-

and their limitations, please see

ation Protection) [1996]

the Safety Connect Terms and Conditions, which are available at Toyota.com in the United States, Toyotapr.com in Puerto Rico and Toyota.ca in Canada.

Those standards were based on

comprehensive and periodic

1

evaluations of the relevant sci-

entific literature. Over 120 scien-

tists, engineers, and physicians

Safety information for Safety Connect

from universities, and government health agencies and industries reviewed the avail-

Important! Read this information before using Safety Connect.

able body of research to develop the ANSI Standard (C95.1).

 Exposure to radio frequency signals
The Safety Connect system installed in your vehicle is a

The design of Safety Connect complies with the FCC guidelines in addition to those standards.

low-power radio transmitter and

receiver. It receives and also

sends out radio frequency (RF)

signals.

In August 1996, the Federal Communications Commission (FCC) adopted RF exposure guidelines with safety levels for mobile wireless phones. Those guidelines are consistent with the safety standards previously set by the following U.S. and international standards bodies.

 ANSI (American National Standards Institute) C95.1 [1992]

 NCRP (National Council on Radiation Protection and

COROLLA HV_U

80

1-4. Hybrid system

1-4.Hybrid system
Hybrid system features

Your vehicle is a hybrid vehicle. It has characteristics different from conventional vehicles. Be sure you are closely familiar with the characteristics of your vehicle, and operate it with care.
The hybrid system combines the use of a gasoline engine and an electric motor (traction motor) according to driving conditions, improving fuel efficiency and reducing exhaust emissions.

System components
 System components

The illustration is an example for explanation and may differ from the actual item.

Gasoline engine

Electric motor (traction motor)

 When stopped/during start off
The gasoline engine stops* when the vehicle is stopped. During start off, the electric motor (traction motor) drives the vehicle. At slow speeds or when

traveling down a gentle slope, the engine is stopped* and the electric motor (traction motor) is used.
When the shift lever is in N, the hybrid battery (traction battery) is not being charged.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

*: When the hybrid battery (traction battery) requires charging or the engine is warming up, etc., the gasoline engine will not automatically stop. (P.81)
 During normal driving
The gasoline engine is predominantly used. The electric motor (traction motor) charges the hybrid battery (traction battery) as necessary.
 When accelerating sharply
When the accelerator pedal is depressed heavily, the power of the hybrid battery (traction battery) is added to that of the gasoline engine via the electric motor (traction motor).
 When braking (regenerative braking)
The wheels operate the electric motor (traction motor) as a power generator, and the hybrid battery (traction battery) is charged.
 Regenerative braking In the following situations, kinetic energy is converted to electric energy and deceleration force can be obtained in conjunction with the recharging of the hybrid battery (traction battery).  The accelerator pedal is released
while driving with the shift lever in D or B.  The brake pedal is depressed while driving with the shift lever in D or B.
 EV indicator The EV indicator comes on when

1-4. Hybrid system

81

the vehicle is driven using only the electric motor (traction motor) or the gasoline engine is stopped.

1
 Conditions in which the gasoline engine may not stop
The gasoline engine starts and stops automatically. However, it may not stop automatically in the following conditions:  During gasoline engine warm-up  During hybrid battery (traction bat-
tery) charging  When the temperature of the
hybrid battery (traction battery) is high or low  When the heater is switched on Depending on the circumstances, the gasoline engine may also not stop automatically in other situations.  Charging the hybrid battery (traction battery) As the gasoline engine charges the hybrid battery (traction battery), the battery does not need to be charged from an outside source. However, if the vehicle is left parked for a long time the hybrid battery (traction battery) will slowly discharge. For this reason, be sure to drive the vehicle at least once every few months for at least 30 minutes or 10 miles (16 km). If the hybrid battery (traction battery) becomes fully discharged and you are unable to start the hybrid system, contact your Toyota dealer.  Charging the 12-volt battery P.515

COROLLA HV_U

82

1-4. Hybrid system

 After the 12-volt battery has discharged or when the terminal has been removed and installed during exchange, etc.
The gasoline engine may not stop even if the vehicle is being driven by the hybrid battery (traction battery). If this continues for a few days, contact your Toyota dealer.
 Sounds and vibrations specific to a hybrid vehicle
There may be no engine sound or vibration even though the vehicle is able to move with the "READY" indicator is illuminated. For safety, apply the parking brake and make sure to shift the shift lever to P when parked. The following sounds or vibrations may occur when the hybrid system is operating and are not a malfunction:  Motor sounds may be heard from
the engine compartment.  Sounds may be heard from the
hybrid battery (traction battery) under the rear seats when the hybrid system starts or stops.  Relay operating sounds such as a snap or soft clank will be emitted from the hybrid battery (traction battery), under the rear seats, when the hybrid system is started or stopped.  Sounds from the hybrid system may be heard when the trunk lid is open.  Sounds may be heard from the transmission when the gasoline engine starts or stops, when driving at low speeds, or during idling.  Engine sounds may be heard when accelerating sharply.  Sounds may be heard due to regenerative braking when the brake pedal is depressed or as the accelerator pedal is released.  Vibration may be felt when the gasoline engine starts or stops.

 Cooling fan sounds may be heard from the air intake vent on the side of the lower part of the rear right seat.
 Maintenance, repair, recycling, and disposal
Contact your Toyota dealer regarding maintenance, repair, recycling and disposal. Do not dispose of the vehicle yourself.  Customization Some functions can be customized. (P.544)
Vehicle proximity notification system
When driving with the gasoline engine stopped, a sound, which changes in accordance with the driving speed, will be played in order to warn people nearby of the vehicle's approach. The sound will stop when the vehicle speed exceeds approximately 22 mph (35 km/h).
 Vehicle proximity notification system
In the following cases, the vehicle proximity notification system may be difficult for surrounding people to hear.  In very noisy areas  In the wind or the rain Also, as the vehicle proximity notification system is installed on the front of the vehicle, it may be more difficult to hear from the rear of the vehicle compared to the front.

COROLLA HV_U

1-4. Hybrid system

83

Hybrid system precautions

Take care when handling the hybrid system, as it is a high voltage system (about 600 V at maximum) as well as contains parts that become extremely hot when the hybrid system is operating. Obey the warning labels attached to the vehicle.
1
System components

For safety and security

The illustration is an example for explanation and may differ from the actual item.
Warning label

Service plug

Hybrid battery (traction battery)

High voltage cables (orange)

Electric motor (traction motor)

Air conditioning compressor

Power control unit

 Running out of fuel When the vehicle has run out of fuel and the hybrid system cannot be started, refuel the vehicle with at least enough gasoline to make the low fuel level warning light (P.481) go off. If there is only a small

amount of fuel, the hybrid system may not be able to start. (The standard amount of fuel is about 2.0 gal. [7.6 L, 1.7 Imp. gal.] when the vehicle is on a level surface. This value may vary when the vehicle is on a slope. Add extra fuel when the vehicle is inclined.)

COROLLA HV_U

84

1-4. Hybrid system

 Electromagnetic waves  High voltage parts and cables on
hybrid vehicles incorporate electromagnetic shielding, and therefore emit approximately the same amount of electromagnetic waves as conventional gasoline powered vehicles or home electronic appliances.  Your vehicle may cause sound interference in some third party-produced radio parts.  Hybrid battery (traction battery) The hybrid battery (traction battery) has a limited service life. The lifespan of the hybrid battery (traction battery) can change in accordance with driving style and driving conditions.  Starting the hybrid system in an extremely cold environment When the hybrid battery (traction battery) is extremely cold (below approximately -22°F [-30°C]) under the influence of the outside temperature, it may not be possible to start the hybrid system. In this case, try to start the hybrid system again after the temperature of the hybrid battery increases due to the outside temperature increasing, etc.

WARNING  High voltage precautions This vehicle has high voltage DC and AC systems as well as a 12-volt system. DC and AC high voltage is very dangerous and can cause severe burns and electric shock that may result in death or serious injury.
Never touch, disassemble, remove or replace the high voltage parts, cables or their connectors.

 The hybrid system will become hot after starting as the system uses high voltage. Be careful of both the high voltage and the high temperature, and always obey the warning labels attached to the vehicle.
 Never try to open the service plug access hole located under the right side of the rear seat. The service plug is used only when the vehicle is serviced and is subject to high voltage.
 Road accident cautions Observe the following precautions to reduce the risk of death or serious injury:  Pull your vehicle off the road,
apply the parking brake, shift the shift lever to P, and turn the hybrid system off.  Do not touch the high voltage parts, cables and connectors.  If electric wires are exposed inside or outside your vehicle, an electric shock may occur. Never touch exposed electric wires.  If a fire occurs in the hybrid vehicle, leave the vehicle as soon as possible. Never use a fire extinguisher that is not meant for electric fires. Using even a small amount of water may be dangerous.

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

WARNING If your vehicle needs to be
towed, do so with the front wheels raised. If the wheels connected to the electric motor (traction motor) are on the ground when towing, the motor may continue to generate electricity. This may cause a fire.
(P.473)
Carefully inspect the ground under the vehicle. If you find that liquid has leaked onto the ground, the fuel system may have been damaged. Leave the vehicle as soon as possible.
Nickel-Metal hydride battery: If a fluid leak occurs, do not touch the fluid as it may be strong alkaline electrolyte from the hybrid battery (traction battery). If it comes into contact with your skin or eyes, wash it off immediately with a large amount of water or, if possible, boric acid solution. Seek immediate medical attention.
Lithium-ion battery: Do not touch the battery if liquid is leaking from or adhering to it. If electrolyte (carbonic-based organic electrolyte) from the hybrid battery (traction battery) comes into contact with the eyes or skin, it could cause blindness or skin wounds. In the unlikely event that it comes into contact with the eyes or skin, wash it off immediately with a large amount of water, and seek immediate medical attention.

1-4. Hybrid system

85

 Lithium-ion battery: If electrolyte

is leaking from the hybrid bat-

tery (traction battery), do not

approach the vehicle.

Even in the unlikely event that

the hybrid battery (traction bat-

tery) is damaged, the internal

construction of the battery will

prevent a large amount of elec-

1

trolyte from leaking out. How-

ever, any electrolyte that does

leak out will give off a vapor.

This vapor is an irritant to skin

and eyes and could cause acute

poisoning if inhaled.

 Lithium-ion battery: Do not bring burning or high-temperature items close to the electrolyte. The electrolyte may ignite and cause a fire.

 Hybrid battery (traction battery)

 Lithium-ion battery: Your vehicle contains a sealed lithium-ion battery.

 Never resell, hand over or modify the hybrid battery. To prevent accidents, hybrid batteries that have been removed from a disposed vehicle are collected through Toyota dealer. Do not dispose of the battery yourself.
Unless the battery is properly collected, the following may occur, resulting in death or serious injury: · The hybrid battery may be ille-
gally disposed of or dumped, and it is hazardous to the environment or someone may touch a high voltage part, resulting in an electric shock.

COROLLA HV_U

86

1-4. Hybrid system

WARNING · The hybrid battery is intended to
be used exclusively with your hybrid vehicle. If the hybrid battery is used outside of your vehicle or modified in any way, accidents such as electric shock, heat generation, smoke generation, an explosion and electrolyte leakage may occur. When reselling or handing over your vehicle, the possibility of an accident is extremely high because the person receiving the vehicle may not be aware of these dangers. If your vehicle is disposed of without the hybrid battery having been removed, there is a danger of serious electric shock if high voltage parts, cables and their connectors are touched. In the event that your vehicle must be disposed of, the hybrid battery must be disposed of by your Toyota dealer or a qualified service shop. If the hybrid battery is not disposed of properly, it may cause electric shock that can result in death or serious injury.

NOTICE
 Hybrid battery (traction battery) air intake vent
Do not carry large amounts of water such as water cooler bottles in the vehicle. If water spills onto the hybrid battery (traction battery), the battery may be damaged. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

the right side of the rear seat for the purpose of cooling the hybrid battery (traction battery). If the vent becomes blocked, the hybrid battery may overheat, charging/discharging of the hybrid battery (traction battery) may become limited.
NOTICE  Hybrid battery (traction bat-
tery) air intake vent  Make sure that the air intake
vent is not blocked, such as by a seat cover, plastic cover, or luggage. If the vent is blocked, charging/discharging of the hybrid battery (traction battery) may become limited, possibly leading to a malfunction.  Clean the air intake vent regularly to prevent the hybrid battery (traction battery) from overheating.  Do not allow liquid or foreign material to enter the air intake vent as this may cause a short circuit and damage the hybrid battery (traction battery).

Hybrid battery (traction battery) air intake vent
There is an air intake vent under

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

NOTICE A filter is installed to the air
intake vent. When the filter remains noticeably dirty even after cleaning the air intake vent, filter cleaning or replacement is recommended. Refer to P.455 for details on how to clean the filters.

1-4. Hybrid system

87

1

Emergency shut off system
When a certain level of impact is detected by the impact sensor, the emergency shut off system blocks the high voltage current and stops the fuel pump to minimize the risk of electrocution and fuel leakage. If the emergency shut off system activates, your vehicle will not restart. To restart the hybrid system, contact your Toyota dealer.

 If a warning light comes on, a warning message is displayed, or the 12-volt battery is disconnected
The hybrid system may not start. In this case, try to start the system again. If the "READY" indicator does not come on, contact your Toyota dealer.

Hybrid warning message
A message is automatically displayed when a malfunction occurs in the hybrid system or an improper operation is attempted.
If a warning message is shown on the multi-information display, read the message and follow the instructions.

COROLLA HV_U

88

1-5. Theft deterrent system

1-5.Theft deterrent system
Immobilizer system
The vehicle's keys have built-in transponder chips that prevent the hybrid system from starting if a key has not been previously registered in the vehicle's on-board computer.
Never leave the keys inside the vehicle when you leave the vehicle.
This system is designed to help prevent vehicle theft but does not guarantee absolute security against all vehicle thefts.

 System maintenance The vehicle has a maintenance-free type immobilizer system.
 Conditions that may cause the system to malfunction
 If the grip portion of the key is in contact with a metallic object
 If the key is in close proximity to or touching a key to the security system (key with a built-in transponder chip) of another vehicle

Operating the system

The indicator light flashes after the power switch has been turned off to indicate that the system is operating. The indicator light stops flashing after the power switch has been turned to ACC or ON to indicate that the system has been canceled.
COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

1-5. Theft deterrent system

89

 Certifications for the immobilizer system  Except for vehicles sold in Canada

1

 For vehicles sold in Canada

COROLLA HV_U

90

1-5. Theft deterrent system

NOTICE
 To ensure the system operates correctly
Do not modify or remove the system. If modified or removed, the proper operation of the system cannot be guaranteed.

Alarm
The alarm uses light and sound to give an alert when an intrusion is detected. The alarm is triggered in the following situations when the alarm is set:
 A locked door or trunk is unlocked or opened in any way other than using the entry function, wireless remote control or mechanical key. (The doors will lock again automatically.)
 The hood is opened.

Setting/deactivating/stopping the alarm system
 Items to check before locking the vehicle
To prevent unexpected triggering of the alarm and vehicle theft, make sure of the following:
 Nobody is in the vehicle.
 The windows are closed before the alarm is set.
 No valuables or other personal items are left in the vehicle.
 Setting
Close the doors, trunk and hood, and lock all the doors. The system will set automatically after 30 seconds.
The indicator light changes from

COROLLA HV_U

For safety and security

1-5. Theft deterrent system

91

being on to flashing when the system is set.

locked. (P.515)

1

 Deactivating or stopping
Do one of the following to deactivate or stop the alarms:
 Unlock the doors.
 Turn the power switch to ACC or ON, or start the hybrid system. (The alarm will be deactivated or stopped after a few seconds.)
 System maintenance The vehicle has a maintenance-free type alarm system.  Triggering of the alarm The alarm may be triggered in the following situations: (Stopping the alarm deactivates the alarm system.)  A person inside the vehicle opens
a door, the trunk or hood, or unlocks the vehicle using a door lock switch or inside lock button.

 Alarm-operated door lock In the following cases, depending on the situation, the door may automatically lock to prevent improper entry into the vehicle:  When a person remaining in the
vehicle unlocks the door and the alarm is activated.  While the alarm is activated, a person remaining in the vehicle unlocks the door.  When recharging or replacing the 12-volt battery
NOTICE  To ensure the system oper-
ates correctly Do not modify or remove the system. If modified or removed, the proper operation of the system cannot be guaranteed.

 The 12-volt battery is recharged or replaced when the vehicle is
COROLLA HV_U

92

1-5. Theft deterrent system

COROLLA HV_U

Vehicle status information
2 and indicators
.2-1. Instrument cluster Warning lights and indicators ...............................94 Gauges and meters .......98 Multi-information display .................................. 103 Energy monitor/consumption screen................. 109

93
2

Vehicle status information and indicators

COROLLA HV_U

94

2-1. Instrument cluster

2-1.Instrument cluster
Warning lights and indicators

The warning lights and indicators on the instrument cluster, center panel and outside rear view mirrors inform the driver of the status of the vehicle's various systems.

Warning lights and indicators displayed on the instrument cluster
 7-inch display (when analog speedometer is displayed)

 7-inch display (when digital speedometer is displayed)

Warning lights
COROLLA HV_U

Warning lights inform the driver of malfunctions in the indicated

Vehicle status information and indicators

vehicle's systems.
Brake system warning (U.S.A.) light*1 (P.478)
Brake system warning (Red) light*1 (P.478) (Canada)
Brake system warning (Yellow) light*1 (P.478)
High coolant temperature warning light*2 (P.478) Hybrid system overheat warning light*2 (P.479) Charging system warning light*1 (P.479) Low engine oil pressure warning light*2 (P.479)
Malfunction indicator (U.S.A.) lamp*1 (P.479)
Malfunction indicator (Canada) lamp*1 (P.479)
SRS warning light*1 (P.480)
ABS warning light*1 (U.S.A.) (P.480)
ABS warning light*1 (Canada) (P.480)
Brake Override System warning light/Drive-Start Control warning light*2 (P.480) Electric power steering system warning light*1 (Red) (P.481)

2-1. Instrument cluster

95

Electric power steering

system warning light*1

(Yellow) (P.481)

Low fuel level warning

light (P.481)

Driver's and front passen-

ger's seat belt reminder

light (P.481)

Rear passengers'

seat belt reminder

lights (P.482)

2

Tire pressure warning

light*1 (if equipped)

(P.482)

LTA indicator (P.482) (Orange)
RCTA OFF indicator*1 (if (Flashes) equipped) (P.483)

PCS warning light*1

(Flashes or illumi-

(P.483)

nates)

Slip indicator*1 (P.483)

Parking brake indicator (Flashes) (P.484) (U.S.A.)
Parking brake indicator (Flashes) (P.484) (Canada)
Brake hold operated indi(Flashes) cator*1(P.484) *1: These lights come on when the
power switch is turned to ON to indicate that a system check is being performed. They will turn off after the hybrid system is started, or after a few seconds.

COROLLA HV_U

96

2-1. Instrument cluster

There may be a malfunction in a system if the lights do not come on, or turn off. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.
*2: This light illuminates on the multi-information display.

WARNING
 If a safety system warning light does not come on
Should a safety system light such as the ABS and SRS warning light not come on when you start the hybrid system, this could mean that these systems are not available to help protect you in an accident, which could result in death or serious injury. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately if this occurs.

Indicators
The indicators inform the driver of the operating state of the vehicle's various systems.
Turn signal indicator (P.166)
Headlight indicator (U.S.A.) (P.173)
Tail light indicator (Canada) (P.173)
Headlight high beam indicator (P.175) Automatic High Beam indicator (P.175) PCS warning light*1, 2 (P.191) Cruise control indicator (P.207)

Dynamic radar cruise control indicator (P.207) Cruise control "SET" indicator (P.207)
LTA indicator (P.202)
*3
BSM outside rear view mirror indicators*4, 5 (if equipped) (P.221) BSM indicator (if equipped) (P.221) RCTA OFF indicator*1, 2 (if equipped) (P.226)
Slip indicator*1 (P.241) (Flashes)
VSC OFF indicator*1, 2 (P.241) Smart key system indicator*6 (P.157) "READY" indicator (P.157) EV drive mode indicator (P.162)
Parking brake indicator (U.S.A.) (P.167)
Parking brake indicator (Canada) (P.167)
Brake hold standby indicator*1 (P.170) Brake hold operated indicator*1 (P.170)
EV indicator (P.81)
Low outside temperature indicator*7 (P.98) Security indicator (P.88, 90)

COROLLA HV_U

Vehicle status information and indicators

"AIR BAG ON/OFF" indicator*1, 8 (P.41)
Eco drive mode indicator (P.239)
Power mode indicator (P.239)
*1: These lights come on when the power switch is turned to ON to indicate that a system check is being performed. They will turn off after the hybrid system is started, or after a few seconds. There may be a malfunction in a system if the lights do not come on, or turn off. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.
*2: This light comes on when the system is turned off.
*3: Depending on the operating condition, the color and illuminating/flashing state of the light change.
*4: In order to confirm operation, the BSM outside rear view mirror indicators illuminate in the following situations:
· When the power switch is in ON, the BSM function is
enabled on of the multi-information display. · When the BSM function is
enabled on of the multi-information display, the power switch is turned to ON.
If the system is functioning correctly, the BSM outside rear view mirror indicators will turn off after a few seconds.

2-1. Instrument cluster

97

If the BSM outside rear view mirror indicators do not illuminate or do not turn off, there may be a malfunction in the system.

If this occurs, have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

*5: This light illuminates on the outside rear view mirrors.

*6: This light illuminates on the

multi-information display.

2

*7: When the outside temperature is

approximately 37°F (3°C) or

lower, this indicator will flash for

approximately 10 seconds, then

stay on.

*8: This light illuminates on the center panel.

COROLLA HV_U

98

2-1. Instrument cluster

Gauges and meters

Meter display
 Locations of gauges and meters  Analog speedometer

The units of measure may differ depending on the intended destination of the vehicle.
Tachometer
Displays the engine speed in revolutions per minute
Speedometer Clock (P.101) Fuel gauge
Displays the quantity of fuel remaining in the tank
Engine coolant temperature gauge
Displays the engine coolant temperature
Display change button (P.100) Odometer and trip meter display (P.100) Multi-information display
Presents the driver with a variety of vehicle data (P.103) Displays warning messages if a malfunction occurs (P.487)
Outside temperature
Displays the outside temperature within the range of -40°F (-40°C) to 122°F (50°C)
COROLLA HV_U

2-1. Instrument cluster

99

Shift position indicator (P.164)  Digital speedometer

Vehicle status information and indicators

2

The units of measure may differ depending on the intended destination of the vehicle.

Tachometer

Displays the engine speed in revolutions per minute

Speedometer

Clock (P.101)

Fuel gauge

Displays the quantity of fuel remaining in the tank

Engine coolant temperature gauge
Displays the engine coolant temperature

Display change button (P.100)

Odometer and trip meter display (P.100)

Multi-information display
Presents the driver with a variety of vehicle data (P.103) Displays warning messages if a malfunction occurs (P.487)
Outside temperature

Displays the outside temperature within the range of -40°F (-40°C) to 122°F (50°C)

Shift position indicator (P.164)

 Engine speed On hybrid vehicles, engine speed is

precisely controlled in order to help improve fuel efficiency and reduce exhaust emissions etc. There are times when the engine

COROLLA HV_U

100 2-1. Instrument cluster
speed that is displayed may differ even when vehicle operation and driving conditions are the same.  Outside temperature display  In the following situations, the cor-
rect outside temperature may not be displayed, or the display may take longer than normal to change: · When stopped, or driving at low speeds (less than 16 mph [25 km/h]) · When the outside temperature has changed suddenly (at the entrance/exit of a garage, tunnel, etc.)  When "--" or "E" is displayed, the system may be malfunctioning. Take your vehicle to your Toyota dealer.  Liquid crystal display P.103  Customization The gauges and meters can be customized in of the multi-information display. (P.108)

NOTICE  To prevent damage to the
engine and its components  Do not let the indicator needle
of the tachometer enter the red zone, which indicates the maximum engine speed.
 The engine may be overheating if the engine coolant temperature gauge is in the red zone (H). In this case, immediately stop the vehicle in a safe place, and check the engine after it has cooled completely. (P.517)
Odometer and trip meter display
 Changing the display Press the display change button until the desired item is displayed.

WARNING  The information display at
low temperatures Allow the interior of the vehicle to warm up before using the liquid crystal information display. At extremely low temperatures, the information display monitor may respond slowly, and display changes may be delayed.
For example, there is a lag between the driver's shifting and the new gear number appearing on the display. This lag could cause the driver to downshift again, causing rapid and excessive engine braking and possibly an accident resulting in death or injury.

 Display items
 Odometer
Displays the total distance the vehicle has been driven.
 Trip meter A/Trip meter B
Displays the distance the vehicle has been driven since the meter was last reset. Trip meters A and B can be used to record and display

COROLLA HV_U

Vehicle status information and indicators

different distances independently. To reset, display the desired trip meter and press and hold the display change button.
Changing the instrument panel light brightness
The brightness of the instrument panel lights can be adjusted.
1 Brighter 2 Darker
 Instrument panel light brightness adjustment
The brightness of the instrument panel lights can be adjusted separately for when the tail lights are on and off.
Adjusting the clock
 Clock adjustment The clocks on the following can be adjusted on the audio system screen.  Multi-information display  Audio system screen

2-1. Instrument cluster 101

 Setting the clock to be adjusted automatically by GPS (Audio [for U.S.A.]/Audio Plus)

1 Press the "MENU" button.

2 Select "Setup" on the "Menu" screen.

3 Select "General" on the

"Setup" screen.

2

4 Select "Clock".

5 Select "Auto Adjust by GPS" to set to on.

 Adjusting the clock manually

 Audio (except for U.S.A.) 1 Press the "MENU" button.

2 Select "Setup" on the "Menu" screen.

3 Select "General" on the "Setup" screen.

4 Select "Clock".

5 Adjust the displayed time.

 Hour: Select "-" or "+" of "Hours" to adjust the hour.

 Minute: Select "-" or "+" of "Minutes" to adjust the minute.

 ":00": Select to set the clock to the beginning of the nearest hour.

e.g.

1:00 to 1:29  1:00

1:30 to 1:59  2:00

 Audio (for U.S.A.)/Audio Plus 1 Press the "MENU" button.

COROLLA HV_U

102 2-1. Instrument cluster
2 Select "Setup" on the "Menu" screen.
3 Select "General" on the "Setup" screen.
4 Select "Clock".
5 Select "Auto Adjust by GPS" to set to off.
6 Adjust the displayed time.
 Hour: Select "-" or "+" of "Hours" to adjust the hour.
 Minute: Select "-" or "+" of "Minutes" to adjust the minute.
 ":00": Select to set the clock to the beginning of the nearest hour.
e.g.
1:00 to 1:29  1:00
1:30 to 1:59  2:00
 Setting the time zone (Audio [for U.S.A.]/Audio Plus)
1 Press the "MENU" button.
2 Select "Setup" on the "Menu" screen.
3 Select "General" on the "Setup" screen.
4 Select "Clock".
5 Select "Time Zone".
Select the desired time zone.
 Setting daylight saving time (Audio [for U.S.A.]/Audio Plus)
1 Press the "MENU" button.

2 Select "Setup" on the "Menu" screen.
3 Select "General" on the "Setup" screen.
4 Select "Clock".
5 Select "Daylight Saving Time" then on/off.
 Changing the clock between 12-hour/24-hour format
1 Press the "MENU" button.
2 Select "Setup" on the "Menu" screen.
3 Select "General" on the "Setup" screen.
4 Select "Clock".
5 Select "24-Hour Time Format" and then on/off.
When set to off, the clock is displayed in 12 hour time format.
 Clock settings screen (Audio [for U.S.A.]/Audio Plus)
If "Clock : 00" is displayed when is selected on the multi-information display, the system may be malfunctioning. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

COROLLA HV_U

Vehicle status information and indicators

Multi-information display
Display and menu icons
 Display

2-1. Instrument cluster 103

meter control switch.

Driving information display

(P.104)

Driving support system

information display

(P.107)

Audio system-linked dis-

play (P.107)

Vehicle information dis-

play (P.107)

2

Settings display (P.108)

Warning message display (P.487)

Driving support system status display area
Displays an image when the following systems are operating and a
menu icon other than is selected: · LTA (Lane Tracing Assist) · Dynamic radar cruise control with
full-speed range · RSA (Road Sign Assist) (if
equipped) (P.218)
Content display area
By selecting menu icons on the multi-information display, a variety of driving-related information can be displayed. The multi-information display can also be used to change display settings and other vehicle settings.
Warning or advice pop-up displays are also displayed in certain situations.
 Menu icons
The menu icons will be dis-
played by pressing the or

 Liquid crystal display Small spots or light spots may appear on the display. This phenomenon is characteristic of liquid crystal displays, and there is no problem continuing to use the display.
WARNING  Caution for use while driving  When operating the multi-infor-
mation display while driving, pay extra attention to the safety of the area around the vehicle.  Do not look continuously at the multi-information display while driving as you may fail to see pedestrians, objects on the road, etc. ahead of the vehicle.  The information display at low temperatures P.100
Changing the meter display
The multi-information display is operated using the meter control

COROLLA HV_U

104 2-1. Instrument cluster
switches.

erence only.

/ : Select menu icons
/ : Change displayed content, scroll up/down the screen and move the cursor up/down
Press: Enter/Set Press and hold: Reset/Display customizable items
Return to the previous screen
Call sending/receiving and history display
Linked with the hands-free system, sending or receiving call is displayed. For details regarding the hands-free system, refer to the "NAVIGATION AND MULTIMEDIA SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL".
Content of driving information
 Display items
 Fuel economy
 Hybrid System Indicator/ECO Accelerator Guidance/Eco score
 Fuel economy
Use the displayed values as a ref-

Average fuel economy (after reset)
To reset the average fuel economy
display, press and hold the
meter control switch.
Current fuel consumption
Displays instantaneous current fuel consumption.
Driving range
Displays driving range with remaining fuel. This distance is computed based on your average fuel consumption. As a result, the actual distance that can be driven may differ from that displayed. When only a small amount of fuel is added to the tank, the display may not be updated. When refueling, turn the power switch off. If the vehicle is refueled without turning the power switch off, the display may not be updated.
The average fuel economy dis-
play can be changed in . (P.108)
 Average fuel economy (after start)
Displays the average fuel con-

COROLLA HV_U

Vehicle status information and indicators

sumption since hybrid system start.
 Average fuel economy (after refuel)
Displays the average fuel consumption since the vehicle was refueled.
 Hybrid System Indicator/ECO Accelerator Guidance/Eco score
EV indicator (P.81) Hybrid System Indicator/ECO Accelerator Guidance Eco score  Hybrid System Indicator
Displays hybrid system output or regeneration level.

2-1. Instrument cluster 105

Hybrid Eco area

Shows that gasoline engine power is not being used very often.

The gasoline engine will automatically stop and restart under various conditions.

Eco area

Shows that the vehicle is being driven in an Eco-friendly manner.

By keeping the bar display within

2

Eco area, more Eco-friendly driv-

ing can be achieved.

Power area

Shows that an Eco-friendly driving range is being exceeded (during full power driving etc.)
*: When used in this manual, regeneration refers to the conversion of energy created by the movement of the vehicle into electrical energy.

 ECO Accelerator Guidance

Charge area
Shows regeneration* status.
Regenerated energy will be used to charge the hybrid battery (traction battery).

Eco area
Indicates that the vehicle is being driven in an Eco-friendly manner.
Zone of Eco acceleration
Displayed as a blue bar, and represents an estimated suitable accelerator pedal operation range for the current driving conditions, such as starting off or cruising.

COROLLA HV_U

106 2-1. Instrument cluster
This display changes according to situation, such as when starting off or cruising.
Current accelerator pedal operation
Displayed as a green bar when within the Eco area. Eco-friendly acceleration can be achieved by keeping the accelerator pedal operation display within the range indicated by the blue bar. (P.147)
 Eco score
The following 3 Eco driving methods are evaluated in 5 levels: Smooth start-off acceleration, driving without sudden acceleration, and smooth stopping. When the vehicle is stopped, an Eco score out of 100 points will be displayed.
Eco start status Eco cruise status Eco stop status Score result
How to read the bar display

Not yet evaluated
Low
High
· After the hybrid system is started, the Eco score will not be displayed until the vehicle speed exceeds approximately 12 mph (20 km/h).
· The Eco score will be reset each time the hybrid system is started.
· When the hybrid system is stopped, the total score of the current trip will be displayed.
 Hybrid System Indicator is displayed when
The Hybrid System Indicator is displayed in the following situations:  The "READY" indicator is illumi-
nated.  The shift lever is in D or B.  The ECO Accelerator Guid-
ance/Eco score will not operate when The ECO Accelerator Guidance/Eco score will not operate in the following situations:  The Hybrid System Indicator is not operating.  The vehicle is being driven using the dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range.

COROLLA HV_U

Vehicle status information and indicators

Driving support system information display
 Driving support system information
Select to display the operational status of the following systems:  LTA (Lane Tracing Assist)
(P.197)  Dynamic radar cruise control
with full-speed range (P.207)
Audio system-linked display
Select to enable selection of an audio source or track on the meter using the meter control switches.
This menu icon can be set to be displayed/not displayed in .
Vehicle information display
 Display items  Drive information  Energy monitor (P.109)  Drive information
Displays drive information such as the following:

2-1. Instrument cluster 107
Drive information type
2
Drive information items Displays the following depending on which drive information type and drive information items were selected in . (P.108)  After start
· Distance: Displays the distance driven since hybrid system start
· Elapsed time: Displays the elapsed time since hybrid system start
· Average vehicle speed: Displays the average vehicle speed since hybrid system start
 After reset
· Distance: Displays the distance driven since the display was reset*
· Elapsed time: Displays the elapsed time since the display was reset*
· Average vehicle speed: Displays the average vehicle speed since the display was reset*
*: To reset, display the desired item and press and hold the meter control switch.

COROLLA HV_U

108 2-1. Instrument cluster
Settings display
 Meter display settings that can be changed
 Language
Select to change the language displayed.
 Units
Select to change the units of measure displayed.
 Speedometer display (7-inch display)
Select to set the display of the speedometer to analog/digital.
 EV indicator
Select to enable/disable the EV indicator.

Select to change the displayed content of the following: · Hybrid system indicator Select to display/not display the Eco Accelerator Guidance. (P.105) · Fuel economy display Select to change the average fuel consumption display between after start/after reset. (P.104)

Select to display/not display the audio system linked display.

Select to change the displayed content of the following: · Display contents Select to display/not display the

energy monitor. (P.109)
· Drive information type
Select to change the drive information type display between after start/after reset.
· Drive information items
Select to set the first and second items of the drive information display to any of the following: average vehicle speed/distance/elapsed time.
 Current trip result display
Select to change the displayed information about the current trip, measured from when the hybrid system was started until it was stopped, between drive information/eco score. (The information will be displayed temporarily when the hybrid system is stopped.)
 Pop-up display
Select to enable/disable pop-up displays for each relevant system.
 Multi-information display off
Select to turn the multi-information display off.
To turn the multi-information display on again, press any of the following meter control switches
//// /.
 Default setting
Select to reset the meter display settings to the default setting.
 Vehicle functions and settings that can be changed
P.544

COROLLA HV_U

Vehicle status information and indicators

2-1. Instrument cluster 109

 Suspension of the settings display
 Some settings cannot be changed while driving. When changing settings, park the vehicle in a safe place.
 If a warning message is displayed, operation of the settings display will be suspended.

Energy monitor/consumption screen
You can view the status of your hybrid system on the multi-information display and the audio system screen.

WARNING  Cautions during setting up
the display If the hybrid system is operating while changing certain settings on the settings display, ensure that the vehicle is parked in a place with adequate ventilation. In a closed area such as a garage, exhaust gases including harmful carbon monoxide (CO) may collect and enter the vehicle. This may lead to death or a serious health hazard.
NOTICE  During setting up the display To prevent 12-volt battery discharge, ensure that the hybrid system is operating while setting up the display features.

2
System components
Audio system screen Multi-information display Meter control switches
Energy monitor
 Audio system screen  Audio without DCM/Audio
Plus without DCM 1 Press the "MENU" button. 2 Select "Info" on the "Menu"
screen.
If a screen other than "Energy monitor" is displayed, select "Energy".
 Audio with DCM/Audio Plus with DCM
1 Press the "MENU" button.

COROLLA HV_U

110 2-1. Instrument cluster

2 Select "Info" on the "Menu" screen.
3 Select "ECO" on the "Information" screen.
If a screen other than "Energy monitor" is displayed, select "Energy".

 Multi-information display
Press the meter control switches on the steering wheel several times to select the energy monitor display.

When the vehicle is powered by the electric motor (traction motor)

Audio system screen

Multi-information display

When the vehicle is powered by both the gasoline engine and the electric motor (traction motor)

Audio system screen

Multi-information display

COROLLA HV_U

2-1. Instrument cluster

When the vehicle is powered by the gasoline engine

Audio system screen

Multi-information display

111

2

When the vehicle is charging the hybrid battery (traction battery)

Audio system screen

Multi-information display

Vehicle status information and indicators

COROLLA HV_U

112 2-1. Instrument cluster
When there is no energy flow Audio system screen

Multi-information display

These images are examples only, and may vary slightly from actual conditions.

 Hybrid battery (traction battery) status
 Audio system screen

High
These images are examples only, and may vary slightly from actual conditions.

Low High  Multi-information display
Low

Consumption
 Trip information
 Audio without DCM/Audio Plus without DCM
1 Press the "MENU" button.
2 Select "Info" on the "Menu" screen.
If a screen other than "Trip Information" is displayed, select "Trip Information".
 Audio with DCM/Audio Plus with DCM
1 Press the "MENU" button.
2 Select "Info" on the "Menu" screen.
3 Select "ECO" on the "Information" screen.
If a screen other than "Trip Informa-

COROLLA HV_U

Vehicle status information and indicators

tion" is displayed, select "Trip Information".
Resetting the consumption data Fuel consumption in the past 15 minutes Current fuel consumption Regenerated energy in the past 15 minutes
One symbol indicates 30 Wh. Up to 5 symbols are shown.
Average vehicle speed since the hybrid system was started. Elapsed time since the hybrid system was started. Cruising range Average fuel consumption for the past 15 minutes is divided by color into past averages and averages attained since the power switch was last turned to ON. Use the displayed average fuel consumption as a reference.
The image is an example only, and may vary slightly from actual conditions.

2-1. Instrument cluster 113

 History

 Audio without DCM/Audio Plus without DCM

1 Press the "MENU" button.

2 Select "Info" on the "Menu" screen.

If a screen other than "History" is displayed, select "History".

 Audio with DCM/Audio Plus

2

with DCM

1 Press the "MENU" button.

2 Select "Info" on the "Menu" screen.

3 Select "ECO" on the "Information" screen.

If a screen other than "History" is displayed, select "History".

Best recorded fuel consumption
Latest fuel consumption
Previous fuel consumption record
Resetting the history data
Updating the latest fuel consumption data
The average fuel consumption history is divided by color into past averages and the average

COROLLA HV_U

114 2-1. Instrument cluster
fuel consumption since the last updated. Use the displayed average fuel consumption as a reference.
The image is an example only, and may vary slightly from actual conditions.  Updating the history data Update the latest fuel consumption by selecting "Update" to measure the current fuel consumption again.  Resetting the data The fuel consumption data can be deleted by selecting "Clear".  Cruising range Displays the estimated maximum distance that can be driven with the quantity of fuel remaining. This distance is computed based on your average fuel consumption. As a result, the actual distance that can be driven may differ from that displayed.
COROLLA HV_U

3 Before driving
.3-1. Key information Keys ............................ 116
3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors
Doors .......................... 119 Trunk ........................... 123 Smart key system ....... 125 3-3. Adjusting the seats Front seats .................. 133 Rear seats................... 134 Head restraints............ 136 3-4. Adjusting the steering
wheel and mirrors Steering wheel ............ 138 Inside rear view mirror
.................................. 139 Outside rear view mirrors
.................................. 140 3-5. Opening and closing the
windows Power windows ........... 142

115
3

Before driving

COROLLA HV_U

116 3-1. Key information
3-1.Key information
Keys
The keys
The following keys are provided with the vehicle.
Electronic keys
· Operating the smart key system (P.125)
· Operating the wireless remote control function (P.117)
Mechanical keys Key number plate
 When riding in an aircraft When bringing an electronic key onto an aircraft, make sure you do not press any buttons on the electronic key while inside the aircraft cabin. If you are carrying an electronic key in your bag, etc., ensure that the buttons are not likely to be pressed accidentally. Pressing a button may cause the electronic key to emit radio waves that could interfere with the operation of the aircraft.  Electronic key battery depletion  The standard battery life is 1 to 2
years.  If the battery becomes low, an
alarm will sound in the cabin and a message will be shown on the multi-information display when the hybrid system is stopped.

 To reduce key battery depletion when the electronic key is to not be used for long periods of time, set the electronic key to the battery-saving mode. (P.127)
 As the electronic key always receives radio waves, the battery will become depleted even if the electronic key is not used. The following symptoms indicate that the electronic key battery may be depleted. Replace the battery when necessary. (P.459)
· The smart key system or the wireless remote control does not operate.
· The detection area becomes smaller.
· The LED indicator on the key surface does not turn on.
 To avoid serious deterioration, do not leave the electronic key within 3 ft. (1 m) of the following electrical appliances that produce a magnetic field:
· TVs · Personal computers · Cellular phones, cordless phones
and battery chargers · Recharging cellular phones or
cordless phones · Table lamps · Induction cookers  If the electronic key is near the
vehicle for longer than necessary, even if the smart key system is not operated, the key battery may become depleted faster than normal.
 Replacing the battery P.459  If "A New Key has been Regis-
tered Contact Your Dealer for Details" is shown on the multi-information display This message will be displayed each time the driver's door is opened when the doors are unlocked from the outside for approximately 10 days after a new electronic key has been registered.

COROLLA HV_U

Before driving

If this message is displayed but you have not had a new electronic key registered, ask your Toyota dealer to check if an unknown electronic key (other than those in your possession) has been registered.
NOTICE  To prevent key damage Do not drop the keys, subject
them to strong shocks or bend them. Do not expose the keys to high temperatures for long periods of time. Do not get the keys wet or wash them in an ultrasonic washer etc. Do not attach metallic or magnetic materials to the keys or place the keys close to such materials. Do not disassemble the keys. Do not attach a sticker or anything else to the surface of the key. Do not place the keys near objects that produce magnetic fields, such as TVs, audio systems and induction cookers. Do not place the keys near medical electrical equipment such as low-frequency therapy equipment or microwave therapy equipment, and do not receive medical attention with the keys on your person.

3-1. Key information 117

 Carrying the electronic key on your person
Carry the electronic key 3.9 in. (10 cm) or more away from electric appliances that are turned on. Radio waves emitted from electric appliances within 3.9 in. (10 cm) of the electronic key may interfere with the key, causing the key to not function properly.

 In case of a smart key system malfunction or other key-related problems

P.511

 When an electronic key is lost

3

P.510

Wireless remote control
The keys are equipped with the following wireless remote control:

Locks the doors (P.119)
Unlocks the doors (P.119) Opens the windows* (P.119)
Opens the trunk (P.124)
Sounds the alarm (P.118)
*: This setting must be customized at your Toyota dealer.

COROLLA HV_U

118 3-1. Key information

 Panic mode

When

is pressed for longer

than about one second, an alarm

will sound intermittently and the

vehicle lights will flash to deter any

person from trying to break into or

damage your vehicle.

To stop the alarm, press any button on the electronic key.

 If you lose your mechanical keys
P.510  If a wrong key is used The key cylinder rotates freely, isolated from the internal mechanism.

Using the mechanical key
To take out the mechanical key, slide the release button and take the key out.
The mechanical key can only be inserted in one direction, as the key only has grooves on one side. If the key cannot be inserted in a lock cylinder, turn it over and re-attempt to insert it.
After using the mechanical key, store it in the electronic key. Carry the mechanical key together with the electronic key. If the electronic key battery is depleted or the entry function does not operate properly, you will need the mechanical key. (P.511)

COROLLA HV_U

Before driving

3-2.Opening, closing and locking the doors
Doors

3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors 119
 Wireless remote control

Unlocking and locking the doors from the outside
 Smart key system Carry the electronic key to enable this function.

1 Locks all the doors

Check that the door is securely

locked.

3

2 Unlocks all the doors

Pressing the button unlocks the

driver's door. Pressing the button

again within 3 seconds unlocks the

1 Grip the driver's door handle to unlock the door. Holding
the driver's door handle for
approximately 2 seconds
unlocks all the doors. Grip

other doors.
Press and hold to open the windows.*
*: This setting must be customized at your Toyota dealer.

the front passenger's door handle to unlock all the

 Switching the door unlock function

doors.*
Make sure to touch the sensor on the back of the handle.
The doors cannot be unlocked for 3 seconds after the doors are locked.

It is possible to set which doors the entry function unlocks using the wireless remote control. 1 Turn the power switch off. 2 When the indicator light on the
key surface is not on, press and

*: The door unlock settings can be changed. (P.119, 544)
2 Touch the lock sensor (the indentation on the side of the front door handle) to lock all the doors.
Check that the door is securely locked.

hold ,

or

for

approximately 5 seconds while

pressing and holding .

The setting changes each time an operation is performed, as shown below. (When changing the setting continuously, release the buttons, wait for at least 5 seconds, and repeat step 2.)

COROLLA HV_U

120 3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors

Multi-informa- Unlocking func-

tion display/Beep

tion

Holding the

driver's door

handle unlocks

only the driver's

door.

Exterior: Beeps 3

times

Holding the front

Interior: Pings once

passenger's door handle unlocks all the

doors.

function or wireless remote control, the security feature automatically locks the vehicle again.  When the door cannot be
locked by the lock sensor on the surface of the front door handle If the doors cannot be locked by touching the lock sensor with a finger, touch the lock sensor with the palm of your hand. If you are wearing gloves, remove them.

Holding either

Exterior: Beeps twice

front door handle unlocks all the doors.

Interior: Pings

once

To prevent unintended triggering of the alarm, unlock the doors using the wireless remote control and open and close a door once after the settings have been changed. (If a door is not opened within 60 seconds after is pressed, the doors will be locked again and the alarm will automatically be set.) In case that the alarm is triggered, immediately stop the alarm. (P.91)  Operation signals A buzzer sounds and the emergency flashers flash to indicate that the doors have been locked/unlocked using the entry function or wireless remote control. (Locked: Once; Unlocked: Twice) A buzzer sounds to indicate that the windows are operating.
 Security feature If a door is not opened within approximately 60 seconds after the vehicle is unlocked using the entry

 Door lock buzzer If an attempt to lock the doors using the entry function or wireless remote control is made when a door is not fully closed, a buzzer will sound continuously for 5 seconds. Fully close the door to stop the buzzer, and lock the doors again.
 Alarm Locking the doors will set the alarm system. (P.90)  Conditions affecting the opera-
tion of the smart key system or wireless remote control P.127  If the smart key system or the wireless remote control does not operate properly Use the mechanical key to lock and unlock the doors. (P.511) Replace the key battery with a new one if it is depleted. (P.459)  If the 12-volt battery is discharged The doors cannot be locked and unlocked using the smart key sys-

COROLLA HV_U

Before driving

3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors 121

tem or wireless remote control. Lock or unlock the doors using the mechanical key. (P.511)

 When using the wireless remote control and operating the power windows

 Customization

Operate the power windows after

Some functions can be customized. (P.544)

checking to make sure that there is no possibility of any passenger having any of their body parts

WARNING

caught in the windows. Also, do not allow children to operate the

 To prevent an accident Observe the following precautions while driving the vehicle. Failure to do so may result in a

wireless remote control. It is possible for children and other passengers to get caught in the power windows.

door opening and an occupant

being thrown out of the vehicle, resulting in death or serious injury.

Unlocking and locking the doors from the inside

3

Ensure that all doors are prop-

erly closed and locked.

 Door lock switches (to

Do not pull the inside door handle while driving.

lock/unlock)

Be especially careful of the front

doors, as the doors may be

opened even if the inside lock

buttons are in the locked position.

Set the rear door child-protector locks when children are seated in the rear seats.

 When opening or closing a door
Check the surroundings of the vehicle such as whether the vehicle is on an incline, whether there is enough space for a door to open and whether a strong wind is blowing. When opening or closing the door, hold the door handle tightly to prepare for any unpredictable movement.

1 Locks all the doors 2 Unlocks all the doors
 Inside lock buttons

1 Locks the door 2 Unlocks the door

COROLLA HV_U

122 3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors

The front doors can be opened by pulling the inside handle even if the lock buttons are in the lock position.
 Locking the front doors from the outside without a key
1 Move the inside lock button to the lock position.
2 Close the door. The door cannot be locked if the power switch is in ACC or ON, or the electronic key is left inside the vehicle. The key may not be detected correctly and the door may be locked.  Open door warning buzzer If a door or the trunk is not fully closed, a buzzer will sound when the vehicle speed reaches 3 mph (5 km/h). The open door(s) or trunk is indicated on the multi-information display.

door switch to lock both rear doors.

Automatic door locking and unlocking systems

The following functions can be set or canceled:
For instructions on customizing, refer to P.544.

Function
Speed linked door locking function
Shift position linked door locking function

Operation
All doors are automatically locked when vehicle speed is approximately 12 mph (20 km/h) or higher.
All doors are automatically locked when shifting the shift lever out of P.

Rear door child-protector lock
The door cannot be opened from inside the vehicle when lock is set.

Shift position linked door unlocking function
Driver's door linked door unlocking function

All doors are automatically unlocked when shifting the shift lever to P.
All doors are automatically unlocked when driver's door is opened.

1 Unlock 2 Lock
These locks can be set to prevent children from opening the rear doors. Push down on each rear
COROLLA HV_U

Before driving

3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors 123

Trunk
The trunk can be opened using the trunk opener, entry function or wireless remote control.
WARNING

 Remove any heavy loads, such as snow and ice, from the trunk lid before opening it. Failure to do so may cause the trunk lid to suddenly shut again after it is opened.
 When opening or closing the trunk lid, thoroughly check to make sure the surrounding area is safe.

Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.

 If anyone is in the vicinity, make sure they are safe and let them know that the trunk is about to open or close.

 Before driving

 Use caution when opening or

3

Make sure that the trunk lid is

closing the trunk lid in windy

fully closed. If the trunk lid is not

weather as it may move

fully closed, it may open unex-

abruptly in strong wind.

pectedly while driving and hit near-by objects or luggage in the trunk may be thrown out, causing an accident.

 The trunk lid may suddenly shut if it is not opened fully. It is more difficult to open or close the trunk lid on an incline than on a

Do not allow children to play in

level surface, so beware of the

the trunk.

trunk lid unexpectedly opening

If a child is accidentally locked

or closing by itself. Make sure

in the trunk, they could suffer

that the trunk lid is fully open

from heat exhaustion, suffoca-

and secure before using the

tion or other injuries.

trunk.

Do not allow a child to open or close the trunk lid. Doing so may cause the trunk lid to open unexpectedly, or cause the child's hands, head, or neck to be caught by the closing trunk lid.

 Important points while driving Never let anyone sit in the trunk. In the event of sudden braking or a collision, they are susceptible to death or serious injury.

 When closing the trunk lid, take extra care to prevent your fingers etc. from being caught.

 Using the trunk Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may cause parts of the body to be caught, resulting in serious injury.

COROLLA HV_U

124 3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors

WARNING When closing the trunk lid,
make sure to press it lightly on its outer surface. Do not attach any accessories other than genuine Toyota parts to the trunk lid. Such additional weight on the trunk lid may cause the lid to suddenly shut again after it is opened.
Opening the trunk
 Trunk opener Pull the lever upward to release the trunk lid.

 Wireless remote control Press and hold the switch.
A buzzer sounds.

 Trunk release button
While carrying the electronic key, press the button on the trunk lid.
When all the doors are unlocked using one of the following methods, the trunk can be opened without the electronic key:
 Entry function
 Wireless remote control
 Door lock switches
 Automatic door unlocking system
 Mechanical key

 Trunk light  The trunk light turns on when the
trunk is opened.  If the trunk light is left on when the
power switch is turned off, the light will go off automatically after 20 minutes.
 Function to prevent the trunk being locked with the electronic key inside
 When all doors are locked, closing the trunk lid with the electronic key left inside the trunk will sound an alarm. In this case, the trunk lid can be opened pressing the trunk release button on the trunk lid.
 If the spare electronic key is put in the trunk with all the doors locked, the key confinement prevention function is activated so the trunk can be opened. In order to prevent theft, take all electronic keys

COROLLA HV_U

Before driving

3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors 125

with you when leaving the vehicle.  If the electronic key is put in the
trunk with all the doors locked, the key may not be detected depending on the location of the key and the surrounding radio wave conditions. In this case, the key confinement prevention function cannot be activated, causing the doors to lock when the trunk is closed. Make sure to check where the key is before closing the trunk.

Smart key system
The following operations can be performed simply by carrying the electronic key on your person, for example in your pocket. The driver should always carry the electronic key.

 The key confinement prevention function cannot be activated if any

 Locks and unlocks the

one of the doors is unlocked. In

doors (P.119)

this case, open the trunk using the trunk opener.

 Opens the trunk (P.124)

3

 Internal trunk release lever The trunk lid can be opened by pulling up the glow-in-the-dark lever located on the inside of the trunk lid. The lever will continue to glow for some time after the trunk lid is closed.

 Starts the hybrid system (P.157)
 Antenna location

 If the smart key system or the wireless remote control does not operate properly
Replace the key battery with a new one if it is depleted. (P.459)  Open door warning buzzer P.122  Customization Some functions can be customized. (P.544)

Antennas outside the cabin Antennas inside the cabin Antenna inside the trunk Antenna outside the trunk

COROLLA HV_U

126 3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors

 Effective range (areas within which the electronic key is detected)

Situation
An attempt was made to lock the vehicle while a door was open.

Correction procedure
Close all of the doors and lock the doors again.

When locking or unlocking the doors
The system can be operated when the electronic key is within about 2.3 ft. (0.7 m) of either of the front outside door handles. (Only the doors detecting the key can be operated.)
When starting the hybrid system or changing power switch modes
The system can be operated when the electronic key is inside the vehicle.
When opening the trunk
The system can be operated when the electronic key is within about 2.3 ft. (0.7 m) of the trunk release button.
 Alarms and warning messages A combination of exterior and interior buzzers as well as warning messages shown on the multi-information display are used to prevent theft of the vehicle and accidents resulting from erroneous operation. Take appropriate measures based on the displayed message. (P.487) When only an alarm sounds, circumstances and correction procedures are as follows.  Exterior buzzer sounds once for 5
seconds

The trunk was closed while the electronic key was still inside the trunk and all the doors were locked.

Retrieve the electronic key from the trunk and close the trunk lid.

 Interior buzzer sounds continuously

Situation

Correction procedure

The power switch

was turned to ACC Turn the

while the driver's

power

door was open (or switch off

the driver's door was and close

opened while the the driver's

power switch was in door.

ACC).

The power switch was turned to off while the driver's door was open.

Close the driver's door

 Battery-saving function The battery-saving function will be activated in order to prevent the electronic key battery and the 12-volt battery from being discharged while the vehicle is not operated for a long time.  In the following situations, the
smart key system may take some time to unlock the doors. · The electronic key has been left within approximately 11 ft. (3.5 m) of the outside of the vehicle for 2 minutes or longer. · The smart key system has not

COROLLA HV_U

Before driving

3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors 127

been used for 5 days or longer.

other wireless communication

 If the smart key system has not

device

been used for 14 days or longer,  When the electronic key is in con-

the doors cannot be unlocked

tact with, or is covered by the fol-

from any door except the driver's

lowing metallic objects

door. In this case, hold the driver's · Cards to which aluminum foil is

door handle, or use the wireless

attached

remote control or mechanical key · Cigarette boxes that have alumi-

to unlock the doors.

num foil inside

 Electronic key battery-saving function

· Metallic wallets or bags · Coins · Hand warmers made of metal

When battery-saving mode is set,

· Media such as CDs and DVDs

battery depletion is minimized by stopping the electronic key from receiving radio waves. Press twice while pressing and

 When other wireless keys (that emit radio waves) are being used nearby
 When carrying the electronic key

3

holding . Confirm that the electronic key indicator flashes 4 times.

together with the following devices that emit radio waves · Another vehicle's electronic key or

While the battery-saving mode is

a wireless key that emits radio

set, the smart key system cannot be

waves

used. To cancel the function, press · Personal computers or personal

any of the electronic key buttons.

digital assistants (PDAs)

· Digital audio players

· Portable game systems

 If window tint with a metallic content or metallic objects are attached to the rear window

 When the electronic key is placed near a battery charger or electronic devices

 Conditions affecting operation The smart key system uses weak radio waves. In the following situations, the communication between the electronic key and the vehicle may be affected, preventing the smart key system, wireless remote control and immobilizer system from operating properly.  When the electronic key battery is
depleted  Near a TV tower, electric power
plant, gas station, radio station, large display, airport or other facility that generates strong radio waves or electrical noise

 When the vehicle is parked in a pay parking spot where radio waves are emitted
If the doors cannot be locked/unlocked using the smart key system, lock/unlock the doors by performing any of the following:  Bring the electronic key close to
either front door handle and operate the entry function.  Operate the wireless remote control. If the doors cannot be locked/unlocked using the above methods, use the mechanical key. (P.511)

 When carrying a portable radio,

If the hybrid system cannot be

cellular phone, cordless phone or started using the smart key system,

COROLLA HV_U

128 3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors

refer to P.512.
 Note for the entry function  Even when the electronic key is
within the effective range (detection areas), the system may not operate properly in the following cases: · The electronic key is too close to the window or outside door handle, near the ground, or in a high place when the doors are locked or unlocked. · The electronic key is near the ground or in a high place, or too close to the center of the rear bumper when the trunk is opened. · The electronic key is on the instrument panel, rear package tray or floor, or in the door pockets or glove box when the hybrid system is started or power switch modes are changed.  Do not leave the electronic key on top of the instrument panel or near the door pockets when exiting the vehicle. Depending on the radio wave reception conditions, it may be detected by the antenna outside the cabin and the door will become lockable from the outside, possibly trapping the electronic key inside the vehicle.  As long as the electronic key is within the effective range, the doors may be locked or unlocked by anyone. However, only the doors detecting the electronic key can be used to unlock the vehicle.  Even if the electronic key is not inside the vehicle, it may be possible to start the hybrid system if the electronic key is near the window.  The doors may unlock or lock if a large amount of water splashes on the door handle, such as in the rain or in a car wash when the electronic key is within the effective range. (The doors will automatically be locked after approximately 60 seconds if the doors are not opened and closed.)

 If the wireless remote control is used to lock the doors when the electronic key is near the vehicle, there is a possibility that the door may not be unlocked by the entry function. (Use the wireless remote control to unlock the doors.)
 If the doors have been locked from outside of the vehicle and are then not unlocked using the wireless remote control or smart key system, the hybrid system cannot be started using the smart key system. (However, if the doors have been locked from inside the vehicle, the hybrid system can be started using the smart key system.) If it is necessary to start the hybrid system, it can be started using the procedure in "If the electronic key dose not operate properly" (P.512).
 Touching the door lock or unlock sensor while wearing gloves may prevent lock or unlock operation.
 When the lock operation is performed using the lock sensor, recognition signals will be shown up to two consecutive times. After this, no recognition signals will be given.
 If the door handle becomes wet while the electronic key is within the effective range, the door may lock and unlock repeatedly. In that case, follow the following correction procedures to wash the vehicle:
· Place the electronic key in a location 6 ft. (2 m) or more away from the vehicle. (Take care to ensure that the key is not stolen.)
· Set the electronic key to battery-saving mode to disable the smart key system. (P.127)
 If the electronic key is inside the vehicle and a door handle becomes wet during a car wash, a message may be shown on the multi-information display and a buzzer will sound outside the vehi-

COROLLA HV_U

Before driving

3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors 129

cle. To turn off the alarm, lock all

tions (inside a metal bag, close to

the doors.

metallic objects) and the radio

 The lock sensor may not work properly if it comes into contact

waves in the surrounding area. (P.124)

with ice, snow, mud, etc. Clean

 If the smart key system does

the lock sensor and attempt to

not operate properly

operate it again.

 Locking and unlocking the doors:

 A sudden handle operation or a

P.511

handle operation immediately after entering the effective range may prevent the doors from being

 Starting the hybrid system: P.512

unlocked. Touch the door unlock  Customization

sensor and check that the doors are unlocked before pulling the door handle again.

Some functions can be customized. (P.544)

 If there is another electronic key in the detection area, it may take slightly longer to unlock the doors

 If the smart key system has been deactivated in a customized setting

3

after the door handle is gripped.

 Locking and unlocking the doors:

 When the vehicle is not driven for extended periods

Use the wireless remote control or mechanical key. (P.119, 511)

 To prevent theft of the vehicle, do not leave the electronic key within 6 ft. (2 m) of the vehicle.

 Starting the hybrid system and changing power switch modes: P.512

 The smart key system can be deactivated in advance. (P.544)

 Stopping the hybrid system: P.159

 Setting the electronic key to battery-saving mode helps to reduce key battery depletion. (P.127)

 To operate the system properly

 Make sure to carry the electronic key when operating the system. Do not get the electronic key too close to the vehicle when operating the system from the outside of the vehicle.

Depending on the position and holding condition of the electronic key, the key may not be detected correctly and the system may not operate properly. (The alarm may go off accidentally, or the door lock prevention function may not operate.)

 Do not leave the electronic key inside the trunk. The key confinement prevention function may not operate, depending on the location of the key (the inside edge of the trunk), condi-

COROLLA HV_U

130 3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors
 Certification for the smart key system  Except for vehicles sold in Canada
 For vehicles sold in Canada COROLLA HV_U

Before driving

3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors 131
3
COROLLA HV_U

132 3-2. Opening, closing and locking the doors
WARNING  Caution regarding interfer-
ence with electronic devices People with implantable car-
diac pacemakers, cardiac resynchronization therapy-pacemakers or implantable cardioverter defibrillators should keep away from the smart key system antennas. (P.125) The radio waves may affect the operation of such devices. If necessary, the entry function can be disabled. Ask your Toyota dealer for details, such as the frequency of radio waves and timing of the emitted radio waves. Then, consult your doctor to see if you should disable the entry function. Users of any electrical medical device other than implantable cardiac pacemakers, cardiac resynchronization therapy-pacemakers or implantable cardioverter defibrillators should consult the manufacturer of the device for information about its operation under the influence of radio waves. Radio waves could have unexpected effects on the operation of such medical devices. Ask your Toyota dealer for details on disabling the entry function.
COROLLA HV_U

3-3.Adjusting the seats
Front seats
Adjustment procedure
 Manual seat

3-3. Adjusting the seats 133
 Power seat (driver's side only)

Before driving

3

Seat position adjustment lever
Seatback angle adjustment lever
Vertical height adjustment lever (driver's side only)
Lumbar support adjustment switch* (driver's side only)
*: If equipped

Seat position adjustment switch
Seatback angle adjustment switch
Seat cushion (front) angle adjustment switch
Vertical height adjustment switch
Lumbar support adjustment switch*
*: If equipped
WARNING
 When adjusting the seat position
 Take care when adjusting the seat position to ensure that other passengers are not injured by the moving seat.
 Do not put your hands under the seat or near the moving parts to avoid injury. Fingers or hands may become jammed in the seat mechanism.

COROLLA HV_U

134 3-3. Adjusting the seats
WARNING Make sure to leave enough
space around the feet so they do not get stuck.  Seat adjustment Be careful that the seat does not hit passengers or luggage. To reduce the risk of sliding under the lap belt during a collision, do not recline the seat more than necessary. If the seat is too reclined, the lap belt may slide past the hips and apply restraint forces directly to the abdomen, or your neck may contact the shoulder belt, increasing the risk of death or serious injury in the event of an accident. Adjustments should not be made while driving as the seat may unexpectedly move and cause the driver to lose control of the vehicle. Manual seat only: After adjusting the seat, make sure that the seat is locked in position.

Rear seats
The seatbacks of the rear seats can be folded down.
Folding down the rear seatbacks
1 Move the front seats forward. (P.133)
2 Stow the rear armrest. (P.410)
3 Seats with an adjustable type head restraint: Lower the head restraints to the lowest position. (P.136)
4 Fold the seatback down while pushing the seatback lock release button.
Each seatback may be folded separately.

NOTICE
 When adjusting a front seat When adjusting a front seat, make sure that the head restraint does not contact the headliner. Otherwise, the head restraint and headliner may be damaged.

WARNING Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.
 When folding the rear seatbacks down
 Do not fold the seatbacks down while driving.

COROLLA HV_U

WARNING Stop the vehicle on level
ground, set the parking brake and shift the shift lever to P. Do not allow anyone to sit on a folded seatback or in the trunk while driving. Do not allow children to enter the trunk. Be careful not to get your hand caught when folding the rear seatbacks. Adjust the position of the front seats before folding down the rear seatbacks so that the front seats do not interfere with the rear seatbacks when folding down the rear seatbacks.  After returning the rear seatback to the upright position Make sure that the seatback is securely locked in position by lightly pushing it back and forth. If the seatback is not securely locked, the red marking will be visible on the seatback lock release button. Make sure that the red marking is not visible.

3-3. Adjusting the seats 135
 Check that the seat belts are not twisted or caught in the seatback.
If the seat belt gets caught between the seatback's securing hook and latch, it may damage the seat belt.
3 NOTICE  When the right seatback is folded down Make sure the luggage loaded in the enlarged trunk will not damage the webbing of the rear center seat belt.

Before driving

COROLLA HV_U

136 3-3. Adjusting the seats
Head restraints
Head restraints are provided for all seats.
WARNING  Head restraint precautions Observe the following precautions regarding the head restraints. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury. Use the head restraints
designed for each respective seat. Adjust the head restraints to the correct position at all times. After adjusting the head restraints, push down on them and make sure they are locked in position. Do not drive with the head restraints removed.
Adjusting a head restraint
 Front seats

 Rear outside seats (adjustable type)
1 Up
Pull the head restraints up.
2 Down
Push the head restraint down while pressing the lock release button .  Adjusting the height of the head
restraints (front seats) Make sure that the head restraints are adjusted so that the center of the head restraint is closest to the top of your ears.

1 Up
Pull the head restraints up.
2 Down
Push the head restraint down while pressing the lock release button .

Removing the head restraints
 Front seats
Pull the head restraint up while pressing the lock release button
.

COROLLA HV_U

Before driving

3-3. Adjusting the seats 137

 Rear outside seats (adjustable type)

 Rear outside seats (adjustable type)

Pull the head restraint up while Align the head restraint with the

pressing the lock release button .

installation holes and push it down to the lock position.

3

Press and hold the lock release
button when lowering the head restraint.

Installing the head restraints
 Front seats
Align the head restraint with the installation holes and push it down to the lock position.
Press and hold the lock release button when lowering the head restraint.

COROLLA HV_U

138 3-4. Adjusting the steering wheel and mirrors

3-4.Adjusting the steering wheel and mirrors
Steering wheel
Adjustment procedure
1 Hold the steering wheel and push the lever down.

 After adjusting the steering wheel
Make sure that the steering wheel is securely locked. Otherwise, the steering wheel may move suddenly, possibly causing an accident, and resulting in death or serious injury. Also, the horn may not sound if the steering wheel is not securely locked.

2 Adjust to the ideal position by moving the steering wheel horizontally and vertically.
After adjustment, pull the lever up to secure the steering wheel.

Horn

To sound the horn, press on or

close to the

mark.

WARNING
 Caution while driving Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving. Doing so may cause the driver to mishandle the vehicle and cause an accident, resulting in death or serious injury.

COROLLA HV_U

Before driving

3-4. Adjusting the steering wheel and mirrors 139
Inside rear view mirror reduced by operating the lever.
The rear view mirror's position can be adjusted to enable sufficient confirmation of the rear view.

Adjusting the height of rear view mirror
The height of the rear view mirror can be adjusted to suit your driving posture. Adjust the height of the rear view mirror by moving it up and down.
WARNING  Caution while driving Do not adjust the position of the mirror while driving. Doing so may lead to mishandling of the vehicle and cause an accident, resulting in death or serious injury.

Normal position

Anti-glare position

 Auto anti-glare inside rear

3

view mirror

Responding to the level of brightness of the headlights of vehicles behind, the reflected light is automatically reduced.

Changing automatic anti-glare function mode

On/off

When the automatic anti-glare func-
tion is in ON mode, the indicator illuminates. The function will set to ON mode each time the power switch is turned to ON.

Pressing the button turns the func-
tion to off mode. (The indicator also turns off.)

Anti-glare function
 Manual anti-glare inside rear view mirror
Reflected light from the headlights of vehicles behind can be

COROLLA HV_U

140 3-4. Adjusting the steering wheel and mirrors

 To prevent sensor error (vehicles with an auto anti-glare inside rear view mirror)
To ensure that the sensors operate properly, do not touch or cover them.

Outside rear view mirrors
The rear view mirror's position can be adjusted to enable sufficient confirmation of the rear view.

WARNING  Important points while driving Observe the following precautions while driving. Failure to do so may result in loss of control of the vehicle and cause an accident, resulting in death or serious injury.  Do not adjust the mirrors while
driving.  Do not drive with the mirrors
folded.  Both the driver and passenger
side mirrors must be extended and properly adjusted before driving.

Adjustment procedure
1 To select a mirror to adjust, turn the switch.

COROLLA HV_U

Left Right

Before driving

3-4. Adjusting the steering wheel and mirrors
2 To adjust the mirror, operate the switch.

141

Up Right Down Left

WARNING

 When a mirror is moving

To avoid personal injury and mir-

ror malfunction, be careful not to get your hand caught by the mov-

3

ing mirror.

 Mirror angle can be adjusted when
The power switch is in ACC or ON.  When the mirrors are fogged up The outside rear view mirrors can be cleared using the mirror defoggers. Turn on the rear window defogger to turn on the outside rear view mirror defoggers. (P.387)
WARNING  When the mirror defoggers
are operating Do not touch the rear view mirror surfaces, as they can become very hot and burn you.

Folding the mirrors
Push the mirror back in the direction of the vehicle's rear.

COROLLA HV_U

142 3-5. Opening and closing the windows

3-5.Opening and closing the windows
Power windows
Opening and closing the power windows
The power windows can be opened and closed using the switches. Operating the switch moves the windows as follows:
1 Closing 2 One-touch closing* 3 Opening 4 One-touch opening*
*: To stop the window partway, operate the switch in the opposite direction.
 The power windows can be operated when
The power switch is in ON.  Operating the power windows
after turning the hybrid system off The power windows can be operated for approximately 45 seconds after the power switch is turned to ACC or OFF. They cannot, however, be operated once either front door is opened.  Jam protection function If an object becomes jammed

between the window and the window frame while the window is closing, window movement is stopped and the window is opened slightly.
 Catch protection function If an object becomes caught between the door and window while the window is opening, window movement is stopped.
 When the window cannot be opened or closed
When the jam protection function or catch protection function operates unusually and the door window cannot be opened or closed, perform the following operations with the power window switch of that door.  Stop the vehicle. With the power
switch in ON, within 4 seconds of the jam protection function or catch protection function activating, continuously operate the power window switch in the one-touch closing direction or one-touch opening direction so that the door window can be opened and closed.  If the door window cannot be opened and closed even when performing the above operations, perform the following procedure for function initialization. 1 Turn the power switch to ON. 2 Pull and hold the power window
switch in the one-touch closing direction and completely close the door window. 3 Release the power window switch for a moment, resume pulling the switch in the one-touch closing direction, and hold it there for approximately 6 seconds or more. 4 Press and hold the power window switch in the one-touch opening direction. After the door window is completely opened, continue holding the switch for an additional 1 second or more.

COROLLA HV_U

Before driving

3-5. Opening and closing the windows 143

5 Release the power window switch for a moment, resume pushing the switch in the one-touch opening direction, and hold it there for approximately 4

 Closing the windows  The driver is responsible for all
the power window operations, including the operation for the

seconds or more.

passengers. In order to prevent

6 Pull and hold the power window switch in the one-touch closing direction again. After the door window is completely closed, continue holding the switch for a further 1 second or more.
If you release the switch while the window is moving, start again from the beginning.

accidental operation, especially by a child, do not let a child operate the power windows. It is possible for children and other passengers to have body parts caught in the power window. Also, when riding with a child, it is recommended to use the win-
dow lock switch. (P.144)

If the window reverses and cannot be fully closed or opened, have the

 Check to make sure that all passengers do not have any part of

3

vehicle inspected by your Toyota

their body in a position where it

dealer.

could be caught when a window

 Door lock linked window opera-

is being operated.

tion

 The power windows can be opened and closed using the mechanical key.* (P.512)

 The power windows can be opened using the wireless remote control.* (P.119)
*: These settings must be customized at your Toyota dealer.
 Customization Some functions can be customized. (P.544)
WARNING Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.

 When using the wireless remote control or mechanical key and operating the power windows, operate the power window after checking to make sure that there is no possibility of any passenger having any of their body parts caught in the window. Also do not let a child operate window by the wireless remote control or mechanical key. It is possible for children and other passengers to get caught in the power window.

 When exiting the vehicle, turn the power switch off, carry the key and exit the vehicle along with the child. There may be accidental operation, due to mischief, etc., that may possibly lead to an accident.

COROLLA HV_U

144 3-5. Opening and closing the windows

WARNING  Jam protection function Never use any part of your body
to intentionally activate the jam protection function.
The jam protection function may not work if something gets jammed just before the window is fully closed. Be careful not to get any part of your body jammed in the window.
 Catch protection function Never use any part of your body
or clothing to intentionally activate the catch protection function.
The catch protection function may not work if something gets caught just before the window is fully opened. Be careful not to get any part of your body or clothing caught in the window.

 The power windows can be operated when
The power switch is in ON.  When the 12-volt battery is dis-
connected The window lock switch is disabled. If necessary, press the window lock switch after reconnecting the 12-volt battery.

Preventing accidental operation (window lock switch)
This function can be used to prevent children from accidentally opening or closing a passenger window.
Press the switch.
The indicator will come on and the passenger windows will be locked.
The passenger windows can still be opened and closed using the driver's switch even if the lock switch is on.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

145
Driving 4

.4-1. Before driving Driving the vehicle....... 146 Cargo and luggage ..... 152 Vehicle load limits ....... 155

Dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range .................................. 207
RSA (Road Sign Assist) .................................. 218

Trailer towing............... 155

BSM (Blind Spot Monitor)

Dinghy towing ............. 156

.................................. 221

4-2. Driving procedures
Power (ignition) switch .................................. 157
EV drive mode ............ 162 Hybrid transmission .... 164 Turn signal lever.......... 166 Parking brake.............. 167

RCTA (Rear Cross Traffic Alert) function ............ 226

Rear view monitor system

.................................. 231

4

Driving mode select switch

.................................. 239

Driving assist systems .................................. 240

Brake Hold .................. 170 4-6. Driving tips

4-3. Operating the lights and wipers

Hybrid vehicle driving tips .................................. 245

Headlight switch .......... 173

Winter driving tips........ 247

Automatic High Beam . 175

Windshield wipers and washer....................... 178

4-4. Refueling

Opening the fuel tank cap .................................. 180

4-5. Using the driving support systems

Toyota Safety Sense 2.0 .................................. 183

PCS (Pre-Collision System) .................................. 189

LTA (Lane Tracing Assist) .................................. 197

COROLLA HV_U

146 4-1. Before driving
4-1.Before driving
Driving the vehicle
The following procedures should be observed to ensure safe driving:
Driving procedure
 Starting the hybrid system
P.157  Driving 1 With the brake pedal
depressed, shift the shift lever to D. (P.164) 2 If the parking brake is in manual mode, release the parking brake. (P.167) 3 Gradually release the brake pedal and gently depress the accelerator pedal to accelerate the vehicle.
 Stopping 1 With the shift lever in D,
depress the brake pedal.
2 If necessary, set the parking brake.
If the vehicle is to be stopped for an extended period of time, shift the shift lever to P. (P.164)
 Parking the vehicle 1 With the shift lever in D,
depress the brake pedal to stop the vehicle completely.
2 Set the parking brake (P.167), and shift the shift lever to P. (P.164)
Check the parking brake indicator

is illuminated.
3 Press the power switch to stop the hybrid system.
4 Slowly release the brake pedal.
5 Lock the door, making sure that you have the electronic key on your person.
If parking on a hill, block the wheels as needed.
 Starting off on a steep uphill
1 Make sure that the parking brake is set and shift the shift lever to D.
Hill-start assist control will operate. (P.240)
2 Gently depress the accelerator pedal.
3 Release the parking brake.
 For fuel-efficient driving Keep in mind that hybrid vehicles are similar to conventional vehicles, and it is necessary to refrain from activities such as sudden acceleration. (P.245)  Driving in the rain  Drive carefully when it is raining,
because visibility will be reduced, the windows may become fogged-up, and the road will be slippery.  Drive carefully when it starts to rain, because the road surface will be especially slippery.  Refrain from high speeds when driving on an expressway in the rain, because there may be a layer of water between the tires and the road surface, preventing the steering and brakes from operating properly.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

 Restraining the hybrid system output (Brake Override System)
 When the accelerator and brake pedals are depressed at the same time, the hybrid system output may be restrained.
 A warning message is displayed on the multi-information display while the system is operating.
 ECO Accelerator Guidance (P.105)
Eco-friendly driving may be achieved more easily by staying within the zone of Eco acceleration. Also, by staying within the zone of Eco acceleration, it will be easier to obtain a good Eco score.  When starting off: Gradually depress the accelerator pedal to stay within the zone of Eco acceleration and accelerate to the desired speed. By refraining from excessive acceleration, a good eco start score will be obtained.  When driving: After accelerating to the desired speed, release the accelerator pedal and drive at a stable speed while staying within the zone of Eco acceleration. By staying within the zone of Eco acceleration, a good eco cruise score will be obtained.  When stopping: By starting to release the accelerator pedal early before decelerating, a good eco stop score will be obtained.
 Restraining sudden start (Drive-Start Control)
 When the following unusual operation is performed, the hybrid system output may be restrained.
· When the shift lever is shifted from R to D, D to R, N to R, P to D*, or P to R* (D includes B) with the accelerator pedal depressed, a warning message appears on the multi-information display. If a

4-1. Before driving 147

warning message is shown on the multi-information display, read the message and follow the instruction. · When the accelerator pedal is depressed too much while the vehicle is in reverse. *: Depending on the situation, the shift position may not be changed.

 While Drive-Start Control is being activated, your vehicle may have trouble escaping from the mud or fresh snow. In such case, deactivate TRAC (P.241) to cancel Drive-Start Control so that the vehicle may become able to escape from the mud or fresh snow.

 Breaking in your new Toyota To extend the life of the vehicle,

4

observing the following precautions

is recommended:

 For the first 186 miles (300 km):

Avoid sudden stops.

 For the first 621 miles (1000 km): · Do not drive at extremely high
speeds. · Avoid sudden acceleration. · Do not drive at a constant speed
for extended periods.

 Operating your vehicle in a foreign country
Comply with the relevant vehicle registration laws and confirm the availability of the correct fuel. (P.525)

WARNING Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.

COROLLA HV_U

148 4-1. Before driving
WARNING  When starting the vehicle Always keep your foot on the brake pedal while stopped with the "READY" indicator is illuminated. This prevents the vehicle from creeping.  When driving the vehicle Do not drive if you are unfamil-
iar with the location of the brake and accelerator pedals to avoid depressing the wrong pedal. · Accidentally depressing the accelerator pedal instead of the brake pedal will result in sudden acceleration that may lead to an accident. · When backing up, you may twist your body around, leading to a difficulty in operating the pedals. Make sure to operate the pedals properly. · Make sure to keep a correct driving posture even when moving the vehicle only slightly. This allows you to depress the brake and accelerator pedals properly. · Depress the brake pedal using your right foot. Depressing the brake pedal using your left foot may delay response in an emergency, resulting in an accident. The driver should pay extra attention to pedestrians when the vehicle is powered only by the electric motor (traction motor). As there is no engine noise, the pedestrians may misjudge the vehicle's movement. Even with the vehicle proximity notification system activate, drive with care as pedestrians in the vicinity may still not notice the vehicle if the surrounding area is noisy.

 Do not drive the vehicle over or stop the vehicle near flammable materials. The exhaust system and exhaust gases can be extremely hot. These hot parts may cause a fire if there is any flammable material nearby.
 During normal driving, do not turn off the hybrid system. Turning the hybrid system off while driving will not cause loss of steering or braking control, however, power assist to the steering will be lost. This will make it more difficult to steer smoothly, so you should pull over and stop the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so. In the event of an emergency, such as if it becomes impossible to stop the vehicle in the normal
way: P.471
 Use engine braking (shift position B) to maintain a safe speed when driving down a steep hill. Using the brakes continuously may cause the brakes to overheat and lose effectiveness.
(P.164)
 Do not adjust the positions of the steering wheel, the seat, or the inside or outside rear view mirrors while driving. Doing so may result in a loss of vehicle control.
 Always check that all passengers' arms, heads or other parts of their body are not outside the vehicle.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

WARNING Do not drive in excess of the
speed limit. Even if the legal speed limit permits it, do not drive over 85 mph (140 km/h) unless your vehicle has high-speed capability tires. Driving over 85 mph (140 km/h) may result in tire failure, loss of control and possible injury. Be sure to consult a tire dealer to determine whether the tires on your vehicle are high-speed capability tires or not before driving at such speeds.  When driving on slippery road surfaces Sudden braking, acceleration and steering may cause tire slippage and reduce your ability to control the vehicle. Sudden acceleration, engine braking due to shifting, or changes in engine speed could cause the vehicle to skid. After driving through a puddle, lightly depress the brake pedal to make sure that the brakes are functioning properly. Wet brake pads may prevent the brakes from functioning properly. If the brakes on only one side are wet and not functioning properly, steering control may be affected.  When shifting the shift lever Do not let the vehicle roll backward while a forward driving position is selected, or roll forward while the shift lever is in R. Doing so may result in an accident or damage to the vehicle. Do not shift the shift lever to P while the vehicle is moving. Doing so can damage the transmission and may result in a loss of vehicle control.

4-1. Before driving 149

 Do not shift the shift lever to R while the vehicle is moving forward. Doing so can damage the transmission and may result in a loss of vehicle control.

 Do not shift the shift lever to a driving position while the vehicle is moving backward. Doing so can damage the transmission and may result in a loss of vehicle control.

 Moving the shift lever to N while the vehicle is moving will disengage the hybrid system. Engine braking is not available with the hybrid system disengaged.

 Be careful not to shift the shift lever with the accelerator pedal

4

depressed. Shifting the shift

lever to any positions other than

P or N may lead to unexpected

rapid acceleration of the vehicle

that may cause an accident and

result in death or serious injury.

 If you hear a squealing or scraping noise (brake pad wear indicators)
Have the brake pads checked and replaced by your Toyota dealer as soon as possible.

Rotor damage may result if the pads are not replaced when needed.

It is dangerous to drive the vehicle when the wear limits of the brake pads and/or those of the brake discs are exceeded.

 When the vehicle is stopped  Do not depress the accelerator
pedal unnecessarily. If the shift lever is any position other than P or N, the vehicle may accelerate suddenly and unexpectedly, causing an accident.

COROLLA HV_U

150 4-1. Before driving
WARNING In order to prevent accidents
due to the vehicle rolling away, always keep depressing the brake pedal while stopped with the "READY" indicator is illuminated, and apply the parking brake as necessary. If the vehicle is stopped on an incline, in order to prevent accidents caused by the vehicle rolling forward or backward, always depress the brake pedal and securely apply the parking brake as needed. Avoid revving or racing the engine. Running the engine at high speed while the vehicle is stopped may cause the exhaust system to overheat, which could result in a fire if combustible material is nearby.  When the vehicle is parked Do not leave glasses, cigarette lighters, spray cans, or soft drink cans in the vehicle when it is in the sun. Doing so may result in the following: · Gas may leak from a cigarette lighter or spray can, and may lead to a fire. · The temperature inside the vehicle may cause the plastic lenses and plastic material of glasses to deform or crack. · Soft drink cans may fracture, causing the contents to spray over the interior of the vehicle, and may also cause a short circuit in the vehicle's electrical components.

 Do not leave cigarette lighters in the vehicle. If a cigarette lighter is in a place such as the glove box or on the floor, it may be lit accidentally when luggage is loaded or the seat is adjusted, causing a fire.
 Do not attach adhesive discs to the windshield or windows. Do not place containers such as air fresheners on the instrument panel or dashboard. Adhesive discs or containers may act as lenses, causing a fire in the vehicle.
 Do not leave a door or window open if the curved glass is coated with a metallized film such as a silver-colored one. Reflected sunlight may cause the glass to act as a lens, causing a fire.
 Always apply the parking brake, shift the shift lever to P, stop the hybrid system and lock the vehicle. Do not leave the vehicle unattended while the "READY" indicator is illuminated. If the vehicle is parked with the shift lever in P but the parking brake is not set, the vehicle may start to move, possibly leading to an accident.
 Do not touch the exhaust pipes while the "READY" indicator is illuminated or immediately after turning the hybrid system off. Doing so may cause burns.

COROLLA HV_U

WARNING  When taking a nap in the vehi-
cle Always turn the hybrid system off. Otherwise, if you accidentally move the shift lever or depress the accelerator pedal, this could cause an accident or fire due to hybrid system overheating. Additionally, if the vehicle is parked in a poorly ventilated area, exhaust gases may collect and enter the vehicle, leading to death or a serious health hazard.
 When braking When the brakes are wet, drive
more cautiously. Braking distance increases when the brakes are wet, and this may cause one side of the vehicle to brake differently than the other side. Also, the parking brake may not securely hold the vehicle.
If the electronically controlled brake system does not operate, do not follow other vehicles closely and avoid hills or sharp turns that require braking. In this case, braking is still possible, but the brake pedal should be depressed more firmly than usual. Also, the braking distance will increase. Have your brakes fixed immediately.
The brake system consists of 2 or more individual hydraulic systems; if one of the systems fails, the other(s) will still operate. In this case, the brake pedal should be depressed more firmly than usual and the braking distance will increase. Have your brakes fixed immediately.

4-1. Before driving 151
 If the vehicle becomes stuck Do not spin the wheels excessively when a driven wheel is up in the air, or the vehicle is stuck in sand, mud, etc. This may damage the driveline components or propel the vehicle forward or backward, causing an accident.

NOTICE

 When driving the vehicle  Do not depress the accelerator
and brake pedals at the same time during driving, as this may restrain the hybrid system output.

 Do not use the accelerator pedal or depress the accelera-

4

tor and brake pedals at the

same time to hold the vehicle on

a hill.

 When parking the vehicle Always set the parking brake and shift the shift lever to P. Failure to do so may cause the vehicle to move or the vehicle may accelerate suddenly if the accelerator pedal is accidentally depressed.

 Avoiding damage to vehicle parts
 Do not turn the steering wheel fully in either direction and hold it there for an extended period of time. Doing so may damage the power steering motor.

 When driving over bumps in the road, drive as slowly as possible to avoid damaging the wheels, underside of the vehicle, etc.

Driving

COROLLA HV_U

152 4-1. Before driving
NOTICE  If you get a flat tire while driv-
ing A flat or damaged tire may cause the following situations. Hold the steering wheel firmly and gradually depress the brake pedal to slow down the vehicle. It may be difficult to control your
vehicle. The vehicle will make abnormal
sounds or vibrations. The vehicle will lean abnor-
mally. Information on what to do in case
of a flat tire (P.501)
 When encountering flooded roads
Do not drive on a road that has flooded after heavy rain etc. Doing so may cause the following serious damage to the vehicle: Engine stalling Short in electrical components Engine damage caused by
water immersion In the event that you drive on a flooded road and the vehicle becomes flooded or stuck in mud or sand, be sure to have your Toyota dealer check the following: Brake function Changes in quantity and quality
of oil and fluid used for the engine, hybrid transmission, etc. Lubricant condition for the bearings and suspension joints (where possible), and the function of all joints, bearings, etc.

Cargo and luggage
Take notice of the following information about storage precautions, cargo capacity and load:
Capacity and distribution
Cargo capacity depends on the total weight of the occupants.
(Cargo capacity) = (Total load capacity) -- (Total weight of occupants)
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit --
(1) Locate the statement "The combined weight of occupants and cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs." on your vehicle's placard.
(2) Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will be riding in your vehicle.
(3) Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs.
(4) The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity.
For example, if the "XXX" amount equals 1400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb passengers in your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lbs. (1400 -

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

750 (5  150) = 650 lbs.) (5) Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4. (6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle. (P.155)
Toyota does not recommend towing a trailer with your vehicle. Your vehicle is not designed for trailer towing.
Calculation formula for your vehicle
Cargo capacity Total load capacity (vehicle capacity weight) (P.524) When 2 people with the combined weight of A lb. (kg) are riding in your vehicle, which has a

4-1. Before driving 153
total load capacity (vehicle capacity weight) of B lb. (kg), the available amount of cargo and luggage load capacity will be C lb. (kg) as follows:
B*2 lb. (kg) - A*1 lb. (kg) = C*3 lb. (kg)
*1: A =Weight of people
*2: B =Total load capacity
*3: C =Available cargo and luggage load
In this condition, if 3 more passengers with the combined weight of D lb. (kg) get on, the available cargo and luggage load will be reduced E 4 lb. (kg) as follows:
C lb. (kg) - D*4 lb. (kg) = E*5 lb. (kg)
*4: D =Additional weight of people
*5: E =Available cargo and luggage load
As shown in the example above, if the number of occupants increases, the cargo and luggage load will be reduced by an amount that equals the increased weight due to the additional occupants. In other words, if an increase in the number of occupants causes an excess of the total load capacity (combined weight of occupants plus cargo and luggage load), you must reduce the cargo and luggage on your vehicle.

COROLLA HV_U

154 4-1. Before driving
WARNING  Things that must not be car-
ried in the trunk The following things may cause a fire if loaded in the trunk: Receptacles containing gaso-
line Aerosol cans  Storage precautions Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may prevent the pedals from being depressed properly, may block the driver's vision, or may result in items hitting the driver or passengers, possibly causing an accident. Stow cargo and luggage in the
trunk whenever possible. To prevent cargo and luggage
from sliding forward during braking, do not stack anything in the enlarged trunk. Keep cargo and luggage low, as close to the floor as possible. When you fold down the rear seats, long items should not be placed directly behind the front seats. Do not place cargo or luggage in or on the following locations. · At the feet of the driver · On the front passenger or rear seats (when stacking items) · On the package tray · On the instrument panel · On the dashboard Secure all items in the occupant compartment.

 Never allow anyone to ride in the enlarged trunk. It is not designed for passengers. They should ride in their seats with their seat belts properly fastened.
 Capacity and distribution  Do not exceed the maximum
axle weight rating or the total vehicle weight rating.
 Even if the total load of occupant's weight and the cargo load is less than the total load capacity, do not apply the load unevenly. Improper loading may cause deterioration of steering or braking control which may cause death or serious injury.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

Vehicle load limits
Vehicle load limits include total load capacity, seating capacity, towing capacity and cargo capacity.
 Total load capacity (vehicle capacity weight): P.524
Total load capacity means the combined weight of occupants, cargo and luggage.
 Seating capacity: P.524
Seating capacity means the maximum number of occupants whose estimated average weight is 150 lb. (68 kg) per person.
 Towing capacity
Toyota does not recommend towing a trailer with your vehicle.
 Cargo capacity
Cargo capacity may increase or decrease depending on the weight and the number of occupants.
 Total load capacity and seating capacity
These details are also described on the tire and loading information label. (P.450)
WARNING
 Overloading the vehicle Do not overload the vehicle. It may not only cause damage to the tires, but also degrade steering and braking ability, resulting in an accident.

4-1. Before driving 155
Trailer towing
Toyota does not recommend towing a trailer with your vehicle. Toyota also does not recommend the installation of a tow hitch or the use of a tow hitch carrier for a wheelchair, scooter, bicycle, etc. Your vehicle is not designed for trailer towing or for the use of tow hitch mounted carriers.
4

COROLLA HV_U

156 4-1. Before driving Dinghy towing
Your vehicle is not designed to be dinghy towed (with 4 wheels on the ground) behind a motor home.
NOTICE  To avoid serious damage to
your vehicle Do not tow your vehicle with the four wheels on the ground.
COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-2.Driving procedures
Power (ignition) switch

4-2. Driving procedures 157
from any power switch mode.

Performing the following

operations when carrying

the electronic key on your person starts the hybrid

system or changes power switch modes.
Starting the hybrid system

5 Check that the "READY" indicator is illuminated.
The vehicle cannot be driven if the "READY" indicator is off.

1 Check that the parking brake is set. (P.167)

 If the hybrid system does not start

4

2 Check that the shift lever is in P.
3 Firmly depress the brake pedal.

 The immobilizer system may not have been deactivated. (P.88) Contact your Toyota dealer.
 If a message related to start-up is shown on the multi-information display, read the message and fol-

and a message will be dis-

low the instructions.

played on the multi-information display. If it is not displayed, the hybrid system cannot be started.

 When the ambient temperature is low, such as during winter driving conditions

4 Press the power switch

When starting the hybrid system,

shortly and firmly.
When operating the power switch, one short, firm press is enough. It is not necessary to press and hold the switch. If the "READY" indicator turns on, the hybrid system will operate normally.

the flashing time of the "READY" indicator may be long. Leave the vehicle as it is until the "READY" indicator is steady on, as steady means the vehicle is able to move.  Sounds and vibrations specific
to a hybrid vehicle P.82

Continue depressing the brake pedal until the "READY" indicator is illuminated.

 If the 12-volt battery is discharged
The hybrid system cannot be started

The hybrid system can be started

using the smart key system. Refer to P.513 to restart the hybrid system.

 Electronic key battery depletion

P.116

COROLLA HV_U

158 4-2. Driving procedures
 Conditions affecting operation P.127  Notes for the entry function P.128  Steering lock function  After turning the power switch off
and opening and closing the doors, the steering wheel will be locked due to the steering lock function. Operating the power switch again automatically cancels the steering lock.  When the steering lock cannot be released, "Push Power Switch while Turning Steering Wheel in Either Direction" will be displayed on the multi-information display. Press the power switch shortly and firmly while turning the steering wheel left and right.
 To prevent the steering lock motor from overheating, the motor may be suspended if the hybrid system is turned on and off repeatedly in a short period of time. In this case, refrain from operating the power switch. After about 10 seconds, the steering lock motor will resume functioning.
 If the "READY" indicator does not come on
In the event that the "READY" indicator does not come on even after performing the proper procedures for starting the vehicle, contact your Toyota dealer immediately.  If the hybrid system is malfunc-
tioning P.87

 Electronic key battery P.459  Operation of the power switch  If the switch is not pressed shortly
and firmly, the power switch mode may not change or the hybrid system may not start.  If attempting to restart the hybrid system immediately after turning the power switch off, the hybrid system may not start in some cases. After turning the power switch off, please wait a few seconds before restarting the hybrid system.  Customization If the smart key system has been deactivated in a customized setting, refer to P.511.
WARNING  When starting the hybrid sys-
tem Always start the hybrid system while sitting in the driver's seat. Do not depress the accelerator pedal while starting the hybrid system under any circumstances. Doing so may cause an accident resulting in death or serious injury.
 Caution while driving If hybrid system failure occurs while the vehicle is moving, do not lock or open the doors until the vehicle reaches a safe and complete stop. Activation of the steering lock in this circumstance may lead to an accident, resulting in death or serious injury.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

NOTICE  When starting the hybrid sys-
tem If the hybrid system becomes difficult to start, have your vehicle checked by your Toyota dealer immediately.
 Symptoms indicating a malfunction with the power switch
If the power switch seems to be operating somewhat differently than usual, such as the switch sticking slightly, there may be a malfunction. Contact your Toyota dealer immediately.

4-2. Driving procedures 159
cally shut off after approximately 1 hour if it has been left running while the shift lever is in P.  The timer for the automatic hybrid system shut off feature will reset if the brake pedal is depressed or if the shift lever is in a position other than P.  After the vehicle is parked, if the door is locked with the door lock switch (P.121) from the inside or the mechanical key (P.511) from the outside, the automatic hybrid system shut off feature will be disabled. The timer for the automatic hybrid system shut off feature will be re-enabled if the driver's door is opened.

Stopping the hybrid sys-

WARNING

4

tem

 Stopping the hybrid system in an emergency

1 Stop the vehicle completely.
2 Set the parking brake (P.167), and shift the shift lever to P.
Check the parking brake indicator is illuminated.
3 Press the power switch.
The hybrid system will stop, and the meter display will be extinguished.
4 Release the brake pedal and check that "ACCESSORY" or "IGNITION ON" is not shown on the multi-information display.

 If you want to stop the hybrid system in an emergency while driving the vehicle, press and hold the power switch for more than 2 seconds, or press it briefly 3 times or more in suc-
cession. (P.471)
However, do not touch the power switch while driving except in an emergency. Turning the hybrid system off while driving will not cause loss of steering or braking control, however, power assist to the steering will be lost. This will make it more difficult to steer smoothly, so you should pull over and stop the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so.

 Automatic hybrid system shut off feature
 The vehicle is equipped with a feature that automatically shuts off the hybrid system when the shift lever is in P with the hybrid system operating for an extended period.
 The hybrid system will automati-

 If the power switch is operated while the vehicle is running, a warning message will be shown on the multi-information display and a buzzer sounds.

COROLLA HV_U

160 4-2. Driving procedures
WARNING To restart the hybrid system
after performing an emergency shutdown, shift the shift lever to N and then press the power switch.  When parking Exhaust gases include harmful carbon monoxide (CO), which is colorless and odorless. Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may cause exhaust gases to enter the vehicle and may lead to an accident caused by light-headedness, or may lead to death or a serious health hazard. If the vehicle is in a poorly ventilated area or a closed area, such as a garage, stop the hybrid system. Do not leave the vehicle with the hybrid system operating for a long time. If such a situation cannot be avoided, park the vehicle in an open space and ensure that exhaust fumes do not enter the vehicle interior. Do not leave the hybrid system operating in an area with snow build-up, or where it is snowing. If snowbanks build up around the vehicle while the hybrid system is operating, exhaust gases may collect and enter the vehicle.
Changing power switch modes
Modes can be changed by pressing the power switch with brake pedal released. (The mode changes each time the switch is pressed.)

1 OFF*
The emergency flashers can be used.
2 ACC
Some electrical components such as the audio system can be used. "ACCESSORY" will be displayed on the multi-information display.
3 ON
All electrical components can be used. "IGNITION ON" will be displayed on the multi-information display. *: If the shift lever is in a position
other than P when turning off the hybrid system, the power switch will be turned to ACC, not to off.
 Auto power off function If the vehicle is left in ACC for more than 20 minutes or ON (the hybrid system is not operating) for more than an hour with the shift lever in P, the power switch will automatically turn off. However, this function can-

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

not entirely prevent 12-volt battery discharge. Do not leave the vehicle with the power switch in ACC or ON for long periods of time when the hybrid system is not operating.
NOTICE  To prevent 12-volt battery dis-
charge Do not leave the power switch
in ACC or ON for long periods of time without the hybrid system on. If "ACCESSORY" or "IGNITION ON" is displayed on the multi-information display, the power switch is not off. Exit the vehicle after turning the power switch off.

4-2. Driving procedures 161
multi-information display are off.
NOTICE  To prevent 12-volt battery dis-
charge Do not stop the hybrid system when the shift lever is in a position other than P. If the hybrid system is stopped in another shift lever position, the power switch will not be turned off but instead be turned to ACC mode. If the vehicle is left in ACC, 12-volt battery discharge may occur.
4

When stopping the hybrid system with the shift lever in a position other than P
If the hybrid system is stopped with the shift lever in a position other than P, the power switch will not be turned off but instead be turned to ACC. Perform the following procedure to turn the switch off:
1 Check that the parking brake is set.
2 Shift the shift lever to P.
3 Check that "ACCESSORY" is displayed on the multi-information display and press the power switch shortly and firmly.
4 Check that "ACCESSORY" or "IGNITION ON" on the

COROLLA HV_U

162 4-2. Driving procedures
EV drive mode
In EV drive mode, electric power is supplied by the hybrid battery (traction battery), and only the electric motor (traction motor) is used to drive the vehicle. This mode allows you to drive in residential areas early in the morning and late at night, or in indoor parking lots etc. without concern for noises and gas emissions.
Operating instructions
Turns EV drive mode on/off
When EV drive mode is turned on, the EV drive mode indicator will come on. Pressing the switch when in EV drive mode will return the vehicle to normal driving (using the gasoline engine and electric motor [traction motor]).
 Situations in which EV drive mode cannot be turned on
It may not be possible to turn EV drive mode on in the following situations. If it cannot be turned on, a

buzzer will sound and a message will be shown on the multi-information display.  The temperature of the hybrid sys-
tem is high. The vehicle has been left in the sun, driven on a hill, driven at high speeds, etc.  The temperature of the hybrid system is low. The vehicle has been left in temperatures lower than about 32°F (0°C ) for a long period of time etc.  The gasoline engine is warming up.  The hybrid battery (traction battery) is low. The remaining battery level indicated in the energy monitor display is low. (P.112)  Vehicle speed is high.  The accelerator pedal is depressed firmly or the vehicle is on a hill etc.  The windshield defogger is in use.  Switching to EV drive mode when the gasoline engine is cold If the hybrid system is started while the gasoline engine is cold, the gasoline engine will start automatically after a short period of time in order to warm up.In this case, you will become unable to switch to EV drive mode. After the hybrid system has started and the "READY" indicator has illuminated, press the EV drive mode switch before the gasoline engine starts to switch to EV drive mode.
 Automatic cancelation of EV drive mode
When driving in EV drive mode, the gasoline engine may start automatically and the vehicle may be driven by the gasoline engine and electric motor (traction motor) in the following situations. When EV drive mode is canceled, a buzzer will sound, the

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

EV drive mode indicator will flash, and a message will be displayed on the multi-information display.  The hybrid battery (traction bat-
tery) becomes low. The remaining battery level indicated in the energy monitor display is low. (P.112)  Vehicle speed is high.  The accelerator pedal is depressed firmly or the vehicle is on a hill etc.  Possible driving distance when driving in EV drive mode EV drive mode's possible driving distance ranges from a few hundred meters to approximately 0.6 mile (1 km). However, depending on vehicle conditions, there are situations when EV drive mode cannot be used. (The distance that is possible depends on the hybrid battery [traction battery] level and driving conditions.)  Fuel economy The hybrid system is designed to achieve the best possible fuel economy during normal driving (using the gasoline engine and electric motor [traction motor]). Driving in EV drive mode more than necessary may lower fuel economy.  If "EV Mode Unavailable" is shown on the multi-information display The EV drive mode is not available. The reason the EV drive mode is not available (the vehicle is idling, battery charge is low, vehicle speed is higher than the EV drive mode operating speed range or accelerator pedal is depressed too much) may be displayed. Use the EV drive mode when it becomes available.  If "EV Mode Deactivated" is shown on the multi-information display The EV drive mode has been auto-

4-2. Driving procedures 163
matically canceled. The reason the EV drive mode is not available (the battery charge is low, vehicle speed is higher than the EV drive mode operating speed range or accelerator pedal is depressed too much) may be displayed. Drive the vehicle for a while before attempting to turn on the EV drive mode again.

WARNING

 Caution while driving

When driving in EV drive mode,

pay special attention to the area

around the vehicle. Because

there is no engine noise, pedestri-

ans, people riding bicycles or

other people and vehicles in the

area may not be aware of the vehicle starting off or approaching

4

them, so take extra care while

driving. Therefore, take extra care

while driving even if the vehicle

proximity notification system is

active.

COROLLA HV_U

164 4-2. Driving procedures
Hybrid transmission
Select the shift position depending on your purpose and situation.

Shift position purpose and functions

Shift position

Objective or function

Parking the vehi-

P

cle/starting the hybrid

system

R

Reversing

Neutral (Condition in

N

which the power is not

transmitted)

D

Normal driving*

Applying moderate

B

engine braking driving

down hills

*: To improve fuel efficiency and reduce noise, shift the shift lever to D for normal driving.

 Restraining sudden start (Drive-Start Control)
P.147

WARNING
 When driving on slippery road surfaces
Do not accelerate or shift gears suddenly. Sudden changes in engine braking may cause the vehicle to spin or skid, resulting in an accident.

NOTICE  Hybrid battery (traction bat-
tery) charge If the shift lever is in N, the hybrid battery (traction battery) will not be charged even when the engine is running. Therefore, if the vehicle is left with the shift lever in N for a long period of time, the hybrid battery (traction battery) will discharge, and this may result in the vehicle not being able to start.
Shifting the shift lever
:While the power switch is in ON and the brake pedal depressed*, shift the shift lever while pushing the shift release button on the shift knob.
:Shift the shift lever while pushing the shift release button on the shift knob.

COROLLA HV_U

:Shift the shift lever normally.
When shifting the shift lever between P and D, make sure that the vehicle is completely stopped. *: For the vehicle be able to be
shifted from P, the brake pedal must be depressed before the shift release button is pushed. If the shift release button is pushed first, the shift lock will not be released.
 Shift lock system The shift lock system is a system to prevent accidental operation of the shift lever in starting. The shift lever can be shifted from P only when the power switch is in ON and the brake pedal is being depressed.
 If the shift lever cannot be shifted from P
First, check whether the brake pedal is being depressed. If the shift lever cannot be shifted with your foot on the brake pedal, there may be a problem with the shift lock system. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately. The following steps may be used as an emergency measure to ensure that the shift lever can be shifted. Releasing the shift lock: 1 Set the parking brake. 2 Turn the power switch off. 3 Depress the brake pedal. 4 Ply the cover up with a flathead
screwdriver or equivalent tool. To prevent damaging the cover,

4-2. Driving procedures 165
wrap the tip of the flathead screwdriver with a tape.
5 Press and hold the shift lock override button and then push the shift release button on the shift knob.
The shift lever can be shifted while the button is pressed.
4
 About engine braking When shift position B is selected, releasing the accelerator pedal will apply engine braking.  When the vehicle is driven at high
speeds, compared to ordinary gasoline-fueled vehicles, the engine braking deceleration is felt less than that of other vehicles.  The vehicle can be accelerated even when shift position B is selected. If the vehicle is driven continuously in the B position, fuel efficiency will become low. Usually, select the D position.

Driving

COROLLA HV_U

166 4-2. Driving procedures
WARNING  To prevent an accident when
releasing the shift lock Before pressing the shift lock override button, make sure to set the parking brake and depress the brake pedal. If the accelerator pedal is accidentally depressed instead of the brake pedal when the shift lock override button is pressed and the shift lever is shifted out of P, the vehicle may suddenly start, possibly leading to an accident resulting in death or serious injury.
Selecting the driving mode
P.239

Turn signal lever Operating instructions

1 Right turn 2 Lane change to the right
(move the lever partway and release it)
The right hand signals will flash 3 times.
3 Lane change to the left (move the lever partway and release it)
The left hand signals will flash 3 times.
4 Left turn
 Turn signals can be operated when
The power switch is in ON.
 If the indicator flashes faster than usual
Check that a light bulb in the front or rear turn signal lights has not

COROLLA HV_U

burned out.

4-2. Driving procedures 167
Parking brake
The parking brake can be set or released automatically or manually.
In automatic mode, the parking brake can be set or released automatically. Also, even in automatic mode, the parking brake can be set or released manually.

Operating instructions

 Using the manual mode

4

The parking brake can be set and released manually.

Driving

COROLLA HV_U

U.S.A.
Canada
1 Pull the switch to set the parking brake
The parking brake indicator and parking brake light will turn on.
Pull and hold the parking brake switch if an emergency occurs and it is necessary to operate the park-

168 4-2. Driving procedures
ing brake while driving.
2 Push the switch to release the parking brake
· Operate the parking brake switch while depressing the brake pedal.
· Using the parking brake automatic release function, the parking brake can be released by depressing the accelerator pedal. When using this function, slowly depress the accelerator pedal.
Make sure that the parking brake indicator and parking brake light turn off.
 Turning automatic mode on
While the vehicle is stopped, pull and hold the parking brake switch until a message is shown on the multi-information display

light will turn on.
Operate the shift lever with the vehicle stopped and the brake pedal depressed.
The parking brake may not operate automatically if the shift lever is moved quickly. In this case, it is necessary to operate the parking brake switch. (P.167)
 Turning automatic mode off
While the vehicle is stopped and depressing the brake pedal, press and hold the parking brake switch until a message is shown on the multi-information display

When the automatic mode is turned on, the parking brake operates as follows.
 When the shift lever is moved out of P, the parking brake will be released, and the parking brake indicator and parking brake light will turn off.
 When the shift lever is moved into P, the parking brake will be set, and the parking brake indicator and parking brake

 Parking brake operation  When the power switch is not in
ON, the parking brake cannot be released using the parking brake switch.  When the power switch is not in ON, automatic mode (automatic brake setting and releasing) is not available.
 Parking brake automatic release function
The parking brake is automatically released when slowly depress the accelerator pedal. The parking brake will be released automatically under the following

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

conditions:  The driver's door is closed  The driver is wearing the seat belt  The shift lever is a forward or
reverse position.  The malfunction indicator lamp or
brake system warning light is not illuminated. If the automatic release function does not operate, manually release the parking brake.
 If "Parking Brake Temporarily Unavailable" is displayed on the multi-information display
If the parking brake is operated repeatedly over a short period of time, the system may restrict operation to prevent overheating. If this happens, refrain from operating the parking brake. Normal operation will return after about 1 minute.
 If "Parking Brake Unavailable" is displayed on the multi-information display
Operate the parking brake switch. If the message does not disappear after operating the switch several times, the system may be malfunctioning. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.
 Parking brake operation sound When the parking brake operates, a motor sound (whirring sound) may be heard. This does not indicate a malfunction.
 Parking brake operation  Depending on the power switch
mode, the parking brake indicator and parking brake light will turn on and stay on as described below: ON: Comes on until the parking brake is released. Not in ON: Stays on for approximately 15 seconds.  When the power switch is turned off with the parking brake set, the parking brake indicator and parking brake light will stay on for

4-2. Driving procedures 169

about 15 seconds. This does not indicate a malfunction.

 When the parking brake switch malfunctions

Automatic mode (automatic brake setting and releasing) will be turned on automatically.

 Parking the vehicle P.146

 Parking brake engaged warning buzzer

A buzzer will sound if the vehicle is driven with the parking brake engaged. "Parking Brake ON" is displayed on the multi-information display.

 If the brake system warning

light comes on

4

P.478

 Usage in winter time P.247

WARNING  When parking the vehicle Do not leave a child in the vehicle alone. The parking brake may be released unintentionally and there is the danger of the vehicle moving that may lead to an accident resulting in death or serious injury.
 Parking brake switch Do not set any objects near the parking brake switch. Objects may interfere with the switch and may lead the parking brake to unexpectedly operate.

NOTICE
 When parking the vehicle Before you leave the vehicle, set the parking brake, shift the shift lever to P and make sure that the vehicle does not move.

COROLLA HV_U

170 4-2. Driving procedures
NOTICE  When the system malfunc-
tions Stop the vehicle in a safe place and check the warning messages.  When the parking brake can-
not be released due to a malfunction Driving the vehicle with the parking brake set will lead to brake components overheating, which may affect braking performance and increase brake wear. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately if this occurs.

Brake Hold
The brake hold system keeps the brake applied when the shift lever is in D, B or N with the system on and the brake pedal has been depressed to stop the vehicle. The system releases the brake when the accelerator pedal is depressed with the shift lever in D or B to allow smooth start off.

Enabling the system
Turn the brake hold system on
The brake hold standby indicator (green) comes on. While the system is holding the brake, the brake hold operated indicator (yellow) comes on.

COROLLA HV_U

 Brake hold system operating conditions
The brake hold system cannot be turned on in the following conditions:  The driver's door is not closed.  The driver is not wearing the seat
belt.

Driving

If any of the conditions above are detected when the brake hold system is enabled, the system will turn off and the brake hold standby indicator light will go off. In addition, if any of the conditions are detected while the system is holding the brake, a warning buzzer will sound and a message will be shown on the multi-information display. The parking brake will then be set automatically.
 Brake hold function  If the brake pedal is left released
for a period of about 3 minutes after the system has started holding the brake, the parking brake will be set automatically. In this case, a warning buzzer sounds and a message is shown on the multi-information display.  To turn the system off while the system is holding the brake, firmly depress the brake pedal and press the button again.  The brake hold function may not hold the vehicle when the vehicle is on a steep incline. In this situation, it may be necessary for the driver to apply the brakes. A warning buzzer will sound and the multi-information display will inform the driver of this situation. If a warning message is shown on the multi-information display, read the message and follow the instructions.
 When the parking brake is set automatically while the system is holding the brakes
Perform any of the following operations to release the parking brake.  Depress the accelerator pedal.
(The parking brake will not be released automatically if the seat belt is not fastened.)  Operate the parking brake switch with the brake pedal depressed. Make sure that the parking brake indicator light goes off. (P.167)

4-2. Driving procedures 171
 When an inspection at your Toyota dealer is necessary
When the brake hold standby indicator (green) does not illuminate even when the brake hold switch is pressed with the brake hold system operating conditions met, the system may be malfunctioning. Have the vehicle inspected at your Toyota dealer.  If "Brake Hold Malfunction
Press Brake to Deactivate Visit Your Dealer" or "Brake Hold Malfunction Visit Your Dealer" is displayed on the multi-information display The system may be malfunctioning. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.  Warning messages and buzzers 4 Warning messages and buzzers are used to indicate a system malfunction or to inform the driver of the need for caution. If a warning message is shown on the multi-information display, read the message and follow the instructions.  If the brake hold operated indicator flashes P.484
WARNING  When the vehicle is on a
steep incline When using the brake hold system on a steep incline exercise caution. The brake hold function may not hold the vehicle in such a situation.
 When stopped on a slippery road
The system cannot stop the vehicle when the gripping ability of the tires has been exceeded. Do not use the system when stopped on a slippery road.

COROLLA HV_U

172 4-2. Driving procedures
NOTICE  When parking the vehicle The brake hold system is not designed for use when parking the vehicle for a long period of time. Turning the power switch off while the system is holding the brake may release the brake, which would cause the vehicle to move. When operating the power switch, depress the brake pedal, shift the shift lever to P and set the parking brake.
COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-3. Operating the lights and wipers 173

4-3.Operating the lights and wipers
Headlight switch
The headlights can be operated manually or automatically.

on.

4

(U.S.A.) Off

(Canada) The daytime
running lights turn on. (P.173)

Operating instructions

Operating the

switch

turns on the lights as follows:

 AUTO mode can be used when The power switch is in ON.
 Daytime running light system  The daytime running lights illumi-
nate using the same lights as the headlights and illuminate darker than the headlights.

 To make your vehicle more visible 4 to other drivers during daytime driving, the daytime running lights turn on automatically when all of the following conditions are met. (The daytime running lights are not designed for use at night.)
· The hybrid system is operating. · The parking brake is released

· The headlight switch is in the

U.S.A. Canada

(Canada only),

or * posi-

tion

*: When the surroundings are bright

1

The headlights, daytime

running lights (P.173) and

all the lights listed below turn

on and off automatically.

2

The side marker, park-

ing, tail, license plate, instru-

ment panel lights, and

daytime running lights

(P.173) turn on.

The daytime running lights remain on after they illuminate, even if the parking brake is set again.  For the U.S.A.: Daytime running
lights can be turned off by operating the switch.  Compared to turning on the headlights, the daytime running light system offers greater durability and consumes less electricity, so it can help improve fuel economy.

3

The headlights and all

lights listed above (except

daytime running lights) turn

COROLLA HV_U

174 4-3. Operating the lights and wipers

 Headlight control sensor
The sensor may not function properly if an object is placed on the sensor, or anything that blocks the sensor is affixed to the windshield. Doing so interferes with the sensor detecting the level of ambient light and may cause the automatic headlight system to malfunction.  Automatic light off system  When the headlights are on: The
headlights and tail lights turn off 30 seconds after the driver's door is opened and closed if the power switch is turned to ACC or OFF. (The lights turn off immediately if
on the key is pressed after all the doors are closed.)  When only the tail lights are on: The tail lights turn off automatically if the power switch is turned to ACC or OFF and the driver's door is opened. To turn the lights on again, turn the power switch to ON, or turn the light switch off once and then back to
or .  Light reminder buzzer A buzzer sounds when the power switch is turned to OFF or ACC and the driver's door is opened while the lights are turned on.  Windshield wiper linked head-
light illumination When driving during daytime with the headlight switch turned to , if the windshield wipers are used, the headlights will turn on automatically after several seconds to help

enhance the visibility of your vehicle.  12-volt battery-saving function In order to prevent the 12-volt battery of the vehicle from discharging, if the headlights and/or tail lights are on when the power switch is turned off the 12-volt battery saving function will operate and automatically turn off all the lights after approximately 20 minutes. When the power switch is turned to ON, the 12-volt battery-saving function will be disabled. When any of the following are performed, the 12-volt battery-saving function is canceled once and then reactivated. All the lights will turn off automatically 20 minutes after the 12-volt battery-saving function has been reactivated:  When the headlight switch is oper-
ated  When a door is opened or closed  Customization Some functions can be customized. (P.544)
NOTICE  To prevent 12-volt battery dis-
charge Do not leave the lights on longer than necessary when the hybrid system is off.

COROLLA HV_U

4-3. Operating the lights and wipers 175

Turning on the high beam headlights

Automatic High Beam

The Automatic High Beam

uses a camera sensor

located behind the upper

portion of the windshield to

assess the brightness of the

lights of vehicles ahead,

streetlights, etc., and auto-

matically turns the high

beams on or off as neces-

1 With the headlights on, push the lever away from you to
turn on the high beams.

sary.
WARNING

Pull the lever toward you to the center position to turn the high

 Limitations of the Automatic High Beam

4

beams off.

Do not overly rely on the Auto-

2 Pull the lever toward you and release it to flash the high

matic High Beam. Always drive safely, taking care to observe your surroundings and turning the high

beams once.
You can flash the high beams with

beams on or off manually if necessary.

the headlights on or off.

 To prevent incorrect operation of the Automatic High

Beam system

Do not overload the vehicle.

Activating the Automatic High Beam
1 Press the Automatic High Beam switch.

Driving

COROLLA HV_U

176 4-3. Operating the lights and wipers

2 Push the lever away from you with the headlight switch in the or position.
The Automatic High Beam indicator will come on when the system is operating.
 Conditions to turn the high beams on/off automatically
 When all of the following conditions are met, the high beams will be turned on automatically (after approximately 1 second):
· The vehicle speed is approximately 21 mph (34 km/h) or more.
· The area ahead of the vehicle is dark.
· There are no vehicles ahead with headlights or tail lights turned on.
· There are few streetlights on the road ahead.
 If any of the following conditions are met, the high beams will turn off automatically:
· The vehicle speed is below approximately 17 mph (27 km/h).
· The area ahead of the vehicle is not dark.
· Vehicles ahead have their headlights or tail lights turned on.
· There are many streetlights on the road ahead.
 Camera sensor detection information
 The high beams may not be automatically turned off in the following situations:
· When a vehicle suddenly appears

from around a curve · When the vehicle is cut in front of
by another vehicle · When vehicles ahead cannot be
detected due to repeated curves, road dividers or roadside trees · When vehicles ahead appear in a faraway lane on a wide road · When the lights of vehicles ahead are not on  The high beams may be turned off if a vehicle ahead that is using fog lights without its headlights turned on is detected.  House lights, streetlights, traffic signals, and illuminated billboards or signs and other reflective objects may cause the high beams to change to the low beams, or the low beams to remain on.  The following factors may affect the amount of time taken for the high beams to turn on or off: · The brightness of the headlights, fog lights, and tail lights of vehicles ahead · The movement and direction of vehicles ahead · When a vehicle ahead only has operational lights on one side · When a vehicle ahead is a two-wheeled vehicle · The condition of the road (gradient, curve, condition of the road surface, etc.) · The number of passengers and amount of luggage in the vehicle  The high beams may turn on or off unexpectedly.  Bicycles or similar vehicles may not be detected.  In the following situations the system may not be able to correctly detect the surrounding brightness level. This may cause the low beams to remain on or the high beams to flash or dazzle pedestrians or vehicles ahead. In such a case, it is necessary to manually switch between the high and low beams.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-3. Operating the lights and wipers 177

· When driving in inclement weather  Temporarily lowering sensor

(heavy rain, snow, fog, sand-

sensitivity

storms, etc.) · When the windshield is obscured
by fog, mist, ice, dirt, etc. · When the windshield is cracked or
damaged

The sensitivity of the sensor can be temporarily lowered. 1 Turn the power switch off while
the following conditions are met.

· When the camera sensor is deformed or dirty

 The headlight switch is in or

· When the temperature of the camera sensor is extremely high

.

· When the surrounding brightness  The headlight switch lever is in

level is equal to that of headlights,

high beam position.

tail lights or fog lights · When headlights or tail lights of
vehicles ahead are turned off, dirty, changing color, or not aimed

 Automatic High Beam switch is on.
2 Turn the power switch to ON.

properly

3 Within 60 seconds after step 2,

· When the vehicle is hit by water,

repeat pulling the headlight

snow, dust, etc. from a preceding

switch lever to the original posi-

vehicle · When driving through an area of
intermittently changing brightness and darkness

tion then pushing it to the high beam position quickly 10 times,

4

then leave the lever in high beam

position.

· When frequently and repeatedly 4 If the sensitivity is changed, the

driving ascending/descending

Automatic High Beam indicator

roads, or roads with rough, bumpy

is turn on and off 3 times.

or uneven surfaces (such as stone-paved roads, gravel roads, etc.) · When frequently and repeatedly

Automatic High Beam (headlights) may turn on even when the vehicle is stopped.

taking curves or driving on a wind-

ing road

Turning the high beams

· When there is a highly reflective object ahead of the vehicle, such

on/off manually

as a sign or mirror · When the back of a preceding

 Switching to the low beams

vehicle is highly reflective, such as a container on a truck

Pull the lever to its original posi-

· When the vehicle's headlights are tion.

damaged or dirty, or are not aimed properly · When the vehicle is listing or titling

The Automatic High Beam indicator will turn off.

due to a flat tire, a trailer being towed, etc. · When the headlights are changed

Push the lever away from you to activate the Automatic High Beam

between the high beams and low system again.

beams repeatedly in an abnormal

manner

· When the driver believes that the

high beams may be flashing or

dazzling pedestrians or other driv-

ers

COROLLA HV_U

178 4-3. Operating the lights and wipers

Windshield wipers and washer

Operating the lever can use the windshield wipers or the washer.

 Switching to the high beams
Press the Automatic High Beam switch.
The Automatic High Beam indicator will turn off and the high beam indicator will turn on.
Press the switch to activate the Automatic High Beam system again.

NOTICE
 When the windshield is dry Do not use the wipers, as they may damage the windshield.

Operating the wiper lever

Operating the

lever oper-

ates the wipers or washer as fol-

lows.

COROLLA HV_U

1

(U.S.A.) or (Canada)

Intermittent windshield wiper

operation

2

(U.S.A.) or (Canada)

Low speed windshield wiper

Driving

4-3. Operating the lights and wipers 179

operation

3

(U.S.A.) or (Canada)

High speed windshield wiper

operation

4

(U.S.A.) or (Canada)

Temporary operation

 The windshield wiper and washer can be operated when
The power switch is in ON.  If no windshield washer fluid
sprays Check that the washer nozzles are not blocked if there is washer fluid in the windshield washer fluid reservoir.

 When stopping the hybrid system in an emergency while driving

5

Washer/wiper dual

operation

If the windshield wipers are operat-

ing when the hybrid system is

stopped, the windshield wipers will

operate in high speed operation.

After the vehicle is stopped, opera-

tion will return to normal when the power switch is turned to ON.

4

WARNING

Pulling the lever operates the wipers and washer.

 Caution regarding the use of washer fluid

Wipers will automatically operate a couple of times after the washer squirts.
Wiper intervals can be adjusted when intermittent operation is selected.

When it is cold, do not use the washer fluid until the windshield becomes warm. The fluid may freeze on the windshield and cause low visibility. This may lead to an accident, resulting in death or serious injury.

6 Increases the intermittent windshield wiper frequency
7 Decreases the intermittent windshield wiper frequency

NOTICE  When the washer fluid tank is
empty Do not operate the switch continually as the washer fluid pump may overheat.
 When a nozzle becomes blocked
In this case, contact your Toyota dealer.Do not try to clear it with a pin or other object. The nozzle will be damaged.

COROLLA HV_U

180 4-4. Refueling
4-4.Refueling
Opening the fuel tank cap
The fuel tank of your vehicle has a special structure, which requires a reduction in fuel tank pressure before refueling. After the opener switch has been pressed, it will take several seconds until the vehicle is ready for refueling.
Before refueling the vehicle
 Turn the power switch off and ensure that all the doors and windows are closed.
 Confirm the type of fuel.
 Fuel types P.531  Fuel tank opening for unleaded
gasoline To help prevent incorrect fueling, your vehicle has a fuel tank opening that only accommodates the special nozzle on unleaded fuel pumps.
WARNING  When refueling the vehicle Observe the following precautions while refueling the vehicle. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.

 After exiting the vehicle and before opening the fuel door, touch an unpainted metal surface to discharge any static electricity. It is important to discharge static electricity before refueling because sparks resulting from static electricity can cause fuel vapors to ignite while refueling.
 Always hold the grips on the fuel tank cap and turn it slowly to remove it. A whooshing sound may be heard when the fuel tank cap is loosened. Wait until the sound cannot be heard before fully removing the cap. In hot weather, pressurized fuel may spray out the filler neck and cause injury.
 Do not allow anyone that has not discharged static electricity from their body to come close to an open fuel tank.
 Do not inhale vaporized fuel. Fuel contains substances that are harmful if inhaled.
 Do not smoke while refueling the vehicle. Doing so may cause the fuel to ignite and cause a fire.
 Do not return to the vehicle or touch any person or object that is statically charged. This may cause static electricity to build up, resulting in a possible ignition hazard.
 When refueling Observe the following precautions to prevent fuel overflowing from the fuel tank:  Securely insert the fuel nozzle
into the fuel filler neck.  Stop filling the tank after the fuel
nozzle automatically clicks off.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

WARNING Do not top off the fuel tank.

4-4. Refueling 181
on the back of the fuel filler door.

NOTICE

 Refueling

Finish refueling within 30 minutes. If more than 30 minutes passes, the internal valve closes. In this condition, fuel may overflow during the refueling process. Press the fuel filler door opener switch again.

NOTICE

Do not spill fuel during refueling. Doing so may damage the vehi-

 When refueling When refueling your vehicle,

cle, such as causing the emis-

make sure that the fuel filler door

sion control system to operate

lock is not pushed by the fuel noz- 4

abnormally or damaging fuel

zle boot, etc., as this may cause a

system components or the vehi-

valve to close, possibly resulting

cle's painted surface.

in a fuel spill.

If the fuel filler door lock has been

pushed, operate the fuel filler door

Opening the fuel tank cap opener switch in the vehicle

before continuing to refuel.

1 Press the opener switch.

The fuel filler door will open within about 10 seconds of the switch being pressed. Before refueling is possible, a message will be shown on the multi-information display in the instrument cluster to indicate the progress of the fuel filler door opener.

Closing the fuel tank cap

After refueling, turn the fuel tank cap until you hear a click. Once the cap is released, it will turn slightly in the opposite direction.

2 Turn the fuel tank cap slowly and remove it, then hang it

COROLLA HV_U

182 4-4. Refueling
WARNING  When replacing the fuel tank
cap Do not use anything but a genuine Toyota fuel tank cap designed for your vehicle. Doing so may cause a fire or other incident which may result in death or serious injury.
COROLLA HV_U

4-5. Using the driving support systems 183

4-5.Using the driving support systems
Toyota Safety Sense

WARNING

2.0

 Toyota Safety Sense 2.0

The Toyota Safety Sense 2.0 is

The Toyota Safety Sense 2.0 consists of the following

designed to operate under the assumption that the driver will drive safely, and is designed to

drive assist systems and

help reduce the impact to the

contributes to a safe and comfortable driving experi-

occupants and the vehicle in the case of a collision or assist the driver in normal driving condi-

ence:

tions.

As there is a limit to the degree of

recognition accuracy and control

Driving assist system

performance that this system can provide, do not overly rely on this

 PCS (Pre-Collision System)

system. The driver is always responsible for paying attention to

P.189  LTA (Lane Tracing Assist)

the vehicle's surroundings and driving safely.

4

P.197

Sensors

 AHB (Automatic High Beam)
P.175
 RSA (Road Sign Assist)*
P.218
*: If equipped

Two types of sensors, located behind the front grille and windshield, detect information necessary to operate the drive assist systems.

 Dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range

P.207

Radar sensor Front camera

Driving

COROLLA HV_U

184 4-5. Using the driving support systems

WARNING  To avoid malfunction of the
radar sensor Observe the following precautions. Otherwise, the radar sensor may not operate properly, possibly leading to an accident resulting in death or serious injury. Keep the radar sensor and the
radar sensor cover clean at all times.
Radar sensor Radar sensor cover If the front of the radar sensor or the front or back of the radar sensor cover is dirty or covered with water droplets, snow, etc., clean it. Clean the radar sensor and radar sensor cover with a soft cloth to avoid damaging them. Do not attach accessories, stickers (including transparent stickers) or other items to the radar sensor, radar sensor cover or surrounding area. Do not subject the radar sensor or its surrounding area to a strong impact. If the radar sensor, front grille, or front bumper has been subjected to a strong impact, have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

 Do not disassemble the radar sensor.
 Do not modify or paint the radar sensor or radar sensor cover.
 In the following cases, the radar sensor must be recalibrated. Contact your Toyota dealer for details.
· When the radar sensor or front grille are removed and installed, or replaced
· When the front bumper is replaced
 To avoid malfunction of the front camera
Observe the following precautions. Otherwise, the front camera may not operate properly, possibly leading to an accident resulting in death or serious injury.  Keep the windshield clean at all
times. · If the windshield is dirty or cov-
ered with an oily film, water droplets, snow, etc., clean the windshield. · If a glass coating agent is applied to the windshield, it will still be necessary to use the windshield wipers to remove water droplets, etc. from the area of the windshield in front of the front camera. · If the inner side of the windshield where the front camera is installed is dirty, contact your Toyota dealer.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 185

WARNING Do not attach objects, such as
stickers, transparent stickers, etc., to the outer side of the windshield in front of the front camera (shaded area in the illustration).

 Do not allow liquids to contact the front camera.
 Do not allow bright lights to shine into the front camera.
 Do not dirty or damage the front camera. When cleaning the inside of the windshield, do not allow glass cleaner to contact the lens of the front camera. Also, do not touch the lens. If the lens is dirty or damaged, contact your Toyota dealer.

 Do not subject the front camera to a strong impact.

From the top of the windshield to approximately 0.4 in. (1 cm) below the bottom of the front

 Do not change the installation position or direction of the front camera or remove it.

4

camera Approximately 7.9 in. (20 cm)

 Do not disassemble the front camera.

(Approximately 4.0 in. [10 cm] to the right and left from the center of the front camera)
If the part of the windshield in front of the front camera is fogged up or covered with condensation, or ice, use the windshield defogger to remove the fog, condensation, or ice.
(P.387)

 Do not modify any components of the vehicle around the front camera (inside rear view mirror, etc.) or ceiling.
 Do not attach any accessories to the hood, front grille or front bumper that may obstruct the front camera. Contact your Toyota dealer for details.

If water droplets cannot be properly removed from the area of the windshield in front of the front camera by the windshield wipers, replace the wiper insert or wiper blade.

 If a surfboard or other long object is to be mounted on the roof, make sure that it will not obstruct the front camera.
 Do not modify the headlights or other lights.

Do not attach window tint to the windshield.

Replace the windshield if it is damaged or cracked. After replacing the windshield, the front camera must be recalibrated. Contact your Toyota dealer for details.

COROLLA HV_U

186 4-5. Using the driving support systems
 Certification  Except for vehicles sold in Canada
 For vehicles sold in Canada
COROLLA HV_U

4-5. Using the driving support systems 187

 If a warning message is displayed on the multi-information display

A system may be temporarily unavailable or there may be a malfunction in

the system.

4

 In the following situations, perform the actions specified in the table. When the normal operating conditions are detected, the message will disappear and the system will become operational.

If the message does not disappear, contact your Toyota dealer.

Situation

Actions

When the area around a sensor is covered with dirt, moisture (fogged up, covered with condensation, ice, etc.), or other foreign matter

To clean the part of the windshield in front of the front camera, use the windshield wipers or the windshield defogger of the air conditioning system (P.387)

Driving

COROLLA HV_U

188 4-5. Using the driving support systems

Situation

Actions

If the front camera is hot, such as after the vehicle had been parked in the sun, use the air conditioning system to decrease the temperature around the front camera.

When the temperature around the front camera is outside of the operational range, such as when the vehicle is in the sun or in an extremely cold environment

If a sunshade was used when the vehicle was parked, depending on its type, the sunlight reflected from the surface of the sunshade may cause the temperature of the front camera to become excessively high.

If the front camera is cold, such after the vehicle is parked in an extremely cold environment, use the air conditioning system to increase the temperature around the front camera.

The area in front of the front camera

is obstructed, such as when the hood is open or a sticker is attached to the part of the windshield in front

Close the hood, remove the sticker, etc. to clear the obstruction.

of the front camera.

 In the following situations, if the situation has changed (or the vehicle has been driven for some time) and the normal operating conditions are detected, the message will disappear and the system will become operational.
If the message does not disappear, contact your Toyota dealer. · When the temperature around the radar sensor is outside of the opera-
tional range, such as when the vehicle is in the sun or in an extremely cold environment · When the front camera cannot detect objects in front of the vehicle, such as when driving in the dark, snow, or fog, or when bright lights are shining into the front camera

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 189

PCS (Pre-Collision System)

System functions
 Pre-collision warning

The pre-collision system uses a radar sensor and front camera to detect objects (P.192) in front of the vehicle. When the system determines that the possibility of a frontal colli-

When the system determines that the possibility of a frontal collision is high, a buzzer will sound and a warning message will be displayed on the multi-information display to urge the driver to take evasive action.

sion with an object is high, a

warning operates to urge

the driver to take evasive

action and the potential

brake pressure is increased to help the driver avoid the

4

collision. If the system

determines that the possi-

bility of a frontal collision with an object is extremely high, the brakes are automatically applied to help avoid the collision or help reduce the impact of the collision.
The pre-collision system can be disabled/enabled

 Pre-collision brake assist
When the system determines that the possibility of a frontal collision is high, the system applies greater braking force in relation to how strongly the brake pedal is depressed.
 Pre-collision braking

and the warning timing can If the system determines that

be changed. (P.191)

the possibility of a frontal colli-

sion is extremely high, the

Detectable objects

brakes are automatically applied to help avoid the collision or

The system can detect the fol- reduce the impact of the colli-

lowing:

sion.

 Vehicles

 Bicyclists

 Pedestrians

COROLLA HV_U

190 4-5. Using the driving support systems

WARNING  Limitations of the pre-colli-
sion system The driver is solely responsible
for safe driving. Always drive safely, taking care to observe your surroundings. Do not use the pre-collision system instead of normal braking operations under any circumstances. This system will not prevent collisions or lessen collision damage or injury in every situation. Do not overly rely on this system. Failure to do so may lead to an accident, resulting in death or serious injury.
Although this system is designed to help avoid a collision or help reduce the impact of the collision, its effectiveness may change according to various conditions, therefore the system may not always be able to achieve the same level of performance. Read the following conditions carefully. Do not overly rely on this system and always drive carefully.
· Conditions under which the system may operate even if there is no possibility of a collision:
P.193
· Conditions under which the system may not operate properly:
P.194
Do not attempt to test the operation of the pre-collision system yourself. Depending on the objects used for testing (dummies, cardboard objects imitating detectable objects, etc.), the system may not operate properly, possibly leading to an accident.

 Pre-collision braking  When the pre-collision braking
function is operating, a large amount of braking force will be applied.  If the vehicle is stopped by the operation of the pre-collision braking function, the pre-collision braking function operation will be canceled after approximately 2 seconds. Depress the brake pedal as necessary.  The pre-collision braking function may not operate if certain operations are performed by the driver. If the accelerator pedal is being depressed strongly or the steering wheel is being turned, the system may determine that the driver is taking evasive action and possibly prevent the pre-collision braking function from operating.  In some situations, while the pre-collision braking function is operating, operation of the function may be canceled if the accelerator pedal is depressed strongly or the steering wheel is turned and the system determines that the driver is taking evasive action.  If the brake pedal is being depressed, the system may determine that the driver is taking evasive action and possibly delay the operation timing of the pre-collision braking function.  When to disable the pre-collision system In the following situations, disable the system, as it may not operate properly, possibly leading to an accident resulting in death or serious injury:  When the vehicle is being towed

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 191

WARNING When your vehicle is towing
another vehicle When transporting the vehicle
via truck, boat, train or similar means of transportation When the vehicle is raised on a lift with the hybrid system on and the tires are allowed to rotate freely

Changing settings of the pre-collision system
 Enabling/disabling the pre-collision system
The pre-collision system can be
enabled/disabled on (P.544) of the multi-information display.

When inspecting the vehicle using a drum tester such as a

The system is automatically enabled each time the power

chassis dynamometer or speedometer tester, or when using an on vehicle wheel balancer

switch is turned to ON.
If the system is disabled, the

When a strong impact is applied to the front bumper or front

PCS warning light will turn on and a message will be displayed

4

grille, due to an accident or other reasons

on the multi-information display.

If the vehicle cannot be driven in a stable manner, such as when the vehicle has been in an accident or is malfunctioning

When the vehicle is driven in a sporty manner or off-road

When the tires are not properly inflated

When the tires are very worn When tires of a size other than
specified are installed When tire chains are installed When a compact spare tire or
an emergency tire puncture repair kit is used If equipment (snow plow, etc.) that may obstruct the radar sensor or front camera is temporarily installed to the vehicle

 Changing the pre-collision warning timing
The pre-collision warning timing
can be changed on (P.544) of the multi-information display.
The warning timing setting is retained when the power switch is turned off. However, if the pre-collision system is disabled and re-enabled, the operation timing will return to the default setting (middle).

COROLLA HV_U

192

4-5. Using the driving support systems
2 Middle
This is the default setting.
3 Late

1 Early

 Operational conditions The pre-collision system is enabled and the system determines that the possibility of a frontal collision with a detected object is high. Each function is operational at the following speed  Pre-collision warning

Detectable objects

Vehicle speed

Relative speed between your vehicle and object

Vehicles

Approx. 7 to 110 mph Approx. 7 to 110 mph

(10 to 180 km/h)

(10 to 180 km/h)

Bicyclists and pedestri- Approx. 7 to 50 mph (10 Approx. 7 to 50 mph (10

ans

to 80 km/h)

to 80 km/h)

 Pre-collision brake assist

Detectable objects

Vehicle speed

Relative speed between your vehicle and object

Vehicles

Approx. 20 to 110 mph Approx. 20 to 110 mph

(30 to 180 km/h)

(30 to 180 km/h)

Bicyclists and pedestri- Approx. 20 to 50 mph Approx. 20 to 50 mph

ans

(30 to 80 km/h)

(30 to 80 km/h)

 Pre-collision braking

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 193

Detectable objects

Vehicle speed

Relative speed between your vehicle and object

Vehicles

Approx. 7 to 110 mph Approx. 7 to 110 mph

(10 to 180 km/h)

(10 to 180 km/h)

Bicyclists and pedestri- Approx. 7 to 50 mph (10 Approx. 7 to 50 mph (10

ans

to 80 km/h)

to 80 km/h)

The system may not operate in the following situations:

 If a 12-volt battery terminal has been disconnected and reconnected and then the vehicle has not been driven for a certain amount of time

 If the shift lever is in R

 When the VSC OFF indicator is illuminated (only the pre-collision warning function will be operational)

 Object detection function

 Conditions under which the

The system detects objects based on their size, profile, motion, etc. However, an object may not be

system may operate even if

there is no possibility of a colli-

sion

4

detected depending on the sur-

 In some situations such as the fol-

rounding brightness and the motion,

lowing, the system may determine

posture, and angle of the detected

that there is a possibility of a fron-

object, preventing the system from

tal collision and operate.

operating properly. (P.194)

· When passing a detectable object,

The illustration shows an image of

etc.

detectable objects.

· When changing lanes while over-

taking a detectable object, etc.

· When approaching a detectable

object in an adjacent lane or on

the roadside, such as when

changing the course of travel or

driving on a winding road

 Cancelation of the pre-collision braking
If either of the following occur while the pre-collision braking function is operating, it will be canceled:  The accelerator pedal is
depressed strongly.  The steering wheel is turned
sharply or abruptly.

· When rapidly closing on a detectable object, etc.
· When approaching objects on the roadside, such as detectable objects, guardrails, utility poles, trees, or walls
· When there is a detectable object or other object by the roadside at the entrance of a curve

COROLLA HV_U

194

4-5. Using the driving support systems (road sign, billboard, etc.)

· When there are patterns or paint in front of your vehicle that may be mistaken for a detectable object
· When the front of your vehicle is hit by water, snow, dust, etc.
· When overtaking a detectable object that is changing lanes or making a right/left turn

· When approaching an electric toll gate barrier, parking area barrier, or other barrier that opens and closes
· When using an automatic car wash
· When driving through or under objects that may contact your vehicle, such as thick grass, tree branches, or a banner

· When passing a detectable object in an oncoming lane that is stopped to make a right/left turn
· When a detectable object approaches very close and then stops before entering the path of your vehicle
· If the front of your vehicle is raised or lowered, such as when on an uneven or undulating road surface
· When driving on a road surrounded by a structure, such as in a tunnel or on an iron bridge
· When there is a metal object (manhole cover, steel plate, etc.), steps, or a protrusion in front of your vehicle
· When passing under an object

· When driving through steam or smoke
· When driving near an object that reflects radio waves, such as a large truck or guardrail
· When driving near a TV tower, broadcasting station, electric power plant, or other location where strong radio waves or electrical noise may be present
 Situations in which the system may not operate properly
 In some situations such as the following, an object may not be detected by the radar sensor and front camera, preventing the system from operating properly:
· When a detectable object is approaching your vehicle
· When your vehicle or a detectable object is wobbling
· If a detectable object makes an abrupt maneuver (such as sudden

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 195

swerving, acceleration or deceleration) · When your vehicle approaches a detectable object rapidly · When a detectable object is not directly in front of your vehicle

rear end, such as a low bed trailer

· If a vehicle ahead has extremely high ground clearance

· When a detectable object is near

a wall, fence, guardrail, manhole

cover, vehicle, steel plate on the

road, etc.

· When a detectable object is under a structure

4

· When part of a detectable object is hidden by an object, such as large baggage, an umbrella, or guardrail
· When multiple detectable objects are close together
· If the sun or other light is shining directly on a detectable object
· When a detectable object is a shade of white and looks extremely bright
· When a detectable object appears to be nearly the same color or brightness as its surroundings
· If a detectable object cuts or suddenly emerges in front of your vehicle
· When the front of your vehicle is hit by water, snow, dust, etc.
· When a very bright light ahead, such as the sun or the headlights of oncoming traffic, shines directly into the front camera
· When approaching the side or front of a vehicle ahead
· If a vehicle ahead is a motorcycle · If a vehicle ahead is narrow, such
as a personal mobility vehicle · If a preceding vehicle has a small
rear end, such as an unloaded truck · If a preceding vehicle has a low

· If a vehicle ahead is carrying a load which protrudes past its rear bumper
· If a vehicle ahead is irregularly shaped, such as a tractor or side car
· If a vehicle ahead is a child sized bicycle, a bicycle that is carrying a large load, a bicycle ridden by more than one person, or a uniquely shaped bicycle (bicycle with a child seat, tandem bicycle, etc.)
· If a pedestrian/or the riding height of a bicyclist ahead is shorter than approximately 3.2 ft. (1 m) or taller than approximately 6.5 ft. (2 m)
· If a pedestrian/bicyclist is wearing oversized clothing (a rain coat, long skirt, etc.), making their silhouette obscure
· If a pedestrian is bending forward or squatting or bicyclist is bending forward
· If a pedestrian/bicyclist is moving fast
· If a pedestrian is pushing a stroller, wheelchair, bicycle or other vehicle
· When driving in inclement weather such as heavy rain, fog, snow or a sandstorm

COROLLA HV_U

196 4-5. Using the driving support systems

· When driving through steam or smoke
· When the surrounding area is dim, such as at dawn or dusk, or while at night or in a tunnel, making a detectable object appear to be nearly the same color as its surroundings
· When driving in a place where the surrounding brightness changes suddenly, such as at the entrance or exit of a tunnel
· After the hybrid system has started the vehicle has not been driven for a certain amount of time
· While making a left/right turn and for a few seconds after making a left/right turn
· While driving on a curve and for a few seconds after driving on a curve
· If your vehicle is skidding · If the front of the vehicle is raised
or lowered

sively worn, improper tire inflation pressure, etc.) · When the vehicle is being driven on a gravel road or other slippery surface  If VSC is disabled  If VSC is disabled (P.241), the pre-collision brake assist and pre-collision braking functions are also disabled.  The PCS warning light will turn on and "VSC Turned OFF Pre-Collision Brake System Unavailable" will be displayed on the multi-information display.

· If the wheels are misaligned · If a wiper blade is blocking the
front camera · The vehicle is being driven at
extremely high speeds · When driving on a hill · If the radar sensor or front camera
is misaligned  In some situations such as the fol-
lowing, sufficient braking force may not be obtained, preventing the system from performing properly: · If the braking functions cannot operate to their full extent, such as when the brake parts are extremely cold, extremely hot, or wet · If the vehicle is not properly maintained (brakes or tires are exces-
COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 197

LTA (Lane Tracing

WARNING

Assist)

 Before using LTA system

When driving on highways and freeways with white (yellow) lane lines, this function alerts the driver when the vehicle might depart from its lane or
course* and provides assistance by operating the steering wheel to keep the vehicle in its lane or
course*. Furthermore, the

 Do not rely solely upon the LTA system. The LTA system does not automatically drive the vehicle or reduce the amount of attention that must be paid to the area in front of the vehicle. The driver must always assume full responsibility for driving safely by paying careful attention to the surrounding conditions and operating the steering wheel to correct the path of the vehicle. Also, the driver must take adequate breaks when fatigued, such as from driving for a long period of time.

system provides steering assistance when dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range is operat-

 Failure to perform appropriate

4

driving operations and pay care-

ful attention may lead to an

accident, resulting in death or

serious injury.

ing to keep the vehicle in its lane.
The LTA system recognizes white (yellow) lane lines or a course* using the front camera. Additionally, it detects preceding vehicles using the front camera and radar.

 When not using the LTA system, use the LTA switch to turn the system off.
 Situations unsuitable for LTA system
In the following situations, use the LTA switch to turn the system off. Failure to do so may lead to an accident, resulting in death or serious injury.

*: Boundary between asphalt and the side of the road, such as grass, soil, or a curb

 Vehicle is driven on a road surface which is slippery due to rainy weather, fallen snow, freezing, etc.

 Vehicle is driven on a snow-covered road.

 White (yellow) lines are difficult to see due to rain, snow, fog, dust, etc.

 Vehicle is driven in a temporary lane or restricted lane due to construction work.

COROLLA HV_U

198 4-5. Using the driving support systems

WARNING Vehicle is driven in a construc-
tion zone. A spare tire, tire chains, etc. are
equipped. When the tires have been
excessively worn, or when the tire inflation pressure is low. When tires of a size other than specified are installed. Vehicle is driven in traffic lanes other than that highways and freeways. During emergency towing.  Preventing LTA system malfunctions and operations performed by mistake Do not modify the headlights or place stickers, etc. on the surface of the lights. Do not modify the suspension etc. If the suspension etc. needs to be replaced, contact your Toyota dealer. Do not install or place anything on the hood or grille. Also, do not install a grille guard (bull bars, kangaroo bar, etc.). If your windshield needs repairs, contact your Toyota dealer.  Conditions in which functions may not operate properly In the following situations, the functions may not operate properly and the vehicle may depart from its lane. Drive safely by always paying careful attention to your surroundings and operate the steering wheel to correct the path of the vehicle without relying solely on the functions.

 When the follow-up cruising dis-
play is displayed (P.202) and
the preceding vehicle changes lanes. (Your vehicle may follow the preceding vehicle and also change lanes.)
 When the follow-up cruising dis-
play is displayed (P.202) and
the preceding vehicle is swaying. (Your vehicle may sway accordingly and depart from the lane.)  When the follow-up cruising dis-
play is displayed (P.202) and
the preceding vehicle departs from its lane. (Your vehicle may follow the preceding vehicle and depart from the lane.)  When the follow-up cruising dis-
play is displayed (P.202) and
the preceding vehicle is being driven extremely close to the left/right lane line. (Your vehicle may follow the preceding vehicle and depart from the lane.)  Vehicle is being driven around a sharp curve.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 199

WARNING Objects or patterns that could
be mistaken for white (yellow) lines are present on the side of the road (guardrails, reflective poles, etc.). Vehicle is driven where the road diverges, merges, etc.
Repair marks of asphalt, white (yellow) lines, etc. are present due to road repair.
There are shadows on the road that run parallel with, or cover, the white (yellow) lines.

 The vehicle is driven in an area without white (yellow) lines, such as in front of a tollgate or checkpoint, or at an intersection, etc.

 The white (yellow) lines are cracked, "Botts' dots", "Raised pavement marker" or stones are present.

 The white (yellow) lines cannot be seen or are difficult to see due to sand, etc.

 The vehicle is driven on a road surface that is wet due to rain, puddles, etc.

 The traffic lines are yellow

(which may be more difficult to recognize than lines that are

4

white).

 The white (yellow) lines cross over a curb, etc.

 The vehicle is driven on a bright surface, such as concrete.

 If the edge of the road is not clear or straight.

 The vehicle is driven on a surface that is bright due to reflected light, etc.

 The vehicle is driven in an area where the brightness changes suddenly, such as at the entrances and exits of tunnels, etc.

 Light from the headlights of an oncoming vehicle, the sun, etc. enters the camera.

 The vehicle is driven on a slope.

 The vehicle is driven on a road which tilts left or right, or a winding road.

 The vehicle is driven on an unpaved or rough road.

COROLLA HV_U

200 4-5. Using the driving support systems

WARNING The traffic lane is excessively
narrow or wide. The vehicle is extremely tilted
due to carrying heavy luggage or having improper tire pressure. The distance to the preceding vehicle is extremely short. The vehicle is moving up and down a large amount due to road conditions during driving (poor roads or road seams). When driving in a tunnel or at night with the headlights off or when a headlight is dim due to its lens being dirty or it being misaligned. The vehicle is struck by a crosswind. The vehicle is affected by wind from a vehicle driven in a nearby lane.

ing is displayed on the multi-information display, and a warning buzzer will sound to alert the driver.
When the warning buzzer sounds, check the area around your vehicle and carefully operate the steering wheel to move the vehicle back to the center of the lane.
Vehicle with BSM: When the system determines that the vehicle might depart from its lane and that the possibility of a collision with an overtaking vehicle in the adjacent lane is high, the lane departure alert will operate even if the turn signals are operating.
*: Boundary between asphalt and the side of the road, such as grass, soil, or a curb

The vehicle has just changed lanes or crossed an intersection.

Tires which differ by structure, manufacturer, brand or tread pattern are used.

Snow tires, etc. are equipped. The vehicle is being driven at
extremely high speeds.

Functions included in LTA system
 Lane departure alert function
When the system determines that the vehicle might depart from its lane or course*, a warn-

 Steering assist function
When the system determines that the vehicle might depart from its lane or course*, the sys-

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 201

tem provides assistance as necessary by operating the steering wheel in small amounts for a short period of time to keep the vehicle in its lane.
If the system detects that the steering wheel has not been operated for a fixed amount of time or the steering wheel is not being firmly gripped, a warning is displayed on the multi-information display and the function is temporarily canceled.

 Vehicle sway warning function
When the vehicle is swaying within a lane, the warning buzzer will sound and a message will be displayed on the multi-information display to alert the driver.

Vehicle with BSM: When the sys-

tem determines that the vehicle

might depart from its lane and that

the possibility of a collision with an

4

overtaking vehicle in the adjacent

lane is high, the steering assist

function will operate even if the turn

signals are operating.

*: Boundary between asphalt and

the side of the road, such as

grass, soil, or a curb

 Lane centering function
This function is linked with dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range and provides the required assistance by operating the steering wheel to keep the vehicle in its current lane.
When dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range is not operating, the lane centering function does not operate.
In situations where the white (yellow) lane lines are difficult to see or are not visible, such as when in a

COROLLA HV_U

202 4-5. Using the driving support systems

traffic jam, this function will operate to help follow a preceding vehicle by monitoring the position of the preceding vehicle.
If the system detects that the steering wheel has not been operated for a fixed amount of time or the steering wheel is not being firmly gripped, a warning is displayed on the multi-information display and the function is temporarily canceled.

next time the hybrid system is started.
Indications on multi-information display

Turning LTA system on
Press the LTA switch to turn the LTA system on.
The LTA indicator illuminates and a message is displayed on the multi-information display.
Press the LTA switch again to turn the LTA system off.
When the LTA system is turned on or off, operation of the LTA system continues in the same condition the

LTA indicator
The illumination condition of the indicator informs the driver of the system operation status.
Illuminated in white: LTA system is operating.
Illuminated in green: Steering wheel assistance of the steering assist function or lane centering function is operating.
Flashing in orange: Lane departure alert function is operating.
Operation display of steering wheel operation support
Displayed when the multi-information display is switched to the driving support system information screen.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 203

Indicates that steering wheel assistance of the steering assist function or lane centering function is operat-

 Inside of displayed lines is black

ing.

Both outer sides of the lane are dis-

played: Indicates that steering

wheel assist of the lane centering

function is operating.

One outer side of the lane is dis-

played: Indicates that steering

wheel assist of the steering assist

function is operating.

Both outer sides of the lane are flashing: Alerts the driver that their

Indicates that the system is not able to recognize white (yellow)

input is necessary to stay in the

lines or a course* or is temporar-

center of the lane (lane centering

ily canceled.

function).
Lane departure alert function

*: Boundary between asphalt and the side of the road, such as

4

display

grass, soil, or a curb

Displayed when the multi-information display is switched to the driving support system information screen.
 Inside of displayed lines is white

Follow-up cruising display
Displayed when the multi-information display is switched to the driving support system information screen.
Indicates that steering assist of the

lane centering function is operating

by monitoring the position of a pre-

ceding vehicle.

When the follow-up cruising display

is displayed, if the preceding vehi-

cle moves, your vehicle may move

in the same way. Always pay care-

ful attention to your surroundings

and operate the steering wheel as

Indicates that the system is recognizing white (yellow) lines or a

necessary to correct the path of the vehicle and ensure safety.

course*. When the vehicle departs from its lane, the white line displayed on the side the vehicle departs from flashes orange.

 Operation conditions of each function
 Lane departure alert function
This function operates when all of the following conditions are met. · LTA is turned on.

COROLLA HV_U

204 4-5. Using the driving support systems

· Vehicle speed is approximately 32 mph (50 km/h) or more.*1
· System recognizes white (yellow) lane lines or a course*2. (When a white [yellow] line or course*2 is recognized on only one side, the system will operate only for the recognized side.)
· Width of traffic lane is approximately 9.8 ft. (3 m) or more.
· Turn signal lever is not operated. (Vehicle with BSM: Except when another vehicle is in the lane on the side where the turn signal was operated)
· Vehicle is not being driven around a sharp curve.
· No system malfunctions are detected. (P.206)
*1: The function operates even if the vehicle speed is less than approximately 32 mph (50 km/h) when the lane centering function is operating.
*2: Boundary between asphalt and the side of the road, such as grass, soil, or a curb
 Steering assist function
This function operates when all of the following conditions are met in addition to the operation conditions for the lane departure alert function.
· Setting for "Steering Assist" in of the multi-information display is set to "ON". (P.544)
· Vehicle is not accelerated or decelerated by a fixed amount or more.
· Steering wheel is not operated with a steering force level suitable for changing lanes.
· ABS, VSC, TRAC and PCS are not operating.
· TRAC or VSC is not turned off. · Hands off steering wheel warning
is not displayed. (P.205)  Vehicle sway warning function
This function operates when all of

the following conditions are met.
· Setting for "Sway Warning" in of the multi-information display is set to "ON". (P.544)
· Vehicle speed is approximately 32 mph (50 km/h) or more.
· Width of traffic lane is approximately 9.8 ft. (3 m) or more.
· No system malfunctions are detected. (P.206)
 Lane centering function
This function operates when all of the following conditions are met. · LTA is turned on. · Setting for "Steering Assist" and
"Lane Center" in of the multi-information display are set to "ON". (P.544) · This function recognizes white (yellow) lane lines or the position of a preceding vehicle (except when the preceding vehicle is small, such as a motorcycle). · The dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range is operating in vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode. · Width of traffic lane is approximately 10 to 13 ft. (3 to 4 m). · Turn signal lever is not operated. · Vehicle is not being driven around a sharp curve. · No system malfunctions are detected. (P.206) · Vehicle does not accelerate or decelerate by a fixed amount or more. · Steering wheel is not operated with a steering force level suitable for changing lanes. · ABS, VSC, TRAC and PCS are not operating. · TRAC or VSC is not turned off. · Hands off steering wheel warning is not displayed. (P.205) · The vehicle is being driven in the center of a lane. · Steering assist function is not operating.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 205

 Temporary cancelation of func-  Hands off steering wheel warn-

tions

ing

 When operation conditions are no longer met, a function may be temporarily canceled. However, when the operation conditions are met again, operation of the function is automatically restored. (P.203)
 If the operation conditions (P.201) are no longer met while the lane centering function is operating, the buzzer may sound to indicate that the function has been temporarily canceled.

In the following situations, a warning message urging the driver to hold the steering wheel and the symbol shown in the illustration are displayed on the multi-information display to warn the driver. The warning stops when the system determines that the driver holds the steering wheel. Always keep your hands on the steering wheel when using this system, regardless of warnings.

 Steering assist function/lane centering function

 Depending on the vehicle speed,

lane departure situation, road conditions, etc., the driver may not

4

feel the function is operating or

the function may not operate at all.

 When the system determines that the driver is driving without hold-

 The steering control of the func-

ing the steering wheel while the

tion is overridden by the driver's

system is operating

steering wheel operation.

If the driver continues to keep their

 Do not attempt to test the opera- hands off of the steering wheel, the

tion of the steering assist function. buzzer sounds, the driver is warned

 Lane departure alert function

and the function is temporarily canceled. This warning also operates in

 The warning buzzer may be diffi- the same way when the driver con-

cult to hear due to external noise, tinuously operates the steering

audio playback, etc.

wheel only a small amount.

 If the edge of the course* is not clear or straight, the lane departure alert function may not operate.
 Vehicle with BSM: It may not be possible for the system to determine if there is a danger of a collision with a vehicle in an adjacent lane.
 Do not attempt to test the operation of the lane departure alert function.
*: Boundary between asphalt and the side of the road, such as grass, soil, or a curb

 When the system determines that the vehicle may not turn and instead depart from its lane while driving around a curve
Depending on the vehicle condition and road conditions, the warning may not operate. Also, if the system determines that the vehicle is driving around a curve, warnings will occur earlier than during straight-lane driving.  When the system determines that
the driver is driving without holding the steering wheel while the steering wheel assist of the steering assist function is operating.

COROLLA HV_U

206 4-5. Using the driving support systems

If the driver continues to keep their hands off of the steering wheel and the steering wheel assist is operating, the buzzer sounds and the driver is warned. Each time the buzzer sounds, the continuing time of the buzzer becomes longer.  Vehicle sway warning function When the system determines that the vehicle is swaying while the vehicle sway warning function is operating, a buzzer sounds and a warning message urging the driver to rest and the symbol shown in the illustration are simultaneously displayed on the multi-information display.

 "LTA Unavailable at Current Speed"
The function cannot be used as the vehicle speed exceeds the LTA operation range. Drive slower.  Customization Function settings can be changed. (P.544)

Depending on the vehicle and road conditions, the warning may not operate.  Warning message If the following warning message is displayed on the multi-information display and the LTA indicator illuminates in orange, follow the appropriate troubleshooting procedure. Also, if a different warning message is displayed, follow the instructions displayed on the screen.  "LTA Malfunction Visit Your
Dealer" The system may not be operating properly. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.  "LTA Unavailable" The system is temporarily canceled due to a malfunction in a sensor other than the front camera. Turn the LTA system off, wait for a little while, and then turn the LTA system back on.
COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems

Dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range

Indicators  Operation switches

207

In vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode, the vehicle automatically accelerates, decelerates and stops to match the speed changes of the preceding vehicle even if the accelerator pedal is not depressed. In constant speed control mode, the vehicle runs at a fixed speed. Use the dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range on freeways and highways.  Vehicle-to-vehicle distance
control mode (P.210)  Constant speed control
mode (P.214)
System Components
 Meter display
Multi-information display Set speed

Vehicle-to-vehicle distance switch

"+RES" switch

Cruise control main switch

4

Cancel switch

"-SET" switch

WARNING
 Before using dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range
 Driving safely is the sole responsibility of the driver. Do not rely solely on the system, and drive safely by always paying careful attention to your surroundings.
 The dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range provides driving assistance to reduce the driver's burden. However, there are limitations to the assistance provided.
Read the following conditions carefully. Do not overly rely on this system and always drive carefully. · When the sensor may not be
correctly detecting the vehicle
ahead: P.216

COROLLA HV_U

208 4-5. Using the driving support systems

WARNING · Conditions under which the
vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode may not function cor-
rectly: P.217
Set the speed appropriately depending on the speed limit, traffic flow, road conditions, weather conditions, etc. The driver is responsible for checking the set speed.
Even when the system is functioning normally, the condition of the preceding vehicle as detected by the system may differ from the condition observed by the driver. Therefore, the driver must always remain alert, assess the danger of each situation and drive safely. Relying solely on this system or assuming the system ensures safety while driving can lead to an accident, resulting in death or serious injury.
Switch the dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range setting to off, using the cruise control main switch when not in use.
 Cautions regarding the driving assist systems
Observe the following precautions, as there are limitations to the assistance provided by the system. Failure to do so may cause an accident resulting in death or serious injury.

 Assisting the driver to measure following distance
The dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range is only intended to help the driver in determining the following distance between the driver's own vehicle and a designated vehicle traveling ahead. It is not a mechanism that allows careless or inattentive driving, and it is not a system that can assist the driver in low-visibility conditions. It is still necessary for driver to pay close attention to the vehicle's surroundings.
 Assisting the driver to judge proper following distance
The dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range determines whether the following distance between the driver's own vehicle and a designated vehicle traveling ahead is within a set range. It is not capable of making any other type of judgement. Therefore, it is absolutely necessary for the driver to remain vigilant and to determine whether or not there is a possibility of danger in any given situation.
 Assisting the driver to operate the vehicle
The dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range does not include functions which will prevent or avoid collisions with vehicles ahead of your vehicle. Therefore, if there is ever any possibility of danger, the driver must take immediate and direct control of the vehicle and act appropriately in order to ensure the safety of all involved.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems
WARNING  Situations unsuitable for
dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range Do not use dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range in any of the following situations. Doing so may result in inappropriate speed control and could cause an accident resulting in death or serious injury. Roads where there are pedestrians, cyclists, etc. In heavy traffic On roads with sharp bends On winding roads On slippery roads, such as those covered with rain, ice or snow On steep downhills, or where there are sudden changes between sharp up and down gradients Vehicle speed may exceed the set speed when driving down a steep hill. At entrances to freeways and highways When weather conditions are bad enough that they may prevent the sensors from detecting correctly (fog, snow, sandstorm, heavy rain, etc.) When there is rain, snow, etc. on the front surface of the radar or front camera In traffic conditions that require frequent repeated acceleration and deceleration During emergency towing When an approach warning buzzer is heard often

209
4

COROLLA HV_U

210 4-5. Using the driving support systems Driving in vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode
This mode employs a radar to detect the presence of vehicles up to approximately 328 ft. (100 m) ahead, determines the current vehicle-to-vehicle following distance, and operates to maintain a suitable following distance from the vehicle ahead. The desired vehicle-to-vehicle distance can also be set by operating the vehicle-to-vehicle distance switch.
When driving on downhill slopes, the vehicle-to-vehicle distance may become shorter.
Example of constant speed cruising When there are no vehicles ahead
The vehicle travels at the speed set by the driver.
Example of deceleration cruising and follow-up cruising When a preceding vehicle driving slower than the set speed appears
When a vehicle is detected running ahead of you, the system automatically decelerates your vehicle. When a greater reduction in vehicle speed is necessary, the system applies the brakes (the stop lights will come on at this time). The system will respond to changes in the speed of the vehicle ahead in order to maintain the vehicle-to-vehicle distance set by the driver. Approach warning warns you when the system cannot decelerate sufficiently to prevent your vehicle from closing in on the vehicle ahead. When the vehicle ahead of you stops, your vehicle will also stop (vehicle is stopped by system control). After the vehicle ahead starts off, pressing the "+RES" switch or depressing the accelerator pedal (start-off operation) will resume follow-up cruising. If the start-off operation is not performed, system control continues to keep your vehicle stopped.
COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 211

When the turn signal lever is operated and your vehicle moves to an overtaking lane while driving at 50 mph (80 km/h) or more, the vehicle will accelerate to help to overtake a passing vehicle.

The system's identification of what is an overtaking lane may be determined solely based on the location of the steering wheel in the vehicle (left side driver position versus right side driver position.) If the vehicle is driven to a region where the overtaking lane is on a different side from where the vehicle is normally driven, the vehicle may accelerate when the turn signal lever is operated in the opposite direction to the overtaking lane (e.g., if the driver normally operates the vehicle in a region where the overtaking lane is to the right but then drives to a region where the overtaking lane is to the left, the vehicle may accelerate when the right turn signal is activated).

Example of acceleration When there are no longer any preceding vehicles driving slower than the set speed

The system accelerates until the set speed is reached. The system then

returns to constant speed cruising.

4

Setting the vehicle speed (vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode)
1 Press the cruise control main switch to activate the cruise control.
Dynamic radar cruise control indicator will come on and a message will be displayed on the multi-information display. Press the switch again to deactivate the cruise control. If the cruise control main switch is pressed and held for 1.5 seconds or more, the system turns on in constant speed control mode.

(P.214)
2 Accelerate or decelerate, with accelerator pedal operation, to the desired vehicle speed (at or above approximately 20 mph [30 km/h]) and press the "-SET" switch to set the speed.
Cruise control "SET" indicator will come on. The vehicle speed at the moment the switch is released becomes the

COROLLA HV_U

212 4-5. Using the driving support systems

set speed.
Adjusting the set speed
To change the set speed, press the "+RES" or "-SET" switch until the desired set speed is displayed.
1 Increases the speed (Except when the vehicle has been stopped by system control in vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode)
2 Decreases the speed
Fine adjustment: Press the switch. Large adjustment: Press and hold the switch to change the speed, and release when the desired speed is reached.
In the vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode, the set speed will be increased or decreased as follows:

 For the U.S. mainland and Hawaii
Fine adjustment: By 1 mph (1.6 km/h)*1 or 1 km/h (0.6 mph)*2 each time the switch is pressed Large adjustment: Increases or decreases in 1 mph (1.6 km/h)*1 or 1 km/h (0.6 mph)*2 increments for as long as the switch is held
 Except for the U.S. mainland and Hawaii
Fine adjustment: By 1 mph (1.6 km/h)*1 or 1 km/h (0.6 mph)*2 each time the switch is pressed Large adjustment: Increases or decreases in 5 mph (8 km/h)*1 or 5 km/h (3.1 mph)*2 increments for as long as the switch is held
In the constant speed control mode (P.214), the set speed will be increased or decreased as follows:
Fine adjustment: By 1 mph (1.6 km/h)*1 or 1 km/h (0.6 mph)*2 each time the switch is pressed
Large adjustment: The speed will continue to change while the switch is held. *1: When the set speed is shown in
"MPH" *2: When the set speed is shown in
"km/h"
Changing the vehicle-to-vehicle distance (vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode)
Pressing the switch changes the

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 213

vehicle-to-vehicle distance as follows:

Distance Vehicle-to-vehicle dis-

options

tance

Long

Approximately 160 ft. (50 m)

Medium

Approximately 130 ft. (40 m)

Short

Approximately 100 ft. (30 m)

1 Long 2 Medium 3 Short

Resuming follow-up cruising when the vehicle has been stopped by system control (vehi-

The vehicle-to-vehicle distance is set automatically to long mode when the power switch is turned to

cle-to-vehicle distance control mode)

4

ON. If a vehicle is running ahead of you,

After the vehicle ahead of you starts off, press the "+RES"

the preceding vehicle mark will switch.

also be displayed.

Your vehicle will also resume

Vehicle-to-vehicle distance settings (vehicle-to-vehicle distance

follow-up cruising if the accelerator pedal is depressed after the vehicle ahead of you starts off.

control mode)

Select a distance from the table below. Note that the distances shown correspond to a vehicle speed of 50 mph (80 km/h). Vehicle-to-vehicle distance increases/decreases in accordance with vehicle speed. When the vehicle is stopped by system control, the vehicle stops at a certain vehicle-to-vehicle distance depending on the situation.

COROLLA HV_U

214 4-5. Using the driving support systems
Canceling and resuming the speed control

1 Pressing the cancel switch cancels the speed control.
The speed control is also canceled when the brake pedal is depressed. (When the vehicle has been stopped by system control, depressing the brake pedal does not cancel the setting.)
2 Pressing the "+RES" switch resumes the cruise control and returns vehicle speed to the set speed.
Approach warning (vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode)
When your vehicle is too close to a vehicle ahead, and sufficient automatic deceleration via the cruise control is not possible, the display will flash and the buzzer will sound to alert the driver. An example of this would be if another driver cuts in front of you while you are following a vehicle. Depress the brake pedal to ensure an appropriate vehicle-to-vehicle distance.

 Warnings may not occur when
In the following instances, warnings may not occur even when the vehicle-to-vehicle distance is small.
 When the speed of the preceding vehicle matches or exceeds your vehicle speed
 When the preceding vehicle is traveling at an extremely slow speed
 Immediately after the cruise control speed was set
 When depressing the accelerator pedal
Selecting constant speed control mode
When constant speed control mode is selected, your vehicle will maintain a set speed without controlling the vehicle-to-vehicle distance. Select this mode only when vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode does not function correctly due to a dirty radar, etc.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 215

1 With the cruise control off, press and hold the cruise
control main switch for 1.5
seconds or more.

setting: P.214

Immediately after the switch is pressed, the dynamic radar cruise control indicator will come on. Afterwards, it switches to the cruise control indicator.

Switching to constant speed control mode is only possible when operating the switch with the cruise control off.

 Dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range can be set when

 The shift lever is in D.

 The desired set speed can be set when the vehicle speed is approximately 20 mph (30 km/h) or more. 4 (However, when the vehicle speed is set while driving at below approximately 20 mph [30 km/h], the set speed will be set to approximately 20 mph [30 km/h].)

2 Accelerate or decelerate, with accelerator pedal operation, to the desired vehicle speed (at or above approximately 20 mph [30 km/h]) and press the "-SET" switch to set the speed.
Cruise control "SET" indicator will come on.
The vehicle speed at the moment the switch is released becomes the set speed.
Adjusting the speed setting: P.212 Canceling and resuming the speed

 Accelerating after setting the vehicle speed
The vehicle can accelerate by operating the accelerator pedal. After accelerating, the set speed resumes. However, during vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode, the vehicle speed may decrease below the set speed in order to maintain the distance to the preceding vehicle.  When the vehicle stops while
follow-up cruising  Pressing the "+RES" switch while
the vehicle ahead stops will resume follow-up cruising if the vehicle ahead starts off within approximately 3 seconds after the switch is pressed.

 If the vehicle ahead starts off within 3 seconds after your vehicle stops, follow-up cruising will be resumed.

COROLLA HV_U

216 4-5. Using the driving support systems

 Automatic cancelation of vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode
Vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode is automatically canceled in the following situations.  VSC is activated.  TRAC is activated for a period of
time.  When the VSC or TRAC system is
turned off.  The sensor cannot detect cor-
rectly because it is covered in some way.  Pre-collision braking is activated.  The parking brake is operated.  The vehicle is stopped by system control on a steep incline.  The following are detected when the vehicle has been stopped by system control: · The driver is not wearing a seat belt. · The driver's door is opened. · The vehicle has been stopped for about 3 minutes If vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode is automatically canceled for any reasons other than the above, there may be a malfunction in the system. Contact your Toyota dealer.
 Automatic cancelation of constant speed control mode
Constant speed control mode is automatically canceled in the following situations:  Actual vehicle speed is more than
approximately 10 mph (16 km/h) below the set vehicle speed.  Actual vehicle speed falls below approximately 20 mph (30 km/h).  VSC is activated.  TRAC is activated for a period of time.  When the VSC or TRAC system is turned off.  Pre-collision braking is activated.

If constant speed control mode is automatically canceled for any reasons other than the above, there may be a malfunction in the system. Contact your Toyota dealer.
 Brake operation A brake operation sound may be heard and the brake pedal response may change, but these are not malfunctions.
 Warning messages and buzzers for dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range
Warning messages and buzzers are used to indicate a system malfunction or to inform the driver of the need for caution while driving. If a warning message is shown on the multi-information display, read the message and follow the instructions. (P.187, 487)  When the sensor may not be
correctly detecting the vehicle ahead In the case of the following and depending on the conditions, operate the brake pedal when deceleration of the system is insufficient or operate the accelerator pedal when acceleration is required. As the sensor may not be able to correctly detect these types of vehicles, the approach warning (P.214) may not be activated.  Vehicles that cut in suddenly  Vehicles traveling at low speeds  Vehicles that are not moving in the same lane  Vehicles with small rear ends (trailers with no load on board, etc.)

COROLLA HV_U

4-5. Using the driving support systems 217

Driving

 Motorcycles traveling in the same lane
 When water or snow thrown up by the surrounding vehicles hinders the detecting of the sensor
 When your vehicle is pointing upwards (caused by a heavy load in the luggage compartment, etc.)

 When steering wheel operation or your position in the lane is unstable

4

 When the vehicle ahead of you decelerates suddenly

 When driving on a road surrounded by a structure, such as in a tunnel or on a bridge

 Preceding vehicle has an extremely high ground clearance

 While the vehicle speed is decreasing to the set speed after the vehicle accelerates by depressing the accelerator pedal

 Conditions under which the vehicle-to-vehicle distance control mode may not function correctly
In the case of the following conditions, operate the brake pedal (or accelerator pedal, depending on the situation) as necessary. As the sensor may not be able to correctly detect vehicles ahead, the system may not operate properly.  When the road curves or when the
lanes are narrow

COROLLA HV_U

218 4-5. Using the driving support systems

RSA (Road Sign Assist)*
*: If equipped
The RSA system recognizes specific road signs using the front camera and/or navigation system (when speed limit information is available) to provide information to the driver via the display.

Indication on the multi-information display
When the front camera recognizes a sign and/or information of a sign is available from the navigation system, the sign will be displayed on the multi-information display.
 When the driving support system information is selected, a maximum of 3 signs can be displayed. (P.103)

If the system judges that the vehicle is being driven over the speed limit, performing prohibited actions, etc. in relation to the recognized road signs, it notifies the driver using a notification display and notification buzzer.
WARNING
 Before using the RSA Do not rely solely upon the RSA system. RSA is a system which supports the driver by providing information, but it is not a replacement for a driver's own vision and awareness. Drive safely by always paying careful attention to the traffic rules.

 When a tab other than the driving support system information is selected, the following types of road signs will be displayed. (P.103)
· Speed limit sign · Do Not Enter sign (when notifica-
tion is necessary)
If signs other than speed limit signs

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 219

are recognized, they will be displayed in an overlapping stack under the current speed limit sign.
Supported types of road signs

 When the RSA system recognizes a do not enter sign and determines that your vehicle has entered a no-entry area, the displayed sign will flash and a buzzer will sound.

The following types of road signs, including electronic signs and blinking signs, are recognized.
A non-official or a recently introduced traffic sign may not be recognized.

Depending on the situation, a notification function may not operate properly.
 Setting procedure 1 Press or of the meter
control switches and select

Speed limit

2 Press or of the meter

control switches and select

4

, then press

Do Not Enter
Stop
Yield
Notification function
In the following situations, the RSA system will notify the driver.  When the vehicle speed
exceeds the speed notification threshold of the speed limit sign displayed, the sign display will be emphasized and a buzzer will sound.

 Automatic turn-off of RSA sign display
In the following situations, a displayed speed limit, do not enter signs will stop being displayed automatically:  A new sign is not recognized for a
certain distance.  The road changes due to a left or
right turn, etc. In the following situations, stop and yield signs will stop being displayed automatically:  The system determines that your
vehicle has passed the sign.  The road changes due to a left or
right turn, etc.
 Conditions in which the function may not operate or detect correctly
In the following situations, RSA does not operate normally and may not recognize signs, display the incorrect sign, etc. However, this does not indicate a malfunction.  The front camera is misaligned
due to a strong impact being

COROLLA HV_U

220 4-5. Using the driving support systems

applied to the sensor, etc.  Dirt, snow, stickers, etc. are on the
windshield near the front camera.  In inclement weather such as
heavy rain, fog, snow or sand storms.  Light from an oncoming vehicle, the sun, etc. enters the front camera.  The sign is dirty, faded, tilted or bent.  The contrast of electronic sign is low.  All or part of the sign is hidden by the leaves of a tree, a pole, etc.  The sign is only visible to the front camera for a short amount of time.  The driving scene (turning, lane change, etc.) is judged incorrectly.  Even if it is a sign not appropriate for the currently traveled lane, such a sign exists directly after a freeway branches, or in an adjacent lane just before merging.  Stickers are attached to the rear of the preceding vehicle.  A sign resembling a system compatible sign is recognized.  Side road speed signs may be detected and displayed (if positioned in sight of the front camera) while the vehicle is traveling on the main road.  Roundabout exit road speed signs may be detected and displayed (if positioned in sight of the front camera) while traveling on a roundabout.  The front of the vehicle is raised or lowered due to the carried load.  The surrounding brightness is not sufficient or changes suddenly.  When a sign intended for trucks, etc. is recognized.  The speed information displayed on the meter and that displayed on the navigation system may be

different due to the navigation system using map data.  Speed limit sign display If the power switch was last turned off while a speed limit sign was displayed on the multi-information display, the same sign displays again when the power switch is turned to ON.  If "RSA Malfunction Visit Your Dealer" is shown The system may be malfunctioning. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.  Customization Some functions can be customized. (P.544)

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 221

BSM (Blind Spot Monitor)*
*: If equipped
The Blind Spot Monitor is a system that uses rear side radar sensors installed on the inner side of the rear bumper on the left and right side to assist the driver in confirming safety when changing lanes.
WARNING
 Cautions regarding the use of the system
The driver is solely responsible for safe driving. Always drive safely, taking care to observe your surroundings. The Blind Spot Monitor is a supplementary function which alerts the driver that a vehicle is in a blind spot of the outside rear view mirrors or is approaching rapidly from behind into a blind spot. Do not overly rely on the Blind Spot Monitor. As the function cannot judge if it is safe to change lanes, over reliance could lead to an accident resulting in death or serious injury. As the system may not function correctly under certain conditions, the driver's own visual confirmation of safety is necessary.

System components

Meter control switches

Turning the Blind Spot Monitor on/off.

Outside rear view mirror indi-

cators

4

When a vehicle is detected in a

blind spot of the outside rear view

mirrors or approaching rapidly from

behind into a blind spot, the outside

rear view mirror indicator on the

detected side will illuminate. If the

turn signal lever is operated toward

the detected side, the outside rear

view mirror indicator flashes.

BSM indicator

Illuminates when the Blind Spot Monitor is enabled

 Outside rear view mirror indicator visibility
In strong sunlight, the outside rear view mirror indicator may be difficult to see.  When "Blind Spot Monitor
Unavailable" is shown on the multi-information display Ice, snow, mud, etc., may be attached to the rear bumper around the sensors. (P.223) The system should return to normal operation after removing the ice, snow, mud, etc. from the rear bumper. Additionally, the sensors may not operate

COROLLA HV_U

222 4-5. Using the driving support systems

normally when driving in extremely hot or cold environments.  When "Blind Spot Monitor Mal-
function Visit Your Dealer" is shown on the multi-information display There may be a sensor malfunction  Certification  Except for vehicles sold in Canada

of misaligned. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.  Customization Some functions can be customized. (P.544)

 For vehicles sold in Canada

COROLLA HV_U

4-5. Using the driving support systems 223

WARNING  Handling the rear side radar
sensor

 Do not subject a sensor or its surrounding area on the rear bumper to a strong impact. If a sensor is moved even

Blind Spot Monitor sensors are installed behind the left and right sides of the rear bumper respectively. Observe the following to ensure the Blind Spot Monitor can operate correctly.

slightly off position, the system may malfunction and vehicles may not be detected correctly. In the following situations, have your vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

Keep the sensors and the surrounding areas on the rear bumper clean at all times.
If a sensor or its surrounding area on the rear bumper is dirty or covered with snow, the Blind Spot

· A sensor or its surrounding area is subject to a strong impact.
· If the surrounding area of a sensor is scratched or dented, or part of them has become disconnected.

Monitor may not operate and a

 Do not disassemble the sensor.

warning message (P.221) will be displayed. In this situation,
clear off the dirt or snow and drive

 Do not modify the sensor or sur- 4 rounding area on the rear bumper.

the vehicle with the operation con-
ditions of the BSM function
(P.225) satisfied for approximately 10 minutes. If the warning

 If a sensor or the rear bumper needs to be removed/installed or replaced, contact your Toyota dealer.

message does not disappear, have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

 Do not paint the rear bumper any color other than an official Toyota color.

Do not attach accessories, stickers (including transparent stickers), aluminum tape, etc. to a sensor or its surrounding area on the rear bumper.

Turning the Blind Spot Monitor on/off
Use the meter control switches to turn on/off the function. 1 Press or to select .
2 Press or to select and then press .

Driving

COROLLA HV_U

224 4-5. Using the driving support systems Blind Spot Monitor operation
 Vehicles that can be detected by the Blind Spot Monitor The Blind Spot Monitor uses rear side radar sensors to detect the following vehicles traveling in adjacent lanes and advises the driver of the presence of such vehicles via the indicators on the outside rear view mirrors.
Vehicles that are traveling in areas that are not visible using the outside rear view mirrors (the blind spots) Vehicles that are approaching rapidly from behind in areas that are not visible using the outside rear view mirrors (the blind spots)  The Blind Spot Monitor detection areas The areas that vehicles can be detected in are outlined below.
The range of each detection area is:
Approximately 1.6 ft. (0.5 m) to 11.5 ft. (3.5 m) from either side of the vehicle*1 Approximately 3.3 ft. (1 m) forward of the rear bumper Approximately 9.8 ft. (3 m) from the rear bumper Approximately 9.8 ft. (3 m) to 197 ft. (60 m) from the rear bumper*2
COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 225

*1: The area between the side of the vehicle and 1.6 ft. (0.5 m) from the side of the vehicle cannot be detected.
*2: The greater the difference in speed between your vehicle and the detected vehicle is, the farther away the vehicle will be detected, causing the outside rear view mirror indicator to illuminate or flash.

 The Blind Spot Monitor is operational when
The Blind Spot Monitor is operational when all of the following conditions are met:

 Vehicles which are being overtaken rapidly by your vehicle*
*: Depending on the conditions, detection of a vehicle and/or object may occur.

 The Blind Spot Monitor is on.  The shift lever is in a position
other than R.

 Conditions under which the Blind Spot Monitor may not function correctly

 The vehicle speed is greater than approximately 10 mph (16 km/h).
 The Blind Spot Monitor will detect a vehicle when

 The Blind Spot Monitor may not detect vehicles correctly in the following situations:
· When the sensor is misaligned due to a strong impact to the sen-

4

The Blind Spot Monitor will detect a vehicle present in the detection area in the following situations:  A vehicle in an adjacent lane over-
takes your vehicle.

sor or its surrounding area · When mud, snow, ice, a sticker,
etc. is covering the sensor or surrounding area on the rear bumper · When driving on a road surface that is wet with standing water

 You overtake a vehicle in adjacent lane slowly.

during bad weather, such as heavy rain, snow, or fog

 Another vehicle enters the detection area when it changes lanes.
 Conditions under which the Blind Spot Monitor will not detect a vehicle

· When multiple vehicles are approaching with only a small gap between each vehicle
· When the distance between your vehicle and a following vehicle is short

The Blind Spot Monitor is not designed to detect the following types of vehicles and/or objects:  Small motorcycles, bicycles,
pedestrians, etc.*

· When there is a significant difference in speed between your vehicle and the vehicle that enters the detection area
· When the difference in speed between your vehicle and another

 Vehicles traveling in the opposite direction
 Guardrails, walls, signs, parked vehicles and similar stationary objects*

vehicle is changing · When a vehicle enters a detection
area traveling at about the same speed as your vehicle · As your vehicle starts from a stop, a vehicle remains in the detection

 Following vehicles that are in the same lane*

area · When driving up and down con-
secutive steep inclines, such as

 Vehicles traveling 2 lanes away from your vehicle*

hills, dips in the road, etc. · When driving on roads with sharp
bends, consecutive curves, or

COROLLA HV_U

226 4-5. Using the driving support systems

uneven surfaces · When vehicle lanes are wide, or
when driving on the edge of a lane, and the vehicle in an adjacent lane is far away from your vehicle · When an accessory (such as a bicycle carrier) is installed to the rear of the vehicle · When there is a significant difference in height between your vehicle and the vehicle that enters the detection area · Immediately after the Blind Spot Monitor is turned on  Instances of the Blind Spot Monitor unnecessarily detecting a vehicle and/or object may increase in the following situations: · When the sensor is misaligned due to a strong impact to the sensor or its surrounding area · When the distance between your vehicle and a guardrail, wall, etc. that enters the detection area is short · When driving up and down consecutive steep inclines, such as hills, dips in the road, etc. · When vehicle lanes are narrow, or when driving on the edge of a lane, and a vehicle traveling in a lane other than the adjacent lanes enters the detection area · When driving on roads with sharp bends, consecutive curves, or uneven surfaces · When the tires are slipping or spinning · When the distance between your vehicle and a following vehicle is short · When an accessory (such as a bicycle carrier) is installed to the rear of the vehicle

RCTA (Rear Cross Traffic Alert) function*
*: If equipped
The RCTA function uses the BSM rear side radar sensors installed behind the rear bumper. This function is intended to assist the driver in checking areas that are not easily visible when backing up.
System components
Meter control switches
Turning the RCTA function on/off. When the RCTA function is disabled, the RCTA OFF indicator illuminates.
Outside rear view mirror indicators
When a vehicle approaching from the right or left at the rear of the vehicle is detected, both outside rear view mirror indicators will flash.
Audio system display

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 227

If a vehicle approaching from the right or left at the rear of the vehicle

WARNING

is detected, the RCTA icon

 Cautions regarding the use of

(P.228) for the detected side will

the function

be displayed on the audio system

The driver is solely responsible for

display. This illustration shows an example of a vehicle approaching

safe driving. Always drive safely, taking care to observe your surroundings.

from both sides of the vehicle.

The RCTA function is only a sup-

RCTA buzzer

plementary function which alerts

If a vehicle approaching from the right or left at the rear of the vehicle

the driver that a vehicle is approaching from the right or left at the rear of the vehicle. As the

is detected, a buzzer will sound.

RCTA function may not function

The buzzer also sounds for approx- correctly under certain condi-

imately 1 second immediately after the RCTA function is turned on.

tions, the driver's own visual confirmation of safety is necessary. Over reliance on this function may

lead to an accident resulting

Turning the RCTA func-

death or serious injury.

4

tion on/off
Use the meter control switches

 Outside rear view mirror indicator visibility

to enable/disable the RCTA

In strong sunlight, the outside rear

function. (P.103)

view mirror indicator may be difficult to see.

1 Press or to select .  Hearing the RCTA buzzer

2 Press or to select "RCTA" and then press .
When the RCTA function is disabled, the RCTA OFF indicator (P.96) illuminates. (Each time the power switch is turned off then changed to ON, the RCTA function will be enabled automatically.)

The RCTA buzzer may be difficult to hear over loud noises, such as if the audio system volume is high.  When "Rear Cross Traffic Alert
Unavailable" is shown on the multi-information display Water, snow, mud, etc., may be attached to the rear bumper around the sensors. (P.223) Removing the water, snow, mud, etc., from the attached to the rear bumper around the sensors to normal.

Additionally, the function may not function normally when used in extremely hot or cold environments.

 Rear side radar sensors

P.223

COROLLA HV_U

228 4-5. Using the driving support systems RCTA function
 Operation of the RCTA function The RCTA function uses rear side radar sensors to detect vehicles approaching from the right or left at the rear of the vehicle and alerts the driver of the presence of such vehicles by flashing the outside rear view mirror indicators and sounding a buzzer.
Approaching vehicles Detection areas of approaching vehicles  RCTA icon display When a vehicle approaching from the right or left at the rear of the vehicle is detected, the following will be displayed on the audio system display.  Toyota parking assist monitor: Vehicles are approaching from both sides of the vehicle  RCTA function detection areas The areas that vehicles can be detected in are outlined below.
COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 229

The buzzer can alert the driver of faster vehicles approaching from farther away.
Example:

Approaching vehicle speed
18 mph (28 km/h) (fast)

Approximate alert distance
65 ft. (20 m)

 Guardrails, walls, signs, parked vehicles and similar stationary objects*

5 mph (8 km/h) (slow)

18 ft. (5.5 m)

 Small motorcycles, bicycles, pedestrians, etc.*

 Vehicles moving away from your

 The RCTA function is opera-

vehicle

tional when

 Vehicles approaching from the

The RCTA function operates when all of the following conditions are

parking spaces next to your vehi-

cle*

4

met:

*: Depending on the conditions,

 The power switch is in ON.

detection of a vehicle and/or

 The RCTA function is on.

object may occur.

 The shift lever is in R.  The vehicle speed is less than
approximately 5 mph (8 km/h).  The approaching vehicle speed is
between approximately 5 mph (8 km/h) and 18 mph (28 km/h).
 Conditions under which the RCTA function will not detect a vehicle
The RCTA function is not designed to detect the following types of vehicles and/or objects:  Vehicles approaching from directly
behind  Vehicles backing up in a parking
space next to your vehicle  Vehicles that the sensors cannot
detect due to obstructions

 Conditions under which the RCTA function may not function correctly
 The RCTA function may not detect vehicles correctly in the following situations:
· When a sensor is misaligned due to a strong impact to the sensor or its surrounding area
· When mud, snow, ice, a sticker, etc. is covering a sensor or its surrounding area on the rear bumper
· When driving on a road surface that is wet with standing water during bad weather, such as heavy rain, snow, or fog
· When multiple vehicles are approaching with only a small gap between each vehicle
· If a vehicle is approaching the rear of your vehicle rapidly
· When a towing eyelet is installed to the rear of the vehicle. (if equipped)
· When backing up on a slope with a sharp change in grade

COROLLA HV_U

230 4-5. Using the driving support systems

· When backing out of a shallow angle parking spot

· When the distance between your vehicle and metal objects, such as a guardrail, wall, sign, or parked vehicle, which may reflect electrical waves toward the rear of the vehicle, is short
· When a towing eyelet is installed to the rear of the vehicle (if equipped)

· Immediately after the RCTA function is turned on
· Immediately after the hybrid system is started with the RCTA function on
· When the sensors cannot detect a vehicle due to obstructions

 Instances of the RCTA function unnecessarily detecting a vehicle and/or object may increase in the following situations:
· When a vehicle passes by the side of your vehicle
· When the parking space faces a street and vehicles are being driven on the street
COROLLA HV_U

4-5. Using the driving support systems 231

Rear view monitor system
 Audio
The rear view monitor system assists the driver by displaying an image of the view behind the vehicle with fixed guide lines on the screen while backing up, for example while parking.

System overview
The rear view image is displayed when the shift lever is in R and the power switch is in ON.

The screen illustrations

used in this text are

intended as examples, and

may differ from the image

4

that is actually displayed on

the screen.

The rear view monitor system

 Audio Plus

will be deactivated when the

Owners of models equipped with a navigation/multime-

shift lever is shifted to any position other than R.

dia system should refer to

the "NAVIGATION AND

MULTIMEDIA SYSTEM

OWNER'S MANUAL".

Using the rear view monitor system
 Screen description The rear view monitor system screen will be displayed if the shift lever is shifted to R while the power switch is in ON.

Driving

COROLLA HV_U

232 4-5. Using the driving support systems
Vehicle width extension guide line
Displays a guide path when the vehicle is being backed straight up. The displayed width is wider than the actual vehicle width.
Vehicle center guide line
This line indicates the estimated vehicle center on the ground.
Distance guide line
Displays a point approximately 1.5 ft. (0.5 m) (red) from the edge of the bumper.
Distance guide line
Displays a point approximately 3 ft. (1 m) (blue) from the edge of the bumper.
Rear view monitor system precautions
 Area displayed on screen

COROLLA HV_U

Corners of bumper

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 233

The rear view monitor system

shown in the illustration.

displays an image of the view from the bumper of the rear area of the vehicle.
The image adjustment proce-

 Using the camera
If dirt or foreign matter (such as water droplets, snow, mud etc.) is adhering to the camera, it cannot

dure for the rear view monitor

transmit a clear image. In this case,

system screen is the same as

flush it with a large quantity of water

the procedure for adjusting the screen. (P.266)

and wipe the camera lens clean with a soft and wet cloth.

 The area displayed on the screen may vary according to

 Differences between the screen and the actual road

vehicle orientation conditions. The distance guide lines and the

 Objects which are close to either corner of the bumper or under the bumper cannot be displayed.

vehicle width guide lines may not actually be parallel with the dividing lines of the parking space, even when they appear to be so. Be sure to check visu-

4

 The camera uses a special

ally.

lens. The distance of the image that appears on the screen differs from the actual distance.

The distances between the vehicle width guide lines and the left and right dividing lines of the parking space may not be equal,

 Items which are located

even when they appear to be

higher than the camera may so. Be sure to check visually.

not be displayed on the monitor.

The distance guide lines give a distance guide for flat road sur-

 Rear view monitor system

faces. In any of the following sit-

camera

uations, there is a margin of

error between the fixed guide

lines on the screen and the

actual distance/course on the

road.

 When the ground behind the vehicle slopes up sharply

The camera for the rear view monitor system is located as

COROLLA HV_U

234 4-5. Using the driving support systems

The distance guide lines will appear to be closer to the vehicle than the actual distance. Because of this, objects will appear to be farther away than they actually are. In the same way, there will be a margin of error between the guide lines and the actual distance/course on the road.
 When the ground behind the vehicle slopes down sharply

The distance guide lines will appear to be further from the vehicle than the actual distance. Because of this, objects will appear to be closer than they actually are. In the same way, there will be a margin of error between the guide lines and the actual distance/course on the road.
 When any part of the vehicle sags

COROLLA HV_U

A margin of error
When any part of the vehicle sags due to the number of passengers or

4-5. Using the driving support systems 235

the distribution of the load, there is the case shown below, the truck

a margin of error between the fixed appears to be outside of the vehicle

guide lines on the screen and the

width guide lines and the vehicle

actual distance/course on the road. does not look as if it hits the truck.

 When approaching three-dimensional objects

However, the rear body of the truck may actually cross over the vehicle width guide lines. In reality if you

The distance guide lines are dis- back up as guided by the vehicle

played according to flat surfaced width guide lines, the vehicle may

objects (such as the road). It is hit the truck.

not possible to determine the

 Distance guide lines

position of three-dimensional

objects (such as vehicles) using

the distance guide lines. When

approaching a three-dimen-

sional object that extends out-

ward (such as the flatbed of a

4

truck), be careful of the follow-

ing.

 Vehicle width guide lines

Driving

Vehicle width guide lines
Visually check the surroundings and the area behind the vehicle. In

Visually check the surroundings and the area behind the vehicle. On the screen, it appears that a truck is
parking at point . However, in
reality if you back up to point , you will hit the truck. On the screen,
it appears that is closest and is farthest away. However, in reality,
the distance to and is the
same, and is farther than
and .

COROLLA HV_U

236 4-5. Using the driving support systems

Things you should know

 If you notice any symptoms
If you notice any of the following symptoms, refer to the likely cause and the solution, and re-check.
If the symptom is not resolved by the solution, have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

Symptom

Likely cause

Solution

 The vehicle is in a dark

area

The image is difficult to see

 The temperature around the lens is
either high or low
 The outside temperature is low
 There are water droplets on the camera
 It is raining or humid  Foreign matter (mud
etc.) is adhering to the
camera
 Sunlight or headlights are shining directly
into the camera
 The vehicle is under fluorescent lights,

If this happens due to these causes, it does not indicate a malfunction. Back up while visually checking the vehicle's surroundings. (Use the monitor again once conditions have been improved.) The procedure for adjusting the picture quality of the rear view monitor system is the same as the procedure for adjusting the screen. (P.266)

sodium lights, mer-

cury lights etc.

The image is blurry

Dirt or foreign matter (such as water droplets, snow, mud etc.) is adhering to the camera.

Flush the camera with a large quantity of water and wipe the camera lens clean with a soft and wet cloth.

The image is out of alignment

The camera or surrounding area has received a strong impact.

Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 237

Symptom
The fixed guide lines are very far out of alignment

Likely cause

Solution

The camera position is out of alignment.

Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

 The vehicle is tilted If this happens due to (there is a heavy load these causes, it does

on the vehicle, tire

not indicate a malfunc-

pressure is low due to tion.

a tire puncture, etc.) Back up while visually

 The vehicle is used on checking the vehicle's

an incline.

surroundings.

WARNING

 When parking, be sure to check

that the parking space will

 When using the rear view

accommodate your vehicle

monitor system

before maneuvering into it.

The rear view monitor system is a supplemental device intended to assist the driver when backing up. When backing up, be sure to visu-

 Do not use the rear view monitor system in the following cases:

4

ally check all around the vehicle

· On icy or slick road surfaces, or

both directly and using the mirrors

in snow

before proceeding. Observe the following precautions to avoid an accident that could result in death

· When using tire chains or emergency tires

or serious injuries.

· When the trunk is not closed

Never depend on the rear view

completely

monitor system entirely when backing up. The image and the position of the guide lines displayed on the screen may differ

· On roads that are not flat or straight, such as curves or slopes

from the actual state. Use caution, just as you would when backing up any vehicle.

 In low temperatures, the screen may darken or the image may become faint. The image could

Be sure to back up slowly, depressing the brake pedal to control vehicle speed.

distort when the vehicle is moving, or you may become unable to see the image on the screen. Be sure to visually check all

The instructions given are only guide lines. When and how

around the vehicle both directly and using the mirrors before

much to turn the steering wheel

proceeding.

will vary according to traffic conditions, road surface conditions, vehicle condition, etc. when parking. It is necessary to be fully aware of this before

 If the tire sizes are changed, the position of the fixed guide lines displayed on the screen may change.

using the rear view monitor sys-

tem.

COROLLA HV_U

238 4-5. Using the driving support systems

WARNING The camera uses a special lens.
The distances between objects and pedestrians that appear in the image displayed on the screen will differ from the actual distances. (P.233)

 Do not expose the camera to strong impact as this could cause a malfunction. If this happens, have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer as soon as possible.

NOTICE  How to use the camera The rear view monitor system
may not operate properly in the following cases. · If the back of the vehicle is hit, the position and mounting angle of the camera may change. · As the camera has a water proof construction, do not detach, disassemble or modify it. This may cause incorrect operation. · When cleaning the camera lens, flush the camera with a large quantity of water and wipe it with a soft and wet cloth. Strongly rubbing the camera lens may cause the camera lens to be scratched and unable to transmit a clear image. · Do not allow organic solvent, car wax, window cleaner or glass coating to adhere to the camera. If this happens, wipe it off as soon as possible. · If the temperature changes rapidly, such as when hot water is poured on the vehicle in cold weather, the system may not operate normally. · When washing the vehicle, do not apply intensive bursts of water to the camera or camera area. Doing so may result in the camera malfunctioning.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 239

Driving mode select switch

trolling the operation of the air conditioning system (heating/cooling).
When the Eco drive mode is

The driving modes can be selected to suit driving con-

selected, Eco drive mode indicator comes on.

dition.

 Operation of the air conditioning system in Eco drive mode

Selecting a drive mode

Eco drive mode controls the heating/cooling operations and fan speed of the air conditioning system to enhance fuel efficiency. To improve air conditioning performance, perform the following operations:

 Turn off eco air conditioning mode (P.388)

 Adjust the fan speed (P.386)

4

 Turn off Eco drive mode

Each time the switch is pressed, the system changes between power mode, normal mode and Eco drive mode.

 The driving mode after turning the power switch off
The driving mode will not be changed automatically until the switch is pressed, even if the power switch is turned off.

1 Normal mode

Provides an optimal balance of fuel

economy, quietness, and dynamic

performance. Suitable for normal

driving.

2 Power mode

Controls the hybrid system to pro-

vide quick, powerful acceleration.

Making it suitable for when agile

driving response is desired, such

as when driving on roads with many

curves.

When the power mode is selected,

power mode indicator comes on.

3 Eco drive mode

Helps the driver accelerate in an

eco-friendly manner and improve

fuel economy through moderate

throttle characteristics and by con-

COROLLA HV_U

240 4-5. Using the driving support systems

Driving assist systems
To keep driving safety and performance, the following systems operate automatically in response to various driving situations. Be aware, however, that these systems are supplementary and should not be relied upon too heavily when operating the vehicle.
Summary of the driving assist systems
 ECB (Electronically Controlled Brake System)
The electronically controlled system generates braking force corresponding to the brake operation
 ABS (Anti-lock Brake System)
Helps to prevent wheel lock when the brakes are applied suddenly, or if the brakes are applied while driving on a slippery road surface
 Brake assist
Generates an increased level of braking force after the brake pedal is depressed when the system detects a panic stop situation

 VSC (Vehicle Stability Control)
Helps the driver to control skidding when swerving suddenly or turning on slippery road surfaces.
 Enhanced VSC (Enhanced Vehicle Stability Control)
Provides cooperative control of the ABS, TRAC, VSC and EPS. Helps to maintain directional stability when swerving on slippery road surfaces by controlling steering performance.
 TRAC (Traction Control)
Helps to maintain drive power and prevent the drive wheels from spinning when starting the vehicle or accelerating on slippery roads
 Active Cornering Assist (ACA)
Helps to prevent the vehicle from drifting to the outer side by performing inner wheel brake control when attempting to accelerate while turning
 Hill-start assist control
Helps to reduce the backward movement of the vehicle when starting on an uphill
 EPS (Electric Power Steering)
Employs an electric motor to reduce the amount of effort needed to turn the steering wheel.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-5. Using the driving support systems 241

 The Secondary Collision Brake

When the SRS airbag sensor

detects a collision and the sys-

tem operates, the brakes and

brake lights are automatically

controlled to reduce the vehicle speed and help reduce the possibility of further damage due to a secondary collision.

 Turning off both TRAC and VSC systems

To turn the TRAC and VSC systems

off, press and hold

for more

than 3 seconds while the vehicle is

 When the TRAC/VSC/ABS sys- stopped.

tems are operating

The VSC OFF indicator light will

The slip indicator light will flash while the TRAC/VSC/ABS systems are operating.

come on and the "Traction Control Turned OFF" will be shown on the multi-information display.*

4

 Disabling the TRAC system If the vehicle gets stuck in mud, dirt or snow, the TRAC system may reduce power from the hybrid system to the wheels. Pressing to turn the system off may make it easier for you to rock the vehicle in order to free it. To turn the TRAC system off, quickly press and release .
The "Traction Control Turned OFF" will be shown on the multi-information display.
Press again to turn the system back on.

Press

again to turn the system

back on.
*: PCS will also be disabled (only Pre-Collision warning is available). The PCS warning light will come on and a message will be displayed on the multi-information display. (P.196)

 When the message is displayed on the multi-information display showing that TRAC has

been disabled even if has not been pressed
TRAC is temporary deactivated. If the information continues to show, contact your Toyota dealer.

 Operating conditions of hill-start assist control
When the following four conditions are met, the hill-start assist control will operate:  The shift lever is in a position
other than P or N (when starting off forward/backward on an upward incline)

COROLLA HV_U

242 4-5. Using the driving support systems

 The vehicle is stopped  The accelerator pedal is not
depressed  The parking brake is not engaged  Automatic system cancelation
of hill-start assist control The hill-start assist control will turn off in any of the following situations:  The shift lever is shifted to P or N.  The accelerator pedal is
depressed  The parking brake is engaged  2 seconds at maximum elapsed
after the brake pedal is released
 Sounds and vibrations caused by the ABS, brake assist, VSC, TRAC and hill-start assist control systems
 A sound may be heard from the engine compartment when the brake pedal is depressed repeatedly, when the hybrid system is started or just after the vehicle begins to move. This sound does not indicate that a malfunction has occurred in any of these systems.
 Any of the following conditions may occur when the above systems are operating. None of these indicates that a malfunction has occurred.
· Vibrations may be felt through the vehicle body and steering.
· A motor sound may be heard also after the vehicle comes to a stop.
 ECB operating sound ECB operating sound may be heard in the following cases, but it does not indicate that a malfunction has occurred.  Operating sound heard from the
engine compartment when the brake pedal is operated.  Motor sound of the brake system heard from the front part of the vehicle when the driver's door is opened.

 Operating sound heard from the engine compartment when one or two minutes passed after the stop of the hybrid system.
 Active Cornering Assist operation sounds and vibrations
When the Active Cornering Assist is operated, operation sounds and vibrations may be generated from the brake system, but this is not a malfunction.  EPS operation sound When the steering wheel is operated, a motor sound (whirring sound) may be heard. This does not indicate a malfunction.  Automatic reactivation of TRAC
and VSC systems After turning the TRAC and VSC systems off, the systems will be automatically re-enabled in the following situations:  When the power switch is turned
off  If only the TRAC system is turned
off, the TRAC will turn on when vehicle speed increases If both the TRAC and VSC systems are turned off, automatic re-enabling will not occur when vehicle speed increases.  Operating conditions of Active Cornering Assist The system operates when the following occurs.  TRAC/VSC can operate  The driver is attempting to accelerate while turning  The system detects that the vehicle is drifting to the outer side  The brake pedal is released  Reduced effectiveness of the EPS system The effectiveness of the EPS system is reduced to prevent the system from overheating when there is frequent steering input over an

COROLLA HV_U

4-5. Using the driving support systems 243

extended period of time. The steering wheel may feel heavy as a result. Should this occur, refrain from excessive steering input or stop the vehicle and turn the hybrid system off. The EPS system should return to normal within 10 minutes.  Secondary Collision Brake
operating conditions The system operates when the SRS airbag sensor detects a collision while the vehicle is in motion. However, the system does not operate in any of the following situations.

 Stopping distance when the ABS is operating may exceed that of normal conditions
The ABS is not designed to shorten the vehicle's stopping distance. Always maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front of you, especially in the following situations:  When driving on dirt, gravel or
snow-covered roads  When driving with tire chains

 The vehicle speed is below 6 mph (10 km/h)

 When driving over bumps in the road

 Components are damaged

 When driving over roads with

 Secondary Collision Brake

potholes or uneven surfaces

automatic cancellation The system is automatically can-

 TRAC/VSC may not operate effectively when

4

celed in any of the following situations.

Directional control and power may not be achievable while driving on

 The vehicle speed drops below

slippery road surfaces, even if the

approximately 6 mph (10 km/h)

TRAC/VSC system is operating.

 A certain amount of time elapses during operation
 The accelerator pedal is

Drive the vehicle carefully in conditions where stability and power may be lost.

depressed a large amount

 Active Cornering Assist does

not operate effectively when

WARNING  The ABS does not operate
effectively when The limits of tire gripping perfor-
mance have been exceeded (such as excessively worn tires on a snow covered road).
The vehicle hydroplanes while driving at high speed on wet or slick roads.

 Do not overly rely on Active Cornering Assist. Active Cornering Assist may not operate effectively when accelerating down slopes or driving on slippery road surfaces.
 When Active Cornering Assist frequently operates, Active Cornering Assist may temporarily stop operating to ensure proper operation of the brakes, TRAC and VSC.

Driving

COROLLA HV_U

244 4-5. Using the driving support systems

WARNING  Hill-start assist control does
not operate effectively when Do not overly rely on hill-start
assist control. Hill-start assist control may not operate effectively on steep inclines and roads covered with ice.
Unlike the parking brake, hill-start assist control is not intended to hold the vehicle stationary for an extended period of time. Do not attempt to use hill-start assist control to hold the vehicle on an incline, as doing so may lead to an accident.
 When the TRAC/ABS/VSC is activated
The slip indicator light flashes. Always drive carefully. Reckless driving may cause an accident. Exercise particular care when the indicator light flashes.
 When the TRAC/VSC systems are turned off
Be especially careful and drive at a speed appropriate to the road conditions. As these are the systems to help ensure vehicle stability and driving force, do not turn the TRAC/VSC systems off unless necessary.
 Replacing tires Make sure that all tires are of the specified size, brand, tread pattern and total load capacity. In addition, make sure that the tires are inflated to the recommended tire inflation pressure level. The ABS, TRAC and VSC systems will not function correctly if different tires are installed on the vehicle. Contact your Toyota dealer for further information when replacing tires or wheels.

 Handling of tires and the suspension
Using tires with any kind of problem or modifying the suspension will affect the driving assist systems, and may cause a system to malfunction.
 Secondary Collision Brake Do not rely solely upon the Secondary Collision Brake. This system is designed to help reduce the possibility of further damage due to a secondary collision, however, that effect changes according to various conditions. Overly relying on the system may result in death or serious injury.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

4-6.Driving tips
Hybrid vehicle driving tips
For economical and ecological driving, pay attention to the following points:
Using Eco drive mode
When using Eco drive mode, the torque corresponding to the accelerator pedal depression amount can be generated more smoothly than it is in normal conditions. In addition, the operation of the air conditioning system (heating/cooling) will be minimized, improving the fuel economy. (P.239)
Use of Hybrid System Indicator
The Eco-friendly driving is possible by keeping the indicate of Hybrid System Indicator within Eco area. (P.105)
Shift lever operation
Shift the shift lever to D when stopped at a traffic light, or driving in heavy traffic etc. Shift the shift lever to P when parking. When using the N, there is no positive effect on fuel consumption. In the N, the gasoline engine operates but electricity cannot be generated. Also, when using the air conditioning

4-6. Driving tips 245
system, etc., the hybrid battery (traction battery) power is consumed.

Accelerator pedal/brake pedal operation

 Drive your vehicle smoothly.

Avoid abrupt acceleration and

deceleration. Gradual accel-

eration and deceleration will

make more effective use of

the electric motor (traction

motor) without having to use

gasoline engine power.

 Avoid repeated acceleration.

4

Repeated acceleration con-

sumes hybrid battery (trac-

tion battery) power, resulting

in poor fuel consumption. Bat-

tery power can be restored by

driving with the accelerator

pedal slightly released.

When braking
Make sure to operate the brakes gently and in a timely manner. A greater amount of electrical energy can be regenerated when slowing down.

Delays
Repeated acceleration and deceleration, as well as long waits at traffic lights, will lead to bad fuel economy. Check traffic reports before leaving and avoid delays as much as possible.

COROLLA HV_U

246 4-6. Driving tips
When driving in a traffic jam, gently release the brake pedal to allow the vehicle to move forward slightly while avoiding overuse of the accelerator pedal. Doing so can help control excessive gasoline consumption.
Highway driving
Control and maintain the vehicle at a constant speed. Before stopping at a toll booth or similar, allow plenty of time to release the accelerator and gently apply the brakes. A greater amount of electrical energy can be regenerated when slowing down.
Air conditioning
Use the air conditioning only when necessary. Doing so can help reduce excessive gasoline consumption. In summer: When the ambient temperature is high, use the recirculated air mode. Doing so will help to reduce the burden on the air conditioning system and reduce fuel consumption as well. In winter: Because the gasoline engine will not automatically cut out until it and the interior of the vehicle are warm, it will consume fuel. Also, fuel consumption can be improved by

avoiding overuse of the heater.
Checking tire inflation pressure
Make sure to check the tire inflation pressure frequently. Improper tire inflation pressure can cause poor fuel economy. Also, as snow tires can cause large amounts of friction, their use on dry roads can lead to poor fuel economy. Use tires that are appropriate for the season.
Luggage
Carrying heavy luggage will lead to poor fuel economy. Avoid carrying unnecessary luggage. Installing a large roof rack will also cause poor fuel economy.
Warming up before driving
Since the gasoline engine starts up and cuts out automatically when cold, warming up the engine is unnecessary. Moreover, frequently driving short distances will cause the engine to repeatedly warm up, which can lead to excess fuel consumption.

COROLLA HV_U

Driving

Winter driving tips
Carry out the necessary preparations and inspections before driving the vehicle in winter. Always drive the vehicle in a manner appropriate to the prevailing weather conditions.
Pre-winter preparations
 Use fluids that are appropriate to the prevailing outside temperatures.
· Engine oil · Engine/power control unit coolant · Washer fluid
 Have a service technician inspect the condition of the 12-volt battery.
 Have the vehicle fitted with four snow tires or purchase a set of tire chains for the front tires.
Ensure that all tires are the same size and brand, and that chains match the size of the tires.
WARNING
 Driving with snow tires Observe the following precautions to reduce the risk of accidents. Failure to do so may result in a loss of vehicle control and cause death or serious injury.
Use tires of the size specified.
Maintain the recommended level of air pressure.

4-6. Driving tips 247

 Do not drive in excess of 75 mph (120 km/h), regardless of the type of snow tires being used.

 Use snow tires on all, not just some wheels.

 Driving with tire chains Observe the following precautions to reduce the risk of accidents. Failure to do so may result in the vehicle being unable to be driven safely, and may cause death or serious injury.

 Do not drive in excess of the speed limit specified for the tire

chains being used, or 30 mph

(50 km/h), whichever is lower.

 Avoid driving on bumpy road

4

surfaces or over potholes.

 Avoid sudden acceleration, abrupt steering, sudden braking and shifting operations that cause sudden engine braking.

 Slow down sufficiently before entering a curve to ensure that vehicle control is maintained.

 Do not use LTA (Lane Tracing Assist) system.

NOTICE  Repairing or replacing snow
tires (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system) Request repairs or replacement of snow tires from Toyota dealers or legitimate tire retailers. This is because the removal and attachment of snow tires affects the operation of the tire pressure warning valves and transmitters.
Before driving the vehicle
Perform the following according

COROLLA HV_U

248 4-6. Driving tips
to the driving conditions:
 Do not try to forcibly open a window or move a wiper that is frozen. Pour warm water over the frozen area to melt the ice. Wipe away the water immediately to prevent it from freezing.
 To ensure proper operation of the climate control system fan, remove any snow that has accumulated on the air inlet vents in front of the windshield.
 Check for and remove any excess ice or snow that may have accumulated on the exterior lights, vehicle's roof, chassis, around the tires or on the brakes.
 Remove any snow or mud from the bottom of your shoes before getting in the vehicle.
When driving the vehicle
Accelerate the vehicle slowly, keep a safe distance between you and the vehicle ahead, and drive at a reduced speed suitable to road conditions.

If the vehicle is parked without setting the parking brake, make sure to block the wheels. Failure to do so may be dangerous because it may cause the vehicle to move unexpectedly, possibly leading to an accident.
 If the vehicle is parked without setting the parking brake, confirm that the shift lever cannot be moved out of P*.
*: The shift lever will be locked if it is attempted to be shifted from P to any other position without depressing the brake pedal. If the shift lever can be shifted from P, there may be a problem with the shift lock system. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.
Selecting tire chains
Use the correct tire chain size when mounting the tire chains. Chain size is regulated for each tire size.

When parking the vehicle
 Park the vehicle and shift the shift lever to P without setting the parking brake. The parking brake may freeze up, preventing it from being released.

Side chain (0.12 in. [3 mm] in diameter)

COROLLA HV_U

Side chain (0.39 in. [10 mm] in width)
Side chain (1.18 in. [30 mm] in length)
Cross chain (0.16 in. [4 mm] in diameter)
Cross chain (0.55 in. [14 mm] in width)
Cross chain (0.98 in. [25 mm] in length)

4-6. Driving tips 249
NOTICE  Fitting tire chains (vehicles
with a tire pressure warning system) The tire pressure warning valves and transmitters may not function correctly when tire chains are fitted.

Regulations on the use of tire chains

Regulations regarding the use

4

of tire chains vary depending on

location and type of road.

Always check local regulations

before installing chains.

 Tire chain installation Observe the following precautions when installing and removing chains:  Install and remove tire chains in a
safe location.  Install tire chains on the front tires
only. Do not install tire chains on the rear tires.  Install tire chains on the front tires as tightly as possible. Retighten chains after driving 1/41/2 mile (0.51.0 km).  Install tire chains following the instructions provided with the tire chains.

Driving

COROLLA HV_U

250 4-6. Driving tips
COROLLA HV_U

251
Audio 5

.5-1. Basic function

5-5. Using the audio/visual

Buttons overview......... 253

system

Menu screen ............... 255

Quick reference ........... 298

Status icon .................. 256

Some basics................ 299

"Setup" screen ............ 258 5-6. Radio operation

5-2. Basic information before operation

AM radio/FM radio/SiriusXM® Satellite

Initial screen ................ 259 Touch screen............... 260 Home screen............... 262 Entering letters and num-

Radio(SXM)............... 303 Internet radio ............... 308 5-7. Media operation USB memory ............... 309

bers/list screen operation

iPod/iPhone (Apple Car-

.................................. 263

Play) .......................... 311

5

Screen adjustment ...... 266

Android Auto................ 314

Linking multi-information

Bluetooth® audio ......... 315

display and the system

5-8. Audio/visual remote con-

.................................. 267

trols

5-3. Connectivity settings

Steering switches ........ 319

Registering/Connecting a Bluetooth® device ..... 268

5-9. Audio settings Setup ........................... 321

Setting Bluetooth® details

5-10.Tips for operating the

.................................. 272

audio/visual system

Wi-Fi® Hotspot ............ 280

Operating information.. 322

Apple CarPlay/ Android Auto.............. 284
5-4. Other settings
General settings.......... 291 Voice settings.............. 295 Vehicle settings ........... 296

5-11.Voice command system operation
Voice command system .................................. 334
Command list .............. 337
5-12.Mobile Assistant operation

Mobile Assistant .......... 341

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

252

5-13.Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones)
Quick reference........... 343
Some basics ............... 344
Placing a call using the Bluetooth® hands-free system ............................ 348
Receiving a call using the Bluetooth® hands-free system ............................ 351
Talking on the Bluetooth® hands-free system..... 352
Bluetooth® phone message function...................... 354
5-14.Phone settings
Setup........................... 358
5-15.What to do if... (Bluetooth®)
Troubleshooting .......... 368
5-16.Connected Services Overview
Functional overview .... 372
Type A: Function achieved by using a smart phone or DCM .......................... 373
Type B: Function achieved by using DCM and the system ............................ 376
Type C: Function achieved by using DCM............ 377

Type D: Function achieved by using DCM and a smartphone ............... 377
5-17.Connected Services Operation
Toyota apps ................. 379
5-18.Toyota apps settings
Setup ........................... 383

COROLLA HV_U

5-1. Basic function 253

Buttons over view 5-1.Basicfunction

*

*: If equipped
 Audio Plus
Owners of this system should refer to the "NAVIGATION AND MULTIMEDIA SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL".

Operations of each part

Audio

5
By touching the screen with your finger, you can control the selected functions. (P.260) Press to seek up or down for a radio station or to access a desired track/file. (P.303, 309, 311, 315) Press to access the Bluetooth® hands-free system. (P.343) When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, press to display the Phone app screen.*1, 2 Press to display the Toyota apps screen.*2, 3 (P.372) Turn to change the radio station or skip to the next or previous track/file. (P.303, 309, 311, 315) Press to turn the audio/visual system on and off, and turn it to adjust the volume. Press and hold to restart the system. (P.259,
COROLLA HV_U

254 5-1. Basic function
299) When an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection is established, press to display the Maps app screen.*1, 2 Press to display the audio/visual system screen. (P.298, 299) Press to display the "Menu" screen. (P.255) Press to display the home screen. (P.262)
*1: For details about Apple CarPlay/Android Auto: P.284 *2: This function is not made available in some countries or areas. *3: When an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection is established, this
function will be unavailable. WARNING
For safety, the driver should not operate the system while he/she is driving. Insufficient attention to the road and traffic may cause an accident. The screen shots in this document and the actual screens of the system differ depending on whether the functions and/or a contract existed.
COROLLA HV_U

5-1. Basic function
Menu screen Menu screen operation
Press the "MENU" button to display the "Menu" screen.

255

Audio

Displays the clock. Select to display the clock settings screen. (P.292) Select to display the audio control screen. (P.298) Select to display the hands-free operation screen. (P.343) When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, select to dis- 5 play the Phone app screen.*1 Select to display the application screen.*1, 2 (P.372) When an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection is established and this button displays "Apple CarPlay"/"Android Auto", select to display the home screen of Apple CarPlay/Android Auto.*1 (P.284) Vehicles without DCM: Select to display the fuel consumption screen. (P.109) Vehicles with DCM: Select to display the information screen. Select "ECO" to display the fuel consumption screen. (P.109) The "Vehicle Alert History" shown on the information screen. *1 Select to display the "Setup" screen. (P.258) Select to adjust the contrast, brightness, etc. of the display. (P.266)
*1: This function is not made available in some countries or areas. *2: When an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection is established, this
function will be unavailable.
COROLLA HV_U

256 5-1. Basic function Status icon
Status icons are displayed at the top of the screen.
Status icon explanation
Indicate during data communication performed via Data Communication Module (DCM)*1 The reception level of Data Communication Module (DCM) display*1 (P.256) The reception level of the connected phone display (P.256) Remaining battery charge display (P.257) Bluetooth® phone connection condition display (P.257) Wi-Fi® connection condition display*1, 2 (P.280)
*1: Vehicles with DCM

*2: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
The number of status icons that can be displayed differs depending on the displayed screen.
Reception level display
The level of reception does not always correspond with the level displayed on the cellular phone. The level of reception may not be displayed depending on the phone you have. When the cellular phone is out of the service area or in a place inaccessible by radio waves,
/ is displayed. "Rm" is displayed when receiving in a roaming area. While roaming, display "Rm" top-left on the icon. The receiving area may not be displayed depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone you have.  While connected with cellular
phone
Reception Level Indicators
Poor
Excellent

COROLLA HV_U

 While using Data Communication Module (DCM)

Reception Level Poor

Indicators

Excellent

 While using Wi-Fi® Hotspot
Reception Level Indicators No connection

Connected

When Wi-Fi® Hotspot is off, no item is displayed.

Remaining battery charge display

The amount displayed does not always correspond with the amount displayed on the Bluetooth® device.
The amount of battery charge left may not be displayed depending on the type of the Bluetooth® device connected.
This system does not have a charging function.

Remaining charge

Indicators

Empty

Full

5-1. Basic function 257

Bluetooth® connection condition display

An antenna for the Bluetooth® connection is built into the instrument panel.
The condition of the Bluetooth® connection may deteriorate and the system may not function when a Bluetooth® phone is used in the following conditions and/or places:
The cellular phone is obstructed by certain objects (such as when it is behind the seat or in the glove box or console box).
The cellular phone is touching or 5 is covered with metal materials.
Leave the Bluetooth® phone in a place where the condition of the Bluetooth® connection is good.

Indicators

Conditions

(Blue)

Indicates that the condition of the Blue-
tooth® connection is good.

(Gray)

While in this condition, sound quality during phone calls may deteriorate.

Indicates that the cellular phone is not connected via Bluetooth®.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

258 5-1. Basic function
"Setup" screen
"Setup" screen
Press the "MENU" button, then select "Setup" to display the "Setup" screen. The items shown on the "Setup" screen can be set.

Select to set vehicle information. (P.296)
Select to set Wi-Fi® connection settings.*1, 2 (P.281)
Select to set Toyota apps settings.*2 (P.383)
*1: Vehicles with DCM *2: This function is not made avail-
able in some countries or areas.

Select to change the selected language, operation sound settings, etc. (P.291) Select to set Bluetooth® device and Bluetooth® system settings. (P.272) Select to set audio settings. (P.321) Select to set the phone sound, contacts, message settings, etc. (P.358) Select to set the voice settings. (P.295)
COROLLA HV_U

5-2. Basic information before operation
5-2.Basic information before operation
Initial screen
When the power switch is turned to ACC or ON, the initial screen will be displayed and the system will begin operating.

259

Caution screen

After a few seconds, the caution screen will be displayed.
After about 5 seconds or selecting "Continue", the caution screen automatically switches to the next screen.

WARNING

5

When the vehicle is stopped with

the engine running, always apply

the parking brake for safety.

Restarting the system
When system response is extremely slow, the system can be restarted.
Press and hold the "POWER VOLUME" knob for 3 seconds or more.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

260 5-2. Basic information before operation

Touch screen

Touch screen gestures

Operations are performed by touching the touch screen directly with your finger.

Operation method

Outline

Main use

 Touch
Quickly touch and release once.

 Selecting an item on the screen

 Drag*
Touch the screen with your finger, and move the screen to the desired position.

 Scrolling the lists

 Flick*
Quickly move the screen by flicking with your finger.

 Scrolling the main screen page

*: The above operations may not be performed on all screens.

Flick operations may not be performed smoothly at high altitudes.

Touch screen operation
This system is operated mainly by the buttons on the screen. (Referred to as screen buttons in this manual.)
When a screen button is

touched, a beep sounds. (To set the beep sound: P.291)
 If the system does not respond to touching a screen button, move your finger away from the screen and then touch it again.
 Dimmed screen buttons cannot be

COROLLA HV_U

5-2. Basic information before operation 261

operated.

 If a source of strong electro-

 The displayed image may become darker and moving images may be slightly distorted when the screen is cold.

magnetic waves is brought near the screen
 If a glove is worn during oper-

 In extremely cold conditions, the screen may not be displayed and the data input by a user may be deleted. Also, the screen buttons may be harder than usual to depress.

ation
 If the screen is touched by a fingernail
 If a stylus is used to operate

 When you look at the screen

the buttons

through polarized material such as polarized sunglasses, the screen

 If your palm touches the oper-

may be dark and hard to see. If

able area of another button

so, look at the screen from different angles, adjust the screen set-

during operation

tings on the display settings

 If a button is touched quickly

screen or take off your sunglasses.

 If the operable part of a

 When

is displayed on the

screen, select

to return to the

previous screen.

capacitive touch screen but-

ton is touched by or covered

with a metal object, such as

5

the following, it may not oper-

NOTICE

ate properly:

To prevent damaging the screen, lightly touch the screen buttons with your finger.

· Magnetic isolation cards
· Metallic foil, such as the inner packaging of a cigarette box

Do not use objects other than your finger to touch the screen.
Wipe off fingerprints using a glass cleaning cloth. Do not use chemical cleaners to clean the screen, as they may damage the touch screen.

· Metallic wallets or bags
· Coins
· Discs, such as a CD or DVD
 If the operable part of a capacitive touch screen button is wiped, it may operate

Capacitive touch screen

unintentionally.

buttons

 If the capacitive touch screen

The operable areas of the capacitive touch screen buttons use capacitive touch sensors and may not operate properly in the following situations:

button is being touched when the power switch is changed to ACC or ON, the button may not operate properly. In this case, remove anything touching the button, turn the power

 If the screen is dirty or wet

switch off and then turn it to

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

262 5-2. Basic information before operation

ACC or ON, or restart the system by press and hold the "POWER VOLUME" knob for 3 seconds or more.
Capacitive touch screen button sensor sensitivity can be adjusted. (P.291)

Home screen
On the home screen, multiple screens, such as the audio/visual system screen, hands-free screen and clock screen, can be displayed simultaneously.

Home screen operation
1 Press the "HOME" button.

COROLLA HV_U

2 Check that the home screen is displayed.
Selecting a screen will display it full screen.  The display information and area
on the home screen can be customized.  The home screen can be set to several types of split layouts

5-2. Basic information before operation 263

Customizing the home screen
The display information/area on the home screen and the home screen layout can be changed. 1 Press the "MENU" button.
2 Select "Setup".
If the general settings screen is not displayed, select "General".
3 Select "Customize Home Screen".
4 Select the items to be set.

Entering letters and numbers/list screen operation
Entering letters and numbers
When searching by a name or entering data, letters and numbers can be entered via the screen.

Select to change the display information and area on the home screen.
Select to change the home screen layout.

5
Text field. Entered character(s) will be displayed.
Select to erase one character. Select and hold to continue erasing characters.
Select to move the cursor.
Select to choose predictive text candidate for entered text. (P.264)
Select to display a list of predictive text candidates when there is more than one. (P.264)
Select to enter desired characters.
Select to enter characters in lower case or in upper case.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

264 5-2. Basic information before operation

Select to change character types. (P.264)
Select to make a space on cursor.

1 Input text. 2 Select the desired candidate.

Keyboard layout can be changed. (P.291)

Changing character type 1 Select "Change Type".

To select a candidate that is not

displayed, select

, and

then select the desired predic-

tive replacement candidate.

2 Select the desired character.

Depending on the screen being displayed, it may not be possible to change keyboard characters.
Displaying predictive text candidates
When text is input, the system predicts the text that may complete the currently unconfirmed text and displays predictive replacement candidates that match the beginning of the text.

List screen
The list screen may be displayed after entering characters. When a list is displayed, use the appropriate screen button to scroll through the list.
Scrolling list screen

COROLLA HV_U

5-2. Basic information before operation

To scroll up/down the list, flick the list up/down.
Select to skip to the next or previous page. Select and
hold or to scroll through the displayed list.
Indicates the position of the displayed entries in the entire list. To scroll up/down pages, drag the bar.

2 Input text.
3 Select "Search". 4 The list is displayed.

265

If appears to the right of an item name, the complete name is too long to display.

 Select to scroll to the end of the name.

 Select to move to the begin-

5

ning of the name.

Searching a list
Items are displayed in the list with the most similar results of the search at the top.
1 Select .

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

266 5-2. Basic information before operation

Screen adjustment
The contrast and brightness of the screen display and the image of the camera display can be adjusted. The screen can also be turned off, and/or changed to either day or night mode.
(For information regarding audio/visual screen adjustment: P.301)
Displaying the screen adjustment screen
1 Press the "MENU" button.

ton. Select to turn day mode on/off. (P.266) Select to adjust the screen display. (P.266) Select to adjust the camera display.
When the screen is viewed through polarized sunglasses, a rainbow pattern may appear on the screen due to optical characteristics of the screen. If this is disturbing, please operate the screen without polarized sunglasses.
Changing between day and night mode
Depending on the position of the headlight switch, the screen changes to day or night mode. This feature is available when the headlight is switched on. Select "Day Mode".

2 Select "Display". 3 Select the desired items to
be set.
Select to turn the screen off. To turn it on, press any but-

If the screen is set to day mode with the headlight switch turned on, this condition is memorized even with the hybrid system turned off.
Adjusting the contrast/brightness
The contrast and brightness of the screen can be adjusted according to the brightness of your surroundings. 1 Select "General" or "Cam-
era". 2 Select the desired item.
"Display (General)" screen only:

COROLLA HV_U

5-2. Basic information before operation 267

Select "<" or ">" to select the desired display.
 "Contrast"
"+": Select to strengthen the contrast of the screen.
"-": Select to weaken the contrast of the screen.
 "Brightness"
"+": Select to brighten the screen.
"-": Select to darken the screen.

Linking multi-information display and the system
The following functions of the system are linked with the multi-information display in the instrument cluster:
 Audio
 Phone*

etc.

These functions can be

operated using multi-infor-

mation display control

switches on the steering

wheel. (P.103)

5

*: When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, this function will be unavailable.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

268 5-3. Connectivity settings
5-3.Connectivity settings
Registering/Connecting a Bluetooth® device
To use the hands-free system, it is necessary to register a Bluetooth® phone with the system.
Once the phone has been registered, it is possible to use the hands-free system.
This operation cannot be performed while driving.
When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, Bluetooth® functions of the system will become unavailable and any connected Bluetooth® devices will be disconnected.*
When connecting to Android Auto, a Bluetooth® connection will be made automatically.*
When an Android Auto connection is established, some Bluetooth® functions other than hands-free system cannot be used.*
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
 This system is not guaranteed to operate with all Bluetooth® devices.

 If your cellular phone does not support HFP, registering the Bluetooth® phone or using OPP, PBAP, MAP or SPP profiles individually will not be possible.
 If the connected Bluetooth® device version is older than recommended or incompatible, the Bluetooth® device function may not work properly.
 Refer to https://www.toyota.com/ audio-multimedia in the United States, https://www.toyota.ca/connected in Canada, and http://www.toyotapr.com/ audio-multimedia in Puerto Rico, to find approved Bluetooth® phones for this system.
 Certification
Bluetooth is a registered trademark of Bluetooth SIG, Inc.
Registering a Bluetooth® phone for the first time
 Registering from the system
1 Turn the Bluetooth® connection setting of your cellular phone on.
This function is not available when Bluetooth® connection setting of your cellular phone is set to off.

COROLLA HV_U

2 Press the "MENU" button.

5-3. Connectivity settings 269
6 Register the Bluetooth® device using your Bluetooth® device.

3 Select "Phone".

Operations up to this point can also be performed by pressing the "PHONE" button on the instrument panel.
4 Select "Yes" to register a phone.

 For details about operating the Bluetooth® device, see the manual that comes with it.
 A PIN code is not required for SSP (Secure Simple Pairing)

compatible Bluetooth®

devices. Depending on the

5

type of Bluetooth® device

being connected, a message

confirming registration may

be displayed on the Blue-

5 Select the desired Bluetooth® device.

tooth® device's screen. Respond and operate the Bluetooth® device according

to the confirmation message.

7 Check that the following screen is displayed, indicating pairing was successful (a
Bluetooth® link has been

If the desired Bluetooth® phone is not on the list, select "If you cannot find..." and follow the guidance on the screen. (P.270)

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

270 5-3. Connectivity settings
established but registration is not yet complete).

 Registering from phone 1 Select "If you cannot find...".

 The system is connecting to the registered device.
 At this stage, the Bluetooth® functions are not yet available.
8 Check that "Connected" is displayed and registration is complete.

2 Select "Register from Phone".

3 Check that the following screen is displayed, and reg-
ister the Bluetooth® device
using your Bluetooth® device.

If an error message is displayed, follow the guidance on the screen to try again. If a cellular phone does not operate properly after being connected, turn the cellular phone off and on and then connect it again.

 For details about operating the Bluetooth® device, see the manual that comes with it.
 A PIN code is not required for SSP (Secure Simple Pairing) compatible Bluetooth®

COROLLA HV_U

devices. Depending on the type of Bluetooth® device being connected, a message confirming registration may be displayed on the Bluetooth® device's screen. Respond and operate the Bluetooth® device according to the confirmation message.
4 Follow the steps in "Registering a Bluetooth® phone for the first time" from step 7. (P.268)
Registering a Bluetooth® audio player for the first time
To use the Bluetooth® audio, it is necessary to register an audio player with the system.
Once the player has been registered, it is possible to use the Bluetooth® audio.
This operation cannot be performed while driving.
For details about registering a Bluetooth® device: P.268 1 Turn the Bluetooth® connec-
tion setting of your audio player on.
This function is not available when the Bluetooth® connection setting of your audio player is set to off.

5-3. Connectivity settings 271
2 Press the "AUDIO" button.

3 Select "Source" on the audio screen or press "AUDIO" but-
ton again.

4 Select "Bluetooth".

5 Select "Yes" to register an audio player.

6 Follow the steps in "Register-

ing a Bluetooth® phone for

5

the first time" from step 5.

(P.268)

Profiles
This system supports the following services.
 Bluetooth® Core Specification
Ver. 2.0 (Recommended: Ver. 4.1 +EDR)
 Profiles
 HFP (Hands Free Profile) Ver. 1.0 (Recommended: Ver. 1.7)
This is a profile to allow hands-free phone calls using a cellular phone. It has outgoing and incoming call functions.
 OPP (Object Push Profile) Ver. 1.1 (Recommended: Ver.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

272 5-3. Connectivity settings
1.2)
This is a profile to transfer contacts data.
 PBAP (Phone Book Access Profile) Ver. 1.0 (Recommended: Ver. 1.2)
This is a profile to transfer phonebook data.
 MAP (Message Access Profile) Ver. 1.0 (Recommended: Ver. 1.2)
This is a profile to use phone message functions.
 SPP (Serial Port Profile) Recommended: Ver. 1.2
This is a profile to use the Toyota audio multimedia function.
 A2DP (Advanced Audio Distribution Profile) Ver. 1.0 (Recommended: Ver. 1.3)
This is a profile to transmit stereo audio or high quality sound to the audio/visual system.
 AVRCP (Audio/Video Remote Control Profile) Ver. 1.0 (Recommended: Ver. 1.6)
This is a profile to allow remote control the A/V equipment.

Setting Bluetooth® details
When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, this function will be unavailable.* When an Android Auto connection is established, some functions will be unavailable.*
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
Displaying the Bluetooth® setup screen
1 Press the "MENU" button.
2 Select "Setup". 3 Select "Bluetooth".

COROLLA HV_U

4 Select the desired item to be set.

5-3. Connectivity settings 273
has been registered, select which device to connect to. 1 Display the Bluetooth® set-
tings screen. (P.272)
2 Select "Registered Device".
3 Select the device to be connected.

Bluetooth® setup screen

: Phone

: Audio player

5

: Phone/Toyota apps services

Connecting a Bluetooth® device and editing the Bluetooth® device information (P.273, 276)
Registering a Bluetooth® device (P.275)
Deleting a Bluetooth® device (P.275)
Setting the Bluetooth® system (P.277)

 The profile icon for a currently connected device will be displayed in color.
 Selecting a profile icon which is not currently connected will switch the connection to the function.
 If the desired Bluetooth® device is not on the list, select "Add New Device" to register the device. (P.275)

Connecting a Bluetooth® device

Up to 5 Bluetooth® devices (Phones (HFP) and audio players (AVP)) can be registered.
If more than 1 Bluetooth® device

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

274 5-3. Connectivity settings
4 Select the desired connection.
"Device Info": Select to confirm and change the Bluetooth® device information. (P.276)
When another Bluetooth® device is connected
To disconnect the Bluetooth® device, select "Yes".
5 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the connection is complete.
If an error message is displayed, follow the guidance on the screen to try again.  It may take time if the device con-
nection is carried out during Bluetooth® audio playback.  Depending on the type of Bluetooth® device being connected, it may be necessary to perform additional steps on the device.  When disconnecting a Bluetooth® device, it is recommended to disconnect using the system.
 Connecting a Bluetooth® device in a different way (from phone top screen)
P.345

 Connecting a Bluetooth® device in a different way (from phone setup screen)
P.358
 Connecting a Bluetooth® device in a different way (from Bluetooth® audio screen)
P.317
 Auto connection mode
To turn auto connection mode on, set "Bluetooth Power" to on. (P.277) Leave the Bluetooth® device in a location where the connection can be established.
 When the power switch is in ACC or ON, the system searches for a nearby registered device.
 The system will connect with the registered device that was last connected, if it is nearby. When automatic connection priority is set to on and there is more than one registered Bluetooth® phone available, the system will automatically connect to the Bluetooth® phone with the highest priority. (P.277)
 Connecting manually
When the auto connection has failed or "Bluetooth Power" is turned off, it is necessary to connect the Bluetooth® device manually.

COROLLA HV_U

1 Display the Bluetooth® settings screen. (P.272)
2 Follow the steps in "Connecting a Bluetooth® device" from step 2. (P.273)
 Reconnecting the Bluetooth® phone
If a Bluetooth® phone is disconnected due to poor reception from the Bluetooth® network when the power switch is in ACC or ON, the system automatically reconnects the Bluetooth® phone.
Registering a Bluetooth® device
Up to 5 Bluetooth® devices can be registered.
Bluetooth® compatible phones (HFP) and audio players (AVP) can be registered simultaneously.
This operation cannot be performed while driving.
1 Display the Bluetooth® settings screen. (P.272)
2 Select "Add New Device".
 When another Bluetooth® device is connected
To disconnect the Bluetooth® device, select "Yes".

5-3. Connectivity settings 275
 When 5 Bluetooth® devices have already been registered
A registered device needs to be replaced. Select "Yes", and select the device to be replaced.
3 Follow the steps in "Registering a Bluetooth® phone for the first time" from step 5. (P.268)

Deleting a Bluetooth® device

This operation cannot be performed while driving.

1 Display the Bluetooth® settings screen. (P.272)

2 Select "Remove Device".

5

3 Select the desired device.

4 Select "Yes" when the confirmation screen appears.
5 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.
When deleting a Bluetooth® phone, the contact data will be deleted at the same time.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

276 5-3. Connectivity settings
Editing the Bluetooth® device information
The Bluetooth® device's information can be displayed on the screen. The displayed information can be edited.
This operation cannot be performed while driving. 1 Display the Bluetooth® set-
tings screen. (P.272) 2 Select "Registered Device". 3 Select the desired device to
be edited.
4 Select "Device Info".

5 Confirm and change the Bluetooth® device information.

The name of the Bluetooth® device is displayed. It can be changed to a desired name. (P.277) Select to set the Bluetooth® audio player connection method. (P.277)
Device address is unique to the device and cannot be changed.
Phone number is unique to the Bluetooth® phone and cannot be changed.
Compatibility profile is unique to the Bluetooth® device and cannot be changed.
Select to reset all setup items.

COROLLA HV_U

 If 2 Bluetooth® devices have been registered with the same device name, the devices can be distinguished referring to the device's address.
 Depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone, some information may not be displayed.
Changing a device name
1 Select "Device Name". 2 Enter the name and select
"OK".
Even if the device name is changed, the name registered in your Bluetooth® device does not change.

5-3. Connectivity settings 277
to the manual that comes with the audio player.
"Detailed Settings" screen
The Bluetooth® settings can be confirmed and changed. 1 Display the Bluetooth® set-
tings screen. (P.272) 2 Select "Detailed Settings". 3 Select the desired item to be
set.

Setting audio player con-

5

nection method

1 Select "Connect Audio Player From".
2 Select the desired connection method.
"Vehicle": Select to connect the audio player from the vehicle's audio/visual system. "Device": Select to connect the vehicle's audio/visual system from the audio player. Depending on the audio player, the "Vehicle" or "Device" connection method may be best. As such, refer

Select to set Bluetooth® connection on/off. (P.277) Select to change the automatic connection priority of the registered Bluetooth® devices. (P.278) Select to edit the system information. (P.278) Select to reset all setup items.
Changing "Bluetooth Power"
1 Select "Bluetooth Power". When "Bluetooth Power" is on: The Bluetooth® device is auto-

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

278 5-3. Connectivity settings

matically connected when the power switch is in ACC or ON. When "Bluetooth Power" is off: The Bluetooth® device is disconnected, and the system will not connect to it next time.
While driving, the auto connection state can be changed from off to on, but cannot be changed from on to off.
Setting automatic connection priority

audio players. (P.278)
Select to reset all setup items.
 Changing Bluetooth® device automatic connection priority
1 Select "Preferred Phones" or "Preferred Audio Players".
2 Select the desired Bluetooth® device and select "Move Up" or "Move Down" to change the preferred order.

The automatic connection priority of the registered Bluetooth® devices can be changed.
1 Select "Preferred Device Settings".
2 Select the desired item to be set.

A newly registered Bluetooth® device will automatically be given the highest automatic connection priority.

Select to set automatic connection priority on/off.
Select to change the automatic connection priority of the registered Bluetooth® phones. (P.278)
Select to change the automatic connection priority of the registered Bluetooth®

Editing the system information
1 Select "System Information".

COROLLA HV_U

2 Select the desired item to be set.

5-3. Connectivity settings 279
 Editing the system name 1 Select "System Name". 2 Enter a name and select
"OK".
 Editing the PIN code 1 Select "System PIN Code". 2 Enter a PIN code and select
"OK".

Audio

Displays system name. Can

5

be changed to a desired

name. (P.279)

PIN code used when the Bluetooth® device was registered. Can be changed to a desired code. (P.279)

Device address is unique to the device and cannot be changed.

Select to set the connection status display of the phone on/off.

Select to set the connection status display of the audio player on/off.

Compatibility profile of the system

Select to reset all setup items.

COROLLA HV_U

280 5-3. Connectivity settings
Wi-Fi® Hotspot*
*: If equipped
By connecting a device to the vehicle via Wi-Fi®, it can access the internet through the DCM.
 To use this function, a Wi-Fi® Hotspot service subscription from Verizon Wireless is required. Contact your Toyota dealer for details.
 This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
Connecting a device to the in-vehicle access point
Searching for and connecting a device to the vehicle access point
1 Enable the Wi-Fi® Hotspot function. (P.281)
2 Disable the "Hide Access Point" function. (P.280)
3 Search for the vehicle access point using the device you wish to connect.
For details about operating the device, refer to the documentation which came with it.

4 Operate the device to connect it to the vehicle access point.
To check the vehicle access point password, check "Password". (P.281)
Hints for connecting to the vehicle via Wi-Fi® can be displayed. (P.281)
Connecting a device to the in-vehicle access point using the access point name (SSID)
1 Enable the Wi-Fi® Hotspot function. (P.281)
2 Enable the "Hide Access Point" function. (P.280)
3 Enter the access point name (SSID) into the device you wish to connect and connect it.
 To check the vehicle access point password, check "Password". (P.281)
 The security settings on the device must be the same as that displayed for "Security". (P.281)
 For details about operating the device, refer to the documentation which came with it.

COROLLA HV_U

Changing the Wi-Fi® settings
1 Press the "MENU" button.
2 Select "Setup". 3 Select "Wi-Fi*".
*: Wi-Fi® is a registered trademark of Wi-Fi Alliance®.
4 Select the desired item to be set.
Select to enable/disable the Wi-Fi® Hotspot function. (P.281)

5-3. Connectivity settings 281

Select to check/change the access point password. (P.282)

Select to display hints for connecting to the vehicle via Wi-Fi®.

Select to make the access point searchable/unsearchable.

Select to check/change the security protocol of the access point (for authentication and encryption). (P.282)

Select to change the access

point name (SSID). (P.282)

Select to change the Wi-Fi®

5

connection channel (within

the 2.4GHz frequency band).

(P.282)

If any settings have been changed, it will be necessary to reset the Wi-Fi® system to complete the changes. To reset the Wi-Fi® system, select "Yes" on the pop-up displayed after changing the settings.

Enabling/disabling the Wi-Fi® Hotspot function
When the Wi-Fi® Hotspot function is enabled, the system checks for a valid Hotspot service subscription.
If a hotspot service subscription has not been started, connect your device to the in-vehicle access point to start your sub-

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

282 5-3. Connectivity settings
scription. A trial subscription may be available.
Checking/changing the password
1 Select "Password". 2 Check that the following
screen is displayed.

 If you write the password down, do not leave it somewhere where it would be visible.
 Do not use the same or a similar password to that for other accounts.
 Avoid using easy to identify words, such as your vehicle's model name or license plate number, simple dictionary words, or words with simple obfuscation, such as c@t (for cat), as your password.

Displays the password
Select to display/hide the entered password.
Select to change the password.
Changing the password
1 Select "Change Password". 2 Enter the desired password
and select "OK".
When setting/changing a password, observe the following guidelines to help prevent the password from being cracked by a third party:
 Use an 8-character or longer password consisting of letters and numbers. (Non-ASCII characters will not be recognized by the system.)
 Change the password regularly.

Changing the security protocol
1 Select "Security". 2 Select the desired security
protocol.
Changing the access point name (SSID)
1 Select "Access Point Name". 2 Enter the desired access
point name (SSID) and select "OK".
Selecting a Wi-Fi® connection channel
1 Select "Channel".

COROLLA HV_U

2 Check that the following screen is displayed.

5-3. Connectivity settings 283
the Wi-Fi® Hotspot function, the communication speed may decrease.  If the vehicle is near a radio antenna, radio station or other source of strong radio waves and electrical noise, communication may be slow or impossible.

WARNING

Select to change the chan-

 Use Wi-Fi® devices only when safe and legal to do so.

nel selection to auto-

 Your audio unit is fitted with

matic/manual.

Wi-Fi® antennas. People with

implantable cardiac pacemak-

When "Manual" is selected,

ers, cardiac resynchronization

select to change the channel.

therapy-pacemakers or implantable cardioverter defibrillators

should maintain a reasonable

Changing the channel

distance between themselves

1 Set "Select Channel" to "Manual".

and the Wi-Fi® antennas. The radio waves may affect the

5

operation of such devices.

2 Select "Channel Number". 3 Enter the desired channel
number and select "OK".
Channels 1 through 11 can be selected.
Wi-Fi® function operating hints
 Wi-Fi® function operating hints

 Before using Wi-Fi® devices, users of any electrical medical device other than implantable cardiac pacemakers, cardiac resynchronization therapy-pacemakers or implantable cardioverter defibrillators should consult the manufacturer of the device for information about its operation under the influence of radio waves. Radio waves could have unexpected effects on the operation of such medical devices.

 If a connected device is taken out of the Wi-Fi® connection area, the connection will be severed.
 If the vehicle is driven out of the cellular communication coverage area, connecting to the internet via the Wi-Fi® Hotspot will not be possible.

Conditions displayed with Wi-Fi® icon
The condition of Wi-Fi® connection appears on the right upper side of the screen. (P.256)

 If a Bluetooth® device is used while a device is connected using

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

284 5-3. Connectivity settings

Specifications
 Communication standards IEEE 802.11b IEEE 802.11g IEEE 802.11n (2.4GHz)
 Security WPATM WPA2TM
· WPATM and WPA2TM are trademarks of Wi-Fi Alliance®.

Apple CarPlay/ Android Auto*
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
Apple CarPlay allows some applications, such as Map, Phone, and Music, to be used on the system.
When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, Apple CarPlay compatible applications will be displayed on the system display.
 Compatible devices
Apple iPhone (iOS Ver. 9.3 or later) that supports Apple CarPlay.
For details, refer to https://www.apple.com/ios/car play/.*
AndroidTM devices with Android OS Ver. 5.0 or higher which support Android Auto and have the Android Auto application installed.
For details, refer to
https://www.android.com/auto/ .*
*: Some devices may not operate with this system.

Establishing an Apple CarPlay connection
1 Enable Siri on the device to be connected.

COROLLA HV_U

2 Connect the device to the USB port. (P.300)
3 Select "Always Enable" or "Enable Once".

5-3. Connectivity settings 285
application supported by Apple CarPlay.
Select to display the system screen.

Establishing an Android Auto connection

1 Check that the Android Auto application is installed to the
device to be connected.

 If "Do Not Enable" is selected, an Apple CarPlay connection will not be established. In this case, the device can be oper-

2 Connect the device to the USB port. (P.299)
3 Select "On" to enable the function.

ated as a normal Apple

 "Off": Select to not enable

device, such as an iPod.
 Depending on the device connected, it may take approximately 3 to 6 seconds before an Apple CarPlay connection

Android Auto. Android Auto

will remain off until "Android

5

Auto" of "Projection Settings"

on the general settings screen

is turned on.

is established.

 Depending on the device con-

4 Check that home screen of Apple CarPlay is displayed.

nected, it may take approximately 3 to 6 seconds before the system returns to previous

screen.

 The screen may change to
"step 6" depending on the system.

Select to display the home screen of Apple CarPlay. Touch and hold to activate Siri.
Select to start the application. User can use any iPhone

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

286 5-3. Connectivity settings
4 Press the "MENU" button.
5 Select "Android Auto". 6 Check that home screen of
Android Auto is displayed.
 When an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection is established, the function of some system buttons will change.
 When an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection is established, some system functions, such as the following, will be replaced by similar Apple CarPlay/Android Auto functions or will become unavailable:
· iPod (Audio Playback) · Hands-free Phone · USB audio/USB video · Bluetooth® audio · Bluetooth® phone (Apple CarPlay
only) · Toyota apps  When an Apple CarPlay/Android
Auto connection is established, voice command system (Siri/Google Assistant) and map application voice guidance volume can be changed by selecting "Voice Volume" on the voice settings screen. It cannot be changed by "POWER VOLUME" knob on Audio control panel. (P.295)  Apple CarPlay/Android Auto is an application developed by Apple Inc/Google LLC. Its functions and services may be terminated or changed without notice depending

on the connected device's operation system, hardware and software, or due to changes in Apple CarPlay/Android Auto specifications.  For a list of the apps supported by Apple CarPlay or Android Auto, refer to their respective website.  While using these functions, vehicle and user information, such as location and vehicle speed, will be shared with the respective application publisher and the cellular service provider.  By downloading and using each application, you agree to their terms of use.  Data for these functions is transmitted using the internet and may incur charges. For information about data transmission fees, contact your cellular service provider.  Depending on the application, certain functions, such as music playback, may be restricted.  As the applications for each function are provided by a third-party, they may be subject to change or discontinuation without notice. For details, refer to the website of the function.  If the USB cable is disconnected, operation of Apple CarPlay/Android Auto will end. At this time, sound output will stop and change to the system screen.
 Use of the Apple CarPlay logo means that a vehicle user interface meets Apple performance standards. Apple is not responsible for the operation of this vehicle

COROLLA HV_U

or its compliance with safety and regulatory standards. Please note that the use of this product with iPhone or iPod may affect wireless performance.  Apple CarPlay is a trademark of Apple Inc.  Compatible models Made for · iPhone X · iPhone 8 · iPhone 8 Plus · iPhone 7 · iPhone 7 Plus · iPhone SE · iPhone 6s · iPhone 6s Plus · iPhone 6 · iPhone 6 Plus · iPhone 5s · iPhone 5c · iPhone 5

5-3. Connectivity settings 287
 Android and Android Auto are trademarks of Google LLC.
WARNING Do not connect iPhone or operate the controls while driving.

NOTICE

 Do not leave your iPhone in the vehicle. In particular, high temperatures inside the vehicle may damage the iPhone.

 Do not push down on or apply unnecessary pressure to the iPhone while it is connected as this may damage the iPhone or its terminal.

 Do not insert foreign objects into

the port as this may damage the

iPhone or its terminal.

5

Troubleshooting
If you are experiencing difficulties with Apple CarPlay/Android Auto, check the following table.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

288 5-3. Connectivity settings

Symptom

Solution

An Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection cannot be established.

Check if the device supports Apple CarPlay/Android Auto. Check if Apple CarPlay/Android Auto is enabled on the connected device. Check if that the Android Auto application is installed to the device to be connected. For details, refer to Apple CarPlay: https://www.apple.com/ios/carplay/. Android Auto: https://www.android.com/auto/.
Check if "Apple CarPlay"/"Android Auto" of "Projection Settings" on the general settings screen is set to on. (P.291)
Check if the USB cable being used is securely connected to the device and USB port. Check that the device is connected directly to the USB port of the system and not connected to a USB hub. For Apple CarPlay: Check if the Lightning cable being used is certified by Apple. Check if Siri is enabled.

After checking all of the above, try to establish an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection. (P.284, 285)

When an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection is established and As the system is not designed to play video a video is being played, through Apple CarPlay/Android Auto, this is not the video is not displayed, a malfunction. but audio is output through the system.

Although an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection is established, audio is not output through the system.

The system may muted or the volume may be low. Increase the system volume.

COROLLA HV_U

5-3. Connectivity settings 289

Symptom

Solution

Check if the USB cable being used to connect

the device to the system is damaged.

The Apple Car-

To check if the USB cable is damaged inter-

Play/Android Auto screen nally, connect the device to another system,

has artifacts and/or audio such as a PC, and check if the device is recog-

from Apple Car-

nized by the connected system. (The device

Play/Android Auto has should begin charging when connected.)

noise.

After checking all of the above, try to establish

an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection.

(P.284, 285)

The map display of the Apple CarPlay Maps app cannot be enlarged or contracted with pinch multi-touch gestures.

As the Apple CarPlay Maps app is not compatible with pinch multi-touch gestures, this is not a malfunction.

During Apple CarPlay

music application (Apple

Music, Spotify, etc.) play-

5

back, if the iPhone is

operated to start and play

audio from an application that is not compatible with Apple CarPlay* and the onboard device volume is

This operation is performed according to the specification of the onboard device, this is not a malfunction.

changed, the audio of the

incompatible application

stops and the system

resumes playback of the

original music application.

After interrupt audio (such as navigation route guidance) is played from an application that is not compatible with Apple CarPlay while the onboard device is playing audio, the system does not resume playback of the original audio.

This operation is performed according to the specification of the onboard device, this is not a malfunction. Manually change the audio source by yourself. Or, do not use applications that are not compat-
ible with Apple CarPlay.* Due to some navigation applications are compatible from iOS 12, update to the latest iOS and application versions.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

290 5-3. Connectivity settings

Symptom

Solution

When using Apple Car-

Play, route guidance

arrows and turn by turn

navigation are not dis-

played on the multi-infor-

mation display and

This is not a malfunction as display of these

system display.

items is not possible with this function.

When using Android Auto,

turn by turn navigation is

not displayed on the

multi-information display

and system display.

Disconnect the phone from the USB cable and

check if hands-free call audio can be heard

When using Android Auto, using the hands-free system.

hands-free call audio can- Connect the phone to the system using Android

not be heard from the

Auto, turn up the volume on the system and

vehicle's speakers.

check if hands-free call audio can be heard.

Check if other sounds can be heard from the

vehicle's speakers.

*: Applications not compatible with Apple CarPlay are applications installed on the iPhone that are not displayed on the Apple CarPlay screen application list. (such as visual voicemail)

COROLLA HV_U

5-4.Other settings
General settings
Settings are available for clock, operation sounds, etc.
Displaying the general settings screen
1 Press the "MENU" button.
2 Select "Setup".
If the general settings screen is not displayed, select "General".
3 Select the desired items to be set.
General settings screen
 "Clock"
Select to change the time zone and select "On" or "Off" for daylight saving time, automatic adjustment of the clock, etc. (P.292)

5-4. Other settings 291

 "Language"

Select to change the language. The language setting of Apple CarPlay/Android Auto can only be changed on the connected device.

 "Customize Home Screen"

Select to change the display information/area on the home screen and the home screen layout. (P.262)
 "Theme Setting"

Select to change the screen theme setting.

 "Beep"

Select to turn the beep sound on/off.

 "Units of Measurement"

Select to change the unit of mea-

5

sure for distance/fuel consumption.

 "Keyboard Layout"

Select to change the keyboard layout.

 "Delete Keyboard History"

Select to delete the keyboard history.

 "Memorize Keyboard History"

Select to set the memorize keyboard history on/off.

 "Animation"

Select to turn the animations on/off.

 "Projection Settings"*1

Select to set automatic Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection establishment on/off. (P.293)
 "Driver Setting"

Select to change the driver set-

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

292 5-4. Other settings
tings. (P.293)
 "Delete Personal Data"
Select to delete personal data. (P.294)
 "Software Update"
Select to update software versions. For details, contact your Toyota dealer.
 "Software Update Setting"*2
Select to set software update setting. (P.294)
 "Gracenote Database Update"
Select to update Gracenote® database versions. For details, contact your Toyota dealer.
 "Software Information"
Select to display the software information. Notices related to third party software used in this product are enlisted. (This includes instructions for obtaining such software, where applicable.)
 "SW Sensitivity Level"
Select to change the capacitive touch screen button sensitivity to 1 (low), 2 (medium), or 3 (high). *1: This function is not made avail-
able in some countries or areas. *2: If equipped
Clock settings
1 Display the general settings screen. (P.291)
2 Select "Clock".

3 Select the desired items to be set.
Select to change the time zone. (P.292) Select to set daylight saving time on/off. Select to set automatic adjustment of the clock by GPS on/off. When set to off, the clock can be manually adjusted. (P.292) Select to set the 24 hour time format on/off. When set to off, the clock is displayed in 12 hour time format.
Setting the time zone 1 Select "Time Zone". 2 Select the desired time zone.
Manual clock setting When "Auto Adjust by GPS" is turned off, the clock can be manually adjusted. 1 Select "Auto Adjust by GPS"
to set to off.

COROLLA HV_U

2 Adjust the clock manually.
Select "+" to set the time forward one hour and "-" to set the time back one hour. Select "+" to set the time forward one minute and "-" to set the time back one minute. Select to round to the nearest hour. e.g. 1:00 to 1:29  1:00 1:30 to 1:59  2:00
Projection settings*
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
1 Display the general settings screen. (P.291)
2 Select "Projection Settings". 3 Select the desired items to
be set.

5-4. Other settings 293

connection establishment on/off when a compatible iPhone is connected to the system via USB. (P.284) Depending on the system, this setting cannot be changed when a device is connected to the system via USB. Disconnect the device before attempting to change the setting.

Select to turn Android Auto

connection establishment

on/off when a compatible

device is connected to the

system via USB. (P.285)

Depending on the system,

this setting cannot be

changed when a device is

5

connected to the system via

USB. Disconnect the device

before attempting to change

the setting.

Driver settings
The driver settings feature will allow the system to link some preferences (such as audio presets, screen theme, language, etc.) to a paired Bluetooth® phone. 1 Display the general settings
screen. (P.291)
2 Select "Driver Setting".

Select to turn Apple CarPlay

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

294 5-4. Other settings
3 Select "Enable This Feature".

4 Select "Yes" when the confirmation screen appears.
Examples of settings that can be returned to their default conditions:
 Audio settings
 Phone settings
etc.

Manually select linked settings 1 Select "Manually Select
Linked Settings". 2 Select the desired phone.
After a few seconds, loaded screen automatically switches to the home screen.

Software update settings*
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
When the automatic update check function is enabled, if a software update is available from the Toyota response center, a message will be displayed.
1 Display the general settings screen. (P.291)
2 Select "Software Update Setting".
3 Select "Automatic Update Check" to enable/disable the automatic update check function.

Deleting personal data
Registered or changed personal settings will be deleted or returned to their default conditions. 1 Display the general settings
screen. (P.291)
2 Select "Delete Personal Data".
3 Select "Delete".

When software update information is displayed, contact your Toyota dealer.

COROLLA HV_U

Voice settings
Voice volume, etc. can be set.
Displaying the voice settings screen
1 Press the "MENU" button.

5-4. Other settings 295
The voice command system adapts the user accent.
Select to start the voice recognition tutorial.
Select to set the voice prompt interrupt on/off.
Select to reset all setup items.

2 Select "Setup".

5

3 Select "Voice".

4 Select the desired items to be set.

Voice settings screen

Audio

Select to adjust the volume of voice guidance. Select to set the voice recognition prompts. Select to train voice recognition.
COROLLA HV_U

296 5-4. Other settings

Vehicle settings
Settings are available for vehicle customization, etc.
Displaying the vehicle settings screen
1 Press the "MENU" button.
2 Select "Setup". 3 Select "Vehicle". 4 Select the desired items to
be set.
Vehicle settings screen

Setting the valet mode
The security system can be set to on by entering a security code (4-digit number).
When set to on, the system will become inoperative once the electrical power source is disconnected until the security code is entered.
1 Display the vehicle settings screen. (P.296)
2 Select "Valet Mode".
3 Enter the 4-digit personal code and select "OK".
4 Enter the same 4-digit personal code again and select "OK".
 The system will request that you input the security code again to confirm that you remember it correctly.
 When valet mode activates, the system stops and a security code (4-digit number) standby screen is displayed.

If the 4-digit personal code is forgotten, please contact your Toyota dealer.

Select to set vehicle customization. (P.544)
Select to set valet mode. (P.296)

If the valet mode has been activated
Enter the 4-digit personal code and select "OK".
If an incorrect security code (4-digit number) is entered 6 times, the system will not accept another security

COROLLA HV_U

code (4-digit number) for 10 minutes.

5-4. Other settings 297

5

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

298 5-5. Using the audio/visual system
5-5.Using the audio/visual system
Quick reference Functional overview
The audio control screen can be reached by the following methods:  From the "AUDIO" button Press the "AUDIO" button.  From the "MENU" button Press the "MENU" button, then select "Audio".
· Using the radio (P.303) · Playing a USB memory (P.309) · Playing an iPod/iPhone (Apple CarPlay*) (P.311) · Using the Android Auto* (P.314) · Playing a Bluetooth® device (P.315) · Using the steering wheel audio switches (P.319) · Audio system settings (P.321)
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
COROLLA HV_U

5-5. Using the audio/visual system 299

Some basics
This section describes some of the basic features of the audio/visual system. Some information may not pertain to your system.
Your audio/visual system works when the power switch is in ACC or ON.

Selecting an audio source
1 Press the "AUDIO" button.

NOTICE To prevent the battery from being discharged, do not leave the audio/visual system on longer than necessary when the hybrid system is not running.
Turning the system on and off
"POWER VOLUME" knob: Press to turn the audio/visual system on and off. The system turns on in the last mode used. Turn this knob to adjust the volume.

2 Select "Source" or press "AUDIO" button again.
3 Select the desired source.
 Dimmed screen buttons cannot be operated.
 When there are two pages, select 5 or to change the page.
 When an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection is established, some system functions, such as the following, will be replaced by similar Apple CarPlay/Android Auto function or will become unavailable*:
· iPod (Audio Playback) · USB audio/USB video · Bluetooth® audio · Toyota apps *: This function is not made avail-
able in some countries or areas.
Reordering the audio source
1 Display the audio source selection screen. (P.299)
2 Select "Reorder".

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

300 5-5. Using the audio/visual system

3 Select the desired audio source then or to reorder.
4 Select "OK".

3 Select the desired item to be set.

USB port
Connect a device.

Turn on the power of the device if it is not turned on.
 If a USB hub is plugged-in, two devices can be connected at a time.
 Even if a USB hub is used to connect more than two USB devices, only the first two connected devices will be recognized.
 If a USB hub that has more than two ports is connected to the USB port, devices connected to the USB hub may not charge or be inoperable, as the supply of current may be insufficient.

Select to set the treble/mid/bass. (P.300)
Select to set the fader/balance. (P.301)
Select to set the automatic sound levelizer. (P.301)
 Treble/Mid/Bass
How good an audio program sounds is largely determined by the mix of the treble, mid and bass levels. In fact, different kinds of music and vocal programs usually sound better with different mixes of treble, mid and bass.
1 Select "Treble/Mid/Bass".
2 Select the desired screen button.

Sound settings
1 Display the audio control screen. (P.299)
2 Select "Sound".

Select "+" or "-" to adjust high-pitched tones.

COROLLA HV_U

5-5. Using the audio/visual system 301

Select "+" or "-" to adjust mid-pitched tones.

according to vehicle speed to compensate for increased road

Select "+" or "-" to adjust low-pitched tones.
 Fader/Balance

noise, wind noise, or other noises while driving.
1 Select "Automatic Sound Levelizer".

A good balance of the left and right stereo channels and of the front and rear sound levels is

2 Select "High", "Mid", "Low" or "Off".

also important. Keep in mind that when listening

Audio screen adjustment

to a stereo recording or broad-  Screen format settings

cast, changing the right/left balance will increase the volume of 1 group of sounds while decreasing the volume of another.

The screen format can be selected for USB video. 1 Press the "MENU" button.
2 Select "Setup".

1 Select "Fader/Balance".

3 Select "Audio".

5

2 Select the desired screen

4 Select "Common".

button.

5 Select "Screen Format".

6 Select the desired item to be adjusted.

Audio

Select to adjust the sound balance between the front and rear speakers.
Select to adjust the sound balance between the left and right speakers.
 Automatic sound levelizer (ASL)
The system adjusts to the optimum volume and tone quality

Select to display a 4 : 3 screen, with either side in black.
Select to enlarge the image horizontally and vertically to full screen.
Select to enlarge the image by the same ratio horizontally

COROLLA HV_U

302 5-5. Using the audio/visual system

and vertically.
 Contrast and brightness adjustment
The contrast and brightness of the screen can be adjusted. 1 Press the "MENU" button. 2 Select "Setup". 3 Select "Audio". 4 Select "Common". 5 Select "Display". 6 Select the desired item to be
adjusted.
 "Contrast"
"+": Select to strengthen the contrast of the screen.
"-": Select to weaken the contrast of the screen.
 "Brightness"
"+": Select to brighten the screen.
"-": Select to darken the screen.

The voice command system and its list of commands can be operated. (P.334)

Depending on the audio source, some functions may not be available.

Voice command system
1 Press this switch to operate the voice command system.

COROLLA HV_U

5-6.Radio operation
AM radio/FM radio/SiriusXM® Satellite Radio(SXM)*
*: If equipped

5-6. Radio operation
Control panel

303

Overview
The radio operation screen can be reached by the following methods: P.299
Control screen

Press to seek for stations in the relevant program type. Press and hold for continuous seek.
Turn to step up/down frequencies. Turn to move up/down the station. Also, the knob can be 5 used to enter selections on the list screens by pressing it.

Select to display the audio source selection screen.
Select to display the preset stations screen. (P.303)
Select to display a list of receivable stations. (P.304)
Select to display the radio options screen. (P.304)
Select to display the sound setting screen. (P.300)
Select to tune to preset stations/channels. (P.303)

The radio automatically changes to stereo reception when a stereo broadcast is received.
Presetting a station
Radio mode has a mix preset function, which can store up to 36 stations (6 stations per page x 6 pages) from any of the AM, FM or SXM bands. 1 Tune in the desired station.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

304 5-6. Radio operation
2 Select and hold "(Hold Edit)".

Radio options
1 Select "Options". 2 Select the desired item to be
set.

 To change the preset station to a different one, select and hold the preset station.

The number of preset radio stations displayed on the screen can be changed. (P.321)
Selecting a station from the list
1 Select "Station List". 2 Select "AM", "FM" or "SXM".
Select the desired program genre when the genre selection screen is displayed.
3 Select the desired station.  Refreshing the station list 1 Select "Refresh". "Cancel Refresh": Select to cancel the refresh. "Source": Select to change to another audio source while refreshing.
 The audio/visual system sound is muted during refresh operation.
 In some situations, it may take some time to update the station list.

When "SXM Tune Start" is turned on, the current song is played from the beginning when you select the channel.
Analog FM only: Select to display RBDS text messages.
Select to scan for receivable stations.
Radio Broadcast Data System
This audio/visual system is equipped with Radio Broadcast Data Systems (RBDS). RBDS mode allows text messages to be received from radio stations that utilize RBDS transmitters.
When RBDS is on, the radio can do the following functions. · Only selecting stations of a
particular program type · Displaying messages from
radio stations · Searching for a stronger sig-

COROLLA HV_U

nal station
RBDS features are available only when listening to an FM station that broadcasts RBDS information and the "FM Info" function is on. (P.304)
How to subscribe to SiriusXM Radio Services
All SiriusXM services, including satellite radio and data services, plus streaming services, require a subscription, sold separately or as a package by Sirius XM Radio Inc. (or in Canada, Sirius XM Canada Inc.), after any trial subscription which may be included with your vehicle purchase or lease. To subscribe after your trial subscription, call 1-877-447-0011 (U.S.A.) or 1-877-438-9677 (Canada).
 Important information about your subscription
Your SiriusXM services will automatically stop at the end of your trial unless you decide to subscribe. If you decide to continue service, the paid subscription plan you choose will automatically renew and you will be charged the rate in effect at that time and according to your chosen payment method. Fees and taxes apply. You may cancel at any time by calling 1-866-635-2349. See SiriusXM Customer Agreement for com-

5-6. Radio operation 305
plete terms at www.siriusxm.com (U.S.A.) or www.siriusxm.ca (Canada). All fees and programming subject to change. Traffic information not available in all markets.

NOTICE

 It is prohibited to copy, decom-

pile, disassemble, reverse engi-

neer, hack, manipulate, or

otherwise make available any

technology or software incorpo-

rated in receivers compatible

with the SiriusXM Satellite

Radio System or that support

the SiriusXM website, the

streaming service or any of its

content. Furthermore, the

AMBE® voice compression soft-

ware included in this product is

protected by intellectual property rights including patent

5

rights, copyrights, and trade

secrets of Digital Voice Sys-

tems, Inc.

 Note: this applies to SiriusXM Satellite Radio receivers only and not SiriusXM Ready devices.

 About SiriusXM Services · Most in-car trials today include
SiriusXM's best package -- All Access. It includes every channel available on your radio, plus streaming.  SiriusXM All Access Subscription · Listen everywhere with All Access. You get every channel available in your ride, plus you can listen on the app and online -- so you can enjoy the best SiriusXM has to offer, anywhere life takes you. It's the only package that gives you all of our premium programming, including Howard Stern, every NFL, MLB® and NBA

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

306 5-6. Radio operation
game, every NASCAR® race, NHL® games, 24/7 talk channels dedicated to the biggest leagues, and more. You get all kinds of commercial-free music, including artist-dedicated channels and more, plus sports, news, talk and entertainment.  Radio operation · Look for the Sirius, XM, SiriusXM, Band, SAT, AUX, Radio or Source button and you're in. If you can't hear us, it's easy to get started: U.S.A.: Locate your Radio ID by turning to Channel 0. If you don't see your number there, go to siriusxm.com/activationhelp to find it. Visit siriusxm.com/refresh or call 1-855-MYREFRESH (697-3373) to send a refresh signal to your radio. Canada: Locate your Radio ID by turning to Channel 0. Visit siriusxm.ca/refresh to send a refresh signal to your radio or call

1-888-539-7474 for service.
Displaying the radio ID
Each SiriusXM tuner is identified with a unique radio ID. The radio ID is required when activating an SiriusXM service or when reporting a problem.
 If "Ch 000" is selected using the "TUNE SCROLL" knob, the ID code, which is 8 alphanumeric characters, will be displayed. If another channel is selected, the ID code will no longer be displayed. The channel (000) alternates between displaying the radio ID and the specific radio code.

Refer to the table below to identify the problem and take the suggested corrective action

When problems occur with the SiriusXM tuner, a message will appear on the screen. Referring to the table below to identify the problem, take the suggested corrective action.

Message
"Check Antenna"
"No Signal"

Explanation
The SiriusXM antenna is not connected. Check whether the SiriusXM antenna cable is attached securely. Contact your Toyota dealer for assistance.
A short circuit occurs in the antenna or the surrounding antenna cable. Contact your Toyota dealer for assistance.
The SiriusXM signal is too weak at the current location. Wait until your vehicle reaches a location with a stronger signal.

COROLLA HV_U

5-6. Radio operation 307

Message

Explanation

"Chan

The channel you selected is not broadcasting any program-

Unavailable" ming. Select another channel.

"Ch Unsubscribed"

The channel you selected is no longer available. Wait for about 2 seconds until the radio returns to the previous channel or "Ch 001". If it does not change automatically, select another channel.

5

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

308 5-6. Radio operation
Internet radio
One of Toyota apps Connect features is the ability to listen to internet radio. In order to use this service, a compatible phone and the system needs to be set up. For details: P.379
 Other applications can be activated while listening to internet radio.
 Some parts of applications can be adjusted using the switches on the steering wheel.
 For additional information, refer to https://www.toyota.com/ audio-multimedia or call 1-800-331-4331 in the United States, https://www.toyota.ca/connected or call 1-888-869-6828 in Canada, and http://www.toyotapr.com/ audio-multimedia or call 1-877-855-8377 in Puerto Rico.
Listening to internet radio
1 Display the audio source selection screen. (P.299)
2 Select the desired application screen button.
 The internet radio application screen is displayed.
 Perform operations according to the displayed application screen.
 For the instrument panel operation method: P.299
 If a compatible phone is

already registered, it will be connected automatically.

COROLLA HV_U

5-7.Media operation
USB memory
WARNING Do not operate the player's controls or connect the USB memory while driving.

5-7. Media operation
Control screen  USB audio

309

NOTICE Do not leave your portable
player in the car. In particular, high temperatures inside the vehicle may damage the portable player.
Do not push down on or apply unnecessary pressure to the portable player while it is connected as this may damage the portable player or its terminal.
Do not insert foreign objects into the port as this may damage the portable player or its terminal.
Overview
The USB memory operation screen can be reached by the following methods: P.299 Connecting a USB memory (P.300) When an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection is established, this function will be unavailable*.
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.

Select to display the audio source selection screen.

Select to return to the top screen.

Select to display a song list screen.

Select to display the play

5

mode selection screen.

Select to display the sound setting screen. (P.300)

Select to set repeat playback. (P.310)

Select to change the file/track. Select and hold to fast rewind.

Select to play/pause.

Select to change the file/track. Select and hold to fast forward.

Select to set random playback. (P.311)

Select to change the folder/album.

Displays cover art

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

310 5-7. Media operation
Select to change the artist.  USB video 1 Select "Browse". 2 Select "Videos". 3 Select the desired folder and
file.

Control panel

Select to display the audio source selection screen.
Select to return to the top screen.
Select to display a song list screen.
Select to display the play mode selection screen.
Select to display the sound setting screen. (P.300)
Select to change the file. Select and hold to fast rewind.
Select to play/pause.
Select to change the file. Select and hold to fast forward.
Select to display a full screen image.
Select to change the folder.

Press to change the file/track. Press and hold to fast forward/rewind. Turn to change the file/track. Turn to move up/down the list. Also, the knob can be used to enter selections on the list screens by pressing it.
 While the vehicle is being driven, this function can only output sound.
 If tag information exists, the file/folder names will be changed to track/album names.
Repeating
The file/track or folder/album currently being listened to can be repeated.
Select .

 Each time

is selected, the

mode changes as follows:

 When random playback is off

File/track repeat  folder/album repeat  off  When random playback is on

File/track repeat  off

COROLLA HV_U

5-7. Media operation 311

Random order
Files/tracks or folders/albums can be automatically and randomly selected.

iPod/iPhone (Apple CarPlay*)
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.

Select .

Overview

Each time

is selected, the

mode changes as follows:

Random (1 folder/album random)  folder/album random (all folder/album random)  off

The iPod/iPhone(Apple CarPlay) operation screen can be reached by the following methods: P.299

Connecting an iPod/iPhone (P.284, 300)

When an Android Auto connection is established, this function will be unavailable.*

*: This function is not made avail-

5

able in some countries or areas.

Control screen
 An Apple CarPlay connection is not established

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

312 5-7. Media operation
 An Apple CarPlay connection is established

control screen of Apple CarPlay.
Control panel

Select to display the audio source selection screen.
Select to return to the top screen.
Select to display a song list screen.
Select to display the play mode selection screen.
Select to display the sound setting screen. (P.300)
Select to set repeat playback. (P.313)
Select to change the track. Select and hold to fast rewind.
Select to play/pause.
Select to change the track. Select and hold to fast forward.
Select to set random playback. (P.313)
Displays cover art
Select to change the album.
Select to change the artist.
Select to change the playlist.
Select to display the audio

Press to change the track. Press and hold to fast forward/rewind.
Turn to change the track. Turn to move up/down the list. Also, the knob can be used to enter selections on the list screens by pressing it.
 Some functions may not be available depending on the type of model.
 When an iPod/iPhone is connected using a genuine iPod/iPhone cable, the iPod/iPhone starts charging its battery.
 Depending on the iPod/iPhone, the video sound may not be able to be heard.
 Depending on the iPod/iPhone and the songs in the iPod/iPhone, a cover art may be displayed. This function can be changed to "On" or "Off". (P.321) It may take time to display the cover art, and the iPod/iPhone may not be operated while the cover art display is in process.
 When an iPod/iPhone is connected and the audio source is

COROLLA HV_U

changed to iPod/iPhone mode, the iPod/iPhone will resume playing from the same point it was last used.  Tracks selected by operating a connected iPod/iPhone may not be recognized or displayed properly.  The system may not function properly if a conversion adapter is used to connect a device.
Repeating
The track currently being listened to can be repeated. 1 Select .

 Each time

is selected, the

mode changes as follows:

 When shuffle is off (iPhone 5 or later)
· Track repeat  album repeat  off

 When shuffle is off (iPhone 4s or earlier)
· Track repeat  off

 When shuffle is on · Track repeat  off

Random order
Tracks or albums can be automatically and randomly selected.
1 Select .

5-7. Media operation 313
WARNING Do not operate the player's controls or connect the iPod/iPhone while driving.
NOTICE  Do not leave your portable
player in the vehicle. In particular, high temperatures inside the vehicle may damage the portable player.  Do not push down on or apply unnecessary pressure to the portable player while it is connected as this may damage the portable player or its terminal.  Do not insert foreign objects into the port as this may damage the portable player or its terminal.
5

 Each time

is selected, the

mode changes as follows:

· Shuffle (1 album shuffle)  album

shuffle (all album shuffle)  off

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

314 5-7. Media operation
Android Auto*
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
Overview
The Android Auto operation screen can be reached by the following methods: P.299 Connecting an Android device (P.284, 300) When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, this function will be unavailable.*
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
Control screen

Select to play/pause. Select to change the track. Displays cover art Control panel
Press to change the track. Turn to change the track.
WARNING Do not connect smartphone or operate the controls while driving.

Select to display the audio source selection screen.
Select to return to the top screen.
Select to display the sound setting screen. (P.300)
Select to display the audio control screen of Android Auto.
Select to change the track.

NOTICE  Do not leave your smartphone
in the vehicle. In particular, high temperatures inside the vehicle may damage the smartphone.  Do not push down on or apply unnecessary pressure to the smartphone while it is connected as this may damage the smartphone or its terminal.  Do not insert foreign objects into the port as this may damage the smartphone or its terminal.

COROLLA HV_U

Bluetooth® audio
The Bluetooth® audio system enables users to enjoy listening to music that is played on a portable player on the vehicle speakers via wireless communication.
This audio/visual system supports Bluetooth®, a wireless data system capable of playing portable audio music without cables. If your device does not support Bluetooth®, the Bluetooth® audio system will not function.
 Depending on the Bluetooth® device that is connected to the system, the music may start playing when selecting while it is paused. Conversely, the music may pause when selecting while it is playing.
 In the following conditions, the system may not function:
· The Bluetooth® device is turned off.
· The Bluetooth® device is not connected.
· The Bluetooth® device has a low battery.
 When using the Bluetooth® audio and Wi-Fi® Hotspot functions at the same time, the following problems may occur:
· It may take longer than normal to connect to the Bluetooth® device.
· The sound may cut out.  It may take time to connect the

5-7. Media operation 315

phone when Bluetooth® audio is being played.

 For operating the portable player, see the instruction manual that comes with it.

 If the Bluetooth® device is disconnected due to poor reception from the Bluetooth® network when the power switch is in ACC or ON, the system automatically reconnects the portable player.

 If the Bluetooth® device is disconnected on purpose, such as it was turned off, this does not happen. Reconnect the portable player manually.

 Bluetooth® device information is

registered when the Bluetooth®

device is connected to the Blue-

tooth® audio system. When selling

or disposing of the vehicle,

remove the Bluetooth® audio

5

information from the system.

(P.294)

 In some situations, sound output via the Bluetooth® audio system may be out of sync with the connected device or output intermittently.

WARNING  Do not operate the player's con-
trols or connect to the Bluetooth® audio system while driving.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

316 5-7. Media operation
WARNING Your audio unit is fitted with
Bluetooth® antennas. People with implantable cardiac pacemakers, cardiac resynchronization therapy-pacemakers or implantable cardioverter defibrillators should maintain a reasonable distance between themselves and the Bluetooth® antennas. The radio waves may affect the operation of such devices. Before using Bluetooth® devices, users of any electrical medical device other than implantable cardiac pacemakers, cardiac resynchronization therapy-pacemakers or implantable cardioverter defibrillators should consult the manufacturer of the device for information about its operation under the influence of radio waves. Radio waves could have unexpected effects on the operation of such medical devices.
NOTICE Do not leave your portable player in the vehicle. In particular, high temperatures inside the vehicle may damage the portable player.
Overview
The Bluetooth® audio operation screen can be reached by the following methods: P.299 Connecting a Bluetooth® audio device (P.317) Depending on the type of portable player connected, some functions may not be available

and/or the screen may look differently than shown in this manual. When an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connection is established, Bluetooth® audio will be suspended and become unavailable*.
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
Control screen
Select to display the audio source selection screen. Select to return to the top screen. Select to display a song list screen. Select to display the play mode selection screen. Select to display the portable device connection screen. (P.317) Select to display the sound setting screen. (P.300) Select to set repeat playback. (P.317) Select to change the track. Select and hold to fast

COROLLA HV_U

rewind. Select to play/pause. Select to change the track. Select and hold to fast forward. Select to set random playback. (P.317) Select to change the album. Displays cover art
Control panel

Press to change the track. Press and hold to fast forward/rewind.
Turn to change the track. Turn to move up/down the list. Also, the knob can be used to enter selections on the list screens by pressing it.

Repeating
The track or album currently being listened to can be repeated.
Select .

 Each time

is selected, the

5-7. Media operation 317
mode changes as follows:  When random playback is off Track repeat  album repeat  off  When random playback is on Track repeat  off
Random order
Tracks or albums can be automatically and randomly selected.
Select .

Each time

is selected, the

mode changes as follows:

Random (1 album random)  album random (all album random)  off

Registering/Connecting a 5 Bluetooth® device

To use the Bluetooth® audio system, it is necessary to register a Bluetooth® device with the system.
 Registering an additional device
1 Display the Bluetooth® audio control screen. (P.316)
2 Select "Connect".
3 Select "Add Device".
When another Bluetooth® device is connected, a confirmation screen will be displayed. To disconnect the Bluetooth® device, select "Yes".
4 Follow the steps in "Registering a Bluetooth® phone for

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

318 5-7. Media operation
the first time" from step 5. (P.268)  Selecting a registered device 1 Display the Bluetooth® audio control screen. (P.316) 2 Select "Connect". 3 Select the desired device to be connected. 4 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the connection is complete.
If an error message is displayed, follow the guidance on the screen to try again.
COROLLA HV_U

5-8. Audio/visual remote controls 319

5-8.Audio/visual remote controls
Steering switches
Steering switch operation
Some parts of the audio/visual system can be adjusted using the switches on the steering wheel.

Mode

Operation/function

Press: Change USB*3, 4, audio modes

iPod/iPhone*4, Android

Press and hold (0.8 sec. or more):

Auto*3, Blue- Pause (Press and

tooth® audio*3, hold again to

4, APPS*3, 4 resume the play mode.)

*1: If equipped

*2: If cached radio is enabled, pressing and holding the "MODE" switch pauses the broadcast. (Press and hold again to play back the cached radio program.)

*3: When an Apple CarPlay is estab-

Volume control switch

Mode

Operation/function

lished, this function will be unavailable.
*4: When an Android Auto is estab-

5

Press: Volume up/down

lished, this function will be unavailable.

All

Press and hold

(0.8 sec. or more):

Volume up/down

continuously

switch

Mode

Operation/function
Press: Preset channel up/down

"MODE" switch

Mode
AM/FM/ SXM*1

Operation/function
Press: Change audio modes
Press and hold (0.8 sec. or more): Mute*2 (Press and hold again to resume the sound.)

AM/FM

Press and hold (0.8 sec. or more): Seek up/down
Press and hold (1.5 sec. or more): Seek up/down continuously while the switch is being pressed

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

320 5-8. Audio/visual remote controls

Mode

Operation/function

Press: Preset channel up/down

SXM*1

Press and hold (0.8 sec. or more): Seek for stations in the relevant program type/channel category

Press and hold (1.5 sec. or more): Fast channel up/down

Press: Track/file USB*2, 3, up/down iPod/iPhone*3, Press and hold Bluetooth® (0.8 sec. or more): audio*2, 3 Fast for-
ward/rewind

Android Auto*2

Press: Track up/down

*1: If equipped
*2: When an Apple CarPlay is established, this function will be unavailable.
*3: When an Android Auto is established, this function will be unavailable.

In the APPS mode, some operation may be done on the screen depend on the selected APPS.

COROLLA HV_U

5-9.Audio settings
Setup
Detailed audio settings can be programmed.
Displaying the audio settings screen
1 Press the "MENU" button.

5-9. Audio settings 321
Common settings
1 Display the audio settings screen. (P.321)
2 Select "Common". 3 Select the desired items to
be set.

2 Select "Setup". 3 Select "Audio". 4 Select the desired items to
be set.
Audio settings screen
Select to set the common settings. (P.321) Select to set the radio settings. (P.321)

Select to set the cover art display on/off.
Select to prioritize the display 5 of information from the Gracenote database.
Select to change the screen size.* (P.301) Select to display the image quality adjustment screen.* (P.302)
*: Only in USB video mode
Radio settings
1 Display the audio settings screen. (P.321)
2 Select "Radio". 3 Select the desired number of
preset radio stations displayed on the screen.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

322 5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system

5-10.Tips for operating the audio/visual system
Operating information
The use of a cellular phone inside or near the vehicle may cause a noise from the speakers of the audio/visual system which you are listening to. However, this does not indicate a malfunction.
NOTICE
To avoid damage to the audio/visual system: Be careful not to spill beverages over the audio/visual system.
Radio
Usually, a problem with radio reception does not mean there is a problem with the radio  it is just the normal result of conditions outside the vehicle.
For example, nearby buildings and terrain can interfere with FM reception. Power lines or phone wires can interfere with AM signals. And of course, radio signals have a limited range. The farther the vehicle is from a station, the weaker its signal will be. In addition, reception conditions change constantly as the vehicle moves.
Here are some common reception problems that may not indicate a problem with the radio as described.
 FM
Fading and drifting stations: Generally, the effective range of

FM is about 25 miles (40 km). Once outside this range, you may notice fading and drifting, which increase with the distance from the radio transmitter. They are often accompanied by distortion.
Multi-path: FM signals are reflective, making it possible for 2 signals to reach the vehicle's antenna at the same time. If this happens, the signals will cancel each other out, causing a momentary flutter or loss of reception.
Static and fluttering: These occur when signals are blocked by buildings, trees or other large objects. Increasing the bass level may reduce static and fluttering.
Station swapping: If the FM signal being listened to is interrupted or weakened, and there is another strong station nearby on the FM band, the radio may tune in the second station until the original signal can be picked up again.
 AM
Fading: AM broadcasts are reflected by the upper atmosphere  especially at night. These reflected signals can interfere with those received directly from the radio station, causing the radio station to sound alternately strong and weak.

COROLLA HV_U

5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system 323

Station interference: When a

reflected signal and a signal

received directly from a radio

station are very nearly the same

frequency, they can interfere

with each other, making it diffi-

cult to hear the broadcast.
Static: AM is easily affected by external sources of electrical noise, such as high tension power lines, lightening or electrical motors. This results in static.
 SiriusXM

 Use of the Made for Apple badge means that an accessory has been designed to connect specifically to the Apple product(s) identified in the badge, and has been certified by the developer to meet

 Cargo loaded on the roof lug-

Apple performance stan-

gage carrier, especially metal

dards. Apple is not responsi-

objects, may adversely affect

ble for the operation of this

the reception of SiriusXM Sat-

device or its compliance with

ellite Radio.

safety and regulatory stan-

5

 Alternation or modifications carried out without appropriate authorization may invalidate the user's right to

dards. Please note that the use of this accessory with an Apple product may affect wireless performance.

operate the equipment.

 iPhone®, iPod®, iPod clas-

iPod

sic®, iPod nano®, iPod touch®, and Lightning® are

 Certification

trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other

countries.

 Compatible models

Made for · iPhone X · iPhone 8 · iPhone 8 Plus · iPhone 7 · iPhone 7 Plus · iPhone SE · iPhone 6s · iPhone 6s Plus

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

324 5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system

· iPhone 6 · iPhone 6 Plus · iPhone 5s · iPhone 5c · iPhone 5 · iPod touch (6th generation) · iPod touch (5th generation)
 This system only supports audio playback.
 Depending on difference between models or software versions etc., some models might be incompatible with this system.
High-resolution sound source
This device supports high-resolution sound sources. The definition of high-resolution is based on the standards of groups such as the CTA (Consumer Technology Association). Supported formats and playable media are as follows.  Supported formats WAV, FLAC, ALAC, OGG Vorbis  Playable media USB memory
File information
Compatible USB devices
USB communi- USB 2.0 HS (480 cation formats Mbps)

File formats
Correspondence class

FAT 16/32
Mass storage class

Compatible audio format

Compatible compressed files

Item

USB

MP3/WMA/AAC

Compatible file format

WAV(LPCM)/FL AC/ALAC/OGG
Vorbis

MP4/AVI/WMV

Compatible file format (video)*

MP4/AVI/WMV

Folders in the device

Maximum 3000

Files in the device

Maximum 9999

Files per folder

Maximum 255

*: USB video only

Corresponding sampling frequency

File type Frequency (kHz)

MP3 files: MPEG 1 LAYER 3

32/44.1/48

MP3 files: MPEG 2 LSF LAYER 3

16/22.05/24

COROLLA HV_U

5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system 325

File type Frequency (kHz)

File type

Bit rate (kbps)

WMA files: Ver. 7, 8, 9*1

32/44.1/48

WMA files: Ver. 7, 8

CBR 48 - 192

(9.1/9.2)
AAC files: MPEG4/AAC-LC

11.025/12/16/ 22.05/24/32/
44.1/48

WMA files: Ver. 9*2 (9.1/9.2)
AAC files: MPEG4/AAC-LC

CBR 48 - 320 8 - 320

WAV (LPCM) files*2

8/11.025/12/16/ 22.05/24/32/ 44.1/48/88.2/ 96/176.4/192

OGG Vorbis

32-500

*1: Variable Bit Rate (VBR) compatible

8/11.025/12/16/ *2: Only compatible with Windows

FLAC*2 ALAC*2

22.05/24/32/

Media Audio Standard

44.1/48/88.2/ 96/176.4/192

File type

Quantization bit rate (bit)

8/11.025/12/16/ 22.05/24/32/ 44.1/48/64/ 88.2/96

WAV (LPCM) files
FLAC

16/24

5

OGG Vorbis*2

8/11.025/16/ 22.05/32/44.1/
48

*1: Only compatible with Windows Media Audio Standard
*2: Sound source of 48kHz or more is down-converted to 48kHz/24bit.

Corresponding bit rates*1

ALAC

Compatible channel modes

File type MP3 files WMA files

Channel mode
Stereo, joint stereo, dual channel and monaural
2ch

File type
MP3 files: MPEG 1 LAYER 3
MP3 files: MPEG 2 LSF LAYER 3

Bit rate (kbps) 32 - 320 8 - 160

AAC files

1ch, 2ch (Dual channel is not supported)

WAV (LPCM)/ FLAC/ALAC/ 2ch OGG Vorbis

 MP3 (MPEG Audio Layer 3), WMA (Windows Media Audio)

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

326 5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system

and AAC (Advanced Audio Coding) are audio compression standards.
 This system can play MP3/WMA/AAC files on USB memory.
 MP4, WMV and AVI files can use the following resolutions: 128x96, 160x120, 176x144 (QCIF), 320x240 (QVGA), 352x240 (SIF), 352x288 (CIF), 640x480 (VGA), 720x480 (NTSC), 720x576 (PAL)
 When naming an MP3/WMA/AAC file, add an appropriate file extension (.mp3/.wma/.m4a).
 This system plays back files with .mp3/.wma/.m4a file extensions as MP3/WMA/AAC files respectively. To prevent noise and playback errors, use the appropriate file extension.
 MP3 files are compatible with the ID3 Tag Ver. 1.0, Ver. 1.1, Ver. 2.2 and Ver. 2.3 formats. This system cannot display disc title, track title and artist name in other formats.
 WMA/AAC files can contain a WMA/AAC tag that is used in the same way as an ID3 tag. WMA/AAC tags carry information such as track title and artist name.
 The emphasis function is

available only when playing MP3 files.
 This system can play back AAC files encoded by iTunes.
 The sound quality of MP3/WMA files generally improves with higher bit rates.
 m3u playlists are not compatible with the audio player.
 MP3i (MP3 interactive) and MP3PRO formats are not compatible with the audio player.
 The player is compatible with VBR (Variable Bit Rate).
 When playing back files recorded as VBR (Variable Bit Rate) files, the play time will not be correctly displayed if the fast forward or reverse operations are used.
 It is not possible to check folders that do not include MP3/WMA/AAC files.
 MP3/WMA/AAC files in folders up to 8 levels deep can be played. However, the start of playback may be delayed when using USB memory containing numerous levels of folders. For this reason, we recommend creating USB memory with no more than 2 levels of folders.

COROLLA HV_U

5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system 327

Compatible video format

 The play order of the USB memory with the structure shown above is as follows:

Format MPEG-4

Codec
Video codec:  H.264/MPEG-4
AVC  MPEG4
Audio codec:  AAC  MP3
Corresponding screen size:  MAX
19201080
Corresponding frame rate:  MAX 60i/30p

5

 The order changes depending on the personal computer and MP3/WMA/AAC encoding software you use.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

328 5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system

Format

Codec

Video codec:
 H.264/MPEG-4 AVC
 MPEG4  WMV9  WMV9
Advanced pro-
file

AVI Container

Audio codec:
 AAC  MP3  WMA9.2
(7,8,9.1,9.2)

Corresponding screen size:  MAX
19201080
Corresponding frame rate:  MAX 60i/30p

Video codec:
 WMV9  WMV9
Advanced pro-
file

Windows Media Video

Audio codec:  WMA9.2
(7,8,9.1,9.2)
Corresponding screen size:  MAX
19201080
Corresponding frame rate:  MAX 60i/30p

Terms
 ID3 tag This is a method of embedding

track-related information in an MP3 file. This embedded information can include the track number, track title, the artist's name, the album title, the music genre, the year of production, comments, cover art and other data. The contents can be freely edited using software with ID3 tag editing functions. Although the tags are restricted to a number of characters, the information can be viewed when the track is played back.
 WMA tag
WMA files can contain a WMA tag that is used in the same way as an ID3 tag. WMA tags carry information such as track title and artist name.
 MP3
MP3 is an audio compression standard determined by a working group (MPEG) of the ISO (International Standard Organization). MP3 compresses audio data to about 1/10 the size of that on conventional discs.
 WMA
 WMA (Windows Media Audio) is an audio compression format developed by Microsoft®. It compresses files into a size smaller than that of MP3 files. The decoding formats for WMA files are Ver. 7, 8 and 9.
 This product includes technology owned by Microsoft Cor-

COROLLA HV_U

5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system 329

poration and cannot be used or distributed without a license from Microsoft Licensing, Inc.
 AAC
AAC is short for Advanced Audio Coding and refers to an audio compression technology standard used with MPEG2 and MPEG4.

 iPod
Message
"iPod Error"
"No music files found."

Explanation
This indicates a problem in the iPod or its connection.
This indicates that there is no music data in the iPod.

This indicates

Error messages

that the software

 USB
Message

Explanation

"Please check the iPod firmware version."

version is not compatible. Perform the iPod firmware

This indicates a

updates and try

"USB Error"

problem in the USB memory or

again.

This indicates

5

"No music files

its connection.
This indicates that no MP3/WMA/AAC

"Unable to authorize the iPod."

that it failed to authorize the iPod.
Please check

found."

files are included in the USB mem-

your iPod.

ory.

 Bluetooth® audio

"No video files found."

This indicates that no video files are included in the USB memory.

Message

Explanation

"Music tracks not supported. Please check your portable player."

This indicates a problem in the
Bluetooth® device.

If the malfunction is not rectified: Take your vehicle to your Toyota dealer.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

330 5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system Certification
 Except for vehicles sold in Canada
COROLLA HV_U

5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system
 For vehicles sold in Canada

331

5

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

332 5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system
 Gracenote
COROLLA HV_U

5-10. Tips for operating the audio/visual system
 For U.S. owners

333

5

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

334 5-11. Voice command system operation

5-11.Voice command system operation
Voice command system

the voice command system.  Microphone

The voice command system enables the radio, phone dialing, etc. to be operated using voice commands. Refer to the command list for samples of voice commands. (P.337)
Using the voice command system
 Steering switch
Talk switch  Voice command system Press the talk switch to start the voice command system. To cancel voice command, press and hold the talk switch.  When an Apple Car-
Play/Android Auto connection is established  Press and hold the talk switch to start Siri/Google Assistant. To cancel Siri/Google Assistant, press the talk switch.  Press the talk switch to start

It is unnecessary to speak directly into the microphone when giving a command.
 Voice commands may not be recognized if:
· Spoken too quickly. · Spoken at a low or high volume. · The windows are open. · Passengers are talking while
voice commands are spoken. · The fan speed of the air condition-
ing system is set at high. · The air conditioning vents are
turned towards the microphone.  In the following conditions, the
system may not recognize the command properly and using voice commands may not be possible: · The command is incorrect or unclear. Note that certain words, accents or speech patterns may be difficult for the system to recognize. · There is excessive background noise, such as wind noise.  Normally, it is necessary to wait for a beep before saying a command. To enable the ability to talk over prompts and say commands before the beep, enable the voice prompt interrupt function. (P.295)  This system may not operate immediately after the power

COROLLA HV_U

5-11. Voice command system operation 335

switch is in ACC or ON.

3 After hearing a beep, say a

supported command.

NOTICE

 To display sample commands

Do not touch and put a sharp object to the microphone. It may cause failure.

of the desired function, say the desired function or select the desired function button. To

Voice command system operation

display more commands, select "More Commands".
 Selecting "Help" or saying

The voice command system is

"Help" prompts the voice com-

operated by saying commands

mand system to offer exam-

which correspond to a sup-

ples of commands and

ported function. To display

operation methods.

examples of commands for supported functions, select a function button on the screen after starting the voice command system.

 Registered POIs, registered names in the contacts list etc., can be said in the place of the "<>" next to the commands. (P.337)

5

Operation from the main menu
1 Press the talk switch.

For example: Say "Find a restaurant", "Call John Smith" etc.
 If a desired outcome is not shown, or if no selections are available, perform one of the following to return to the previous screen:

· Say "Go back".

Voice guidance for the voice command system can be skipped by pressing the talk switch.
2 If "Getting Started with Voice" screen is displayed, select "OK" or press the talk switch. (P.336)

· Select .
 To cancel voice recognition,
select , say "Cancel", or press and hold the talk switch.
 To perform the voice command operation again, select "Start Over" or say "Start over".
 To suspend voice command operation, select "Pause" or say "Pause". To resume the

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

336 5-11. Voice command system operation

voice command operation, select "Resume" or press the talk switch.

2 Select the desired item to be set.

 If the system does not respond or the confirmation screen does not disappear, press the talk switch and try again.
 If a voice command cannot be recognized 3 consecutive times, voice recognition will be canceled.
 Voice recognition prompts can be changed on the voice settings screen. (P.295)
This function can be used to cancel voice guidance by turning the voice prompts off. When you press the talk switch while using this setting, a beep sounds, and then you can immediately say a command.  Some voice guidance can be can-
celed by setting voice prompts to off. Use this setting when it is desirable to say a command immediately after pressing the talk switch and hearing a beep.
Increasing the voice recognition performance

Select to display the voice command tutorials.
Select to train the voice command system.
The user will be asked to say 10 sample phrases. This will help the voice command system adapt to the user's accent.
Select to prevent the screen from being displayed again.
Select to proceed to the voice command screen.

To increase voice recognition performance, use the "Tutorials" and "Voice Training" functions on the "Getting Started with Voice" screen. These functions are only available when the vehicle is not moving.
The "Tutorials" and "Voice Training" functions can also be started on the voice settings screen. (P.295)
1 Press the talk switch.

COROLLA HV_U

5-11. Voice command system operation 337

Command list

Command list

Command list overview

 Common

Recognizable voice commands and their actions are shown below.
 Frequently used commands

Command "Help"

Action
Displays examples of some of the available commands

are listed in the following tables.

"Go back"

Returns to the previous screen

 For devices that are not installed to the vehicle, commands relating to that device may not be displayed on the screen. Also, depending on other conditions, such as compatibility, some commands may not be displayed on the screen.

"Cancel" "Start over"
"Pause"

Cancels the voice command system
Returns to top menu screen
Temporarily pauses a voice session until it is 5 resumed by

 The functions available may vary according to the system

pressing the talk switch again.

installed.
 When an Apple CarPlay/Android Auto connec-

 Top menu
Command

Action

tion is established, some commands will become unavailable.
 Voice recognition language can be changed. (P.291)

"Show command examples for <menu>"

Displays the command list of the selected menu

"More commands"

Displays more commonly used commands

"Voice settings"

Displays Voice Setting screen

Displays Train
"Train my voice" Voice Recognition screen*

*: Vehicle must be parked

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

338 5-11. Voice command system operation

 Phone*1

 While in a phone call*

Command

Action

"Call <contact>"*2

Places a call to the specified contact from the phone book

Places a call to

"Call <contact> <phone type>"*2

the specified phone type of the contact from

the phone book

"Dial <phone number>"

Places a call to the specified phone number

"Redial"

Places a call to the phone number of the latest outgoing call

"Call back"

Places a call to the phone number of latest incoming call

"Show recent calls"

Displays the call history screen

"Send a message to <contact>"

Sends a text message to specified contact from the phone book

*1: When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, this voice commands will be unavailable.
*2: If the system does not recognize the name of a contact, create a voice tag. (P.360) The name of a contact can also be recognized by adding a voice tag.

Command "Send <digits>"
"Mute" "Unmute"

Action
Sends DTMF tones has specified
Mutes the microphone (far side cannot hear the conversation)
Unmutes the microphone

*: When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, this voice commands will be unavailable.
 While incoming message notification is displayed*1, 2

Command

Action

Reads the

"Read message"

incoming message over the

vehicle speakers

"Ignore"

Ignores the incoming message notification

"Reply"

Initiates sending a reply to the incoming message

"Call"

Places a call to the phone number of incoming message

*1: Full screen message notification must be turned on within the phone settings (P.358)
*2: When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, this voice

COROLLA HV_U

5-11. Voice command system operation 339

commands will be unavailable.
 Radio

 Audio*1
Command

Action

Command
"Tune to <frequency> AM"
"Tune to <frequency> FM"

Action
Changes the radio to the specified AM frequency
Changes the radio to the specified FM frequency

"Play Playlist <name>"*2
"Play Artist <name>"*2
"Play Song <name>"*2

Plays tracks from the selected playlist
Plays tracks from the selected artist
Plays the selected track

Changes the

"Play a <genre> radio to an FM

station"

station of the

"Play Album <name>"*2

Plays tracks from the selected album

"Tune to preset

specified genre*1
Changes the radio to the

"Play Genre <name>"*2

Plays tracks from the selected genre

<1-36>"

specified preset

Plays tracks

5

radio station

"Play Composer from the

"Tune to a

Changes the radio to a satel-

<name>"*2

selected composer

<genre> satellite station"

lite radio channel of the specified genre*2

"Play Podcast <name>"*2

Plays tracks from the selected podcast

"Tune to <satellite channel name>"

Changes the radio to the satellite radio channel with the
specified name*2

Changes the

"Tune to chan- radio to a satel-

nel <number> on lite radio channel

XM"

of the specified

number*2

Plays tracks

"Play Audiobook from the

<name>"*2

selected audio-

book

"Audio On"

Turns the audio/visual system on

"Audio Off"

Turns the audio/visual system off

*1: A station list must be built first using the radio screen (P.303)
*2: Requires a satellite radio subscription

"Change the

Sets the source

audio source to to the specified

<source name>" audio mode

*1: The audio device must be connected via a USB cable to use

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

340 5-11. Voice command system operation

the functionality in this section *2: When an Apple CarPlay connec-
tion is established, this voice commands will be unavailable.
 Toyota apps

Command

Action

"Launch <appli- Activates the cation name>"* Toyota apps

*: When an application is opened and is in full screen mode, pressing the talk switch will start the voice command system and commands for the currently displayed application will be available

Commands relating to operation of the audio/visual system can only be performed when the audio/visual system is turned on.

COROLLA HV_U

5-12. Mobile Assistant operation 341

5-12.Mobile Assistant operation
Mobile Assistant
The Mobile Assistant function is a voice input assist function. Mobile Assist supports the Siri Eyes Free Mode and Google App. (Google App can be used only with the corresponding device.) Instructions can be spoken into the vehicle microphone as if speaking a command to the phone. The content of the request is then interpreted by the phone and the result is output from the vehicle speakers. To operate the Mobile Assistant, a compatible device must be registered and connected to this system via Bluetooth®. (P.268) When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, this function will be unavailable.

· The windows are open. · Passengers are talking while the
Mobile Assistant is being used. · The fan speed of the air condition-
ing system is set at high. · The air conditioning vents are
turned toward the microphone.
Connectable devices and available functions
Mobile Assist supports the Siri Eyes Free Mode and Google App. The available features and functions may vary based on the iOS/Android version installed on the connected device.

Mobile Assistant opera-

tion

5

 Type A

1 Press and hold the talk switch on the steering wheel
until Mobile Assistant screen
is displayed.

 While a phone call is active, the Mobile Assistant cannot be used.
 If using the navigation feature of the cellular phone, ensure the active audio source is Bluetooth® audio or iPod in order to hear turn by turn direction prompts.
 Wait for the listening beeps before using the Mobile Assistant.
 The Mobile Assistant may not recognize commands in the following situations:
· Spoken too quickly. · Spoken at a low or high volume.

 Type B
1 Press and hold the switch on the steering wheel until

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

342 5-12. Mobile Assistant operation

Mobile Assistant screen is displayed.
2 The Mobile Assistant can be used only when the following screen is displayed.

restarted after the system responds to a voice command.
· After some phone and music commands, the Mobile Assistant feature will automatically end to complete the requested action.
 The volume of the Mobile Assistant can be adjusted using the "POWER VOLUME" knob or steering wheel volume control switches. The Mobile Assistant and phone call volumes are synchronized.

 Type A: To cancel the Mobile Assistant, select "Cancel" or press and hold the talk switch on the steering wheel. Type B: To cancel the Mobile Assistant, select "Cancel" or press and hold the switch on the steering wheel.
 Type A: To restart the Mobile Assistant for additional commands, press the talk switch on the steering wheel. Type B: To restart the Mobile Assistant for additional commands, press the switch on the steering wheel.
· Mobile Assistant can only be
COROLLA HV_U

5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones) 343

5-13.Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones)
Quick reference
Phone screen operation
The phone screen can be reached by the following methods:  From the "PHONE" button Press the "PHONE" button.  From the "MENU" button Press the "MENU" button, then select "Phone".

Message function
The following function can be used on message function: Using the Bluetooth® phone message function (P.354)
Setting up a phone
The following functions can be made in the system:  Phone settings (P.358)  Bluetooth® settings (P.272)

5
Bluetooth® hands-free system operation
The following functions can be used on phone operation:  Registering/connecting a
Bluetooth® device (P.268)  Placing a call using the Blue-
tooth® hands-free system (P.348)  Receiving a call using the Bluetooth® hands-free system (P.351)  Talking on the Bluetooth® hands-free system (P.352)

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

344 5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones)

Some basics
The hands-free system enables calls to be made and received without having to take your hands off the steering wheel.
This system supports Bluetooth®. Bluetooth® is a wireless data system that enables cellular phones to be used without being connected by a cable or placed in a cradle.
The operating procedure of the phone is explained here.
When an Apple CarPlay connection is established, phone functions will be performed by Apple CarPlay instead of the hands-free system.
 This system is not guaranteed to operate with all Bluetooth® devices.
 If your cellular phone does not support Bluetooth®, this system cannot function.
 In the following conditions, the system may not function:
· The cellular phone is turned off. · The current position is outside the
communication area. · The cellular phone is not con-
nected. · The cellular phone has a low bat-
tery.  Depending on the type of Blue-
tooth® phone, some function is not available.

 When using the hands-free system or Bluetooth® audio and Wi-Fi® Hotspot functions at the same time, the following problems may occur:
· The Bluetooth® connection may be cut.
· Noise may be heard on the Bluetooth® audio playback.
· A noise may be heard during phone calls.
 Bluetooth® uses the 2.4 GHz frequency band. If both a Wi-Fi® connection and Bluetooth® connection are being used simultaneously, each connection may be affected.
 If a Bluetooth® device is attempting to connect to the vehicle while another device is connected as a Bluetooth® audio device or connected using the hands-free system or Wi-Fi® Hotspot function, the communication speed may decrease or malfunctions may occur, such as image distortion or audio skipping. If a Bluetooth® device is connected to the system, the interference it may cause will be reduced. When carrying a device with its Bluetooth® connection enabled, make sure to register it to the system and connect it or disable its Bluetooth® function.
 When a device is connected via Bluetooth®, the Bluetooth® icon on the status bar will be displayed in blue. (P.256)
WARNING  While driving, do not operate a
cellular phone.

COROLLA HV_U

5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones) 345

WARNING

 Connecting a Bluetooth®

Your audio unit is fitted with

device

Bluetooth® antennas. People

 Registering an additional

with implantable cardiac pacemakers, cardiac resynchronization therapy-pacemakers or

device 1 Display the phone top

implantable cardioverter defibrillators should maintain a reason-

screen. (P.343)

able distance between

2 Select "Select Device".

themselves and the Bluetooth® antennas. The radio waves may

3 Select "Add Device".

affect the operation of such devices.

When another Bluetooth® device is connected, a confirmation screen

Before using Bluetooth® devices, users of any electrical

will be displayed. To disconnect the Bluetooth® device, select "Yes".

medical device other than implantable cardiac pacemakers, cardiac resynchronization

4 Follow the steps in "Registering a Bluetooth® phone for

therapy-pacemakers or implantable cardioverter defibrillators should consult the manufacturer

the first time" from step 5. (P.268)

of the device for information about its operation under the influence of radio waves. Radio

 Selecting a registered device 1 Display the phone top

5

waves could have unexpected effects on the operation of such medical devices.

screen. (P.343) 2 Select "Select Device".

NOTICE

3 Select the desired device to be connected.

Do not leave your cellular phone in the vehicle. The temperature inside may rise to a level that could damage the phone.
Registering/Connecting a Bluetooth® phone
To use the hands-free system

4 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the connection is complete.
If an error message is displayed, follow the guidance on the screen to try again.
 Bluetooth® phone condition display

for cellular phones, it is necessary to register a cellular phone with the system. (P.268)

The condition of the Bluetooth® phone appears on the upper right side of the screen.

(P.257)

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

346 5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones)

Using the phone switch/microphone
 Steering switch
By pressing the phone switch, a call can be received or ended without taking your hands off the steering wheel.

Phone switch
· If the switch is pressed during a call, the call will end.
· If the switch is pressed when an incoming call is received, the call will be answered.
· If the switch is pressed during a call when a separate incoming call is waiting, the waiting call will be answered.
· If the switch is pressed when an Apple CarPlay connection is established, the Apple CarPlay phone application will be displayed on the system screen.
Volume control switch
· Press the "+" side to increase the volume.
· Press the "-" side to decrease the volume.
 Microphone
The microphone is used when talking on the phone.

 The other party's voice will be heard from the front speakers. The audio/visual system will be muted during phone calls or when hands-free voice commands are used.
 Talk alternately with the other party on the phone. If both parties speak at the same time, the other party may not hear what has been said. (This is not a malfunction.)
 Keep call volume down. Otherwise, the other party's voice may be audible outside the vehicle and voice echo may increase. When talking on the phone, speak clearly towards the microphone.
 The other party may not hear you clearly when:
· Driving on an unpaved road. (Making excessive traffic noise.)
· Driving at high speeds. · The windows are open. · The air conditioning vents are
pointed towards the microphone. · The sound of the air conditioning
fan is loud. · There is a negative effect on
sound quality due to the phone and/or network being used.
NOTICE Do not touch and put a sharp object to the microphone. It may cause failure.

COROLLA HV_U

5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones) 347

Voice command system
Press this switch to operate the voice command system.

When selling or disposing of the vehicle
A lot of personal data is registered when the hands-free system is used. When selling or disposing of the vehicle, initialize the data. (P.294)

The following data in the system can be initialized:

 Contact data

The voice command system and its list of commands can be operated. (P.334)

 Call history data  Favorites data  Image data

 All phone settings

About the contacts in the  Message settings

contact list

5

The following data is stored for every registered phone. When

Once initialized, the data and settings will be erased. Pay additional attention when initializing the data.

another phone is connected, the

following registered data cannot

be read:

 Contact data

 Call history data

 Favorites data

 Image data

 All phone settings

 Message settings

When a phone's registration is deleted, the above-mentioned data is also deleted.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

348 5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones)

Placing a call using the Bluetooth® hands-free system
After a Bluetooth® phone has been registered, a call can be made using the hands-free system. There are several methods by which a call can be made, as described below.

items (missed, incoming and outgoing) can be selected.
1 Display the phone top screen. (P.343)
2 Select "History" and select the desired contact.
If the contact which is not registered on the contact list is selected, the name is displayed as "Unknown Contact". In this case, select the number to make a call properly.
3 Check that the dialing screen is displayed.

Calling methods on the Bluetooth® phone
1 Display the phone top screen. (P.343)
2 Select the desired method to call from.
 Calling methods from phone screen
 By call history (P.348)  By favorites (P.348)  By contacts (P.349)  By keypad (P.350)  By message (P.357)  Also the following lists are
available from each function's screen
 By voice command system (P.335)
 By home screen (P.350)

 The icons of call type are displayed. : Missed call
: Incoming call
: Outgoing call  When making a call to the same
number continuously, only the most recent call is listed in call history.  When a phone number registered in the contact list is received, the name is displayed.  Number-withheld calls are also memorized in the system.  International phone calls may not be made depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone you have.  The list should group together consecutive entries with the same phone number and same call type. For example, two calls from John's mobile would be displayed as follows: John (2)
By favorites list

By call history
Up to 30 of the latest call history

Calls can be made using registered contacts which can be

COROLLA HV_U

5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones) 349

selected from a contact list. (P.349)
1 Display the phone top screen. (P.343)
2 Select "Favorites" and select the desired contact.

play all registered e-mail addresses for the contact.
"Addresses": Select to display all registered addresses for the contact.
4 Check that the dialing screen is displayed.

3 Select the desired number.
4 Check that the dialing screen is displayed.

When the contact list is empty

 For PBAP compatible Blue-

By contacts list

tooth® phones when "Auto-

Calls can be made by using contact data which is transferred from a registered cellular phone. (P.360)

matic Transfer" is set to on (P.360)
Contacts are transferred automatically.

Up to 5000 contacts (maximum  For PBAP compatible Blue-

of 4 phone numbers, e-mail

tooth® phones when "Auto- 5

addresses and addresses per

matic Transfer" is set to off

contact) can be registered in the

(P.360)

contact list.

1 Select the desired item.

1 Display the phone top

screen. (P.343)

2 Select "Contacts" and select the desired contact.

3 Select the desired number.

"Add Favorite"/"Remove Favorite": Select to register/remove the contact in the favorites list. (P.364, 365) "E-mail Addresses": Select to dis-

Select to always transfer all the contacts from a connected cellular phone automatically.
Select to transfer all the contacts from a connected cellular phone only once.
Select to cancel transferring.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

350 5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones)

2 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.
 For PBAP incompatible but OPP compatible Bluetooth® phones
1 Select the desired item.

tact list may not transfer depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone connected.
By keypad
1 Display the phone top screen. (P.343)
2 Select "Keypad" and enter the phone number.

3 Select or press the switch on the steering wheel.
4 Check that the dialing screen is displayed.

Select to transfer the contacts from the connected cellular phone. Transfer the contact data to the system using a Bluetooth® phone.
Select to add a new contact manually. Follow the steps in "Registering a new contact to the contacts list" from step 2. (P.363)
Select to cancel transferring.
 If your cellular phone is neither PBAP nor OPP compatible, the contacts cannot be transferred using Bluetooth®. But the contacts can be transferred from USB device. (P.363)
 Depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone:
· It may be necessary to perform additional steps on the phone when transferring contact data.
· The registered image in the con-

Depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone being connected, it may be necessary to perform additional steps on the phone.
By home screen
1 Display the home screen. (P.262)
2 Select the desired contact. 3 Check that the dialing screen
is displayed.  Registering a new contact 1 Select and hold the screen
button to add a contact. 2 Select the desired contact. 3 Select the desired number.
 If there is no contact in the contacts list, the contacts cannot be registered at the home screen.
 The contact cannot be registered at the home screen while driving.

COROLLA HV_U

5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones) 351

Receiving a call using the Bluetooth® hands-free system

Bluetooth® phone, both the system and Bluetooth® phone may ring simultaneously when there is an incoming call. (P.358)

When a call is received, the following screen is displayed with a sound.

Incoming calls
1 Select "Answer" or press the switch on the steering
wheel to talk on the phone.

5
"Decline": Select to refuse to receive the call. To adjust the volume of a received call: Turn the "POWER VOLUME" knob, or use the volume control switch on the steering wheel.
 The contact image picture can be displayed only when the vehicle is not moving.
 During international phone calls, the other party's name or number may not be displayed correctly depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone you have.
 The incoming call display mode can be set. (P.359)
 The ringtone that has been set in the sound settings screen can be heard when there is an incoming call. Depending on the type of

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

352 5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones)

Talking on the Bluetooth® hands-free system
While talking on the phone, the following screen is displayed. The operations outlined below can be performed on this screen.
Call screen operation
Select to display the keypad to send tones. (P.352) Select to send tones. This button only appears when a number that contains a (w) is dialed in hands-free mode. (P.352) Select to adjust your voice volume that the other party hears from their speaker. (P.353) Select to mute your voice to the other party. Select to change handset modes between hands-free and cellular phone. Select to put a call on hold. To cancel this function, select

"Activate". Select to hang up the phone.
 Changing from hands-free call to cellular phone call is not possible while driving.
 Only when the vehicle is not moving, the contact image can be displayed.
 When cellular phone call is changed to hands-free call, the hands-free screen will be displayed and its functions can be operated on the screen.
 Changing between cellular phone call and hands-free call can be performed by operating the cellular phone directly.
 Transferring methods and operations will be different depending on the type of cellular phone you have.
 For the operation of the cellular phone, see the manual that comes with it.
Sending tones
 By keypad This operation cannot be performed while driving. 1 Select "0-9". 2 Enter the desired number.  By selecting "Release
Tones" "Release Tones" appear when a continuous tone signal (s) containing a (w) is registered in the contact list. This operation can be performed while driving. Select "Release Tones".

COROLLA HV_U

5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones) 353

 A continuous tone signal is a char-

current call is placed on hold.

acter string that consists of num-  When there is no current call,

bers and the characters "p" or "w". (e.g. 056133w0123p#1)  When the "p" pause tone is used, the tone data up until the next

but there is a call on hold: "Activate" is displayed. When selected, the system switches

pause tone will be automatically

to the call that was on hold.

sent after 2 seconds have elapsed. When the "w" pause tone

 When there is another call on

is used, the tone data up until the

hold during a call: "Swap

next pause tone will be automatically sent after a user operation is performed.

Calls" is displayed. When selected, the current call is

 Release tones can be used when

placed on hold, and the sys-

automated operation of a phone

tem switches to the call that

based service such as an answering machine or bank phone ser-

was on hold.

vice is desired. A phone number

with continuous tone signals can This function may not be available

be registered in the contact list.

depending on the type of cellular

 Tone data after a "w" pause tone phone.

can be operated by voice com-

mand during a call.

Incoming call waiting

5

Transmit volume setting
1 Select "Transmit Volume". 2 Select the desired level for
the transmit volume.
3 Select to display previous screen.
 The sound quality of the voice heard from the other party's speaker may be negatively impacted.
 "Transmit Volume" is dimmed when mute is on.
Switching calls while a call is in progress

When a call is interrupted by a third party while talking, the incoming screen is displayed.
Select "Answer" or press the switch on the steering wheel to start talking with the other party.
 To refuse to receive the call: Select "Decline".
 Each time "Swap Calls" is selected, the party who is on hold will be switched.
This function may not be available depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone.

 When there are no calls on hold during a call: "Hold" is displayed. When selected, the

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

354 5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones)

Bluetooth® phone message function
Received messages can be forwarded from the connected Bluetooth® phone, enabling checking and replying using the system.
Depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone connected, received messages may not be transferred to the system.
If the phone does not support the message function, this function cannot be used. Even when the supported phone is used, reply function may not be used.
Displaying the message screen

names of the accounts that exist on the currently connected phone.
 The following functions can be used on message function:
· Receiving a message (P.354)
· Checking messages (P.355)
· Replying to a message (dictation reply) (P.356)
· Replying to a message (quick reply) (P.356)
· Calling the message sender (P.357)
· Message settings (P.366)
Receiving a message
When an e-mail/SMS/MMS is received, the incoming message screen pops up with sound and is ready to be operated on the screen.

1 Display the phone top screen. (P.343)
2 Select "Message".
A confirmation message appears when the "Automatic Message Transfer" function is set to off (P.366), select "Yes".
3 Check that the message screen is displayed.
"Phone": Select to change to phone mode.
 The account name is displayed on the left side of screen.
 Account names are the

Select to check the message. Select to not open the message. Select to call the message sender.
 Depending on the type of Blue-

COROLLA HV_U

5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones) 355

tooth® phone used for receiving messages, or its registration status with the system, some information may not be displayed.
 The pop-up screen is separately available for incoming e-mail and SMS/MMS messages under the following conditions:
E-mail: · "Incoming E-mail Display" is set to
"Full Screen". (P.359) · "E-mail Notification Pop-up" is set
to on. (P.359) SMS/MMS:

sender.
Select to have messages read out. To cancel this function, select "Stop". When "Automatic Message Readout" is set to on, messages will be automatically read out. (P.366)
Select to display the previous or next message.

· "Incoming SMS/MMS Display" is set to "Full Screen". (P.359)
· "SMS/MMS Notification Pop-up" is set to on. (P.359)

This function can be chosen the method to reply message with "Dictation" or

 Depending on the type of Blue-

"Quick Message".

tooth® phone being connected,

E-Mail function cannot be used via  Reading a text message is not

Bluetooth®.

available while driving.

5

 Depending on the type of Blue-

Checking received messages

tooth® phone being connected, this function cannot be used.  Depending on the type of Blue-

1 Display the message screen. (P.354)

tooth® phone being connected, it may be necessary to perform additional steps on the phone.

2 Select a desired account name.
3 Select the desired message from the list.

 Messages are displayed in the appropriate connected Bluetooth® phone's registered mail address folder. Select the desired folder to be displayed.

4 Check that the message is displayed.

 Only received messages on the connected Bluetooth® phone can be displayed.

 The text of the message is not displayed while driving.

 Turn the "POWER VOLUME" knob, or use the volume control switch on the steering wheel to adjust the message read out volume.

 "Subject:" field is not shown on SMS case.

Select to call the message

 E-mail only: Select "Mark Unread"

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

356 5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones)

or "Mark Read" to mark mail unread or read on the message screen. This function is available when "Update Message Read Status on Phone" is set to on. (P.366)
Replying to a message (dictation reply)*
*: If equipped
1 Display the message screen. (P.354)
2 Select the desired message from the list.
3 Select "Reply". 4 Select "Dictation". 5 When the "Say Your Mes-
sage" screen is displayed, speak message that you want to send.
6 Select "Send" to send message.
"Cancel": Select to cancel sending the message. "Retry": Select to retry speaking message that you want to send. While the message is being sent, a sending message screen is displayed.
7 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.
If an error message is displayed, follow the guidance on the screen to try again.
Replying to a message (quick reply)
15 messages have already

been stored. 1 Display the message screen.
(P.354) 2 Select the desired message
from the list.
3 Select "Reply". 4 Select "Quick Message". 5 Select the desired message.
: Select to edit the message. (P.356)
6 Select "Send".
"Cancel": Select to cancel sending the message. While the message is being sent, a sending message screen is displayed.
7 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.
If an error message is displayed, follow the guidance on the screen to try again.
Depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone, reply function is not available.
 Editing quick reply messages
This operation cannot be performed while driving.
1 Select corresponding to the desired message to edit.
2 Select "OK" when editing is completed.
To reset the edited quick reply messages, select "Default".

COROLLA HV_U

5-13. Phone operation (Hands-free system for cellular phones) 357

Calling the message sender

3 Select the text area.

Calls can be made to an e-mail/SMS/MMS message sender's phone number.
This operation can be performed while driving.

 Calling from e-mail/SMS/MMS message display
1 Display the message screen. (P.354)
2 Select the desired message.

Identified phone numbers contained in the message are displayed in blue text.
4 Select the desired number.
5 Check that the dialing screen is displayed.

3 Select , or press the

A series of numbers may be recog-

switch on the steering wheel.

nized as a phone number. Additionally, some phone numbers may not

If there are 2 or more phone num-

be recognized, such as those for

5

bers, select the desired number.

other countries.

4 Check that the dialing screen is displayed.

 Calling from the incoming message screen

 Calling from a number within a message
Calls can be made to a number

For detail, refer to "Receiving a message". (P.354)

identified in a message's text

area.

This operation cannot be performed while driving.

1 Display the message screen. (P.354)

2 Select the desired message.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

358 5-14. Phone settings
5-14.Phone settings
Setup Displaying the phone settings screen
1 Press the "MENU" button.
2 Select "Setup". 3 Select "Phone". 4 Select the desired item to be
set.

(P.360) Message settings* (P.366)
*: This operation cannot be performed while driving.
Sounds settings screen
The call and ringtone volume can be adjusted. A ringtone can be selected. 1 Display the phone settings
screen. (P.358) 2 Select "Sounds". 3 Select the desired item to be
set.

Phone settings screen

Connecting a Bluetooth® device and editing the Bluetooth® device information (P.272, 276)
Sound settings* (P.358)
Notification settings* (P.359)
Contact/call history settings*

Select to set the desired ringtone.
Select "-" or "+" to adjust the ringtone volume.
Select "-" or "+" to adjust the default volume of the other party's voice.

COROLLA HV_U

Select to set the desired incoming e-mail tone.
Select to set the desired incoming SMS/MMS tone.
Select "-" or "+" to adjust the incoming SMS/MMS tone volume.
Select "-" or "+" to adjust the incoming e-mail tone volume.
Select "-" or "+" to adjust the message readout volume.
Select to reset all setup items.

5-14. Phone settings 359
3 Select the desired item to be set.

Depending on the type of Blue-

tooth® phone, certain functions may

not be available.

Select to change the incom-

5

Notifications settings

ing call display.

screen

"Full Screen": When a call is received, the incoming call screen

1 Display the phone settings screen. (P.358)
2 Select "Notifications".

is displayed and can be operated on the screen. "Drop-down": A message is displayed at the top of the screen.

Select to set the SMS/MMS notification pop-up on/off.

Select to change the incoming SMS/MMS display. "Full Screen": When an SMS/MMS message is received, the incoming SMS/MMS display screen is displayed and can be operated on the screen. "Drop-down": When an SMS/MMS message is received, a message is displayed at the top of the

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

360 5-14. Phone settings
screen.
Select to set the e-mail notification pop-up on/off.
Select to change the incoming e-mail display. "Full Screen": When an e-mail is received, the incoming e-mail display screen is displayed and can be operated on the screen. "Drop-down": When an e-mail is received, a message is displayed at the top of the screen.
Select to set display of the contact/history transfer completion message on/off.
Select to reset all setup items.
Depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone, these functions may not be available.
Contacts/Call history settings screen
Contacts can be transferred from a Bluetooth® phone to this system. Contacts and favorites can be added, edited and deleted. Also, the call history can be deleted. 1 Display the phone settings
screen. (P.358)
2 Select "Contacts/Call History".

3 Select the desired item to be set.
For PBAP compatible Bluetooth® phones: Select to change the contact/history transfer settings. (P.361) Select to update contacts from the connected device. (P.361) Select to sort contacts by the first name or last name field. Select to add contacts to the favorites list. (P.364) Select to delete contacts from the favorites list. (P.364) Select to clear the call history.* Select to add new contacts to the contact list.* (P.363) Select to edit contacts in the

COROLLA HV_U

contact list.* (P.364) Select to delete contacts from the contact list.* (P.364) Select to set the voice tags. (P.365) Select to reset all setup items.
*: For PBAP compatible Bluetooth® phones, this function is available when "Automatic Transfer" is set to off. (P.361)
 Depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone, certain functions may not be available.
 Contact data is managed independently for every registered phone. When one phone is connected, another phone's registered data cannot be read.
Setting automatic contact/history transfer
The automatic contact/history function is available for PBAP compatible Bluetooth® phones only. 1 Select "Automatic Transfer". 2 Select the desired item to be
set.

5-14. Phone settings 361

Select to set automatic contact/history transfer on/off. When set to on, the phone's contact data and history are automatically transferred.

Select to update contacts from the connected phone. (P.361)

Select to set the transferred contact image display on/off. Only when the vehicle is not moving, the contact image can be displayed.

Select to reset all setup items.

 Updating contacts from

phone

1 Select "Update Now".

5

Contacts are transferred automatically.
2 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.

 This operation may be unnecessary depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone.

 If another Bluetooth® device is connected when transferring contact data, depending on the phone, the connected
Bluetooth® device may need to be disconnected.

 Depending on the type of
Bluetooth® phone being connected, it may be necessary to perform additional steps on the phone.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

362 5-14. Phone settings
 Updating the contacts in a different way (from the call history screen)*
1 Display the phone top screen. (P.343)
2 Select "History" and select a contact not yet registered in the contact list.
3 Select "Update Contact". 4 Select the desired contact. 5 Select a phone type for the
phone number.
*: For PBAP compatible Bluetooth® phones, this function is available when "Automatic Transfer" is set to off. (P.360)
Transfer contacts from device
When an Android Auto connection is established, this function will be unavailable.*
*: This function is not made available in some countries or areas.
From phone (OPP compatible Bluetooth® phones only)
 When the contact is not registered
1 Select "Transfer Contacts from Device".
2 Select "From Phone (Bluetooth)".

3 Transfer the contact data to the system using a Bluetooth® phone.
 This operation may be unnecessary depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone.
 To cancel this function, select "Cancel".
4 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.
 When the contact is registered
1 Select "Transfer Contacts from Device".
2 Select "From Phone (Bluetooth)".
3 Select "Replace Contacts" or "Add Contact".
"Replace Contacts": Select to transfer the contact from the connected cellular phone and replace the current one. "Add Contact": Select to transfer the desired contact data from the connected cellular phone to add to the current one.
4 Transfer the contact data to the system using a Bluetooth® phone.
 This operation may be unnecessary depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone.
 To cancel this function, select "Cancel".
5 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.

COROLLA HV_U

From USB device
Backed-up contact data (vCard formatted) can be transferred from USB device or Bluetooth® phone to this system. 1 Connect a USB device.
(P.300)
2 Select "Transfer Contacts from Device".
3 Select "From USB".
4 Select "USB 1" or "USB 2" when the multiple USB devices are connected. If a USB device is connected, skip this procedure.
5 Select "Replace Contacts" or "Add Contact". If the contact is already registered, skip this procedure.
"Replace Contacts": Select to transfer the contact from the connected USB device or Bluetooth® phone and replace the current one. "Add Contact": Select to transfer the desired contact data from the connected USB device or Bluetooth® phone to add to the current one.
6 Select a desired file from vCard file list.
7 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.
 Depending on the type of Bluetooth® phone used and number of files, it may take time to display vCard file lists and download contacts.

5-14. Phone settings 363
 Downloading may not complete correctly in the following cases:
· If the power switch is turned off during downloading.
· If the USB device or Bluetooth® phone is removed before downloading is complete.

Registering a new contact to the contacts list

New contact data can be registered.

Up to 4 numbers per person can

be registered. For PBAP com-

patible Bluetooth® phones, this

function is available when "Auto-

matic Transfer" is set to off.

(P.360)

1 Select "New Contact".

5

2 Enter the name and select "OK".

3 Enter the phone number and select "OK".

4 Select the phone type for the phone number.

5 To add another number to this contact, select "Yes".

 Registering a new contact in a different way (from the call history screen)

1 Display the phone top screen. (P.343)

2 Select "History" and select a contact not yet registered in
the contact list.

3 Select "Add to Contacts".

4 Follow the steps in "Registering a new contact to the con-

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

364 5-14. Phone settings
tacts list" from step 2. (P.363)
Editing the contact data
For PBAP compatible Bluetooth® phones, this function is available when "Automatic Transfer" is set to off. (P.360) 1 Select "Edit Contact". 2 Select the desired contact.
3 Select next to the name or desired number.
4 Enter the name or the phone number and select "OK".
Deleting the contact data
For PBAP compatible Bluetooth® phones, this function is available when "Automatic Transfer" is set to off. (P.360) 1 Select "Delete Contacts". 2 Select the desired contact
and select "Delete". 3 Select "Yes" when the confir-
mation screen appears.
 Multiple data can be selected and deleted at the same time.
 When a Bluetooth® phone is deleted, the contact data will be deleted at the same time.
Favorites list setting
Up to 15 contacts (maximum of 4 numbers per contact) can be registered in the favorites list.

 Registering the contacts in the favorites list
1 Select "Add Favorite".
2 Select the desired contact to add to the favorites list.
Dimmed contacts are already stored as a favorite.
3 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.
 When 15 contacts have already been registered to the favorites list
1 When 15 contacts have already been registered to the favorites list, a registered contact needs to be replaced. Select "Yes" when the confirmation screen appears to replace a contact.
2 Select the contact to be replaced.
3 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.
 Registering contacts in the favorites list in a different way (from the contact details screen)
1 Display the phone top screen. (P.343)
2 Select "Contacts" and select the desired contact.
3 Select "Add Favorite".
4 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.

COROLLA HV_U

 Deleting the contacts in the favorites list
1 Select "Remove Favorite".
2 Select the desired contacts and select "Remove".
3 Select "Yes" when the confirmation screen appears.
4 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.
 Deleting contacts in the favorites list in a different way (from the contact details screen)
1 Display the phone top screen. (P.343)
2 Select "Favorites" or "Contacts" and select the desired contact to delete.
3 Select "Remove Favorite".
4 Select "Yes" when the confirmation screen appears.
5 Check that a confirmation screen is displayed when the operation is complete.
Setting voice tags
Calls can be made by saying the voice tag of a registered contact in the contact list. (P.334) 1 Select "Manage Voice Tags".

5-14. Phone settings 365
2 Select the desired item to be set.
Select to register a new voice tag. (P.365) Select to edit a voice tag. (P.365) Select to delete a voice tag. (P.366)  Registering a voice tag Up to 50 voice tags can be reg- 5 istered. 1 Select "New". 2 Select the desired contact to register a voice tag for. 3 Select "REC" and record a voice tag.
When recording a voice tag, do so in a quiet area. "Play": Select to play the voice tag.
4 Select "OK" when voice tag registration is complete.
 Editing a voice tag 1 Select "Edit". 2 Select the desired contact to
edit. 3 Follow the steps in "Register-
ing a voice tag" from step 3. (P.365)

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

366 5-14. Phone settings
 Deleting the voice tag 1 Select "Delete". 2 Select the desired contact
and select "Delete". 3 Select "Yes" when the confir-
mation screen appears.
 Multiple data can be selected and deleted at the same time.
 Voice tags are deleted when the set language of the system is changed. (P.291)
Message settings screen
1 Display the phone settings screen. (P.358)
2 Select "Messaging". 3 Select the desired item to be
set.

account names used on the cellular phone will be displayed. Select to set adding the vehicle signature to outgoing messages on/off. The vehicle signature can be edited. (P.366) Select to reset all setup items.
Depending on the phone, these functions may not be available.
Vehicle signature settings
1 Select "Vehicle Signature". 2 Select the desired item to be
set.

Select to set automatic message transfer on/off.
Select to set automatic message readout on/off.
Select to set updating message read status on phone on/off.
Select to set display of messaging account names on the message screen on/off. When set to on, messaging

Select to set adding the vehicle signature to outgoing messages on/off.
Select to edit the vehicle signature. (P.366)
Select to reset all setup items.
 Editing vehicle signature 1 Select "Edit Vehicle Signa-
ture".

COROLLA HV_U

2 Enter desired signature with using keyboard.
3 Select "OK".
4 Select "OK" on the confirmation screen, or select "Edit Again" when it needs to amend.

5-14. Phone settings 367

5

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

368 5-15. What to do if... (Bluetooth®)

5-15.What to do if... (Bluetooth®)
Troubleshooting
If there is a problem with the hands-free system or a Bluetooth® device, first check the table below.
Troubleshooting
 When using the hands-free system with a Bluetooth® device
The hands-free system or Bluetooth® device does not work.

Likely cause

Solution

For a list of spe-

cific devices

which operation

has been con-

firmed on this

system, check

with your Toyota

dealer or the fol-

lowing website:

The connected https://www.

device may not toyota.com/

be a compatible audio-

Bluetooth® cellu- multimedia in the

lar phone.

United States,

https://www.

toyota.ca/

connected in

Canada, and

http://www.

toyotapr.com/

audio-

multimedia in

Puerto Rico

The Bluetooth®

Use a cellular phone with Blue-

version of the connected cellular phone may be older than the specified version.

tooth® version 2.0 or higher (recommended: Ver. 4.1 +EDR or higher). (P.271)

 When registering/connecting a cellular phone
A cellular phone cannot be registered.

COROLLA HV_U

5-15. What to do if... (Bluetooth®) 369

Likely cause

Solution

Likely cause

Solution

An incorrect passcode was entered on the cellular phone.

Enter the correct passcode on the cellular phone.

Set automatic Automatic Blue- Bluetooth® contooth® connec- nection on this
tion on this system to on

Complete the The registration registration operoperation has ation on the cel-

system is set to when the power

off.

switch is in ACC

or ON. (P.277)

not been com- lular phone

Set preferred

pleted on the cel- (approve regis-

device settings

lular phone side. tration on the

function on this

phone).

system to off.

Delete the exist-

ing registration

Old registration information remains on either this system or the cellular phone.

information from both this system and the cellular phone, then register the cellular phone you wish to connect to this

Preferred device (P.278)

settings function

on this system is Set the desired

set to on.

cellular phone to

the highest auto-

matic connec-

tion priority.

(P.278)

 When making/receiving a

5

system.

call

(P.275)

A call cannot be made/received.

A Bluetooth® connection cannot be made.

Likely cause

Solution

Another Blue-
tooth® device is already connected.

Manually connect the cellular phone you wish to use to this system. (P.272)

Bluetooth® func- Enable the Blue-

tion is not

tooth® function

enabled on the on the cellular

cellular phone. phone.

Likely cause

Solution

Move to where

Your vehicle is in

no longer

a area.

appears on the

display.

 When using the phonebook
Phonebook data cannot be transferred manually/automatically.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

370 5-15. What to do if... (Bluetooth®)

Likely cause

Solution

For a list of specific devices which operation has been confirmed on this system, check with your Toyota dealer or the folThe profile ver- lowing website: sion of the con- https://www. nected cellular toyota.com/ phone may not audiobe compatible multimedia in the with transferring United States, phonebook data. https://www. toyota.ca/ connected in Canada, and http://www. toyotapr.com/ audiomultimedia in Puerto Rico

Automatic contact transfer function on this system is set to off.

Set automatic contact transfer function on this system to on. (P.361)

Enter the pass-

Passcode has code on the cel-

not been entered lular phone if

on the cellular requested

phone.

(default pass-

code: 1234).

Complete trans-

Transfer operation on the cellular phone has not completed.

fer operation on the cellular phone (approve transfer operation on the

phone).

Phonebook data cannot be edited.

Likely cause
Automatic contact transfer function on this system is set to on.

Solution
Set automatic contact transfer function on this system to off. (P.361)

 When using the Bluetooth® message function
Messages cannot be viewed.

Likely cause

Solution

Enable mes-

Message transfer is not enabled on the cellular phone.

sage transfer on the cellular phone (approve message transfer on the

phone).

Automatic trans- Set automatic

fer function on transfer function

this system is set on this system to

to off.

on. (P.361)

New message notifications are not displayed.

Likely cause

Solution

Notification of Set notification of

SMS/MMS/E-ma SMS/MMS/E-ma

il reception on il reception on

this system is set this system to

to off.

on. (P.359)

Automatic message transfer function is not enabled on the cellular phone.

Enable automatic transfer function on the cellular phone.

COROLLA HV_U

5-15. What to do if... (Bluetooth®) 371

 In other situations

Likely cause

Solution

The Bluetooth® connection sta-

Turn the cellular

tus is displayed at the top of the screen each time the power switch is in ACC or ON.

phone off, remove and reinstall the battery pack, and then

Likely cause

Solution

To turn off the Connection con- display, set confirmation display nection confir-

restart the cellular phone.
Enable the cellular phone's Blue-

on this system is mation display

set to on.

on this system to

off. (P.278)

Even though all conceivable measures have been taken, the symptom status does not change.

tooth®

The cellular

connection.

phone is the

Stop the cellular

most likely cause phone's security

of the symptom. software and

close all applica-

tions.

Likely cause

Solution

Before using an application

5

The cellular phone is not close enough to this system.

Bring the cellular phone closer to this system.

Radio interference has occurred.

Turn off Wi-Fi® devices or other devices that may emit radio waves.

installed on the cellular phone, carefully check its source and how its operation might affect this system.
For details, refer to the owner's manual that came with the cellular phone.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

372 5-16. Connected Services Overview

5-16.Connected Services Overview
Functional overview

Functional overview

Toyota Connected hotspot includes Toyota apps, Wi-Fi® Hotspot, Safety Connect and Service Connect.
 Audio Plus
Owners of this system should refer to the "NAVIGATION AND MULTIMEDIA SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL".
 Each function is available in the following areas:
· Toyota apps is available in the contiguous United States, Washington D.C., Alaska, Hawaii, Puerto Rico and Canada.
· Toyota apps is not available in the United States Virgin Islands.
· Wi-Fi® Hotspot is available in the contiguous United States, Washington D.C.,Alaska and Hawaii.
· Wi-Fi® Hotspot is not available in Puerto Rico, Canada, and in the United States Virgin Islands.
· Safety Connect features include: Automatic Collision Notification, Emergency Assistance, S.O.S, Stolen Vehicle Location (available in the contiguous United States, Washington D.C., Hawaii, Alaska, Puerto Rico and Canada) and Enhanced Roadside Assistance (available in the contiguous United States, Washington D.C., Alaska, Puerto Rico and Canada).
· Safety Connect is not available in the United States Virgin Islands.
· Service Connect is available in the contiguous United States, Washington D.C., Alaska, Hawaii, the United States Virgin Islands, Puerto Rico and Canada.
 Connected services functionality is dependent upon network reception level and signal strength.

 The functions included are classified into the following four types.
· Type A: Function achieved by using a smart phone or an embedded cellular device in the vehicle (DCM: Data Communication Module) and the system
· Type B: Function achieved by using DCM and the system
· Type C: Function achieved by using DCM
· Type D: Function achieved by using DCM and a smartphone

Function

Type

Toyota apps

Type A

Wi-Fi® Hotspot

Type B

Safety Connect

Type C

Service Connect

Type D

COROLLA HV_U

5-16. Connected Services Overview 373

Type A: Function achieved by using a smart phone or DCM*

*: If equipped
Of the functions included with Connected Services, the Toyota apps relies on the use of a smart phone or DCM.

 Using a smart phone

· Toyota audio multimedia system enables applicable apps installed on a smart phone to be displayed on and operated from the screen via a Bluetooth®.

 Via DCM

· Toyota audio multimedia system enables applicable apps installed on the system to be displayed on and operated from the screen.

A few settings must be performed before Toyota apps can be

used. (P.379)

5

By using a smart phone or DCM

Audio

Content provider
COROLLA HV_U

374 5-16. Connected Services Overview
Provides contents to the application server.
Application server Provides applications to the system or a smart phone.
Smart phone* Using the Toyota mobile application, communication is relayed between the system, application server and contents provider. The smart phone cannot be operated while communicating.
Applications Display usable content from the content providers on the screen using the data connection of the connected smart phone or DCM.
System Content received, via a smart phone or DCM, from content provider servers is displayed on the screen. The system is equipped with an application player to run applications.
Via DCM
*: For known compatible phones, refer to https://www.toyota.com/connected-services in the United States, https://www.toyota.ca/connected in Canada, and http://www.toyotapr.com/connected-services in Puerto Rico.

Before using the function
The required operations to activate applications and connect a smart phone to the system, and the registration steps for the connected services are explained in this section.
 Subscription
 Toyota apps does not require an activation fee or monthly recurring fees.
 Services requiring a separate contract can also be used.*
*: For details, refer to https://www.toyota.com/ connected-services or call 1-800-331-4331 in the

United States, https://www.toyota.ca/connected or call 1-888-869-6828 in Canada, and http://www.toyotapr.com/ connected-services or call 1-877-855-8377 in Puerto Rico.
 Availability of function
 Toyota apps is available in the contiguous United States, Washington D.C., Alaska, Hawaii, Puerto Rico and Canada.
 Toyota apps is not available in the United States Virgin Islands.
 Data usage fees may apply while

COROLLA HV_U

5-16. Connected Services Overview 375

using Toyota apps function. Confirm data usage fees before using this function.  For details regarding operation of the Toyota apps, refer to https://www.toyota.com/ connected-services in the United States, https://www.toyota.ca/connected in Canada, and http://www.toyotapr.com/ connected-services in Puerto Rico.

2 Open the Toyota mobile application on your smart phone and follow instructions. Bluetooth® Pairing is required.
In order to use Toyota mobile application, the following must first be performed:
 Register a Bluetooth® phone with the hands-free system.

 These functions are not made

(P.268)

available in some countries or

areas. Availability of functions of the Toyota apps is dependent on network reception level.

 Applications can only be used when the Toyota mobile application has been downloaded to your

 Initializing personal data

smart phone or the system, and the application is running.

The personal data used in appli- Toyota mobile application opera-

cations can be reset. (P.294) The following personal data can

tional procedures can also be con-

firmed by visiting https://www.toyota.com/

5

be deleted and returned to their default settings:

connected-services in the United States, https://www.toyota.ca/connected

 Downloaded contents

in Canada, and http://www.toyotapr.com/

 Radio stations that were lis-

connected-services

tened to

in Puerto Rico.

 If a Toyota mobile application is

Once initialized, the data and settings will be erased. Pay much attention when initializing the data.

used while iPod audio/video is being played back, system operation may become unstable.

Preparation before using Toyota mobile application
 Settings required to use Toyota mobile application
Perform the settings in the following order. 1 Download the Toyota mobile
application to your smart phone or the system.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

376 5-16. Connected Services Overview

Type B: Function achieved by using DCM and the system*
*: If equipped
The functionality of Wi-Fi® Hotspot is made possible through the shared work of the DCM and the system.
This service is available by subscription and supported by the Toyota response center, which operates 24 hours a day, 7 days a week.

 Wi-Fi® Hotspot is not available in Puerto Rico, Canada, and in the United States Virgin Islands.

For details about Wi-Fi® Hotspot:P.280

Before using the function
 Subscription
After you have signed the Telematics Subscription Service Agreement and are enrolled, you can begin receiving services. A variety of subscription terms are available. Contact your Toyota dealer, or call 1-800-331-4331 in the United States, 1-888-869-6828 in Canada, and 1-877-855-8377 in Puerto Rico, for further subscription details. (P.374)
 Availability of functions
 Wi-Fi® Hotspot is available in the contiguous United States, Washington D.C., Alaska and Hawaii.

COROLLA HV_U

5-16. Connected Services Overview 377

Type C: Function achieved by using DCM*
*: If equipped
The functionality of Safety Connect is made possible by the use of a DCM.
For details, (P.73)

Type D: Function achieved by using DCM and a smartphone*
*: If equipped
The functionality of Service Connect is made possible by the use of a DCM and a smartphone.
For details about these services, refer to https://www.toyota.com/ connected-services.

Service Connect

Service Connect uses DCM to

5

collect and transmit vehicle data

that allows Toyota to provide:

 Vehicle Health Report (VHR) (Safety Recalls, Service Campaigns, Current Vehicle Alerts, Required Maintenance, and Vehicle Condition Status)

 Maintenance Notifications

 Vehicle Alert Notifications

 Availability of function

 Service Connect is available in the contiguous United States, Washington D.C., Alaska, Hawaii, the United States Virgin Islands, Puerto Rico and Canada.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

378 5-16. Connected Services Overview
 Availability of functions of the Service Connect is dependent on network reception level.
COROLLA HV_U

5-17. Connected Services Operation 379

5-17.Connected Services Operation
Toyota apps
Toyota apps is a function that enables certain apps installed on a smart phone or the system to be displayed on and operated from the system screen. Before the Toyota apps can be used, some setup needs to be performed. (P.375)

3 Follow the steps in "From the "APPS" button" from step 3. (P.379)
 From the "APPS" button
1 Press the "APPS" button.

For details about the func-

tions and services provided

by each application, refer to https://www.toyota.com/ connected-services

2 Select "Apps".
If a specific application screen is displayed, select "Apps" again.

in the United States, https://www.toyota.ca/ connected

3 Select the desired application screen button.

5

in Canada, and http://www.toyotapr.com/ connected-services in Puerto Rico.

: Select to activate an application.
"Update": Select to update the applications. (P.379) "App Catalog": Select to change the order of the applications. (P.380)

Using Toyota apps
 From the "MENU" button

: Displays the number of new notifications for the application

1 Press the "MENU" button.

Updating an application

2 Select "Apps".

When the Toyota apps is activated, an application may need to be updated. To update an application, it is necessary to download update data and install it.
 Downloading update
If an update is available, "Update" can be selected.

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

380 5-17. Connected Services Operation

1 Select "Update" on the application screen. (P.379)
2 Check that downloading starts.
"Download in Background": Select to operate other functions while downloading. "Cancel": Select to cancel updating.
3 Check that downloading is complete.
"Later": Select to install later. When this screen button is selected, the screen will return to the last displayed screen. To install the update data: (P.380) "See Detail": Select to display detailed information on the update data. "Install": Select to install the update data. Follow the steps "Installing the update data" from step 2. (P.380)
 Installing the update data
After the downloading is complete, "Update" will be changed to "Install". 1 Select "Install" on the appli-
cation screen. (P.379)
2 Select "Continue".
"Later": Select to postpone the installation of the update data and go back to the previous screen.
3 Check that installing is started.
"Install in Background": Select to operate other functions while installing.
4 Select "OK" after the installing is complete.
The Toyota apps cannot be operated while installing.

Reordering the applications
Order of the applications can be changed. 1 Display the application
screen. (P.379)
2 Select "App Catalog".
3 Select the desired application to be moved.
4 Select "<<" or ">>" to move the application, and then select the done button.
If a message appears on the screen
When problems occur with starting the application player, a message will appear on the screen. Referring to the following items, identify the problem and take the suggested corrective action.
 "When it is safe and legal to do so, please ensure your mobile application is running and logged in on your phone."
The Toyota mobile application cannot be connected to Bluetooth® SPP.
Refer to https://www.toyota.com/ connected-services in the United States, https://www.toyota.ca/connected in Canada, and http://www.toyotapr.com/ connected-services in Puerto Rico, to confirm if the

COROLLA HV_U

5-17. Connected Services Operation 381

phone is Bluetooth® SPP compatible or not, and then activate the Toyota mobile application.
 "Installation failed, please try again"
Installation can be attempted again by changing to the application screen and pressing the "Install" switch.

 "To use the services, mobile application needs to be running on your phone. For more information, please visit toyota.com or call 1-800-331-4331 in the United States, 1-888-869-6828 in Canada, and 1-877-855-8377 in Puerto Rico."

 "Application download error.

The Toyota mobile application can-

Please try again later."

not be connected to Bluetooth®

Downloading can be attempted

SPP.

again by checking the communica- Refer to

tion status, changing to the applica- https://www.toyota.com/

tion screen and pressing the

connected-services

"Download" switch again.

in the United States,

 "Download error, some mobile application functions may not work as expected. Please

https://www.toyota.ca/connected in Canada, and http://www.toyotapr.com/ connected-services

5

reinitiate the download pro-

in Puerto Rico, to confirm if the

cess."

phone is Bluetooth® SPP compati-

The Toyota mobile application cannot be connected to Bluetooth®

ble or not, and then activate the Toyota mobile application.

SPP.

 "Communication unsuccess-

Refer to

ful. Please try again."

https://www.toyota.com/ connected-services in the United States, https://www.toyota.ca/connected

Communication was disconnected.
After a few moments, retry the operation.

in Canada, and http://www.toyotapr.com/

Entering keyword opera-

connected-services in Puerto Rico, to confirm if the

tion

phone is Bluetooth® SPP compati- A keyword can be entered to an

ble or not, and then activate the

application by the software key-

Toyota mobile application.

board or voice recognition func-

Please ensure your Toyota mobile tion. For details about the

application is running and logged in functions and services provided

on your phone while vehicle is not moving.

by each application, refer to https://www.toyota.com/

Audio

COROLLA HV_U

382 5-17. Connected Services Operation

connected-services in the United States, https://www.toyota.ca/connected in Canada, and http://www.toyotapr.com/ connected-services in Puerto Rico.
The keyboard layout can be changed. (P.291)

Completion of the keyword will be detected automatically.
5 Search results will be displayed on the screen.

Entering a keyword using the software keyboard
1 Display the application screen. (P.379)
2 Select the desired application screen button.
3 Select the character entering space.
4 Enter a search term, and then select "OK".
5 Entering characters will be reflected on the character entering space.
For details on operating the keyboard: P.263
Entering a keyword using the voice recognition function
1 Display the application screen. (P.379)
2 Select the desired application screen button.
3 Press the talk switch. (P.334)
4 Say the desired keyword.

COROLLA HV_U

5-18.Toyota apps settings
Setup
The settings of Toyota apps can be changed.
Displaying the Toyota apps settings screen
1 Press the "MENU" button.

5-18. Toyota apps settings 383
Select to set the enhanced mode with connecting USB device on/off.
When an iPhone is connected while this setting is set to "On", communication with devices connected to other USB ports may not be possible. Also, depending on the device, charging may not be possible.
Select to reset all setup items.

2 Select "Setup". 3 Select "Toyota apps". 4 Select the desired items to
be set.
Toyota apps settings screen

Data use notification pop-up settings

The data use notification

pop-up, which indicates that the

system will use an internet con-

nection, can be enabled/dis-

5

abled.

1 Display the Toyota apps settings screen. (P.383)

2 Select "Data Usage Message".

3 Change the setting as desired.

Audio

Select to set the pop up reminder for smart phone data usage. (P.381) Select to detect iPhone app automatically on/off.
COROLLA HV_U

384 5-18. Toyota apps settings
COROLLA HV_U

6 Interior features
.6-1. Using the air conditioning system and defogger
Automatic air conditioning system....................... 386
Heated steering wheel/seat heaters ...................... 393
6-2. Using the interior lights Interior lights list .......... 395
6-3. Using the storage features List of storage features .................................. 397 Trunk features ............. 400
6-4. Other interior features Other interior features . 401 Garage door opener.... 411

385
6

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

386 6-1. Using the air conditioning system and defogger
6-1.Using the air conditioning system and defogger
Automatic air conditioning system
Air outlets are automatically selected and fan speed is automatically adjusted according to the set temperature setting. Also, the display and button positions will differ depending on the type of the system.
Air conditioning controls

Temperature control switch

Fan speed control switch

"A/C" switch

S-FLOW mode switch

Outside/recirculated air mode switch

Eco air conditioning mode switch

Airflow mode control switch

Rear window defogger and outside rear view mirror defoggers switch

Windshield defogger switch

Off switch

Automatic mode switch

 Adjusting the temperature setting
To adjust the temperature setting, turn the temperature control switch clockwise (warm) or counterclockwise (cool).

If "A/C" switch is not pressed, the system will blow ambient temperature air or heated air.
 Setting the fan speed
To adjust the fan speed, turn the fan speed control switch clock-

COROLLA HV_U

6-1. Using the air conditioning system and defogger 387

wise (increase) or counterclockwise (decrease).
Pressing the off switch to turns off the fan.

on the outside/recirculated air mode switch.
 Set cooling and dehumidification function

 Change the airflow mode

Press the "A/C" switch.

Press the airflow mode control switch.
The airflow mode changes as follows each time the switch is pressed.

When the function is on, the indicator illuminates on the "A/C" switch.
 Defogging the windshield
Defoggers are used to defog the windshield and front side windows.

Press the windshield defogger switch.

Set the outside/recirculated air mode switch to outside air mode if the recirculated air mode is used. (It may switch automatically.)

1 Upper body
2 Upper body and feet
3 Feet
4 Feet and the windshield defogger operates

To defog the windshield and the

side windows quickly, turn the air

flow and temperature up.

To return to the previous mode,

6

press the windshield defogger

switch again when the windshield is

defogged.

When the windshield defogger switch is on, the indicator illuminates on the windshield defogger switch.

 Switching between outside air and recirculated air modes

 Defogging the rear window and outside rear view mirrors

Press the outside/recirculated air mode switch.
The mode switches between outside air mode and recirculated air mode modes each time the switch is operated. When recirculated air mode is selected, the indicator illuminates

Defoggers are used to defog the rear window, and to remove raindrops, dew and frost from the outside rear view mirrors.
Press the rear window and outside rear view mirror defoggers switch.

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

388 6-1. Using the air conditioning system and defogger

The defoggers will automatically turn off after a while.
When the rear window and outside rear view mirror defoggers switch is on, the indicator illuminates on the rear window and outside rear view mirror defoggers switch.
 Eco air conditioning mode
The air conditioning is controlled with low fuel consumption prioritized such as reducing fan speed, etc.
Press the eco air conditioning mode switch.
When the eco air conditioning mode is on, the indicator illuminates on the eco air conditioning mode switch.
 When the outside temperature exceeds 75°F (24°C) and the air conditioning system is on
 In order to reduce the air conditioning power consumption, the air conditioning system may switch to recirculated air mode automatically. This may also reduce fuel consumption.
 Recirculated air mode is selected as a default mode when the power switch is turned to ON.
 It is possible to switch to outside air mode at any time by pressing the outside air mode switch.
 Fogging up of the windows  The windows will easily fog up
when the humidity in the vehicle is high. Turning "A/C" on will dehumidify the air from the outlets and defog the windshield effectively.  If you turn "A/C" off, the windows may fog up more easily.  The windows may fog up if the recirculated air mode is used.

 When driving on dusty roads Close all windows. If dust thrown up by the vehicle is still drawn into the vehicle after closing the windows, it is recommended that the air intake mode be set to outside air mode and the fan speed to any setting except off.
 Outside/recirculated air mode  Setting to the recirculated air
mode temporarily is recommended in preventing dirty air from entering the vehicle interior and helping to cool the vehicle when the outside air temperature is high.  Outside/recirculated air mode may automatically switch depending on the temperature setting or the inside temperature.
 Eco air conditioning mode When Eco drive mode is selected using the driving mode select switch, eco air conditioning mode turns on. When a drive mode other than Eco drive mode is selected, eco air conditioning mode may turn off.
 Operation of the air conditioning system in Eco drive mode
 In Eco drive mode, the air conditioning system is controlled as follows to prioritize fuel efficiency:
· Engine speed and compressor operation controlled to restrict heating/cooling capacity
· Fan speed restricted when automatic mode is selected
 To improve air conditioning performance, perform the following operations:
· Turn off eco air conditioning mode (P.388)
· Adjust the fan speed · Turn off Eco drive mode (P.239)  When the outside temperature
falls to nearly 32°F (0°C) The dehumidification function may not operate even when "A/C" switch

COROLLA HV_U

6-1. Using the air conditioning system and defogger 389

is pressed.

 Ventilation and air conditioning odors

Caution

 To let fresh air in, set the air conditioning system to the outside air mode.

Air conditioning system

 During use, various odors from inside and outside the vehicle may enter into and accumulate in the air conditioning system. This may then cause odor to be emitted from the vents.

Air conditioning system lubricant type
Requires registered technician to service air conditioning sys-

 To reduce potential odors from

tem

occurring:

· It is recommended that the air conditioning system be set to out-

Flammable refrigerant

side air mode prior to turning the

vehicle off. · The start timing of the blower may

 Customization

be delayed for a short period of

Some functions can be customized.

time immediately after the air con- (P.544)

ditioning system is started in auto-

matic mode.

WARNING

 When parking, the system automatically switches to outside air mode to encourage better air cir-

 To prevent the windshield from fogging up

culation throughout the vehicle,

Do not use the windshield defog-

6

helping to reduce odors that occur ger switch during cool air opera-

when starting the vehicle.

tion in extremely humid weather.

 Air conditioning filter

The difference between the temperature of the outside air and

P.454

that of the windshield can cause

 Air conditioning system refrigerant
 A label regarding the refrigerant of

the outer surface of the windshield to fog up, blocking your vision.

the air conditioning system is

 When the outside rear view

attached to the hood at the loca-

mirror defoggers are operat-

tion shown in the following illustra-

ing

tion.

Do not touch the outside rear view

mirror surfaces, as they can

become very hot and burn you.

 The meaning of each symbol on the label are as follows:

NOTICE
 To prevent 12-volt battery discharge
Do not leave the air conditioning system on longer than necessary when the hybrid system is off.

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

390 6-1. Using the air conditioning system and defogger

NOTICE
 When repairing/replacing parts of the air conditioning system
Have repair/replacement performed by your Toyota dealer. When a part of the air conditioning system, such as the evaporator, is to be replaced, it must be replaced with a new one.

Windshield wiper de-icer (if equipped)

Using automatic mode
1 Press the automatic mode switch.
2 Adjust the temperature setting.
3 To stop the operation, press the off switch.
If the fan speed setting or air flow modes are operated, the automatic mode indicator goes off. However, automatic mode for functions other than that operated is maintained.
 Using automatic mode Fan speed is adjusted automatically according to the temperature setting and the ambient conditions. Therefore, the fan may stop for a while until warm or cool air is ready to flow immediately after the automatic mode switch pressed.

Prevent ice from building up on the windshield and wiper blades.
When the windshield wiper de-icer switch is on, the indicator illuminates on the windshield wiper de-icer switch.
The windshield wiper de-icer will automatically turn off after a period of time.
WARNING
 To prevent burns Do not touch the glass at lower part of the windshield or to the side of the front pillars when the windshield wiper de-icer is on.
S-FLOW mode
In S-FLOW mode, priority for the airflow is given to the front seats, reducing the airflow and air conditioning effect on the rear seats.
The following S-FLOW modes are available:
 Automatic S-FLOW mode
In this mode, when a passenger

COROLLA HV_U

6-1. Using the air conditioning system and defogger 391

is judged to be in a rear seat, S-FLOW mode will be automatically disabled.

A passenger is judged to be in a rear seat when in automatic S-FLOW mode.

When the S-FLOW mode is on, the indicator illuminates on the S-FLOW mode switch.
To enable/disable S-FLOW mode

Depending on the set temperature, operation in S-FLOW mode may not change as described above.

and enter manual S-FLOW mode, press the S-FLOW mode switch.
 Manual S-FLOW mode

 How the system judges if a passenger is in the vehicle when in S-FLOW mode

When the S-FLOW mode switch is pressed, S-FLOW mode will be manually enabled/ disabled.
When the S-FLOW mode is on, the indicator illuminates on the S-FLOW mode switch.
Operation in S-FLOW mode differs according to the following conditions:
 Priority is given to the driver's seat only when:
 Automatic S-FLOW mode
When no passengers are judged to be in the front passenger seat or rear seats.
 Manual S-FLOW mode
When no passenger is judged to be in the front passenger seat.
 Priority is given to the front seats when:
Manual S-FLOW mode is selected

In S-FLOW mode, the system judges if a passenger is in the vehicle as follows:

· Front passenger seat:

A passenger is judged to be in the

front passenger seat when the sys-

tem detects an object on the front

passenger seat, fastening of the

front passenger seat belt or the

opening and closing of the front pas-

senger door. (However, when only

opening and closing of the front pas-

senger door is detected, the system

will judge that a passenger is not in the front passenger seat after the

6

vehicle speed reaches approxi-

mately 12 mph [20 km/h] or more.)

· Rear seats (automatic S-FLOW mode only):

A passenger is judged to be in a rear seat when the system detects the opening and closing of a rear door.

If a passenger is judged to be in the vehicle, the system will retain the judgement for a certain amount of time after the power switch is turned off.

or no passengers are judged to be in the rear seats when in automatic

 Operation of automatic S-FLOW mode

S-FLOW mode.
 S-FLOW mode will be disabled when:

When the system is operating in automatic S-FLOW mode, if a rear door is opened and then closed, S-FLOW mode will be disabled. To enable S-FLOW mode, press the S-FLOW mode switch. (In this case, the system will operate in manual

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

392 6-1. Using the air conditioning system and defogger

S-FLOW mode.)
 Changing from manual S-FLOW mode to automatic S-FLOW mode
1 Press the S-FLOW mode switch to disable S-FLOW mode.
2 Turn the power switch off. 3 Wait for 60 minutes or more and
change the power switch to ON.

or down
 Front right-hand side

Air outlet layout and operations
 Location of air outlets
The air outlets and air volume changes according to the selected air flow mode.

Direct air flow to the left or right, up or down
 Front left-hand side

:If equipped
 Adjusting the position of and opening and closing the air outlets
 Front center

Direct air flow to the left or right, up or down

Direct air flow to the left or right, up COROLLA HV_U

6-1. Using the air conditioning system and defogger 393

WARNING
 To prevent the windshield defogger from operating improperly
Do not place anything on the instrument panel which may cover the air outlets. Otherwise, air flow may be obstructed, preventing the windshield defoggers from defogging.

Heated steering wheel*/seat heaters*
*: If equipped
 Heated steering wheel Warms up the grip of the steering wheel  Seat heaters Warm up the seat upholstery

WARNING

 To prevent minor burn injuries
Care should be taken if anyone in the following categories comes in contact with the steering wheel or seats when the heater is on:

 Babies, small children, the elderly, the sick and the physically challenged

 Persons with sensitive skin

6

 Persons who are fatigued

 Persons who have taken alcohol or drugs that induce sleep (sleeping drugs, cold remedies, etc.)

NOTICE  To prevent damage to the
seat heaters Do not put heavy objects that have an uneven surface on the seat and do not stick sharp objects (needles, nails, etc.) into the seat.
 To prevent 12-volt battery discharge
Do not use the functions when the hybrid system is off.

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

394 6-1. Using the air conditioning system and defogger

Operation instructions
 Heated steering wheel
Turns heated steering wheel on/off
When the heated steering wheel is on, the indicator illuminates on the heated steering wheel switch.

When the seat heater is on, the indicator illuminates on the seat heater switch.

 Seat heaters  Front Turns seat heaters on/off

 The heated steering wheel and seat heaters can be used when
The power switch is in ON.
WARNING  To prevent overheating and
minor burn injuries Observe the following precautions when using the seat heaters.  Do not cover the seat with a
blanket or cushion when using the seat heater.  Do not use seat heater more than necessary.

1 High temperature 2 Low temperature
When the seat heater is on, the indicator illuminates on the seat heater switch.
When not in use, put the switch in the neutral position. The indicator will turn off.
 Rear
Turns seat heaters on/off

COROLLA HV_U

6-2.Using the interior lights
Interior lights list

6-2. Using the interior lights 395

Location of the interior lights

Interior features

Rear interior light (P.396)

6

Door trim lights (if equipped)

Front interior/personal lights (P.395)

Center tray light (if equipped)

Cup holder lights (if equipped)

Operating the interior lights
 Front

1 Turns the door position on/off
When a door is opened while the door position is on, the lights turn on.

COROLLA HV_U

396 6-2. Using the interior lights

2 Turns the lights on/off  Rear
1 Turns the door position on
The rear interior light turns on/off together the front interior lights. When a door is opened while the front and rear interior light door position is on, the lights turn on.
2 Turns the light on
Operating the personal lights

 To prevent the 12-volt battery from being discharged
If the interior lights remain on when the power switch is turned off, the lights will go off automatically after 20 minutes.  The interior lights may turn on
automatically when If any of the SRS airbags deploy (inflate) or in the event of a strong rear impact, the interior lights will turn on automatically. The interior lights will turn off automatically after approximately 20 minutes. The interior lights can be turned off manually. However, in order to help prevent further collisions, it is recommended that they be left on until safety can be ensured. (The interior lights may not turn on automatically depending on the force of the impact and conditions of the collision.)  Customization Some functions can be customized. (P.544)

NOTICE
 To prevent 12-volt battery discharge
Do not leave the lights on longer than necessary when the hybrid system is off.

Turns the lights on/off
 Illuminated entry system The lights automatically turn on/off according to the power switch mode, the presence of the electronic key, whether the doors are locked/unlocked, and whether the doors are open/closed.

COROLLA HV_U

6-3. Using the storage features
6-3.Using the storage features
List of storage features

397

Location of the storage features

Interior features

Bottle holders/door pockets (P.398)

6

Open trays (if equipped) (P.399)

Glove box (P.398)

Cup holders (P.398)

Console box (P.399)

WARNING  Items that should not be left
in the storage spaces Do not leave glasses, lighters or spray cans in the storage spaces, as this may cause the following when cabin temperature becomes high:
Glasses may be deformed by heat or cracked if they come into contact with other stored items.

 Lighters or spray cans may explode. If they come into contact with other stored items, the lighter may catch fire or the spray can may release gas, causing a fire hazard.

COROLLA HV_U

398 6-3. Using the storage features Glove box

Pull up the lever to open the glove box.
WARNING  Caution while driving Keep the glove box closed. In the event of sudden braking or sudden swerving, an accident may occur due to an occupant being struck by the open glove box or the items stored inside.
Cup holders
 Front

WARNING  Items unsuitable for the cup
holder Do not place anything other than cups or beverage cans in the cup holders. Other items may be thrown out of the holders in the event of an accident or sudden braking and cause injury. If possible, cover hot drinks to prevent burns.
Bottle holders
 Front

 Rear Pull the armrest down.

 Rear

COROLLA HV_U

6-3. Using the storage features 399

 Bottle holders  When storing a bottle, close the
cap.  The bottle may not be stored
depending on its size or shape.

WARNING
 Caution while driving Keep the console box closed. Injuries may result in the event of an accident or sudden braking.

WARNING
 Items unsuitable for the bottle holders
Do not place anything other than a bottle in the bottle holders. Other items may be thrown out of the holders in the event of an accident or sudden braking and cause injury.

Open trays
 Front (if equipped)

Console box

 Rear

6

1 Slide the lid to the rear most position.
2 Lift the lid while pulling up the knob.
 Slide function
The console box lid can be slid forward or backward.

WARNING  Caution while driving Observe the following precautions when putting items in the open tray. Failure to do so may cause items to be thrown out of the tray in the event of sudden braking or steering. In these cases, the items may interfere with pedal operation or cause driver distraction, resulting in an accident.
 Do not store items in the tray that can easily shift or roll out.

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

400 6-3. Using the storage features

WARNING Do not stack items in the tray
higher than the tray's edge. Do not put items in the tray that
may protrude over the tray's edge.

Trunk features Auxiliary box
Lift the deck mat.

 Type A

 Type B

COROLLA HV_U

6-4. Other interior features 401

6-4.Other interior features
Other interior features
USB charging port
The USB charging port are used to supply 2.1 A of electricity at 5 V to external devices. The USB charging port are for charging only. They are not designed for data transfer or other purposes. Depending on the external device, it may not charge properly. Refer to the manual included with the device before using a USB charging port.

connected  If the connected external device is
turned off (depending on device)  If the temperature inside the vehi-
cle is high, such as after the vehicle has been parked in the sun  About connected external device Depending on the connected external device, charging may occasionally be suspended and then start again. This is not a malfunction.
NOTICE  To prevent damage to the
USB charging port  Do not insert foreign objects into
the port.

 Using the USB charging port
Lift the lid while pulling up the knob.

 Do not spill water or other liquids into the port.

 Do not apply excessive force to or impact the USB charging port.

 Do not disassemble or modify

6

the USB charging port.

 To prevent damage to external devices
 Do not leave external devices in the vehicle. The temperature inside the vehicle may become high, resulting in damage to an external device.

 The USB charging port can be used when
The power switch is in ACC or ON.  Situations in which the USB
charging port may not operate correctly  If a device which consumes more than 2.1 A at 5 V is connected  If a device designed to communicate with a personal computer, such as a USB memory device, is

 Do not push down on or apply unnecessary force to an external device or the cable of an external device while it is connected.
 To prevent 12-volt battery discharge
Do not use the USB charging port for a long period of time with the hybrid system stopped.

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

402 6-4. Other interior features

Power outlet
The power outlet can be used for 12 V accessories that run on less than 10 A. Lift the lid while pulling up the knob and open the power outlet lid.
 The power outlet can be used when
The power switch is in ACC or ON.  When stopping the hybrid sys-
tem Disconnect electrical devices with charging functions, such as mobile battery packs. If such devices are left connected, the hybrid system may not stop normally.
NOTICE  To prevent the fuse from
being blown Do not use an accessory that uses more than 12 V 10 A.  To avoid damaging the power
outlet Close the power outlet lid when the power outlet is not in use. Foreign objects or liquids that enter the power outlet may cause a short circuit.

 To prevent 12-volt battery discharged
Do not use the power outlet longer than necessary when the hybrid system is off.
Wireless charger (if equipped)
A portable device, such as a smartphone or mobile battery, can be charged by just placing it on the charging area, provided the device is compatible with the Qi wireless charging standard created by the Wireless Power Consortium.
The wireless charger cannot be used with a portable device that is larger than the charging area. Additionally, depending on the portable device, the wireless charger may not operate properly. Refer to the operation manual of the portable device.
 The "Qi" symbol
The "Qi" symbol is a trademark of the Wireless Power Consortium.

COROLLA HV_U

 Name for all parts

6-4. Other interior features 403
While charging, the operation indicator light (orange) will be illuminated. If charging does not begin, move the portable device as close to the center of the charging area as possible. When charging is complete, the operation indicator light (green) will illuminate.

Power supply switch

Operation indicator light

Charge area

 Recharging function

 Using the wireless charger
1 Press the power supply switch of the wireless charger.

 If a certain amount of time has elapsed since charging completed and the portable device has not been moved, the wireless charger will restart

6

Pressing the switch again turns the wireless charger off.

charging.

When turned on, the operation indi-  If the portable device is

cator light (green) comes on. When the power switch is turned off, the on/off state of the wireless

moved within the charging area, charging will stop tem-

charger will be memorized.

porarily then restart.

Interior features

2 Place a portable device on the charging area with its charging surface facing down.
COROLLA HV_U

404 6-4. Other interior features

 Operation indicator light status

Operation indicator light

State

Off

The Wireless charger is off

Green (illuminated)

Standby (charging is possible) Charging is complete*

Orange (illuminated)

A portable device has been placed on the charging area (identifying the portable device)

Charging in progress

*: Depending on the portable device, the operation indicator light may stay illuminated (orange) after charging has completed.
 If the operation indicator light blinks

If an error is detected, the operation indicator light will blink (orange). Take the appropriate measures according to the table below.

Operation indicator light Suspected cause

Measure

Blinks (orange) at a one second interval continuously

Vehicle to charger communication failure.

Contact your Toyota dealer.

Blinks (orange) 3 times repeatedly

A foreign object exists between the portable device and charging area.
Portable device is not positioned properly on the charging area.

Remove the foreign object.
Move the portable device toward the center of the charging area.

Blinks (orange) 4 times repeatedly

The temperature of the wireless charger is excessively high.

Stop charging immediately and continue charging after a while.

 The wireless charger can be operated when
The power switch is in ACC or ON.  Portable devices that can be
charged  Portable devices compatible with
the Qi wireless charging standard can be charged by the wireless

charger. However, compatibility with all devices which meet the Qi wireless charging standard is not guaranteed.  The wireless charger is designed to supply low power electricity (5 W or less) to a cellular phone, smartphone, or other portable device.

COROLLA HV_U

6-4. Other interior features 405

 If a cover or accessory is attached to the portable device
Do not charge a portable device if a cover or accessory which is not Qi compatible is attached. Depending on the type of cover and/or accessory attached, it may not be possible to charge the portable device. If the portable device is placed on the charging area and does not charge, remove the cover and/or accessories.  If interference is heard in AM
radio broadcasts while charging Turn off the wireless charger and check if the noise is reduced. If noise is reduced, press and hold the power supply switch of the wireless charger for 2 seconds. The frequency of the wireless charger is changed and noise may be reduced. When the frequency is changed, the operation indicator light will blink (orange) 2 times.

 Charging precautions  If the electronic key cannot be
detected in the cabin, charging cannot be performed. When a door is opened and closed, charging may be temporarily suspended.  While charging, the wireless charger and the portable device will become warm. This is not a malfunction.If a portable device becomes warm while charging and charging stops due to the protection function of the portable device, wait until the portable device cools down and charge it again.  Sound generated during operation When the power supply switch is turned on or while a portable device is being identified, operation sounds may be heard. This is not a malfunction.  Cleaning the wireless charger

P.423

6

 Certification for the wireless charger

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

406 6-4. Other interior features
COROLLA HV_U

6-4. Other interior features 407
6 COROLLA HV_U

Interior features

408 6-4. Other interior features

WARNING  Caution while driving When charging a portable device while driving, for safety reasons, the driver should not operate the portable device.  Caution regarding interfer-
ence with electronic devices People with implantable cardiac pacemakers, cardiac resynchronization therapy pacemakers or implantable cardioverter defibrillators, as well as any other electrical medical device, should consult their physician about the usage of the wireless charger. Operations of the wireless charger may have an affect on medical devices.  To prevent damage or burns Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in the possibility of fire, equipment failure or damage, or burns due to heat. Do not put any metallic objects
between the charging area and the portable device while charging. Do not attach metallic objects, such as aluminum stickers, to the charging area. Do not cover the wireless charger with a cloth or other object while charging. Do not attempt to charge portable devices which are not compatible with the Qi wireless charging standard. Do not disassemble, modify or remove the wireless charger. Do not apply force or impact to the wireless charger.

NOTICE  Conditions in which the wire-
less charger may not operate correctly In the following situations, the wireless charger may not operate correctly:  When a portable device is fully charged  When there is a foreign object between the charging area and portable device  When a portable device becomes hot while charging  When a portable device is placed on the wireless area with its charging surface facing up  When a portable device is not centered on the charging area  When the vehicle is near a TV tower, electric power plant, gas station, radio station, large display, airport or other facility that generates strong radio waves or electrical noise  When the portable device is in contact with, or is covered by any of the following metallic objects: · Cards to which aluminum foil is attached · Cigarette boxes that have aluminum foil inside · Metallic wallets or bags · Coins · Metal hand warmers · Media such as CDs and DVDs

COROLLA HV_U

6-4. Other interior features 409

NOTICE

Sun visors

When wireless keys (that emit radio waves) other than those of your vehicle are being used nearby.

If in situations other than above the wireless charger does not operate properly or the operation indicator light is blinking, the wireless charger may be malfunctioning. Contact your Toyota dealer.

 To prevent failure or damage to data

1 To set the visor in the forward position, flip it down.

Do not bring magnetic cards, such as a credit card, or magnetic recording media, close to

2 To set the visor in the side position, flip down, unhook,

the wireless charger while

and swing it to the side.

charging. Otherwise, data may be erased due to the influence

3 To use the side extender,

of magnetism.

place the visor in the side

Additionally, do not bring precision instruments such as wrist watches, close to the wireless

position, then slide it backward.

charger, as such objects may

malfunction.

Vanity mirrors

6

Do not leave portable devices in the cabin. The temperature inside the cabin may become high when parked in the sun, and cause damage to the device.

Slide the cover to open.
The vanity light turns on.

 To prevent 12-volt battery discharge
Do not use the wireless charger for a long period of time with the hybrid system stopped.

 To prevent 12-volt battery discharge
If the vanity lights remain on when the power switch is OFF, the lights will go off automatically after 20 minutes.

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

410 6-4. Other interior features

NOTICE  To prevent the 12-volt battery
from being discharged Do not leave the vanity lights on for extended periods while the hybrid system is off.
Armrest
Fold down the armrest for use.

WARNING  Assist grip Do not use the assist grip when getting in or out of the vehicle or rising from your seat.
NOTICE  To prevent damage to the
assist grip Do not hang any heavy object or put a heavy load on the assist grip.

Coat hooks
The coat hooks are provided with the rear assist grips.

NOTICE  To prevent damage to the
armrest Do not apply too much load on the armrest.
Assist grips
An assist grip installed on the ceiling can be used to support your body while sitting on the seat.

WARNING
 Items that cannot be hung on the coat hook
Do not hang coat hangers or other hard or sharp objects on the hook. If the SRS curtain shield airbags deploy, these items may become projectiles, causing death or serious injury.

COROLLA HV_U

6-4. Other interior features 411

Garage door opener*

*: If equipped

The garage door opener can be programmed using the HomeLink® to operate garage doors, gates, entry doors, door locks, home lighting systems, security systems, and other devices.
System components

HomeLink® indicator light
Garage door operation indicators HomeLink® icon

The HomeLink® wireless control system in your vehicle has 3

Illuminates while HomeLink® is operating.

buttons which can be pro-

Buttons

grammed to operate 3 different

devices. Refer to the programming methods on the following

 Codes stored in the HomeLink® memory

pages to determine the method which is appropriate for the

 The registered codes are not erased even if the 12-volt battery cable is disconnected.

6

device.

 If learning failed when registering

a different code to a HomeLink®

button that already has a code

registered to it, the already regis-

tered code will not be erased.

 Certification for the garage door opener  Except for vehicles sold in Canada

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

412 6-4. Other interior features
 For vehicles sold in Canada

 When support is necessary Visit on the web at www. homelink.com/toyota or call 1-800-355-3515.
WARNING  When programming a garage
door or other remote control device The garage door or other device may operate, so ensure people and objects are out of danger to prevent potential harm.  Conforming to federal safety standards Do not use the HomeLink® compatible transceiver with any garage door opener or device that lacks safety stop and reverse features as required by federal safety standards. This includes any garage door that cannot detect an interfering object. A door or device without these features increases the risk of death or serious injury.

 When operating or programming HomeLink®
Never allow a child to operate or play with the HomeLink® buttons.
Programming the HomeLink®
 Before programming HomeLink®
 During programming, it is possible that garage doors, gates, or other devices may operate. For this reason, make sure that people and objects are clear of the garage door or other devices to prevent injury or other potential harm.
 It is recommended that a new battery be placed in the remote control transmitter for more accurate programming.

COROLLA HV_U

6-4. Other interior features 413

 Garage door opener motors manufactured after 1995 may be equipped with rolling code protection. If this is the case, you may need a stepladder or other sturdy, safe device to reach the "Learn" or "Smart" button on the garage door opener motor.
 Programming HomeLink®
Steps 1 through 3 must be performed within 60 seconds, otherwise the indicator light will stop flashing and programming will not be able to be completed.

 Programming a device other than an entry gate (for U.S.A. owners)
Press and hold the handheld transmitter button until the HomeLink® indicator light changes from slowly flashing orange to rapidly flashing green (rolling code) or continuously lit green (fixed code), then release the button.

1 Press and release the Home-

Link® button you want to pro-

gram and check that the

HomeLink® indicator light

flashes (orange).
2 Point the remote control transmitter for the device at the rear view mirror, 1 to 3 in.

 Programming an entry gate (for U.S.A. owners)/Programming a device in the Canadian market

6

(25 to 75 mm) from the

Press and release the remote

HomeLink® buttons.
Keep the HomeLink® indicator light in view while programming.

control transmitter button at 2 second intervals, repeatedly,
until the HomeLink® indicator light changes from slowly flash-

ing (orange) to rapidly flashing

(green) (rolling code) or continu-

ously lit (green) (fixed code).

4 Test the HomeLink® operation by pressing the newly
programmed button and
observing the indicator light:

3 Program a device.

 Indicator light illuminates: Programming of a fixed code device has completed. The

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

414 6-4. Other interior features

garage door or other device should operate when a HomeLink® button is pressed and released.
 Indicator light flashes rapidly: The garage door opener motor or other device is equipped with a rolling code. To complete programming, firmly press and hold the HomeLink® button for 2 seconds then release it.
 If the garage door or other device does not operate, proceed to "Programming a rolling code system".
5 Repeat the steps above to program another device for any of the remaining HomeLink® buttons.
 Programming a rolling code system
2 or more people may be necessary to complete rolling code programming.
1 Locate the "Learn" or "Smart" button on the garage door opener motor in the garage.
This button can usually be found where the hanging antenna wire is attached to the unit. The name and color of the button may vary by manufacturer. Refer to the owner's manual supplied with the garage

door opener motor for details.
2 Press and release the "Learn" or "Smart" button.
Perform 3 within 30 seconds after performing 2.
3 Press and hold the desired HomeLink® button (inside the vehicle) for 2 seconds and release it. Repeat this sequence (press/hold/release) up to 3 times to complete programming. If the garage door opener motor operates when the HomeLink® button is pressed, the garage door

COROLLA HV_U

6-4. Other interior features 415

opener motor recognizes the HomeLink® signal.

form 2 and 3 within the first 10 presses of the HomeLink® button after programming has been completed.
2 Press a programmed HomeLink® button to operate a garage door.

3 Within 1 minute of pressing

the HomeLink® button, after

the garage door operation

 Enabling 2-way communication with a garage door (only available for compatible devices)

has stopped, press the "Learn" or "Smart" button on the garage door opener motor. Within 5 seconds of the establishment of 2-way

When enabled, 2-way communication allows you to check the status of the opening and closing of a garage door through indicators in your vehicle.
2-way communication is only available if the garage door opener motor used is a compatible device. (To check device

communication with the garage door opener, both garage door operation indicators in the vehicle will flash rapidly (green) and the light on the garage door opener motor will blink twice, indicat- 6 ing that 2-way communication is enabled.

compatibility, refer to

 Reprogramming a single

www.homelink.com.)

HomeLink® button

1 Within 5 seconds after programming the garage door opener has been completed, if the garage door opener motor is trained to Home-
Link®, both garage door operation indicators will flash rapidly (green) and the light on the garage door opener

When the following procedure is performed, buttons which already have devices registered to them can be overwritten:
1 With one hand, press and hold the desired HomeLink® button.
2 When the HomeLink® indica-

motor will blink twice, indicat-

tor starts flashing (orange),

ing that 2-way communica-

continue to hold the Home-

tion is enabled.

Link® button and perform

If the indicators do not flash, per-

"Programming HomeLink®" 1

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

416 6-4. Other interior features

(it takes 20 seconds for the HomeLink® indicator to start flashing).

Color
Orange (flashing)

Status
Currently opening/closing

 Before programming  Install a new battery in the trans-
mitter.  The battery side of the transmitter
must be pointed away from the HomeLink®.
Operating HomeLink®
Press the appropriate HomeLink® button. The HomeLink® indicator light should turn on. The status of the opening and closing of a garage door is shown by the indicators.

Green Red (flashing)

Opening/closing has completed
Feedback signals cannot be
received

The indicators can operate within approximately 820 ft. (250 m) of the garage door. However, if there are obstructions between the garage door and the vehicle, such as houses and trees, feedback signals from the garage door may not be received.

To recall the previous door operation status, press and release
either HomeLink® buttons

and

or

and

simultaneously. The last

recorded status will be dis-

played for 3 seconds.

Opening
Closing
This function is only available if the garage door opener motor used is a compatible device. (To check device compatibility, refer to www.homelink.com.)

Erasing the entire HomeLink® memory (all three codes)
Press and hold the 2 outside buttons for 10 seconds until the HomeLink® indicator light changes from continuously lit (orange) to rapidly flashing (green).
If you sell your vehicle, be sure to erase the programs stored in the

COROLLA HV_U

HomeLink® memory.

6-4. Other interior features 417

6

Interior features

COROLLA HV_U

418 6-4. Other interior features
COROLLA HV_U

7 Maintenance and care
.7-1. Maintenance and care Cleaning and protecting the vehicle exterior .......... 420 Cleaning and protecting the vehicle interior ........... 422
7-2. Maintenance Maintenance requirements .................................. 425 General maintenance.. 426 Emission inspection and maintenance (I/M) programs ........................ 429
7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance
Do-it-yourself service precautions..................... 430
Hood ........................... 432 Positioning a floor jack
.................................. 433 Engine compartment... 434 Tires ............................ 441 Tire inflation pressure.. 450 Wheels ........................ 452 Air conditioning filter.... 454 Cleaning the hybrid battery
(traction battery) air intake vent and filter............. 455 Electronic key battery.. 459 Checking and replacing fuses.......................... 461 Light bulbs................... 463
COROLLA HV_U

419
7

Maintenance and care

420 7-1. Maintenance and care

7-1.Maintenance and care
Cleaning and protecting the vehicle exterior
Perform cleaning in a manner appropriate to each component and its material.
Cleaning instructions
 Working from top to bottom, liberally apply water to the vehicle body, wheel wells and underside of the vehicle to remove any dirt and dust.
 Wash the vehicle body using a sponge or soft cloth, such as a chamois.
 For hard-to-remove marks, use car wash soap and rinse thoroughly with water.
 Wipe away any water.
 Wax the vehicle when the waterproof coating deteriorates.
If water does not bead on a clean surface, apply wax when the vehicle body is cool.
 Automatic car washes  Fold the mirrors before washing
the vehicle. Start washing from the front of the vehicle. Make sure to extend the mirrors before driving.  Brushes used in automatic car washes may scratch the vehicle surface, parts (wheel, etc.) and harm your vehicle's paint.  High pressure car washes As water may enter the cabin, do

not bring the nozzle tip near the gaps around the doors or perimeter of the windows, or spray these areas continuously.
 When using a car wash If the door handle becomes wet while the electronic key is within the effective range, the door may lock and unlock repeatedly. In that case, follow the following correction procedures to wash the vehicle:  Place the key in a position 6 ft. (2
m) or more separate from the vehicle while the vehicle is being washed. (Take care to ensure that the key is not stolen.)  Set the electronic key to battery-saving mode to disable the smart key system. (P.126)  Wheels and wheel ornaments  Remove any dirt immediately by using a neutral detergent.  Wash detergent off with water immediately after use.  To protect the paint from damage, make sure to observe the following precautions. · Do not use acidic, alkaline or abrasive detergent · Do not use hard brushes · Do not use detergent on the wheels when they are hot, such as after driving or parking in hot weather
 Bumpers Do not scrub with abrasive cleaners.
 Plated portions If dirt cannot be removed, clean the parts as follows:  Use a soft cloth dampened with an
approximately 5% solution of neutral detergent and water to clean the dirt off.  Wipe the surface with a dry, soft cloth to remove any remaining moisture.  To remove oily deposits, use alcohol wet wipes or a similar product.

COROLLA HV_U

7-1. Maintenance and care 421

WARNING  When washing the vehicle

· If liquids such as benzene and gasoline are spilled on the paint surface

Do not apply water to the inside of the engine compartment. Doing so may cause the electrical components, etc. to catch fire.

 If the paint is chipped or scratched, have it repaired immediately.

 Precautions regarding the exhaust pipe
Exhaust gasses cause the exhaust pipe to become quite hot. When washing the vehicle, be careful not to touch the pipe until it has cooled sufficiently, as touching a hot exhaust pipe can cause burns.
 Precaution regarding the rear bumper with Blind Spot Monitor (if equipped)
If the paint of the rear bumper is chipped or scratched, the system may malfunction. If this occurs, consult your Toyota dealer.

 To prevent the wheels from corroding, remove any dirt and store in a place with low humidity when storing the wheels.
 Cleaning the exterior lights  Wash carefully. Do not use
organic substances or scrub with a hard brush. This may damage the surfaces of the lights.  Do not apply wax to the surfaces of the lights. Wax may cause damage to the lenses.  To prevent damage to the windshield wiper arms

When lifting the wiper arms away

NOTICE

from the windshield, pull the driver

 To prevent paint deterioration and corrosion on the body and components (aluminum wheels, etc.)

side wiper arm upward first, and repeat for the passenger side. When returning the wipers to their original position, do so from the passenger side first.

7

Wash the vehicle immediately in

the following cases:

 When using a high pressure

· After driving near the sea coast

car wash

 When washing the vehicle, do

· After driving on salted roads

not spray the camera or its sur-

· If coal tar or tree sap is present on the paint surface

rounding area directly with a high pressure washer. Shock applied from high pressure

· If dead insects, insect droppings or bird droppings are present on

water may cause the device to not operate normally.

the paint surface

 Do not bring the nozzle tip close

· After driving in an area contaminated with soot, oily smoke, mine dust, iron powder or chemical substances

to boots (rubber or resin manufactured cover), connectors or the following parts. The parts may be damaged if they come into contact with high-pressure

· If the vehicle becomes heavily

water.

soiled with dust or mud

· Traction related parts

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

422 7-1. Maintenance and care

NOTICE · Steering parts · Suspension parts · Brake parts Keep the cleaning nozzle at
least 11.9 in. (30 cm) away from the vehicles body. Otherwise resin section, such as moldings and bumpers, may be deformed and damaged. Also, do not continuously hold the nozzle in the same place. Do not spray the lower part of the windshield continuously. If water enters the air conditioning system intake located near the lower part of the windshield, the air conditioning system may not operate correctly. Do not wash the underside of the vehicle using a high pressure car washer.

Cleaning and protecting the vehicle interior
Perform cleaning in a manner appropriate to each component and its material.
Protecting the vehicle interior
 Remove dirt and dust using a vacuum cleaner. Wipe dirty surfaces with a cloth dampened with lukewarm water.
 If dirt cannot be removed, wipe it off with a soft cloth dampened with neutral detergent diluted to approximately 1%. Wring out any excess water from the cloth and thoroughly wipe off remaining traces of detergent and water.

 Shampooing the carpets There are several commercial foaming-type cleaners available. Use a sponge or brush to apply the foam. Rub in overlapping circles. Do not use water. Wipe dirty surfaces and let them dry. Excellent results are obtained by keeping the carpet as dry as possible.
 Handling the seat belts Clean with mild soap and lukewarm water using a cloth or sponge. Also check the belts periodically for excessive wear, fraying or cuts.

COROLLA HV_U

WARNING  Water in the vehicle Do not splash or spill liquid in
the vehicle, such as on the floor, in the hybrid battery (traction battery) air intake vent, and in the trunk. (P.422) Doing so may cause the hybrid battery, electrical components, etc. to malfunction or catch fire. Do not get any of the SRS components or wiring in the vehicle interior wet. (P.31) An electrical malfunction may cause the airbags to deploy or not function properly, resulting in death or serious injury. Vehicles with wireless charger: Do not let the wireless charger (P.402) get wet. Failure to do so may cause the charger to become hot and cause burns or could cause electric shock resulting in death or serious injury.  Cleaning the interior (especially instrument panel) Do not use polish wax or polish cleaner. The instrument panel may reflect off the windshield, obstructing the driver's view and leading to an accident, resulting in death or serious injury.
NOTICE  Cleaning detergents Do not use the following types
of detergent, as they may discolor the vehicle interior or cause streaks or damage to painted surfaces: · Areas other than the seats and steering wheel: Organic substances such as benzene or gasoline, alkaline or acidic solutions, dye, and bleach

7-1. Maintenance and care 423

· Seats: Alkaline or acidic solutions, such as thinner, benzene, and alcohol

· Steering wheel: Organic substances, such as thinner, and cleaner that contains alcohol

 Do not use polish wax or polish cleaner. The instrument panel's or other interior part's painted surface may be damaged.

 Preventing damage to leather surfaces
Observe the following precautions to avoid damage to and deterioration of leather surfaces:  Remove any dust or dirt from
leather surfaces immediately.

 Do not expose the vehicle to direct sunlight for extended periods of time. Park the vehicle in the shade, especially during summer.

 Do not place items made of

vinyl, plastic, or containing wax

on the upholstery, as they may

stick to the leather surface if the

vehicle interior heats up signifi-

cantly.

7

 Water on the floor Do not wash the vehicle floor with water. Vehicle systems such as the audio system may be damaged if water comes into contact with electrical components such as the audio system above or under the floor of the vehicle. Water may also cause the body to rust.

 When cleaning the inside of the windshield
Do not allow glass cleaner to contact the lens. Also, do not touch the lens. (P.183)

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

424 7-1. Maintenance and care

NOTICE  Cleaning the inside of the rear
window Do not use glass cleaner to
clean the rear window, as this may cause damage to the rear window defogger heater wires or antenna. Use a cloth dampened with lukewarm water to gently wipe the window clean. Wipe the window in strokes running parallel to the heater wires or antenna. Be careful not to scratch or damage the heater wires or antenna.
Cleaning the areas with satin-finish metal accents

Use a diluted water solution of approximately 5% neutral wool detergent.
 Wring out any excess water from the cloth and thoroughly wipe off all remaining traces of detergent.
 Wipe the surface with a dry, soft cloth to remove any remaining moisture. Allow the leather to dry in a shaded and ventilated area.
 Caring for leather areas Toyota recommends cleaning the interior of the vehicle at least twice a year to maintain the quality of the vehicle's interior.

 Remove dirt using a water-dampened soft cloth or synthetic chamois.
 Wipe the surface with a dry, soft cloth to remove any remaining moisture.
 Cleaning the areas with satin-finish metal accents
The metal areas use a layer of real metal for the surface. It is necessary to clean them regularly. If dirty areas are left uncleaned for long periods of time, they may be difficult to clean.

Cleaning the synthetic leather areas
 Remove dirt and dust using a vacuum cleaner.
 Wipe it off with a soft cloth dampened with neutral detergent diluted to approximately 1%.
 Wring out any excess water from the cloth and thoroughly wipe off remaining traces of detergent and water.

Cleaning the leather areas

 Remove dirt and dust using a vacuum cleaner.
 Wipe off any excess dirt and dust with a soft cloth dampened with diluted detergent.

COROLLA HV_U

7-2. Maintenance 425

7-2.Maintenance
Maintenance requirements
To ensure safe and economical driving, day-to-day care and regular maintenance are essential. It is the owner's responsibility to

 Handling of the 12-volt battery
 Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and a wide variety of automobile components contain or emit chemicals known to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects and other reproductive harm. Work in a well ventilated area.

perform regular checks.

 Oils, fuels and fluids contained

Toyota recommends the maintenance below.

in vehicles as well as waste produced by component wear contain or emit chemicals known to

the State of California to cause

 Repair and replacement

cancer and birth defects or other reproductive harm. Avoid

It is recommended that genuine

exposure and wash any

Toyota parts be used for repairs to

affected area immediately.

ensure performance of each system. If non-Toyota parts are used in replacement or if a repair shop other than a Toyota dealer performs repairs, confirm the warranty coverage.  Allow inspection and repairs to

 12-volt battery posts, terminals and related accessories contain lead and lead compounds which are known to cause brain damage. Wash your hands after handling. (P.439)

be performed by a Toyota

dealer

General maintenance

 Toyota technicians are

well-trained specialists and are kept up to date with the latest service information. They are well

General maintenance should be performed on a daily basis. This

7

informed about the operation of all can be done by yourself or by a

systems on your vehicle.

Toyota dealer.

 Keep a copy of the repair order. It

proves that the maintenance that has been performed is under war-

Scheduled maintenance

ranty coverage. If any problem

should arise while your vehicle is under warranty, your Toyota dealer will promptly take care of it.

Scheduled maintenance should be performed at specified intervals according to the mainte-

WARNING

nance schedule.

 If your vehicle is not properly maintained
Improper maintenance could result in serious damage to the vehicle and possible death or serious injury.

For details about maintenance items and schedules, refer to the "Scheduled Maintenance Guide" or "Owner's Manual Supplement".

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

426 7-2. Maintenance

 Resetting the message indicating maintenance is required
After the required maintenance is performed according to the maintenance schedule, please reset the message. To reset the message, follow the procedure described below: 1 Press or of the meter
control switch to select .
2 Press or to select "Vehicle Settings" and then press and hold .
3 Press or to select "Scheduled Maintenance" and then press .
4 Press or to select "Yes" and then press .
A message will be displayed on the multi-information display when the reset procedure has been completed.
Do-it-yourself maintenance
You can perform some maintenance procedures by yourself. Please be aware that do-it-yourself maintenance may affect warranty coverage.
The use of Toyota repair manuals is recommended. For details about warranty coverage, refer to the separate "Owner's Warranty Information Booklet" or "Owner's Manual Supplement".

General maintenance

Listed below are the general maintenance items that should be performed at the intervals specified in the "Owner's Warranty Information Booklet" or "Owner's Manual Supplement/Scheduled Maintenance Guide". It is recommended that any problem you notice should be brought to the attention of your Toyota dealer or qualified service shop for advice.
WARNING
 If the hybrid system is operating
Turn the hybrid system off and ensure that there is adequate ventilation before performing maintenance checks.

Engine compartment

Items

Check points

12-volt battery

Check the connections. (P.439)

Brake fluid

Is the brake fluid at the correct level? (P.438)

Engine/power control unit coolant

Is the engine/power control unit coolant at the correct level? (P.436)

COROLLA HV_U

Items

Check points

Engine oil

Is the engine oil at the correct level? (P.434)

Exhaust system

There should not be any fumes or strange sounds.

Radiator/condenser

The radiator and condenser should be free from foreign objects. (P.437)

Washer fluid

Is there sufficient washer fluid? (P.440)

Vehicle interior

Items Accelerator pedal
Brake pedal

Check points
The accelerator pedal should move smoothly (without uneven pedal effort or catching).
· Does the brake pedal move smoothly?
· Does the brake pedal have appropriate clearance from the floor? (P.528)
· Does the brake pedal have the correct amount of free play? (P.528)

7-2. Maintenance 427

Items

Check points

Brakes

· The vehicle should not pull to one side when the brakes are applied.
· The brakes should work effectively.
· The brake pedal should not feel spongy.
· The brake pedal should not get too close to the floor when the brakes are applied.

Head restraints

Do the head restraints move smoothly and lock securely?

When parked on a

Hybrid trans- slope and the shift

mission "Park" lever is in P, is the

mechanism vehicle securely

7

stopped?

Indicators/buzzers

Do the indicators and buzzers function properly?

Lights

Do all the lights come on?

Parking brake

· Does the parking brake operate normally?
· When parked on a slope and the parking brake is on, is the vehicle securely stopped?

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

428 7-2. Maintenance

Items

Check points

Seat belts

· Do the seat belts operate smoothly?
· The seat belts should not be damaged.

Seats

Do the seat controls operate properly?

· Does the steering wheel rotate smoothly?
· Does the steering wheel have the correct
Steering wheel amount of free play?
· There should not be any strange sounds coming from the steering wheel.

Vehicle exterior

Items Doors/trunk Engine hood
Fluid leaks

Check points
Do the doors/trunk operate smoothly?
Does the engine hood lock system work properly?
There should not be any signs of fluid leakage after the vehicle has been parked.

Items Tires
Windshield wipers

Check points
· Is the tire inflation pressure correct?
· The tires should not be damaged or excessively worn.
· Have the tires been rotated according to the maintenance schedule?
· The wheel nuts should not be loose.
· The wiper blades should not show any signs of cracking, splitting, wear, contamination or deformation.
· The wiper blades should clear the windshield without streaking or skipping.

COROLLA HV_U

Emission inspection and maintenance (I/M) programs
Some states have vehicle emission inspection programs which include OBD (On Board Diagnostics) checks. The OBD system monitors the operation of the emission control system.
If the malfunction indicator lamp comes on
The OBD system determines that a problem exists somewhere in the emission control system. Your vehicle may not pass the I/M test and may need to be repaired. Contact your Toyota dealer to service the vehicle.

7-2. Maintenance 429
The malfunction indicator lamp comes on indicating a temporary malfunction and your vehicle may not pass the I/M test.
When the malfunction indicator lamp still remains on after several driving trips
The error code in the OBD system will not be cleared unless the vehicle is driven 40 or more times.
If your vehicle does not pass the I/M test
Contact your Toyota dealer to prepare the vehicle for re-testing.
7

Your vehicle may not pass the I/M test in the following situations:
 When the 12-volt battery is disconnected or discharged
Readiness codes that are set during ordinary driving are erased. Also, depending on your driving habits, the readiness codes may not be completely set.
 When the fuel tank cap is loose

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

430 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

7-3.Do-it-yourself maintenance
Do-it-yourself service precautions
If you perform maintenance by yourself, be sure to follow the correct procedure as given in these sections.

Maintenance

Items

Parts and tools

· Warm water

12-volt bat- · Baking soda

tery condi- · Grease

tion

· Conventional

(P.439) wrench (for terminal

clamp bolts)

Brake fluid level (P.438)

· FMVSS No.116 DOT 3 or SAE J1703 brake fluid FMVSS No.116 DOT 4 or SAE J1704 brake fluid
· Rag or paper towel · Funnel (used only
for adding brake fluid)

Items

Parts and tools

· "Toyota Super Long

Life Coolant" or a

similar high quality

ethylene gly-

col-based non-sili-

cate, non-amine,

non-nitrite and

non-borate coolant

with long-life hybrid

organic acid tech-

Engine/pow nology

er control For the U.S.A.:

unit cool- "Toyota Super Long

ant level

Life Coolant" is

(P.436) pre-mixed with 50%

coolant and 50%

deionized water.

For Canada:

"Toyota Super Long

Life Coolant" is

pre-mixed with 55%

coolant and 45%

deionized water.

· Funnel (used only

for adding coolant)

Engine oil level (P.434)

· "Toyota Genuine Motor Oil" or equivalent
· Rag or paper towel · Funnel (used only
for adding engine oil)

Fuses (P.461)

· Fuse with same amperage rating as original

Hybrid bat-

tery (traction battery) air intake vent

· ·

Vacuum cleaner, etc. Phillips screwdriver

(P.455)

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 431

Items

Parts and tools

· Bulb with same number and wattage
Light bulbs rating as original (P.463) · Flathead screw-

 Be careful not to touch the engine, power control unit, radiator, exhaust manifold, etc. right after driving as they may be hot. Oil and other fluids may also be hot.

Radiator and condenser (P.437)
Tire inflation pressure (P.450)

driver · Wrench

· Tire pressure gauge · Compressed air
source · Water or washer

 Do not leave anything that may burn easily, such as paper and rags, in the engine compartment.
 Do not smoke, cause sparks or expose an open flame to fuel or the 12-volt battery. Fuel and 12-volt battery fumes are flammable.
 Be extremely cautious when working on the 12-volt battery. It contains poisonous and corrosive sulfuric acid.

Washer

fluid containing antifreeze (for winter

 When working near the electric cooling fans or radiator

fluid

use)

grille

(P.440) · Funnel (used only

Be sure the power switch is OFF.

for adding water or

With the power switch in ON, the

washer fluid)

electric cooling fans may auto-

matically start to run if the air con-

WARNING

ditioning is on and/or the coolant temperature is high. (P.437)

The engine compartment contains many mechanisms and fluids that

 Safety glasses

7

may move suddenly, become hot,

Wear safety glasses to prevent

or become electrically energized.

flying or falling material, fluid

To avoid death or serious injury,

spray, etc. from getting in your

observe the following precautions. eyes.

 When working on the engine compartment
Make sure that the "ACCESSORY" or "IGNITION ON" on the multi-information display and the "READY" indicator are both off.
Keep hands, clothing and tools away from the moving fans.

NOTICE
 If you remove the air cleaner filter
Driving with the air cleaner filter removed may cause excessive engine wear due to dirt in the air.

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

432 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

Hood Opening the hood

3 Hold the hood open by inserting the support rod into the
slot.

1 Pull the hood lock release lever.
The hood will pop up slightly.

2 Pull the auxiliary catch lever to the left and lift the hood.

WARNING  Pre-driving check Check that the hood is fully closed and locked. If the hood is not locked properly, it may open while the vehicle is in motion and cause an accident, which may result in death or serious injury.  After installing the support
rod into the slot Make sure the rod supports the hood securely preventing it from falling down onto your head or body.
NOTICE  When closing the hood Be sure to return the support rod to its clip before closing the hood. Closing the hood with the support rod not clipped could cause the hood to bend.

COROLLA HV_U

Positioning a floor jack

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance
 Rear

When using a floor jack, follow the instructions in the manual provided with the jack and perform the operation safely. When raising your vehicle with a floor jack, position the jack correctly. Improper placement may damage your vehicle or cause injury.

433

Location of the jack point
 Front

7

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

434 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance Engine compartment Components

Washer fluid tank (P.440) Engine coolant reservoir (P.436) Fuse boxes (P.461) Engine oil level dipstick (P.435) Engine oil filler cap (P.435) Power control unit coolant reservoir (P.436) Brake fluid reservoir (P.438) 12-volt battery (P.439) Radiator (P.437) Condenser (P.437) Electric cooling fans

Checking and adding the engine oil
With the engine at operating

temperature and turned off, check the oil level on the dipstick.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 435

 Checking the engine oil
1 Park the vehicle on level ground. After warming up the engine and turning off the hybrid system, wait more than 5 minutes for the oil to drain back into the bottom of the engine.
2 Holding a rag under the end, pull the dipstick out.

6 Wipe the dipstick and reinsert it fully.
 Checking the oil type and preparing the item needed
Make sure to check the oil type and prepare the items needed before adding oil.
 Engine oil selection P.526
 Oil quantity (Low  Full) 1.6 qt. (1.5 L, 1.3 Imp. qt.)

 Item Clean funnel

 Adding engine oil

3 Wipe the dipstick clean.

If the oil level is below or near the low level mark, add engine oil of the same type as that already in the engine.

4 Reinsert the dipstick fully.

5 Holding a rag under the end,

pull the dipstick out and

check the oil level.

7

Low Normal Excessive
The shape of the dipstick may differ depending on the type of vehicle or engine.

1 Remove the oil filler cap by turning it counterclockwise.
2 Add engine oil slowly, checking the dipstick.
3 Install the oil filler cap by turning it clockwise.
 Engine oil consumption A certain amount of engine oil will be consumed while driving. In the following situations, oil consump-

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

436 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

tion may increase, and engine oil may need to be refilled in between oil maintenance intervals.  When the engine is new, for
example directly after purchasing the vehicle or after replacing the engine  If low quality oil or oil of an inappropriate viscosity is used  When driving at high engine speeds or with a heavy load, or when driving while accelerating or decelerating frequently  When leaving the engine idling for a long time, or when driving frequently through heavy traffic
WARNING  Used engine oil Used engine oil contains poten-
tially harmful contaminants which may cause skin disorders such as inflammation and skin cancer, so care should be taken to avoid prolonged and repeated contact. To remove used engine oil from your skin, wash thoroughly with soap and water.

 When replacing the engine oil  Be careful not to spill engine oil
on the vehicle components.  Avoid overfilling, or the engine
could be damaged.  Check the oil level on the dip-
stick every time you refill the vehicle.  Be sure the engine oil filler cap is properly tightened.
Checking the coolant
 Engine coolant reservoir The coolant level is satisfactory if it is between the "MAX" and "MIN" lines on the reservoir when the engine is cold.

Dispose of used oil and filters only in a safe and acceptable manner. Do not dispose of used oil and filters in household trash, in sewers or onto the ground. Call your Toyota dealer, service station or auto parts store for information concerning recycling or disposal.
Do not leave used engine oil within the reach of children.
NOTICE  To prevent serious engine
damage Check the oil level on a regular basis.

Reservoir cap
"MAX" line
"MIN" line
If the level is on or below the "MIN" line, add coolant up to the "MAX" line. (P.517)
 Power control unit coolant reservoir
The coolant level is satisfactory if it is between the "FULL" and "LOW" lines on the reservoir when the hybrid system is cold.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 437

WARNING

Reservoir cap

 When the hybrid system is hot
Do not remove the engine/power control unit coolant reservoir caps. The cooling system may be under pressure and may spray hot coolant if the cap is removed, causing serious injuries, such as burns.

"FULL" line "LOW" line
If the level is on or below the "LOW" line, add coolant up to the "FULL" line. (P.517)
 Coolant selection Only use "Toyota Super Long Life Coolant" or a similar high quality ethylene glycol based non-silicate, non-amine, non-nitrite, and non-borate coolant with long-life hybrid organic acid technology. U.S.A.:

NOTICE  When adding coolant Coolant is neither plain water nor straight antifreeze. The correct mixture of water and antifreeze must be used to provide proper lubrication, corrosion protection and cooling. Be sure to read the antifreeze or coolant label.
 If you spill coolant Be sure to wash it off with water to prevent it from damaging parts or paint.

"Toyota Super Long Life Coolant" is a mixture of 50% coolant and 50% deionized water. (Minimum tem-

Checking the radiator and condenser

7

perature: -31°F [-35°C])

Canada:

Check the radiator and con-

"Toyota Super Long Life Coolant" is denser and clear away any for-

a mixture of 55% coolant and 45% eign objects. If either of the

deionized water. (Minimum temperature: -44°F [-42°C]) For more details about coolant, contact your Toyota dealer.

above parts is extremely dirty or you are not sure of their condition, have your vehicle

 If the coolant level drops within inspected by your Toyota dealer.

a short time of replenishing Visually check the radiator, hoses,

WARNING

engine/power control unit coolant

 When the hybrid system is

reservoir caps, drain cock and water

hot

pump. If you cannot find a leak, have your Toyota dealer test the cap and check for leaks in the cooling system.

Do not touch the radiator or condenser as they may be hot and cause serious injuries, such as burns.

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

438 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

Checking and adding the brake fluid

3 Remove the reservoir cap.

 Checking fluid level
The brake fluid level should be between the "MAX" and "MIN" lines on the tank.

 Adding fluid 1 Slide and lift up the rubber
strip to partly remove it as shown.
2 Disconnect the claws and remove the service cover.

4 Add brake fluid slowly while checking the fluid level.
Make sure to check the fluid type and prepare the necessary item.  Fluid type
FMVSS No.116 DOT 3 or SAE J1703 brake fluid FMVSS No.116 DOT 4 or SAE J1704 brake fluid
 Item
Clean funnel
 Brake fluid can absorb moisture from the air
Excess moisture in the brake fluid can cause a dangerous loss of braking efficiency. Use only newly opened brake fluid.
WARNING  When filling the reservoir Take care as brake fluid can harm your hands and eyes and damage painted surfaces. If fluid gets on your hands or in your eyes, flush the affected area with clean water immediately. If you still experience discomfort, see a doctor.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 439

NOTICE  If the fluid level is low or high It is normal for the brake fluid level to go down slightly as the brake pads wear out or when the fluid level in the accumulator is high. If the reservoir needs frequent refilling, there may be a serious problem.
12-volt battery

 Make sure the charger is off when connecting and disconnecting the charger cables to the 12-volt battery.
 After recharging/reconnecting the 12-volt battery
 Unlocking the doors using the smart key system may not be possible immediately after reconnecting the 12-volt battery. If this happens, use the wireless remote control or the mechanical key to lock/unlock the doors.

Check the 12-volt battery as follows.

 Start the hybrid system with the power switch in ACC. The hybrid system may not start with the

 12-volt battery exterior

power switch turned off. However, the hybrid system will operate nor-

Make sure that the 12-volt bat-

mally from the second attempt.

tery terminals are not corroded and that there are no loose con-

 The power switch mode is recorded by the vehicle. If the 12-volt battery is reconnected, the

nections, cracks, or loose

vehicle will return the power

clamps.

switch mode to the status it was in before the 12-volt battery was dis-

connected. Make sure to turn off

the power before disconnecting

the 12-volt battery. Take extra

care when connecting the 12-volt

battery if the power switch mode

prior to discharge is unknown.

7

If the system will not start even after

multiple attempts, contact your Toy-

ota dealer.

Terminals Hold-down clamp
 Before recharging When recharging, the 12-volt battery produces hydrogen gas which is flammable and explosive. Therefore, observe the following precautions before recharging:  If recharging with the 12-volt bat-
tery installed on the vehicle, be sure to disconnect the ground cable.

WARNING  Chemicals in the 12-volt bat-
tery The 12-volt battery contains poisonous and corrosive sulfuric acid and may produce hydrogen gas which is flammable and explosive. To reduce the risk of death or serious injury, take the following precautions while working on or near the 12-volt battery:
 Do not cause sparks by touching the 12-volt battery terminals with tools.

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

440 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

WARNING Do not smoke or light a match
near the 12-volt battery. Avoid contact with eyes, skin
and clothes. Never inhale or swallow electro-
lyte. Wear protective safety glasses
when working near the 12-volt battery. Keep children away from the 12-volt battery.  Where to safely charge the 12-volt battery Always charge the 12-volt battery in an open area. Do not charge the 12-volt battery in a garage or closed room where there is insufficient ventilation.  Emergency measures regarding electrolyte If electrolyte gets in your eyes Flush your eyes with clean water for at least 15 minutes and get immediate medical attention. If possible, continue to apply water with a sponge or cloth while traveling to the nearest medical facility. If electrolyte gets on your skin Wash the affected area thoroughly. If you feel pain or burning, get medical attention immediately. If electrolyte gets on your clothes It can soak through clothing on to your skin. Immediately take off the clothing and follow the procedure above if necessary.

 If you accidentally swallow electrolyte Drink a large quantity of water or milk. Get emergency medical attention immediately.
 When disconnecting the 12-volt battery
Do not disconnect the negative (-) terminal on the body side. The disconnected negative (-) terminal may touch the positive (+) terminal, which may cause a short and result in death or serious injury.
NOTICE  When recharging the 12-volt
battery Never recharge the 12-volt battery while the hybrid system is operating. Also, be sure all accessories are turned off.
Adding the washer fluid
Add washer fluid in the following situations:  A washer does not work.  The warning message
appears on the multi-information display.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 441

WARNING
 When adding washer fluid Do not add washer fluid when the hybrid system is hot or operating as washer fluid contains alcohol and may catch fire if spilled on the engine, etc.

Tires
Replace or rotate tires in accordance with maintenance schedules and treadwear.

NOTICE  Do not use any fluid other
than washer fluid Do not use soapy water or engine antifreeze instead of washer fluid. Doing so may cause streaking on the vehicle's painted surfaces, as well as damaging the pump leading to problems of the washer fluid not spraying.
 Diluting washer fluid Dilute washer fluid with water as necessary. Refer to the freezing temperatures listed on the label of the washer fluid bottle.

Checking tires
Check if the treadwear indicators are showing on the tires. Also check the tires for uneven wear, such as excessive wear on one side of the tread.
Check the spare tire condition and pressure if not rotated.

7

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

New tread Worn tread Treadwear indicator
The location of treadwear indicators is shown by a "TWI" or " " mark,

442 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

etc., molded into the sidewall of each tire. Replace the tires if the treadwear indicators are showing on a tire.
 When to replace your vehicle's tires
Tires should be replaced if:  The treadwear indicators are
showing on a tire  You have tire damage such as
cuts, splits, cracks deep enough to expose the fabric, and bulges indicating internal damage  A tire goes flat repeatedly or cannot be properly repaired due to the size or location of a cut or other damage If you are not sure, consult with your Toyota dealer.  Tire life Any tire over 6 years old must be checked by a qualified technician even if it has seldom or never been used or damage is not obvious.  Maximum load of tire Check that the maximum load of the replacement tire is greater than 1/2 of the Gross Axle Weight Ratings (GAWR) of either the front axle or the rear axle, whichever is greater. For the GAWR, see the Certification Label. For the maximum load of the tire, see the load limit at maximum cold tire inflation pressure mentioned on the sidewall of the tire. (P.533)
 Tire types  Summer tires

Summer tires are high-speed performance tires best suited to highway driving under dry conditions. Since summer tires do not have the same traction performance as snow tires, summer tires are inadequate for driving on snow-covered or icy roads. For driving on snow-covered roads or icy roads, the use of snow tires is recommended. When installing snow tires, be sure to replace all four tires.
 All season tires
All season tires are designed to provide better traction in snow and to be adequate for driving in most winter conditions as well as for use year-round. All season tires, however, do not have adequate traction performance compared with snow tires in heavy or loose snow. Also, all season tires fall short in acceleration and handling performance compared with summer tires in highway driving.
 Snow tires
For driving on snow-covered roads or icy roads, we recommend using snow tires. If you need snow tires, select tires of the same size, construction and load capacity as the originally installed tires. Since your vehicle has radial tires as original equipment, make sure your snow tires also have radial construction. Do not install studded tires without first checking local regulations for possible restrictions. Snow tires should be installed on all wheels. (P.247)
 If the tread on snow tires wears down below 0.16 in. (4 mm)
The effectiveness of the tires as snow tires is lost.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 443

 Checking the tire valves When replacing the tires, check the tire valves for deformation, cracks, and other damage.
WARNING  When inspecting or replacing
tires Observe the following precautions to prevent accidents. Failure to do so may cause damage to parts of the drive train as well as dangerous handling characteristics, which may lead to an accident resulting in death or serious injury. Do not mix tires of different
makes, models or tread patterns. Also, do not mix tires of remarkably different treadwear.

 Driving on rough roads Take particular care when driving on roads with loose surfaces or potholes. These conditions may cause losses in tire inflation pressure, reducing the cushioning ability of the tires. In addition, driving on rough roads may cause damage to the tires themselves, as well as the vehicle's wheels and body.
Tire rotation
Rotate the tires in the order shown.

Do not use tire sizes other than those recommended by Toyota.

Do not mix differently constructed tires (radial, bias-belted or bias-ply tires).

Do not mix summer, all season and snow tires.

Front
To equalize tire wear and extend

7

Do not use tires that have been used on another vehicle.

tire life, Toyota recommends that tire rotation is carried out at the

Do not use tires if you do not know how they were used previously.

same interval as tire inspection. Vehicles with a tire pressure warn-

ing system: Do not fail to initialize

NOTICE

the tire pressure warning system after tire rotation.

 If tire inflation pressure of each tire becomes low while driving
Do not continue driving, or your tires and/or wheels may be ruined.

Tire pressure warning system (if equipped)
Your vehicle is equipped with a tire pressure warning system

that uses tire pressure warning

valves and transmitters to detect

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

444 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

low tire inflation pressure before serious problems arise.
If the tire pressure drops below a predetermined level, the driver is warned by a warning light. (P.482)
 Routine tire inflation pressure checks
The tire pressure warning system does not replace routine tire inflation pressure checks. Make sure to check tire inflation pressure as part of your routine of daily vehicle checks.  Situations in which the tire
pressure warning system may not operate properly  In the following cases, the tire pressure warning system may not operate properly. · If non-genuine Toyota wheels are used. · A tire has been replaced with a tire that is not an OE (Original Equipment) tire. · A tire has been replaced with a tire that is not of the specified size. · Tire chains, etc. are equipped. · An auxiliary-supported run-flat tire is equipped. · If a window tint that affects the radio wave signals is installed. · If there is a lot of snow or ice on the vehicle, particularly around the wheels or wheel housings. · If the tire inflation pressure is extremely higher than the specified level. · If tires not equipped with tire pressure warning valves and transmitters are used. · If the ID code on the tire pressure warning valves and transmitters is not registered in the tire pressure warning computer.  Performance may be affected in the following situations. · Near a TV tower, electric power

plant, gas station, radio station, large display, airport or other facility that generates strong radio waves or electrical noise. · When carrying a portable radio, cellular phone, cordless phone or other wireless communication device.  When the vehicle is parked, the time taken for the warning to start or go off could be extended.  When tire inflation pressure declines rapidly for example when a tire has burst, the warning may not function.  Warning performance of the tire pressure warning system The warning of the tire pressure warning system will change in accordance with driving conditions. For this reason, the system may give a warning even if the tire pressure does not reach a low enough level, or if the pressure is higher than the pressure that was adjusted to when the system was initialized.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance  Tire pressure warning system certification

445

Maintenance and care

7 COROLLA HV_U

446 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

Installing tire pressure warning valves and transmitters (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system)

When replacing tires or wheels, tire pressure warning valves and transmitters must also be installed.
When new tire pressure warning

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 447

valves and transmitters are installed, new ID codes must be registered in the tire pressure warning computer and the tire pressure warning system must be initialized. Have tire pressure warning valves and transmitter ID codes registered by your Toyota dealer. (P.449)
 Replacing tires and wheels

 To avoid damage to the tire pressure warning valves and transmitters
When a tire is repaired with liquid sealants, the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter may not operate properly. If a liquid sealant is used, contact your Toyota dealer or other qualified service shop as soon as possible. Make sure to replace the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter when replacing the tire. (P.446)

If the ID code of the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter is not registered, the tire pressure warning system will not work properly. After driving for about 20 minutes, the tire pressure warning light blinks for 1 minute and stays on to indicate a system malfunction.

Initializing the tire pressure warning system (if equipped)
 The tire pressure warning system must be initialized

NOTICE

in the following circumstances:

 Repairing or replacing tires, wheels, tire pressure warn-

 When rotating front and rear

ing valves, transmitters and

tires which have different tire

tire valve caps

inflation pressures.

When removing or fitting the wheels, tires or the tire pressure warning valves and transmitters, contact your Toyota dealer as the tire pressure warning

 When changing the tire size.
 When the tire inflation pressure is changed such as

7

valves and transmitters may be damaged if not handled correctly.

when changing traveling speed or load weight.

Make sure to install the tire valve caps. If the tire valve caps are not installed, water could enter the tire pressure warning valves and the tire pressure warning valves could be bound.

 When changing between two registered wheel sets.
When the tire pressure warning system is initialized, the current tire inflation pressure is set as

When replacing tire valve caps, do not use tire valve caps other than those specified. The cap may become stuck.

the benchmark pressure.
 How to initialize the tire pressure warning system

1 Park the vehicle in a safe place and turn the power

switch off.

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

448 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

Initialization cannot be performed while the vehicle is moving.
2 Adjust the tire inflation pressure to the specified cold tire inflation pressure level. (P.529)
Make sure to adjust the tire pressure to the specified cold tire inflation pressure level. The tire pressure warning system will operate based on this pressure level.
3 Turn the power switch to ON.
4 Press or of the meter control switch to select .
5 Press or to select "Vehicle Settings" and then
press and hold .
6 Press or to select
"TPWS" and then press .
7 Press or to select "Set Pressure". Then press and
hold until the tire pressure warning light blinks 3 times.

Also, make sure the tires are cold before carrying out initialization or tire inflation pressure adjustment.  If you have accidentally turned the power switch off during initialization, it is not necessary to press the reset switch again as initialization will restart automatically when the power switch to ON for the next time.  If initialization has accidentally been started when it is not necessary, adjust the tire inflation pressure to the specified level when the tires are cold, and then perform the initialization procedure again.
 When initialization of the tire pressure warning system has failed
Initialization can be completed in a few minutes. However, in the following cases, the settings have not been recorded and the system will not operate properly. If repeated attempts to record tire inflation pressure settings are unsuccessful, have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.  When attempting to start initializa-
tion, the tire pressure warning light does not blink 3 times.  After driving for a certain period of time since the initialization has been completed, the warning light comes on after blinking for 1 minute.

 Initialization procedure  Make sure to carry out initializa-
tion after adjusting the tire inflation pressure.
COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 449

WARNING
 When initializing the tire pressure warning system
Do not initialize the tire pressure warning system without first adjusting the tire inflation pressure to the specified level. Otherwise, the tire pressure warning light may not come on even if the tire inflation pressure is low, or it may come on when the tire inflation pressure is actually normal.
Registering ID codes
The tire pressure warning valve and transmitter is equipped with a unique ID code. When replacing a tire pressure warning valve and transmitter, it is necessary to register the ID code. Have the ID code registered by your Toyota dealer.

second wheel set has been registered. If no second wheel set has been registered, no change will be made when selecting this function in the menu.
 Only a change between both registered wheel set is possible, mixing between these wheel sets is not supported.
 How to change between wheel sets
1 Have the vehicle fitted with the preferred wheel set.
2 Press or of the meter
control switch to select .
3 Press or to select "Vehicle Settings" and then
press .

Selecting wheel set

4 Press or to select

Your vehicle is equipped with

"TPWS" and then press . 7

tire pressure warning system with the function to have ID codes registered for a second wheel set, for example a winter

5 Press or to select "Change Wheel". Then press
and hold until the tire

set, by Toyota dealer.

pressure warning light blinks

After registration of a second

slowly 3 times.

wheel set, either of these two

wheel sets can be selected for

usage with the tire pressure

warning system.

 Operating conditions for the function

 This function will perform the change of wheel set only if a

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

450 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

6 Initialize the tire pressure warning system. (P.447)

Tire inflation pressure
Checking the specified tire inflation pressure

The recommended cold tire inflation pressure and tire size are displayed on the tire and loading information label. (P.529)

COROLLA HV_U

Inspection and adjustment procedure
Tire valve

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 451

Tire pressure gauge
1 Remove the tire valve cap.
2 Press the tip of the tire pressure gauge onto the tire valve.
3 Read the pressure using the gauge gradations.
4 If the tire inflation pressure is not at the recommended level, adjust the pressure. If you add too much air, press the center of the valve to deflate.
5 After completing the tire inflation pressure measurement and adjustment, apply soapy water to the valve and check for leakage.
6 Put the tire valve cap back on.

 Instructions for checking tire inflation pressure
When checking tire inflation pressure, observe the following:  Check only when the tires are
cold. If your vehicle has been parked for at least 3 hours or has not been driven for more than 1 mile or 1.5 km, you will get an accurate cold tire inflation pressure reading.  Always use a tire pressure gauge. It is difficult to judge if a tire is properly inflated based only on its appearance.  It is normal for the tire inflation pressure to be higher after driving as heat is generated in the tire. Do not reduce tire inflation pressure after driving.  Never exceed the vehicle capacity weight. Passengers and luggage weight should be placed so that the vehicle is balanced.
WARNING

 Tire inflation pressure check interval
You should check tire inflation pressure every two weeks, or at least once a month. Do not forget to check the spare.

 Proper inflation is critical to save tire performance
Keep your tires properly inflated. If the tires are not properly inflated, the following conditions may occur which could lead to an accident resulting in death or seri-

7

 Effects of incorrect tire inflation ous injury:

pressure Driving with incorrect tire inflation

 Excessive wear

pressure may result in the following:  Uneven wear

 Reduced fuel economy  Reduced driving comfort and poor
handling  Reduced tire life due to wear

 Poor handling  Possibility of blowouts resulting
from overheated tires

 Reduced safety  Damage to the drive train

 Air leaking from between tire and wheel

If a tire needs frequent inflating, have it checked by your Toyota dealer.

 Wheel deformation and/or tire damage

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

452 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

WARNING Greater possibility of tire dam-
age while driving (due to road hazards, expansion joints, sharp edges in the road, etc.)
NOTICE  When inspecting and adjust-
ing tire inflation pressure Be sure to put the tire valve caps back on. If a valve cap is not installed, dirt or moisture may get into the valve and cause an air leak, resulting in decreased tire inflation pressure.

Wheels
If a wheel is bent, cracked or heavily corroded, it should be replaced. Otherwise, the tire may separate from the wheel or cause a loss of handling control.
Wheel selection
When replacing wheels, care should be taken to ensure that they are equivalent to those removed in load capacity, diameter, rim width and inset*.
Replacement wheels are available at your Toyota dealer.
*: Conventionally referred to as offset.
Toyota does not recommend using the following:
 Wheels of different sizes or types
 Used wheels
 Bent wheels that have been straightened

 When replacing wheels (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system)
The wheels of your vehicle are equipped with tire pressure warning valves and transmitters that allow the tire pressure warning system to provide advance warning in the event of a loss in tire inflation pressure. Whenever wheels are replaced, the tire pressure warning valves and transmitters must be installed. (P.446)

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 453

WARNING

NOTICE

 When replacing wheels Do not use wheels that are a dif-
ferent size from those recommended in the Owner's Manual, as this may result in a loss of handling control.
Never use an inner tube in a leaking wheel which is designed for a tubeless tire. Doing so may result in an accident, causing death or serious injury.
 When installing the wheel nuts
Never use oil or grease on the wheel bolts or wheel nuts. Oil and grease may cause the wheel nuts to be excessively tightened, leading to bolt or disc wheel damage. In addition, the oil or grease can cause the wheel nuts to loosen and the wheel may fall off, causing an accident and resulting in death or serious injury. Remove any oil or grease from the wheel bolts or wheel nuts.

 Replacing tire pressure warning valves and transmitters (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system)
 Because tire repair or replacement may affect the tire pressure warning valves and transmitters, make sure to have tires serviced by your Toyota dealer or other qualified service shop. In addition, make sure to purchase your tire pressure warning valves and transmitters at your Toyota dealer.
 Ensure that only genuine Toyota wheels are used on your vehicle. Tire pressure warning valves and transmitters may not work properly with non-genuine wheels.
Aluminum wheel precautions
 Use only Toyota wheel nuts

 Use of defective wheels prohibited

and wheel nut wrenches designed for use with your

7

Do not use cracked or deformed wheels. Doing so could cause the tire to leak air during driving, possibly causing an accident.

aluminum wheels.
 When rotating, repairing or changing your tires, check

that the wheel nuts are still

tight after driving 1000 miles

(1600 km).

 Be careful not to damage the aluminum wheels when using tire chains.

 Use only Toyota genuine balance weights or equivalent and a plastic or rubber hammer when balancing your wheels.

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

454 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

Air conditioning filter
The air conditioning filter must be changed regularly to maintain air conditioning efficiency.

claws ( ), and remove the filter cover.

Removing the air conditioning filter
1 Turn the power switch off. 2 Open the glove box. Slide off
the damper.

5 Remove the filter case.

3 Push in the glove box on the vehicle's outer side to discon-
nect the claws. Then pull out
the glove box and disconnect
the lower claws.

6 Remove the air conditioning filter from the filter case and replace it with a new one.
The " UP" marks shown on the filter and the filter case should be pointing up.

4 Unlock the filter cover ( ), pull the filter cover out of the

 Checking interval Replace the air conditioning filter according to the maintenance schedule. In dusty areas or areas with heavy traffic flow, early replace-

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 455

ment may be required. (For scheduled maintenance information, please refer to the "Scheduled Maintenance Guide" or "Owner's Manual Supplement".)  If air flow from the vents
decreases dramatically The filter may be clogged. Check the filter and replace if necessary.
NOTICE  When using the air condition-
ing system Make sure that a filter is always installed. Using the air conditioning system without a filter may cause damage to the system.  To prevent damage to the fil-
ter cover When moving the filter cover in the direction of arrow to release the fitting, pay attention not to apply excessive force to the claws. Otherwise, the claws may be damaged.

Cleaning the hybrid battery (traction battery) air intake vent and filter
To prevent the fuel economy from being affected, visually inspect the hybrid battery (traction battery) air intake vent periodically for dust and clogs. If it is dusty or clogged or if "Maintenance Required for Traction Battery Cooling Parts See Owner's Manual" is displayed on the multi-information display, clean the air intake vent using the following procedures:
Cleaning the air intake vent

Remove the dust from the air

7

intake vent with a vacuum

cleaner, etc.

Make sure to only use a vacuum to suck out dust and clogs. Attempting to blow out dust and clogs using an airgun, etc. may push it into the air intake vent. (P.458)

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

456 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

If dust and clogs cannot be completely removed

4 Remove the air intake vent filter.

If dust and clogs cannot be completely removed with the air intake vent cover installed, remove the cover and clean the filter. 1 Turn the power switch off. 2 Using a Phillips screwdriver,
remove the clip.
3 Remove the air intake vent cover.

Disengage the claw as shown in the illustration.
Remove the filter from the cover.
5 Remove the dust and clogs from the filter using a vacuum cleaner, etc.
Make sure to also remove the dust and clogs from the inside of the air intake vent cover.

Pull the cover as shown in the illustration to disengage the 3 claws, starting from the claw in the upper right corner.
Pull the cover toward the front of the vehicle to remove it.

6 Reinstall the filter to the cover.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 457

Engage the filter to the 2 claws as shown in the illustration.

intake vent may need to be cleaned more regularly. For details, refer to "Scheduled Maintenance Guide" or "Owner's Manual Supplement".

Engage the claw to install the filter.
Make sure that the filter is not crooked or deformed when installing it.
7 Install the air intake vent cover.

 Cleaning the air intake vent  Dust in the air intake vent may
interfere with the cooling of the hybrid battery (traction battery). If charging/discharging of the hybrid battery (traction battery) becomes limited, the distance that the vehicle can be driven using the electric motor (traction motor) may be reduced and the fuel economy may be reduced. Inspect and clean the air intake vent periodically.

 Improper handling of the air intake vent cover and filter may result in damage to them. If you have any concerns about cleaning the filter, contact your Toyota dealer.

 If "Maintenance Required for Traction Battery Cooling Parts

Insert the tab of the cover as shown in the illustration.

See Owner's Manual" is displayed on the multi-information display

Push the cover to engage the If this warning message is dis-

3 claws.

played on the multi-information

8 Using a Phillips screwdriver,

display, remove the air intake vent

cover and clean the filter.

7

install the clip.

(P.456)

 Scheduled maintenance of the air intake vent is necessary when

 After cleaning the air intake vent, start the hybrid system and check that the warning message is no longer displayed. After the hybrid system is started, it may be necessary to drive the vehicle up to approximately 20 minutes before the warning message disappears. If the warning message does not disappear after driving for appropriately 20 minutes, have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

In some situations such as when the vehicle is used frequently or in heavy traffic or dusty areas, the air

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

458 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

WARNING  When cleaning the air intake
vent Do not use water or other liq-
uids to clean the air intake vent. If water is applied to the hybrid battery (traction battery) or other components, a malfunction or fire may occur. Before cleaning the air intake vent, make sure to turn the power switch off to stop the hybrid system.  When removing the air intake vent cover Do not touch the service plug located near the air intake vent. (P.84)
NOTICE  When cleaning the air intake
vent When cleaning the air intake vent, make sure to only use a vacuum to suck out dust and clogs. If a compressed air blow gun, etc. is used to blow out dust and clogs, the dust or clogs may be pushed into the air intake vent, which may affect the performance of the hybrid battery (traction battery) and cause a malfunction.

 To prevent damage to the vehicle
 Do not allow liquid or foreign material to enter the air intake vent when the cover is removed.
 Carefully handle the removed filter so that it will not be damaged. If the filter is damaged, have it replaced with a new filter by your Toyota dealer.
 Make sure to reinstall the filter and cover to their original positions after cleaning.
 Do not install anything to the air intake vent other than the exclusive filter for this vehicle or use the vehicle without the filter installed.
 If "Maintenance Required for Traction Battery Cooling Parts See Owner's Manual" is displayed on the multi-information display
If the vehicle is continuously driven with the warning message (indicating that charging/discharging of the hybrid battery [traction battery] may become limited) displayed, the hybrid battery (traction battery) may malfunction. If the warning message is displayed, clean the air intake vent immediately.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 459

Electronic key battery
Replace the battery with a new one if it is depleted. As the key may be damaged if the following procedure is not performed properly, it is recommended that key battery replacement be performed by your Toyota dealer.

Replacing the battery
1 Release the lock and remove the mechanical key.

 If the electronic key battery is depleted
The following symptoms may occur:  The smart key system and wire-
less remote control will not function properly.  The operational range will be reduced.

2 Remove the key cover.
To prevent damage to the key, cover the tip of the flathead screwdriver with a rag.

Items to prepare

 Flathead screwdriver

 Small flathead screwdriver

7

 Lithium battery CR2032
 Use a CR2032 lithium battery  Batteries can be purchased at
your Toyota dealer, local electrical appliance shops or camera stores.  Replace only with the same or equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer.  Dispose of used batteries according to local laws.

3 Remove the depleted battery using a small flathead screwdriver.
When removing the cover, the electronic key module may stick to the cover and the battery may not be visible. In this case, remove the electronic key module in order to remove the battery. Insert a new battery with the "+" ter-

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

460 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

minal facing up.

 Do not touch or move any other component inside the remote control.

 Do not bend either of the battery terminals.

4 When installing the key cover and mechanical key, install by conducting step 2 and step 1 with the directions reversed.
5 Operate the or switch and check that the doors can be locked/unlocked.
WARNING  Removed battery and other
parts These parts are small and if swallowed by a child, they can cause choking. Keep away from children. Failure to do so could result in death or serious injury.
NOTICE  When replacing the battery Use a flathead screwdriver of appropriate size. Applying excessive force may deform or damage the cover.
 For normal operation after replacing the battery
Observe the following precautions to prevent accidents: Always work with dry hands.
Moisture may cause the battery to rust.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 461

Checking and replacing fuses
If any of the electrical components do not operate, a fuse may have blown. If this happens, check and replace the fuses as necessary.

 Under the driver's side instrument panel
Remove the lid.
Make sure to push the claw when removing/installing the lid.

Checking and replacing fuses
1 Turn the power switch off. 2 Open the fuse box cover.  Engine compartment: type A
fuse box
Push the tabs in and lift the lid off.

3 Remove the fuse with the pullout tool.
Only type A fuse can be
removed using the pullout
tool.

7

 Engine compartment: type B fuse box
Push the tabs in and lift the lid off.

4 Check if the fuse is blown.
Replace the blown fuse with a new fuse of an appropriate amperage rating. The amperage rating can be found on the fuse box lid.

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

462 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

 Type A

 Type D

Normal fuse Blown fuse  Type B
Normal fuse Blown fuse  Type C
Normal fuse Blown fuse

Normal fuse Blown fuse
 After a fuse is replaced  When installing the lid, make sure
that the tab is installed securely.  If the lights do not turn on even
after the fuse has been replaced, a bulb may need replacement. (P.463)  If the replaced fuse blows again, have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.  If there is an overload in a circuit The fuses are designed to blow, protecting the wiring harness from damage.  When replacing light bulbs Toyota recommends that you use genuine Toyota products designed for this vehicle. Because certain bulbs are connected to circuits designed to prevent overload, non-genuine parts of parts not designed for this vehicle may be unusable.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 463

WARNING  To prevent system break-
downs and vehicle fire Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may cause damage to the vehicle, and possibly a fire or injury. Never use a fuse of a higher
amperage rating than that indicated, or use any other object in place of a fuse. Always use a genuine Toyota fuse or equivalent. Never replace a fuse with a wire, even as a temporary fix.

Light bulbs
You may replace the following bulbs yourself. The difficulty level of replacement varies depending on the bulb. If necessary bulb replacement seems difficult to perform, contact your Toyota dealer.
For more information about replacing other light bulbs, contact your Toyota dealer.

Do not modify the fuses or fuse boxes.

Preparing for light bulb replacement

NOTICE

Check the wattage of the light

 Before replacing fuses

bulb to be replaced. (P.530)

Have the cause of electrical over-

load determined and repaired by your Toyota dealer as soon as

Bulb locations

possible.

 Front

7

Front side marker lights

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

464 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

 Rear
Back-up lights Rear turn signal lights Rear side marker lights  Bulbs that need to be replaced by your Toyota dealer  Headlights/daytime running lights  Parking lights  Front turn signal lights  Tail lights  Stop lights  High mounted stoplight  License plate lights

has a ventilation hole, moist air may enter. If the ambient temperature is low, condensation may form temporarily, but it will dissipate as the inside of the light is warmed up. As the condensation is due to a phenomenon similar to windows fogging in the rain, it does not indicate a malfunction. Contact your Toyota dealer for more information in the following situations:  Large drops of water have built up
on the inside of the lens.  Water has built up inside the
headlight.  When replacing light bulbs P.462
Replacing light bulbs
 Front side marker lights 1 Turn the bulb base counter-
clockwise.

 LED light bulbs The lights other than the front side marker lights, rear turn signal lights, rear side marker lights and back-up lights consist of a number of LEDs. If any of the LEDs burn out, take your vehicle to your Toyota dealer to have the light replaced.  Condensation build-up on the
inside of the lens In certain situations, such as when driving in the rain or when washing the vehicle, condensation may form on the inner side of the headlight lens and other lights. As each light

2 Remove the light bulb.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance 465

3 When installing, reverse the steps listed.
 Rear turn signal lights and rear side marker lights
1 Open the trunk lid.
2 Insert a flathead screwdriver between the cover and the light assembly and pry up the cover to disengage the claws (indicated by a dotted line).
To prevent scratching the vehicle, wrap the tip of the flathead screwdriver with a cloth, etc.

4 Remove the 2 screws and then remove the light assembly by pulling it straight back.
5 Turn the bulb base counterclockwise.

3 Pull the cover toward the rear of the vehicle and remove the

Rear side marker lights

cover.

Rear turn signal lights

7

6 Remove the light bulb.

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

Rear side marker lights
Rear turn signal lights 7 When installing the light bulb,
install it by conducting steps

466 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance

6 and 5 with the directions reversed.
8 Install the light assembly and then install the 2 screws.

2 Turn the bulb base counterclockwise and remove it.

Align the guide and pin on the light assembly with the mounting when installing it.

3 Remove the light bulb.

9 Install the cover.
 Back-up lights
1 Open the trunk lid, remove the clips, and pull back the cover.

4 When installing, reverse the steps listed.
WARNING  Replacing light bulbs  Turn off the lights. Do not
attempt to replace the bulb immediately after turning off the lights. The bulbs become very hot and may cause burns.
 Do not touch the glass portion of the light bulb with bare hands. When it is unavoidable to hold the glass portion, use and hold with a clean dry cloth to avoid getting moisture and oils on the bulb. Also, if the bulb is scratched or dropped, it may blow out or crack.

COROLLA HV_U

7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance
WARNING Fully install light bulbs and any
parts used to secure them. Failure to do so may result in heat damage, fire, or water entering the light unit. This may damage the lights or cause condensation to build up on the lens.  To prevent damage or fire Make sure bulbs are fully seated and locked.

467

7

Maintenance and care

COROLLA HV_U

468 7-3. Do-it-yourself maintenance
COROLLA HV_U

469
8 When trouble arises

.8-1. Essential information
Emergency flashers .... 470
If your vehicle has to be stopped in an emergency .................................. 471
If the vehicle is trapped in rising water................ 472
8-2. Steps to take in an emergency
If your vehicle needs to be towed......................... 473
If you think something is wrong ........................ 476
If a warning light turns on or a warning buzzer sounds .................................. 478
If a warning message is displayed........................ 487
If you have a flat tire (vehicles without spare tire) .................................. 490
If you have a flat tire (vehicles with a spare tire) .................................. 501
If the hybrid system will not start ........................... 509
If you lose your keys ... 510
If the fuel filler door cannot be opened ................. 511
If the electronic key does not operate properly .. 511
If the 12-volt battery is discharged ..................... 513

If your vehicle overheats .................................. 517
If the vehicle becomes stuck .................................. 520
8

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

470 8-1. Essential information
8-1.Essential information
Emergency flashers
The emergency flashers are used to warn other drivers when the vehicle has to be stopped on the road due to a breakdown, etc.

conditions of the collision.)

Operating instructions
Press the switch.
All the turn signal lights will flash. To turn them off, press the switch once again.

 Emergency flashers  If the emergency flashers are
used for a long time while the hybrid system is not operating (while the "READY" indicator is not illuminated), the 12-volt battery may discharge.  If any of the SRS airbags deploy (inflate) or in the event of a strong rear impact, the emergency flashers will turn on automatically. The emergency flashers will turn off automatically after operating for approximately 20 minutes. To manually turn the emergency flashers off, press the switch twice. (The emergency flashers may not turn on automatically depending on the force of the impact and
COROLLA HV_U

If your vehicle has to be stopped in an emergency

8-1. Essential information 471
briefly 3 times or more in succession.

Only in an emergency, such as if it becomes impossible to stop the vehicle in the normal way, stop the vehicle using the following procedure:
Stopping the vehicle

5 Stop the vehicle in a safe place by the road.

1 Steadily step on the brake pedal with both feet and firmly depress it.
Do not pump the brake pedal repeatedly as this will increase the effort required to slow the vehicle.
2 Shift the shift lever to N.
 If the shift lever is shifted to N
3 After slowing down, stop the vehicle in a safe place by the road.

WARNING
 If the hybrid system has to be turned off while driving
Power assist for the steering wheel will be lost, making the steering wheel heavier to turn. Decelerate as much as possible before turning off the hybrid system.

4 Stop the hybrid system.

 If the shift lever cannot be

8

shifted to N

3 Keep depressing the brake pedal with both feet to reduce
vehicle speed as much as
possible.

4 To stop the hybrid system, press and hold the power
switch for 2 consecutive sec-
onds or more, or press it

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

472 8-1. Essential information

If the vehicle is trapped in rising water
In the event the vehicle is submerged in water, remain calm and perform the following.
 Remove the seat belt first.
 If the door can be opened, open the door and exit the vehicle.
 If the door can not be opened, open the window using the power window switch and exit the vehicle through the window.
 If the window can not be opened using the power window switch, remain calm, wait until the water level inside the vehicle rises to the point that the water pressure inside of the vehicle equals the water pressure outside of the vehicle, and then open the door and exit the vehicle.

WARNING
 Using an emergency hammer* for emergency escape
The front side windows and rear side windows, as well as the rear window can be shattered with an emergency hammer* used for emergency escape. However, an emergency hammer* can not shatter the windshield as it is laminated glass. *: Contact your Toyota dealer or
aftermarket accessory manufacturer for further information about an emergency hammer.
 Escaping the vehicle from the window
There are cases where escaping the vehicle from the window is not possible due to seating position, passenger body type, etc. When using an emergency hammer, consider your seat location and the size of the window opening to ensure that the opening is accessible and large enough to escape.

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 473

8-2.Steps to take in an emergency
If your vehicle needs to be towed
If towing is necessary, we recommend having your vehicle towed by your Toyota dealer or commercial towing service, using a wheel-lift type truck or flatbed truck.
Use a safety chain system for all towing, and abide by all state/provincial and local laws.
WARNING
Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in death or serious injury.

 While towing  When towing using cables or
chains, avoid sudden starts, etc. which place excessive stress on the towing eyelets, cables or chains. The towing eyelets, cables or chains may become damaged, broken debris may hit people, and cause serious damage.  Do not turn the power switch off. There is a possibility that the steering wheel is locked and cannot be operated.  Installing towing eyelets to the vehicle Make sure that towing eyelets are installed securely. If not securely installed, towing eyelets may come loose during towing.
NOTICE

 When towing the vehicle Be sure to transport the vehicle with the front wheels raised or

 To prevent damage to the vehicle when towing using a wheel-lift type truck

with all four wheels raised off the

 Do not tow the vehicle from the

ground. If the vehicle is towed

rear when the power switch is

with the front wheels contacting

off. The steering lock mecha-

the ground, the drivetrain and

nism is not strong enough to

related parts may be damaged or electricity generated by the operation of the motor may cause a fire to occur depending on the nature of the damage or malfunction.

hold the front wheels straight.  When raising the vehicle,
ensure adequate ground clearance for towing at the opposite end of the raised vehicle. With-

8

out adequate clearance, the

vehicle could be damaged while

being towed.

 To prevent damage to the vehicle when towing with a sling-type truck
Do not tow with a sling-type truck, either from the front or rear.

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

474 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

NOTICE
 To prevent damage to the vehicle during emergency towing
Do not secure cables or chains to the suspension components.

 From the rear

Situations when it is necessary to contact dealers before towing
The following may indicate a problem with your transmission. Contact your Toyota dealer or commercial towing service before towing.
 The hybrid system warning message is shown on the multi-information display and the vehicle does not move.
 The vehicle makes an abnormal sound.

Use a towing dolly under the front wheels.
NOTICE  Towing with a sling-type truck Do not tow with a sling-type truck to prevent body damage.

Towing with a wheel-lift type truck
 From the front
Release the parking brake. Turn automatic mode off. (P.168)

Using a flatbed truck
When using a flat-bed truck to transport the vehicle, use tire strapping belts. Refer to the owner's manual of the flat-bed truck for the tire strapping method. In order to suppress vehicle movement during transportation, set the parking brake and turn the power switch off.
Emergency towing
If a tow truck is not available in

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 475

an emergency, your vehicle may be temporarily towed using cables or chains secured to the emergency towing eyelets. This should only be attempted on hard surfaced roads for short distances at under 18 mph (30 km/h). A driver must be in the vehicle to steer and operate the brakes. The vehicle's wheels, drive train, axles, steering and brakes must be in good condition.

illustration.

Emergency towing procedure

3 Insert the towing eyelet into the hole and tighten partially
by hand.

To have your vehicle towed by

another vehicle, the towing eye-

let must be installed to your

vehicle. Install the towing eyelet

using the following procedure.

1 Take out the wheel nut wrench(if equipped) and tow-

ing eyelet. (P.492, 502)

2 Remove the eyelet cover

4 Tighten down the towing eye-

using a flathead screwdriver.

let securely using a wheel nut 8

To protect the bodywork, place a

wrench (if equipped) or hard

rag between the screwdriver and

metal bar.

the vehicle body as shown in the

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

5 Securely attach cables or chains to the towing eyelet.

476 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

Take care not to damage the vehicle body.
6 Enter the vehicle being towed and start the hybrid system.
If the hybrid system does not start, turn the power switch to ON.
7 Shift the shift lever to N and release the parking brake. Turn automatic mode off. (P.168) When the shift lever cannot be shifted: P.165

If you think something is wrong
If you notice any of the following symptoms, your vehicle probably needs adjustment or repair. Contact your Toyota dealer as soon as possible.
Visible symptoms

 While towing If the hybrid system is off, the power assist for the brakes and steering will not function, making steering and braking more difficult.
 Wheel nut wrench Vehicle without wheel nut wrench: Wheel nut wrench can be purchased at your Toyota dealer. Vehicle with wheel nut wrench: Wheel nut wrench is installed in trunk. (P.502)

 Fluid leaks under the vehicle. (Water dripping from the air conditioning after use is normal.)
 Flat-looking tires or uneven tire wear
 Engine coolant temperature gauge needle continually points higher than normal.
Audible symptoms

 Changes in exhaust sound
 Excessive tire squeal when cornering
 Strange noises related to the suspension system
 Pinging or other noises related to the hybrid system

Operational symptoms
 Engine missing, stumbling or running roughly
 Appreciable loss of power  Vehicle pulls heavily to one

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency
side when braking
 Vehicle pulls heavily to one side when driving on a level road
 Loss of brake effectiveness, spongy feeling, pedal almost touches the floor

477

When trouble arises

8 COROLLA HV_U

478 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency
If a warning light turns on or a warning buzzer sounds
Calmly perform the following actions if any of the warning lights comes on or flashes. If a light comes on or flashes, but then goes off, this does not necessarily indicate a malfunction in the system. However, if this continues to occur, have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

Actions to the warning lights or warning buzzers

 Brake system warning light (warning buzzer)

Warning light

Details/Actions

(U.S.A.) or
(Red) (Canada)

Indicates that:  The brake fluid level is low; or  The brake system is malfunctioning
 Immediately stop the vehicle in a safe place and contact your Toyota dealer. Continuing to drive the vehicle may be dangerous.

 Brake system warning light

Warning light

Details/Actions

(Yellow)

Indicates a malfunction in:  The regenerative braking system;  The electronically controlled brake system; or  The parking brake system
 Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.

 High coolant temperature warning light* (warning buzzer)

Warning light

Details/Actions

Indicates that the engine coolant temperature is excessively high
 Immediately stop the vehicle in a safe place. Handling method (P.517)

*: This light illuminates on the multi-information display.

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 479
 Hybrid system overheat warning light* (warning buzzer)

Warning light

Details/Actions

Indicates that the temperature of the hybrid system is excessively high  Stop the vehicle in a safe place.
Handling method (P.517)
*: This light illuminates on the multi-information display.
 Charging system warning light

Warning light

Details/Actions

Indicates a malfunction in the vehicle's charging system
 Immediately stop the vehicle in a safe place and contact your Toyota dealer.

 Low engine oil pressure warning light* (warning buzzer)

Warning light

Details/Actions

Indicates that the engine oil pressure is excessively low
 Immediately stop the vehicle in a safe place and contact your Toyota dealer.

*: This light illuminates on the multi-information display.
 Malfunction indicator lamp (warning buzzer)

Warning light

Details/Actions

(U.S.A.) or

Indicates a malfunction in:  The hybrid system;  The electronic engine control system; or  The electronic throttle control system

8

(Canada)

 Immediately stop the vehicle in a safe place and contact your Toyota dealer.

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

480 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

 SRS warning light (warning buzzer)

Warning light

Details/Actions

Indicates a malfunction in:  The SRS airbag system;  The front passenger occupant classification system; or  The seat belt pretensioner system
 Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.

 ABS warning light

Warning light

Details/Actions

(U.S.A.) or
(Canada)

Indicates a malfunction in:  The ABS; or  The brake assist system
 Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.

 Brake Override System warning light/Drive-Start Control warning light* (warning buzzer)

Warning light

Details/Actions

When a buzzer sounds:

Indicates a malfunction in:  The Brake Override System; or  The Drive-Start Control
 Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.

Indicates that the shift position was changed and Drive-Start Control was operated while depressing the accelerator pedal.
 Momentarily release the accelerator pedal.
When a buzzer does not sound:

Indicates that the accelerator and brake pedals are being depressed simultaneously, and the Brake Override System is operating.
 Release the accelerator pedal and depress the brake pedal.

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency
*: This light illuminates on the multi-information display.
 Electric power steering system warning light (warning buzzer)

Warning light

Details/Actions

481

(Red) or

Indicates a malfunction in the EPS (Electric Power Steering) system
 Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.

(Yellow)

 Low fuel level warning light

Warning light

Details/Actions

Indicates that remaining fuel is approximately 1.7 gal. (6.4 L , 1.4 Imp. gal.) or less
 Refuel the vehicle.

 Driver's and front passenger's seat belt reminder light (warning buzzer)*

Warning light

Details/Actions

Warns the driver and/or front passenger to fasten their seat

belts

 Fasten the seat belt.

If the front passenger's seat is occupied, the front

passenger's seat belt also needs to be fastened to

8

make the warning light (warning buzzer) turn off.

*: Driver's seat belt warning buzzer:
The driver's seat belt warning buzzer sounds to alert the driver that his or her seat belt is not fastened. Once the power switch is turned to ON, the buzzer sounds. If the seat belt is still unfastened, the buzzer sounds intermittently for a certain period of time after the vehicle reaches a certain speed.
Front passenger's seat belt warning buzzer:
The front passenger's seat belt warning buzzer sounds to alert the front passenger that his or her seat belt is not fastened. If the seat belt is unfastened, the buzzer sounds intermittently for a certain period of time after the vehicle reaches a certain speed.

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

482 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency
 Rear passengers' seat belt reminder lights (warning buzzer)*

Warning light

Details/Actions

Warns the rear passengers to fasten their seat belts  Fasten the seat belt.

*: Rear passengers' seat belt warning buzzer:
The rear passengers' seat belt warning buzzer sounds to alert the rear passenger that his or her seat belt is not fastened. If the seat belt is unfastened, the buzzer sounds intermittently for a certain period of time, after the seat belt is fastened and unfastened and the vehicle reaches a certain speed.
 Tire pressure warning light

Warning light

Details/Actions

When the light comes on after blinking for approximately 1 minute:
Malfunction in the tire pressure warning system  Have the system checked by your Toyota dealer.
When the light comes on:
(if equipped) Low tire inflation pressure such as  Natural causes  Flat tire  Immediately stop the vehicle in a safe place. Handling method (P.485)

 LTA indicator (warning buzzer)

Warning light

Details/Actions

(Orange)

Indicates a malfunction in the LTA (Lane Tracing Assist)
 Follow the instructions displayed on the multi-information display. (P.206)

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 483

 RCTA OFF indicator (warning buzzer)

Warning light

Details/Actions

(Flashes) (if equipped)

Indicates a malfunction in the RCTA (Rear Cross Traffic Alert) function
 Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.
Indicates that the rear bumper around the radar sensor is covered with dirt, etc. (P.223)  Follow the instructions displayed on the multi-infor-
mation display. (P.227)

 PCS warning light

Warning light

Details/Actions

When a buzzer sounds simultaneously:

Indicates a malfunction has occurred in the PCS (Pre-Collision System).
 Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.

If a buzzer does not sound:

The PCS (Pre-Collision System) has become temporarily
(Flashes or illu- unavailable, corrective action may be necessary. minates)  Follow the instructions displayed on the multi-information display. (P.187)

If the PCS (Pre-Collision System) or VSC (Vehicle Stability

Control) system is disabled, the PCS warning light will illu-

minate.

8

 P.196

 Slip indicator

Warning light

Details/Actions

Indicates a malfunction in:  The VSC system;  The TRAC system; or  The hill-start assist control system
 Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

484 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

 Parking brake indicator

Warning light

Details/Actions

(Flashes) (U.S.A.)
or
(Flashes) (Canada)

It is possible that the parking brake is not fully engaged or released
 Operate the parking brake switch once again.
This light comes on when the parking brake is not released. If the light turns off after the parking brake is fully released, the system is operating normally.

 Brake hold operated indicator

Warning light

Details/Actions

(Flashes)

Indicates a malfunction in the brake hold system
 Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.

 Warning buzzer In some cases, the buzzer may not be heard due to being in a noisy location or audio sound.  Front passenger detection sen-
sor, seat belt reminder and warning buzzer  If luggage is placed on the front passenger seat, the front passenger detection sensor may cause the warning light to flash and the warning buzzer to sound even if a passenger is not sitting in the seat.  If a cushion is placed on the seat, the sensor may not detect a passenger, and the warning light may not operate properly.  Operation of rear passengers' seat belt reminder lights  The rear passengers' seat belt reminder lights will illuminate for approximately 60 seconds after either rear door has been opened and closed.

 If any rear seat belt is fastened and then unfastened, the corresponding light for that seat will illuminate continuously. If either rear door is opened and closed while a rear passengers' seat belt light is illuminated, it will turn off approximately 60 seconds after the door is closed.
 SRS warning light This warning light system monitors the airbag sensor assembly, front impact sensors, side impact sensors (front door), side impact sensors (front), side impact sensors (rear), driver's seat position sensor, driver's seat belt buckle switch, front passenger occupant classification system (ECU and sensors), "AIR BAG ON" indicator light, "AIR BAG OFF" indicator light, seat belt pretensioners, airbags, interconnecting wiring and power sources. (P.32)  Electric power steering system
warning light (warning buzzer) When the 12-volt battery charge becomes insufficient or the voltage

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 485

temporarily drops, the electric power steering system warning light may come on and the warning buzzer may sound.  When the tire pressure warning
light comes on (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system) Inspect the tires to check if a tire is punctured. If a tire is punctured: P.490, 501

The compact spare tire is not equipped with a tire pressure warning valve and transmitter. If a tire goes flat, the tire pressure warning light will not turn off even though the flat tire has been replaced with the spare tire. Replace the spare tire with the repaired tire and adjust the tire inflation pressure. The tire pressure warning light will go off after a few minutes.

If none of the tires are punctured: Turn the power switch off then turn it to ON. Check if the tire pressure warning light comes on or blinks.

 Conditions that the tire pressure warning system may not function properly (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system)

 If the tire pressure warning light blinks for approximately 1 minute then stays on

P.444 WARNING

There may be a malfunction in the tire pressure warning system. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.

 If both the ABS and the brake system warning lights remain on

 If the tire pressure warning light comes on
1 After the temperature of the tires has lowered sufficiently, check the inflation pressure of each tire and adjust them to the specified level.
2 If the warning light does not turn

Stop your vehicle in a safe place immediately and contact your Toyota dealer. The vehicle will become extremely unstable during braking, and the ABS system may fail, which could cause an accident resulting in death or serious injury.

off even after several minutes

 When the electric power

have elapsed, check that the

steering system warning light

inflation pressure of each tire is

comes on

at the specified level and perform initialization. (P.447)

When the light comes on yellow, the assist to the power steering is

8

 The tire pressure warning light may come on due to natural

restricted. When the light comes on red, the assist to the power

causes (vehicles with a tire

steering is lost and handling oper-

pressure warning system)

ations of the steering wheel

The tire pressure warning light may come on due to natural causes such as natural air leaks and tire inflation pressure changes caused by temperature. In this case, adjusting the

become extremely heavy. When steering wheel operations are heavier than usual, grip the steering wheel firmly and operate it using more force than usual.

tire inflation pressure will turn off the

warning light (after a few minutes).

 When a tire is replaced with a spare tire (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system)

Vehicles with a compact spare tire:

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

486 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

WARNING  If the tire pressure warning
light comes on (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system) Be sure to observe the following precautions. Failure to do so could cause a loss of vehicle control and result in death or serious injury. Stop your vehicle in a safe place as soon as possible. Adjust the tire inflation pressure immediately. Vehicles with a compact spare tire: If the tire pressure warning light comes on even after tire inflation pressure adjustment, it is probable that you have a flat tire. Check the tires. If a tire is flat, change it with the spare tire and have the flat tire repaired by the nearest Toyota dealer. Vehicles with emergency tire puncture repair kit: If the tire pressure warning light comes on even after tire inflation pressure adjustment, it is probable that you have a flat tire. Check the tires. If a tire is flat, repair the flat tire by using emergency tire puncture repair kit. Avoid abrupt maneuvering and braking. If the vehicle tires deteriorate, you could lose control of the steering wheel or the brakes.  If a blowout or sudden air leakage should occur (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system) The tire pressure warning system may not activate immediately.

 Maintenance of the tires Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label (tire and load information label). (If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label [tire and load information label], you should determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS-tire pressure warning system) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale (tire pressure warning light) when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale (tire pressure warning light) illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS (tire pressure warning system) is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale (tire pressure warning light).

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 487

WARNING Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS (tire pressure warning system) malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS (tire pressure warning system) malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale (tire pressure warning light). When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS (tire pressure warning system) malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the TPMS (tire pressure warning system) from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS (tire pressure warning system) malfunction telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS (tire pressure warning system) to continue to function properly.
NOTICE  To ensure the tire pressure
warning system operates properly (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system) Do not install tires with different specifications or makers, as the tire pressure warning system may not operate properly.

If a warning message is displayed
The multi-information display shows warnings for system malfunctions and incorrectly performed operations, and messages that indicate a need for maintenance. When a message is displayed, perform the appropriate corrective action for the message.
If a warning message is displayed again after the appropriate actions have been performed, contact your Toyota dealer.
Additionally, if a warning light comes on or flashes at the same time that a warning message is displayed, take the appropriate corrective action for the warning light. (P.478)
8  Warning messages The warning messages explained below may differ from the actual messages according to operation conditions and vehicle specifications.
 Warning buzzer A buzzer may sound when a message is displayed. The buzzer may not be audible if the vehicle is in a noisy location or if the audio system volume is high.
 If "Engine Oil Level Low Add or Replace" is displayed
The engine oil level is low. Check

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

488 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

the level of the engine oil, and add if necessary. This message may appear if the vehicle is stopped on a slope. Move the vehicle to a level surface and check to see if the message disappears.  If "Hybrid System Stopped
Steering Power Low" is displayed This message is displayed if the hybrid system is stopped while driving. When steering wheel operations are heavier than usual, grip the steering wheel firmly and operate it using more force than usual.  If "Hybrid System Overheated Output Power Reduced" is displayed This message may be displayed when driving under severe operating conditions. (For example, when driving up a long steep hill.) Handling method: P.517  If "Traction Battery Needs to be Protected Refrain from the Use of N Position" is displayed This message may be displayed when the shift lever is in N. As the hybrid battery (traction battery) cannot be charged when the shift lever is in N, shift the shift lever to P when the vehicle is stopped.  If "Traction Battery Needs to be Protected Shift into P to Restart" is displayed This message is displayed when the hybrid battery (traction battery) charge has become extremely low because the shift lever has been left in N for a certain amount of time. When operating the vehicle, shift to P and restart the hybrid system.  If "Shift is in N Release Accelerator Before Shifting" is displayed The accelerator pedal has been

depressed when the shift lever is in N. Release the accelerator pedal and shift the shift lever to D or R.
 If "Press Brake when Vehicle is Stopped Hybrid System may Overheat" is displayed
The message may be displayed when the accelerator pedal is depressed to hold the vehicle while the vehicle is stopped on an incline, etc. The hybrid system may overheat. Release the accelerator pedal and depress the brake pedal.
 If "Auto Power OFF to Conserve Battery" is displayed
Power was cut off due to the automatic power off function. Next time when starting the hybrid system, operate the hybrid system for approximately 5 minutes to recharge the 12-volt battery.
 If "Headlight System Malfunction Visit Your Dealer" is displayed
The following systems may be malfunctioning. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.  The LED headlight system  Automatic High Beam  If a message that indicates the
malfunction of front camera is displayed The following systems may be suspended until the problem shown in the message is resolved. (P.187, 478)  PCS (Pre-Collision system)  LTA (Lane Tracing Assist)  Automatic High Beam  RSA (Road Sign Assist) (if equipped)  Dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 489

 If "Radar Cruise Control Unavailable See Owner's Manual" is displayed
The dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range system is suspended temporarily or until the problem shown in the message is resolved. (causes and coping methods: P.187)  If "Radar Cruise Control
Unavailable" is displayed The dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range system cannot be used temporarily. Use the system when it becomes available again.

Maintenance" or "Owner's Manual Supplement" for the maintenance interval applicable to your vehicle.
 If a message that indicates the need for visiting your Toyota dealer is displayed
The system or part shown on the multi-information display is malfunctioning. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer immediately.
 If a message that indicates the need for referring to Owner's Manual is displayed

 If "Maintenance Required Soon" is displayed
Indicates that all maintenance according to the driven distance on the maintenance schedule* should be performed soon.

 If "Engine Coolant Temp High" is displayed, follow the instructions accordingly. (P.517)
 If any of the following messages are displayed on the multi-information display, it may indicate a malfunction. Have the vehicle

Comes on approximately 4500

inspected by your Toyota dealer

miles (7200 km) after the message

immediately.

has been reset. If necessary, per-

· "Smart Key System Malfunction"

form maintenance. Please reset the · "Hybrid System Malfunction"

message after the maintenance is

· "Check Engine"

performed. (P.426)

· "Hybrid Battery System Malfunc-

*: Refer to the separate "Scheduled Maintenance" or "Owner's Man-

tion" · "Accelerator System Malfunction"

ual Supplement" for the maintenance interval applicable to your vehicle.
 If "Maintenance Required Visit Your Dealer" is displayed
Indicates that all maintenance is required to correspond to the driven distance on the maintenance schedule*.

 If any of the following messages are displayed on the multi-information display, it may indicate a malfunction. Immediately stop the vehicle and contact your Toyota dealer.
· "Braking Power Low" · "Charging System Malfunction" · "Oil Pressure Low"  If any of the following messages
are shown on the multi-informa-

8

Comes on approximately 5000

tion display, the vehicle may have

miles (8000 km) after the message

run out of fuel. Stop the vehicle in

has been reset. (The indicator will

a safe place and, if the fuel level is

not work properly unless the mes-

low, refuel the vehicle. (P.83)

sage has been reset.) Perform the · "Hybrid System Stopped"

necessary maintenance. Please

· "Engine Stopped"

reset the message after the maintenance is performed. (P.426)

 If "Maintenance Required for Traction Battery Cooling Parts See

*: Refer to the separate "Scheduled

Owner's Manual" is shown, the fil-

ters may be clogged, the air intake

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

490 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

vent may be blocked, or there may be a gap in the duct. Therefore, perform the following correction procedure. · If the air intake vent and filter of the hybrid battery (traction battery) are dirty, perform the procedure on P.455 to clean them. · If the warning message is shown when the air intake vent and filter of the hybrid battery (traction battery) are not dirty, have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.
NOTICE  If "High Power Consumption
Partial Limit on AC/Heater Operation" is displayed frequently There is a possible malfunction relating to the charging system or the 12-volt battery may be deteriorating. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

If you have a flat tire (vehicles without spare tire)
Your vehicle is not equipped with a spare tire, but instead is equipped with an emergency tire puncture repair kit.
A puncture caused by a nail or screw passing through the tire tread can be repaired temporarily using the emergency tire puncture repair kit. (The kit contains a bottle of sealant. The sealant can be used only once to temporarily repair one tire without removing the nail or screw from the tire.) After temporarily repairing the tire with the kit, have the tire repaired or replaced by your Toyota dealer.

WARNING
 If you have a flat tire Do not continue driving with a flat tire. Driving even a short distance with a flat tire can damage the tire and the wheel beyond repair, which could result in an accident.

Before repairing the tire
 Stop the vehicle in a safe place on a hard, flat surface.
 Set the parking brake.  Shift the shift lever to P.

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 491

 Stop the hybrid system.
 Turn on the emergency flashers.
 Check the degree of the tire damage.
A tire should only be repaired with the emergency tire puncture repair kit if the damage is caused by a nail or screw passing through the tire tread. · Do not remove the nail or
screw from the tire. Removing the object may widen the opening and make emergency repair with the repair kit impossible. · To avoid sealant leakage, move the vehicle until the area of the puncture, if known, is positioned at the top of the tire.

 When there are any cracks or damage at any location on the tire, such as on the side wall, except the tread
 When the tire is visibly separated from the wheel
 When the cut or damage to the tread is 0.16 in. (4 mm) long or more
 When the wheel is damaged  When 2 or more tires have been
punctured  When 2 or more sharp objects
such as nails or screws have passed through the tread on a single tire  When the sealant has expired

8
 A flat tire that cannot be repaired with the emergency tire puncture repair kit
In the following cases, the tire cannot be repaired with the emergency tire puncture repair kit. Contact your Toyota dealer.  When the tire is damaged due to
driving without sufficient air pressure

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

492 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency
Location of the emergency tire puncture repair kit and towing eyelet

Emergency tire puncture repair kit Towing eyelet

Emergency tire puncture repair kit components
 Bottle

 Compressor

Hose Air release cap Sticker
COROLLA HV_U

Power plug Rubber stopper Air pressure gauge Compressor switch
 Note for checking the emergency tire puncture repair kit
Check the sealant expiry date occasionally. The expiry date is shown on the bottle. Do not use sealant whose expiry date has already passed. Other-

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 493

wise, repairs conducted using the emergency tire puncture repair kit may not be performed properly.

WARNING  Caution while driving

 Emergency tire puncture repair kit

 Store the repair kit in the trunk. Injuries may result in the event

 The emergency tire puncture repair kit is for filling the car tire

of an accident or sudden braking.

with air.  The sealant has a limited life
span. The expiry date is marked on the bottle. The sealant should be replaced before the expiry date. Contact your Toyota dealer for replacement.  The sealant stored in the emergency tire puncture repair kit can be used only once to temporarily repair a single tire. If the sealant in the bottle and other parts of the kit have been used and need to be replaced, contact your Toyota

 The repair kit is exclusively only for your vehicle. Do not use repair kit on other vehicles, which could lead to an accident causing death or serious injury.
 Do not use repair kit for tires that are different size than the original ones, or for any other purpose. If the tires have not been completely repaired, it could lead to an accident causing death or serious injury.

dealer.  The compressor can be used
repeatedly.  The sealant can be used when the
outside temperature is from -40°F (-40°C) to 140°F (60°C).  The kit is exclusively designed for size and type of tires originally installed on your vehicle. Do not use it for tires that a different size than the original ones, or for any other purposes.

 Precautions for use of the sealant
 Ingesting the sealant is hazardous to your health. If you ingest sealant, consume as much water as possible, and then immediately consult a doctor.
 If sealant gets in eyes or adheres to skin, immediately wash it off with water. If discomfort persists, consult a doctor.

 If the sealant gets on your clothes, it may stain.

Taking out the emer-

8

 If the sealant adheres to a wheel or the surface of the vehicle body, the stain may not be removable if

gency tire puncture repair kit

it is not cleaned at once. Immediately wipe away the sealant with a

1 Lift the deck mat. (P.400)

wet cloth.  During operation of the repair kit,
a loud operation noise is pro-

2 Take out the emergency tire puncture repair kit. (P.492)

duced. This does not indicate a

malfunction.

Emergency repair method

 Do not use to check or to adjust the tire pressure.

1 Take out the repair kit from

the plastic bag.

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

494 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

2 Remove the valve cap from the valve of the punctured
tire.

wise as far as possible.

3 Extend the hose. Remove the air release cap from the hose.
Attach the sticker enclosed with the bottle on the specified locations. (See step 10.) You will use the air release cap again. Therefore keep it in a safe place.

5 Make sure that the compressor switch is off.
6 Lift the rubber stopper on the compressor.

4 Connect the hose to the valve.
Screw the end of the hose clock-

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

7 Remove the power plug from the compressor.

the upper end of the notch.

495

8 Connect the power plug to the power outlet socket.
(P.402)

10Attach the sticker provided with the tire puncture repair
kit to a position easily seen
from the driver's seat.

9 Connect the bottle to the compressor.

As shown in the illustration, insert

the bottle securely into the com-

pressor until the upper side of the mark on the bottle is aligned with

8

U.S.A.
Canada 11Check the specified tire infla-
tion pressure.
Tire inflation pressure is specified on the label on the driver's side pil-

COROLLA HV_U

When trouble arises

496 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

lar as shown. (P.529)

14Inflate the tire until the specified air pressure is reached.

12Start the hybrid system.
13To inject the sealant and inflate the tire, turn the compressor switch on.

COROLLA HV_U

The sealant will be injected and the pressure will spike to between 44 psi (300 kPa, 3.0 kgf/cm2 or bar) and 58 psi (400 kPa, 4.0 kgf/cm2 or bar), then gradually decrease.
The air pressure gauge will display the actual tire inflation pressure about 1 to 5 minutes after the switch is turned on.
Turn the compressor switch off and then check the tire inflation pressure. Being careful not to over inflate, check and repeat the inflation procedure until the specified tire inflation pressure is reached.
The tire can be inflated for about 5 to 20 minutes (depending on the outside temperature). If the tire inflation pressure is still lower than the specified point after inflation for 25 minutes, the tire is too damaged

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 497

to be repaired. Turn the compressor switch off and contact your Toyota dealer.
If the tire inflation pressure exceeds the specified air pressure, let out some air to adjust the tire inflation pressure. (P.498, 529)
15With the compressor switch off, disconnect the hose from the valve on the tire and then pull out the power plug from the power outlet socket.
Some sealant may leak when the hose is removed.
16Install the valve cap onto the valve of the emergency repaired tire.
17Attach the air release cap to the end of the hose.
If the air release cap is not attached, the sealant may leak and the vehicle may get dirty.

flat surface and reconnect the repair kit.
Remove the air release cap from the hose before reconnecting the hose.
21Turn the compressor switch on and wait for several seconds, then turn it off. Check the tire inflation pressure.

When trouble arises

18Temporarily store the bottle in the trunk while it is connected to the compressor.
19To spread the liquid sealant evenly within the tire, immediately drive safely for about 3 miles (5 km) below 50 mph (80 km/h).
20After driving, stop your vehicle in a safe place on a hard,

If the tire inflation pressure is under 19 psi (130 kPa, 1.3

8

kgf/cm2 or bar): The puncture

cannot be repaired. Contact

your Toyota dealer.

If the tire inflation pressure is 19 psi (130 kPa, 1.3
kgf/cm2or bar) or higher, but less than the specified air pressure: Proceed to step 22.

If the tire inflation pressure is the specified air pressure

COROLLA HV_U

498 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

(P.529): Proceed to step 23. 22Turn the compressor switch on to inflate the tire until the specified air pressure is reached. Drive for about 3 miles (5 km) and then perform step 20.
23Attach the air release cap to the end of the hose.
If the air release cap is not attached, the sealant may leak and the vehicle may get dirty.

 If the tire is inflated to more than the specified air pressure
1 Disconnect the hose from the valve.
2 Install the air release cap to the end of the hose and push the protrusion on the air release cap into the tire valve to let some air out.

24Store the bottle in the trunk while it is connected to the compressor.
25Taking precautions to avoid sudden braking, sudden acceleration and sharp turns, drive carefully at under 50 mph (80 km/h) to the nearest Toyota dealer that is less than 62 miles (100 km) away for tire repair or replacement.
When having the tire repaired or replaced, make sure to tell the Toyota dealer that the sealant is injected.

3 Disconnect the hose from the valve, remove the air release cap from the hose and then reconnect the hose.
4 Turn the compressor switch on and wait for several seconds, and then turn it off. Check that the air pressure indicator shows the specified air pressure. (P.529)
If the air pressure is under the designated pressure, turn the compressor switch on again and repeat the inflation procedure until the specified air pressure is reached.
 The valve of a tire that has been repaired (vehicles without a tire pressure warning system)
After a tire is repaired with the emergency tire puncture repair kit, the valve should be replaced.
 After a tire is repaired with the emergency tire puncture repair kit (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system)
 The tire pressure warning valve and transmitter should be replaced.
 Even if the tire inflation pressure is at the recommended level, the tire pressure warning light may come

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 499

on/flash.

 Keep back from the tire while it

is being repaired, as there is a

WARNING  Do not drive the vehicle with
a flat tire

chance of it bursting while the repair operation is being performed. If you notice any cracks or deformation of the tire, turn

Do not continue driving with a flat tire. Driving even a short distance with

off the compressor switch and stop the repair operation immediately.

a flat tire can damage the tire and the wheel beyond repair. Driving with a flat tire may cause a circumferential groove on the side wall. In such a case, the tire may explode when using a repair kit.

 The repair kit may overheat if operated for a long period of time. Do not operate the repair kit continuously for more than 40 minutes.

 When fixing the flat tire

 Parts of the repair kit become hot during operation. Be careful

Stop your vehicle in a safe and flat area.

handling the repair kit during and after operation. Do not touch the metal part connecting

Do not touch the wheels or the

the bottle and the compressor. It

area around the brakes immedi-

will be extremely hot.

ately after the vehicle has been driven. After the vehicle has been driven, the wheels and the area around the brakes may be extremely hot. Touching these areas with hands, feet or other body parts may result in burns.

 Do not attach the vehicle speed warning sticker to an area other than the one indicated. If the sticker is attached to an area where an SRS airbag is located, such as the pad of the steering wheel, it may prevent the SRS airbag from operating properly.

Connect the valve and hose securely with the tire installed on the vehicle. If the hose is not

 Driving to spread the liquid sealant evenly

properly connected to the valve,

Observe the following precautions

air leakage may occur as seal-

to reduce the risk of accidents.

8

ant may be sprayed out.

Failing to do so may result in a

If the hose comes off the valve while inflating the tire, there is a

loss of vehicle control and cause death or serious injury.

risk that the hose will move abruptly due to air pressure.

 Drive the vehicle carefully at a low speed. Be especially careful

After inflation of the tire has

when turning and cornering.

completed, the sealant may splatter when the hose is disconnected or some air is let out of the tire.

 If the vehicle does not drive straight or you feel a pull through the steering wheel, stop the vehicle and check the fol-

Follow the operation procedure to repair the tire. If the procedures not followed, the sealant

lowing. · Tire condition. The tire may
have separated from the wheel.

may spray out.

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

500 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

WARNING · Tire inflation pressure. If the tire
inflation pressure is 19 psi (130 kPa, 1.3 kgf/cm2 or bar) or less, the tire may be severely damaged.
NOTICE  When performing an emer-
gency repair A tire should only be repaired
with the emergency tire puncture repair kit if the damage is caused by a sharp object such as nail or screw passing through the tire tread. Do not remove the sharp object from the tire. Removing the object may widen the opening and disenable emergency repair with the repair kit. The repair kit is not waterproof. Make sure that the repair kit is not exposed to water, such as when it is being used in the rain. Do not put the repair kit directly onto dusty ground such as sand at the side of the road. If the repair kit vacuums up dust etc., a malfunction may occur.  Precautions for the emergency tire puncture repair kit The repair kit power source should be 12 V DC suitable for vehicle use. Do not connect the repair kit to any other source. If fuel splatters on the repair kit, the repair kit may deteriorate. Take care not to allow fuel to contact it. Place the repair kit in a storage to prevent it from being exposed to dirt or water. Store the repair kit in the trunk out of reach of children.

 Do not disassemble or modify the repair kit. Do not subject parts such as the air pressure indicator to impacts. This may cause a malfunction.
 To avoid damage to the tire pressure warning valves and transmitters (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system)
When a tire is repaired with liquid sealants, the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter may not operate properly. If a liquid sealant is used, contact your Toyota dealer or other qualified service shop as soon as possible. After use of liquid sealant, make sure to replace the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter when repairing or replacing the tire. (P.446)

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency
If you have a flat tire (vehicles with a spare tire)
Your vehicle is equipped with a spare tire. The flat tire can be replaced with the spare tire. For details about tires: P.441
WARNING  If you have a flat tire Do not continue driving with a flat tire. Driving even a short distance with a flat tire can damage the tire and the wheel beyond repair, which could result in an accident.
Before jacking up the vehicle
 Stop the vehicle in a safe place on a hard, flat surface.
 Set the parking brake.  Shift the shift lever to P.  Stop the hybrid system.  Turn on the emergency flash-
ers.

501
8

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

502 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency Location of the spare tire, jack and tools

Jack handle Wheel nut wrench Jack Spare tire Towing eyelet
WARNING  Using the tire jack Observe the following precautions. Improper use of the tire jack may cause the vehicle to suddenly fall off the jack, leading to death or serious injury. Do not use the tire jack for any
purpose other than replacing tires or installing and removing tire chains.

 Only use the tire jack that comes with this vehicle for replacing a flat tire. Do not use it on other vehicles, and do not use other tire jacks for replacing tires on this vehicle.
 Put the jack properly in its jack point.

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 503

WARNING Do not put any part of your body
under the vehicle while it is supported by the jack. Do not start the hybrid system or drive the vehicle while the vehicle is supported by the jack. Do not raise the vehicle while someone is inside.

2 Take out the jack.

When raising the vehicle, do not put an object on or under the jack.
Do not raise the vehicle to a height greater than that required to replace the tire.

For tightening For loosening
Taking out the spare tire

Use a jack stand if it is necessary to get under the vehicle.
When lowering the vehicle, make sure that there is no-one near the vehicle. If there are people nearby, warn them vocally before lowering.

1 Remove the deck mat. (P.503)
2 Remove the tool tray.

Taking out the jack
1 Remove the deck mat.

3 Loosen the center fastener

8

that secures the spare tire.

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

504 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

WARNING
 When storing the spare tire Be careful not to catch fingers or other body parts between the spare tire and the body of the vehicle.

and the wheel ornament.

Replacing a flat tire
1 Chock the tires.

3 Slightly loosen the wheel nuts (one turn).

Flat tire

Wheel chock positions

Front left-hand side

Behind the rear right-hand side tire

Front right-hand Behind the rear

side

left-hand side tire

Rear left-hand side

In front of the front right-hand side tire

Rear right-hand side

In front of the front left-hand side tire

2 Remove the wheel ornament using the wrench.

Insert the wrench into the notch on the wheel cap. To protect the wheel ornament, place a rag between the wrench

4 Turn the tire jack portion by hand until the center of the
recessed portion of the jack
is in contact with the center of
the jack point.

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 505

5 Assemble the jack handle extension.
6 Raise the vehicle until the tire is slightly raised off the ground.

WARNING  Replacing a flat tire  Do not touch the disc wheels or
the area around the brakes immediately after the vehicle has been driven. After the vehicle has been driven the disc wheels and the area around the brakes will be extremely hot. Touching these areas with hands, feet or other body parts while changing a tire, etc. may result in burns.
 Failure to follow these precautions could cause the wheel nuts to loosen and the tire to fall off, resulting in death or serious injury.
· Have the wheel nuts tightened with a torque wrench to 76 ft·lbf (103 N·m, 10.5 kgf·m) as soon as possible after changing wheels.

7 Remove all the wheel nuts and the tire.
When resting the tire on the ground, place the tire so that the wheel design faces up to avoid scratching the wheel surface.

· Do not attach a heavily damaged wheel ornament, as it may fly off the wheel while the vehicle is moving.

· When installing a tire, only use wheel nuts that have been specifically designed for that wheel.

· If there are any cracks or deformations in the bolt screws, nut

8

threads or bolt holes of the

wheel, have the vehicle

inspected by your Toyota

dealer.

· When installing the wheel nuts, be sure to install them with the tapered ends facing inward.

Installing the spare tire
1 Remove any dirt or foreign matter from the wheel contact surface.

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

506 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

If foreign matter is on the wheel contact surface, the wheel nuts may loosen while the vehicle is in motion, causing the tire to come off.

order shown in the illustration.
Tightening torque: 76 ft·lbf (103 N·m, 10.5 kgf·m)

2 Install the tire and loosely tighten each wheel nut by hand by approximately the same amount.
Tighten the wheel nuts until the tapered portion comes into loose contact with the disc wheel seat .
3 Lower the vehicle.
4 Firmly tighten each wheel nut two or three times in the

5 Stow the flat tire, tire jack and all tools.
 The compact spare tire  The compact spare tire is identi-
fied by the label "TEMPORARY USE ONLY" on the tire sidewall. Use the compact spare tire temporarily, and only in an emergency.  Make sure to check the tire inflation pressure of the compact spare tire. (P.529)  When the compact spare tire is equipped The vehicle becomes lower when driving with the compact spare tire compared to when driving with standard tires.  After completing the tire change (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system) The tire pressure warning system must be reset. (P.447)  When using the compact spare tire (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system) As the compact spare tire is not equipped with a tire pressure warning valve and transmitter, low inflation pressure of the spare tire will not be indicated by the tire pressure warning system. Also, if you replace

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 507

the compact spare tire after the tire pressure warning light comes on, the light remains on.
 If you have a flat front tire on a road covered with snow or ice
Install the compact spare tire on one of the rear wheels of the vehicle. Perform the following steps and fit tire chains to the front tires: 1 Replace a rear tire with the com-
pact spare tire. 2 Replace the flat front tire with the
tire removed from the rear of the vehicle. 3 Fit tire chains to the front tires.
 When reinstalling the wheel ornament (except compact spare tire)
Align the cutout of the wheel ornament with the valve stem as shown in the illustration.

 Avoid sudden acceleration, abrupt steering, sudden braking and shifting operations that cause sudden engine braking.
 When the compact spare tire is attached
The vehicle speed may not be correctly detected, and the following systems may not operate correctly: · ABS & Brake assist · VSC · TRAC · Automatic High Beam · Dynamic radar cruise control
with full-speed range · EPS

· PCS (Pre-Collision System)

· LTA (Lane Tracing Assist)

· Tire pressure warning system (if equipped)

· BSM (Blind Spot Monitor) (if equipped)

WARNING  When using the compact
spare tire

· RCTA (Rear Cross Traffic Alert) function (if equipped)

· Rear view monitor system

8

Remember that the compact spare tire provided is specifically designed for use with your vehicle. Do not use your compact spare tire on another vehicle.
Do not use more than one compact spare tires simultaneously.
Replace the compact spare tire with a standard tire as soon as possible.

 Speed limit when using the compact spare tire
Do not drive at speeds in excess of 50 mph (80 km/h) when a compact spare tire is installed on the vehicle.
The compact spare tire is not designed for driving at high speeds. Failure to observe this precaution may lead to an accident causing death or serious injury.

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

508 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

WARNING  After using the tools and jack Before driving, make sure all the tools and jack are securely in place in their storage location to reduce the possibility of personal injury during a collision or sudden braking.
NOTICE  Be careful when driving over
bumps with the compact spare tire installed on the vehicle. The vehicle becomes lower when driving with the compact spare tire compared to when driving with standard tires. Be careful when driving over uneven road surfaces.  Driving with tire chains and the compact spare tire Do not fit tire chains to the compact spare tire. Tire chains may damage the vehicle body and adversely affect driving performance.  When replacing the tires (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system) When removing or fitting the wheels, tires or the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter, contact your Toyota dealer as the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter may be damaged if not handled correctly.

 To avoid damage to the tire pressure warning valves and transmitters (vehicles with a tire pressure warning system)
When a tire is repaired with liquid sealants, the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter may not operate properly. If a liquid sealant is used, contact your Toyota dealer or other qualified service shop as soon as possible. Make sure to replace the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter when replacing the tire.

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 509

If the hybrid system will not start
Reasons for the hybrid system not starting vary depending on the situation. Check the following and perform the appropriate procedure:

The interior lights and headlights are dim, or the horn does not sound or sounds at a low volume.
One of the following may be the cause of the problem:
 The 12-volt battery may be discharged. (P.513)

The hybrid system will not start even though the correct starting procedure is being followed. (P.157)
One of the following may be the cause of the problem:
 The electronic key may not be functioning properly. (P.511)
 There may not be sufficient fuel in the vehicle's tank. Refuel the vehicle.

 The 12-volt battery terminal connections may be loose or corroded. (P.439)
The interior lights and headlights do not turn on, or the horn does not sound.
One of the following may be the cause of the problem:
 The 12-volt battery may be discharged. (P.513)

 There may be a malfunction in the immobilizer system. (P.88)

 One or both of the 12-volt battery terminals may be disconnected. (P.439)

 There may be a malfunction

Contact your Toyota dealer if the

8

in the steering lock system.

problem cannot be repaired, or if repair procedures are unknown.

 The hybrid system may be

malfunctioning due to an electrical problem such as elec-

Emergency start function

tronic key battery depletion or When the hybrid system does

a blown fuse. However,

not start, the following steps can

depending on the type of mal- be used as an interim measure

function, an interim measure to start the hybrid system if the

is available to start the hybrid power switch is functioning nor-

system. (P.509)

mally.

Do not use this starting proce-

dure except in case of emer-

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

510 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

gency.
1 Set the parking brake. (P.167)
2 Check that the shift lever is in P.
3 Turn the power switch to ACC.
4 Press and hold the power switch for about 15 seconds while depressing the brake pedal firmly.
Even if the hybrid system can be started using the above steps, the system may be malfunctioning. Have the vehicle inspected by your Toyota dealer.

If you lose your keys
New genuine keys can be made by your Toyota dealer using another mechanical key and the key number stamped on your key number plate.
Keep the plate in a safe place such as your wallet, not in the vehicle.
NOTICE  When an electronic key is lost If the electronic key remains lost, the risk of vehicle theft increases significantly. Visit your Toyota dealer immediately with all remaining electronic keys that were provided with your vehicle.

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 511

If the fuel filler door cannot be opened
If the fuel filler door opener switch cannot be operated, contact your Toyota dealer to service the vehicle. In case where refueling is urgently necessary, the following procedure can be used to open the fuel filler door.
Opening the fuel filler door
Pull the lever.

If the electronic key does not operate properly
If communication between the electronic key and vehicle is interrupted (P.127) or the electronic key cannot be used because the battery is depleted, the smart key system and wireless remote control cannot be used. In such cases, the doors can be opened and the hybrid system can be started by following the procedure below.

Using the lever to open the fuel

filler door may not allow for an adequate reduction in fuel tank pressure before refueling. To

 When the electronic key does not work properly
 Make sure that the smart key system has not been deactivated in

prevent fuel from spilling out,

the customization setting. If it is

turn the cap slowly when removing it. During refueling, fuel may spill out from the filler opening

off, turn the function on. (Customizable features: P.544)  Check if battery-saving mode is set. If it is set, cancel the function.

due to air being discharged from inside the fuel tank. Therefore,

(P.127)

8

fill the fuel tank carefully and

NOTICE

slowly.

 In case of a smart key system malfunction or other key-related problems

Take your vehicle with all the electronic keys provided with your vehicle to your Toyota dealer.

Locking and unlocking the doors
Use the mechanical key (P.118) in order to perform the

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

512 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

following operations:
1 Locks all the doors 2 Unlocks all the doors
Turning the key unlocks the driver's door. Turning the key again unlocks the other doors.

WARNING  When using the mechanical
key and operating the power windows Operate the power window after checking to make sure that there is no possibility of any passenger having any of their body parts caught in the window. Also, do not allow children to operate the mechanical key. It is possible for children and other passengers to get caught in the power window.
Starting the hybrid system

 Key linked functions
1 Closes the windows (turn and hold)*
2 Opens the windows (turn and hold)*
*: This setting must be customized at your Toyota dealer.

1 Ensure that the shift lever is in P and depress the brake pedal.
2 Touch the Toyota emblem side of the electronic key to the power switch.
When the electronic key is detected, a buzzer sounds and the power switch will turn to ON. When the smart key system is deactivated in customization setting, the power switch will turn to ACC.

COROLLA HV_U

3 Firmly depress the brake

pedal and check that

is

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 513

shown on the multi-information display.
4 Press the power switch shortly and firmly.
In the event that the hybrid system still cannot be started, contact your Toyota dealer.
 Stopping the hybrid system Shift the shift lever to P and press the power switch as you normally do when stopping the hybrid system.  Electronic key battery As the above procedure is a temporary measure, it is recommended that the electronic key battery be replaced immediately when the battery is depleted. (P.459)  Changing power switch modes Release the brake pedal and press the power switch in step 3 above. The hybrid system does not start and modes will be changed each time the switch is pressed. (P.160)

If the 12-volt battery is discharged
The following procedures may be used to start the hybrid system if the 12-volt battery is discharged. You can also call your Toyota dealer or a qualified repair shop.

8

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

514 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

Restarting the hybrid system

situation, the alarm may activate and doors locked. (P.91)

If you have a set of jumper (or booster) cables and a second vehicle with a 12-volt battery, you can jump start your vehicle by following the steps below.
1 Confirm that the electronic key is being carried.
When connecting the jumper (or booster) cables, depending on the

2 Open the hood. (P.432)

3 Connect a positive jumper cable clamp to on your vehicle and connect the clamp on the other end of the positive cable to on
the second vehicle. Then, connect a negative cable clamp to on the second vehicle and connect the clamp at the other end of
the negative cable to .

Positive (+) battery terminal (your vehicle)

Positive (+) battery terminal (second vehicle)

Negative (-) battery terminal (second vehicle)

Solid, stationary, unpainted metallic point away from the battery and any moving parts as shown in the illustration

4 Start the engine of the second vehicle. Increase the
engine speed slightly and

maintain at that level for approximately 5 minutes to

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 515

recharge the 12-volt battery of your vehicle.
5 Open and close any of the doors of your vehicle with the power switch OFF.
6 Maintain the engine speed of the second vehicle and start the hybrid system of your

 When the 12-volt battery is removed or discharged
 Information stored in the ECU is cleared. When the 12-volt battery is depleted, have the vehicle inspected at your Toyota dealer.
 Some systems may require initialization. (P.552)
 When removing the 12-volt battery terminals

vehicle by turning the power switch to ON.
7 Make sure the "READY" indicator comes on. If the indica-

When the 12-volt battery terminals are removed, the information stored in the ECU is cleared. Before removing the 12-volt battery terminals, contact your Toyota dealer.

tor does not come on, contact  Charging the 12-volt battery

your Toyota dealer.
8 Once the hybrid system has started, remove the jumper cables in the exact reverse order from which they were connected.
Once the hybrid system starts, have the vehicle inspected at

The electricity stored in the 12-volt battery will discharge gradually even when the vehicle is not in use, due to natural discharge and the draining effects of certain electrical appliances. If the vehicle is left for a long time, the 12-volt battery may discharge, and the hybrid system may be unable to start. (The 12-volt battery recharges automatically while the hybrid system is operating.)

your Toyota dealer as soon as possible.

 When recharging or replacing the 12-volt battery
 In some cases, it may not be pos-

sible to unlock the doors using the

 Starting the hybrid system

smart key system when the

when the 12-volt battery is discharged

12-volt battery is discharged. Use the wireless remote control or the

8

The hybrid system cannot be started by push-starting.

mechanical key to lock or unlock the doors.

 To prevent 12-volt battery discharge
 Turn off the headlights and the audio system while the hybrid system is off.
 Turn off any unnecessary electrical components when the vehicle is running at a low speed for an extended period, such as in heavy traffic.

 The hybrid system may not start on the first attempt after the 12-volt battery has recharged but will start normally after the second attempt. This is not a malfunction.
 The power switch mode is memorized by the vehicle. When the 12-volt battery is reconnected, the system will return to the mode it was in before the 12-volt battery was discharged. Before disconnecting the 12-volt battery, turn the power switch off. If you are unsure what mode the

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

516 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

power switch was in before the 12-volt battery discharged, be especially careful when reconnecting the 12-volt battery.  When replacing the 12-volt battery  Use a 12-volt battery that conforms to European regulations.  Use a 12-volt battery with the same case size as the previous 12-volt battery and an equivalent 20 hour rate capacity (20HR) or greater. · If the sizes differ, the 12-volt battery cannot be properly secured. · If the 20 hour rate capacity is low, even if the time period where the vehicle is not used is a short time, the 12-volt battery may discharge and the hybrid system may not be able to start.  For details, consult your Toyota dealer.
WARNING  When removing the 12-volt
battery terminals Always remove the negative (-) terminal first. If the positive (+) terminal contacts any metal in the surrounding area when the positive (+) terminal is removed, a spark may occur, leading to a fire in addition to electrical shocks and death or serious injury.
 Avoiding 12-volt battery fires or explosions
Observe the following precautions to prevent accidentally igniting the flammable gas that may be emitted from the 12-volt battery:
Make sure each jumper cable is connected to the correct terminal and that it is not unintentionally in contact with any other than the intended terminal.

 Do not allow the other end of the jumper cable connected to the "+" terminal to come into contact with any other parts or metal surfaces in the area, such as brackets or unpainted metal.
 Do not allow the + and - clamps of the jumper cables to come into contact with each other.
 Do not smoke, use matches, cigarette lighters or allow open flame near the 12-volt battery.
 12-volt battery precautions The 12-volt battery contains poisonous and corrosive acidic electrolyte, while related parts contain lead and lead compounds. Observe the following precautions when handling the 12-volt battery:  When working with the 12-volt
battery, always wear safety glasses and take care not to allow any battery fluids (acid) to come into contact with skin, clothing or the vehicle body.  Do not lean over the 12-volt battery.  In the event that battery fluid comes into contact with the skin or eyes, immediately wash the affected area with water and seek medical attention. Place a wet sponge or cloth over the affected area until medical attention can be received.  Always wash your hands after handling the 12-volt battery support, terminals, and other battery-related parts.  Do not allow children near the 12-volt battery.

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 517

NOTICE
 When handling jumper cables When connecting the jumper cables, ensure that they do not become entangled in the cooling fans, etc.

If your vehicle overheats
The following may indicate that your vehicle is overheating.
 The engine coolant temperature gauge (P.98) is in the red zone or a loss of hybrid system power is experienced. (For example, the vehicle speed does not increase.)
 "Engine Coolant Temp High Stop in a Safe Place See Owner's Manual" or "Hybrid System Overheated Output Power Reduced" is shown on the multi-information display.
 Steam comes out from under the hood.

Correction procedures
 If the engine coolant tempera- 8 ture gauge enters the red zone or "Engine Coolant Temp High Stop in a Safe Place See Owner's Manual" is shown on the multi-information display
1 Stop the vehicle in a safe place and turn off the air conditioning system, and then stop the hybrid system.
2 If you see steam: Carefully lift the hood after the steam sub-

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

518 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

sides. If you do not see steam: Carefully lift the hood.
3 After the hybrid system has cooled down sufficiently, inspect the hoses and radiator core (radiator) for any leaks.

Water can be used in an emergency if coolant is unavailable.

Radiator Cooling fans
If a large amount of coolant leaks, immediately contact your Toyota dealer.
4 The coolant level is satisfactory if it is between the "MAX" and "MIN" lines on the reservoir.
Reservoir "MAX" line "MIN" line 5 Add coolant if necessary.

6 Start the hybrid system and turn the air conditioning system on to check that the radiator cooling fans operate and to check for coolant leaks from the radiator or hoses.
The fans operate when the air conditioning system is turned on immediately after a cold start. Confirm that the fans are operating by checking the fan sound and air flow. If it is difficult to check these, turn the air conditioning system on and off repeatedly. (The fans may not operate in freezing temperatures.)
7 If the fans are not operating: Stop the hybrid system immediately and contact your Toyota dealer. If the fans are operating: Have the vehicle inspected at the nearest Toyota dealer.
 If "Hybrid System Overheated Output Power Reduced" is shown on the multi-information display
1 Stop the vehicle in a safe place.
2 Stop the hybrid system and carefully lift the hood.

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency 519

3 After the hybrid system has cooled down, inspect the
hoses and radiator core (radi-
ator) for any leaks.

gency if coolant is unavailable.

Radiator
Cooling fans
If a large amount of coolant leaks, immediately contact your Toyota dealer.
4 The coolant level is satisfactory if it is between the "FULL" and "LOW" lines on the reservoir.

6 After stopping the hybrid system and waiting for 5 minutes or more, start the hybrid system again and check for the multi-information display. If the message does not disappear: Stop the hybrid system and contact your Toyota dealer. If the message is not displayed: The hybrid system temperature has dropped and the vehicle may be driven normally.

However, if the message appears again frequently, contact your Toyota dealer.

WARNING

8

Reservoir "FULL" line "LOW" line 5 Add coolant if necessary.
Water can be used in an emer-

 When inspecting under the hood of your vehicle
Observe the following precautions. Failure to do so may result in serious injury such as burns.
 If steam is seen coming from under the hood, do not open the hood until the steam has subsided. The engine compartment may be very hot.

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

520 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency

WARNING After the hybrid system has
been turned off, check that the "READY" indicator is off. When the hybrid system is operating, the gasoline engine may automatically start, or the cooling fans may suddenly operate even if the gasoline engine stops. Do not touch or approach rotating parts such as the fan, which may lead to fingers or clothing (especially a tie, a scarf or a muffler) getting caught, resulting in serious injury. Do not loosen the coolant reservoir caps while the hybrid system and radiator are hot. High temperature steam or coolant could spray out.
NOTICE  When adding engine/power
control unit coolant Add coolant slowly after the hybrid system has cooled down sufficiently. Adding cool coolant to a hot hybrid system too quickly can cause damage to the hybrid system.  To prevent damage to the
cooling system Observe the following precautions: Avoid contaminating the coolant
with foreign matter (such as sand or dust etc.). Do not use any coolant additive.

If the vehicle becomes stuck
Carry out the following procedures if the tires spin or the vehicle becomes stuck in mud, dirt or snow:

Recovering procedure
1 Stop the hybrid system. Set the parking brake and shift the shift lever to P.
2 Remove the mud, snow or sand from around the front wheels.
3 Place wood, stones or some other material under the front wheels to help provide traction.
4 Restart the hybrid system.
5 Shift the shift lever to D or R and release the parking brake. Then, while exercising caution, depress the accelerator pedal.

 When it is difficult to free the vehicle

Press the TRAC.

switch to turn off

COROLLA HV_U

8-2. Steps to take in an emergency
WARNING  When attempting to free a
stuck vehicle If you choose to push the vehicle back and forth to free it, make sure the surrounding area is clear to avoid striking other vehicles, objects or people. The vehicle may also lunge forward or lunge back suddenly as it becomes free. Use extreme caution.  When shifting the shift lever Be careful not to shift the shift lever with the accelerator pedal depressed. This may lead to unexpected rapid acceleration of the vehicle that may cause an accident resulting in death or serious injury.

521

NOTICE

 To avoid damaging the transmission and other components
Avoid spinning the front wheels and depressing the accelerator pedal more than necessary.

If the vehicle remains stuck

even after these procedures are

performed, the vehicle may

require towing to be freed.

8

When trouble arises

COROLLA HV_U

522 8-2. Steps to take in an emergency
COROLLA HV_U

9 Vehicle specifications
.9-1. Specifications Maintenance data (fuel, oil level, etc.).................. 524 Fuel information .......... 531 Tire information ........... 533
9-2. Customization Customizable features .................................. 544
9-3. Initialization Items to initialize ......... 552

523

9

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

524 9-1. Specifications
9-1.Specifications
Maintenance data (fuel, oil level, etc.)

Dimensions and weight

Overall length Overall width Overall height*1 Wheelbase
Tread
Vehicle capacity weight (Occupants + luggage) *1: Unladen vehicles *2: For Guam and Saipan

Front Rear

182.3 in. (4630 mm) 70.1 in. (1780 mm) 56.5 in. (1435 mm) 57.3 in. (1455 mm)*2 106.3 in. (2700 mm) 60.1 in. (1527 mm)*2 60.3 in. (1531 mm) 60.1 in. (1526 mm)*2 60.4 in. (1534 mm)
825 lb. (375 kg)

Seating capacity

Seating capacity

5 (Front 2, Rear 3)

Vehicle identification
 Vehicle identification number
The vehicle identification number (VIN) is the legal identifier for your vehicle. This is the primary identification number for your Toyota. It is used in registering the ownership of your vehicle.
This number is stamped under the right-hand front seat.

This number is also stamped on the top left of the instrument panel.

COROLLA HV_U

9-1. Specifications 525
 Engine number The engine number is stamped on the engine block as shown.
This number is also on the Certification Label.

Vehicle specifications

Engine
Model Type Bore and stroke Displacement Valve clearance
Fuel
Fuel type Octane Rating Fuel tank capacity (Reference)

1.8 L 4-cylinder (2ZR-FXE) 4-cylinder in line, 4-cycle, gasoline 3.17  3.48 in. (80.5  88.3 mm) 109.7 cu. in. (1798 cm3) Automatic adjustment
9
Unleaded gasoline only 87 (Research Octane Number 91) or higher
11.4 gal. (43.0 L, 9.5 Imp. gal.)

COROLLA HV_U

526 9-1. Specifications

Electric motor (traction motor)

Type
Maximum output Maximum torque

Permanent magnet synchronous motor
53 kW
120.2 ft·lbf (163 N·m, 16.6 kgf·m)

Hybrid battery (traction battery)

Type
Voltage Capacity Quantity Nominal voltage

Nickel-Metal hydride battery 7.2 V/module 6.5 Ah 28 modules 201.6 V

Lithium-ion battery
3.7 V/cell 4.0 Ah 56 cells 207.2 V

Lubrication system

 Oil capacity (Drain and refill [Reference*])

With filter

4.4 qt. (4.2 L, 3.7 Imp. qt.)

Without 4.1 qt. (3.9 L, 3.4 Imp.

filter

qt.)

*: The engine oil capacity is a reference quantity to be used when changing the engine oil. Warm up the engine and turn off the hybrid system, wait more than 5 minutes, and check the oil level on the dipstick.
 Engine oil selection
"Toyota Genuine Motor Oil" is used in your Toyota vehicle. Use Toyota approved "Toyota Genuine Motor Oil" or equivalent to

satisfy the following grade and viscosity. Oil grade: API SN/RC multigrade engine oil Recommended viscosity: SAE 0W-16
Outside temperature SAE 0W-16 is the best choice for good fuel economy and good starting in cold weather. If SAE 0W-16 is not available, SAE 0W-20 oil may be used.

COROLLA HV_U

However, it must be replaced with SAE 0W-16 at the next oil change.
Oil viscosity (0W-16 is explained here as an example): · The 0W in 0W-16 indicates
the characteristic of the oil which allows cold startability. Oils with a lower value before the W allow for easier starting of the engine in cold weather. · The 16 in 0W-16 indicates the viscosity characteristic of the oil when the oil is at high temperature. An oil with a higher viscosity (one with a higher

9-1. Specifications 527
value) may be better suited if the vehicle is operated at high speeds, or under extreme load conditions.
How to read oil container label:
API registered mark is added to some oil containers to help you select the oil you should use.

Cooling system

Capacity (Reference)

Gasoline engine

5.9 qt. (5.6 L, 4.9 Imp. qt.)

Power control unit

1.5 qt. (1.4 L, 1.2 Imp. qt.)

Coolant type

Use either of the following:

 "Toyota Super Long Life Coolant"

 Similar high-quality ethylene glycol-based

non-silicate, non-amine, non-nitrite, and

non-borate coolant with long-life hybrid organic

acid technology

9

Do not use plain water alone.

Ignition system (spark plug)

Make Gap

DENSO FC16HR-CY9 0.035 in. (0.9 mm)

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

528 9-1. Specifications

NOTICE
 Iridium-tipped spark plugs Use only iridium-tipped spark plugs. Do not adjust the spark plug gap.

Electrical system (12-volt battery)

Open voltage at 68°F (20°C):
Charging rates Quick charge Slow charge

12.0 V or higher (Turn the power switch off and turn on the high beam headlights for 30 seconds.)
15 A max. 5 A max.

Hybrid transmission

Fluid capacity*

3.8 qt. (3.6 L, 3.2 Imp. qt.)

Fluid type

Toyota Genuine ATF WS

*: The fluid capacity is a reference quantity. If replacement is necessary, contact your Toyota dealer.

NOTICE
 Hybrid transmission fluid type Using transmission fluid other than the above type may cause abnormal noise or vibration, or ultimately damage the transmission of your vehicle.

Brakes

Pedal clearance*1 Pedal free play
Brake pad wear limit

5.2 in. (133 mm) Min.
0.04  0.24 in. (1  6 mm)  Front 0.07 in. (1.8 mm)  Rear 0.08 in. (2.0 mm)

COROLLA HV_U

9-1. Specifications 529

Parking brake indicator*2

When pulling the parking brake switch for 1 to 2 seconds: comes on
When pushing the parking brake switch for 1 to 2 seconds: turns off

Fluid type

FMVSS No.116 DOT 3 or SAE J1703 FMVSS No.116 DOT 4 or SAE J1704

*1: Minimum pedal clearance when depressed with a force of 67.4 lbf (300 N, 30.6 kgf) while the hybrid system is operating.
*2: Make sure to confirm that the brake system warning light (yellow) does not illuminate. (If the brake system warning light illuminates, refer to P.478.)

Steering

Free play

Less than 1.2 in. (30 mm)

Tires and wheels

 Type A

Tire size

195/65R15 91S, T125/70D17 98M

 Front

38 psi (260 kPa, 2.6 kgf/cm2 or bar)

Tire inflation pressure  Rear

(Recommended cold tire inflation pressure)

36 psi (250 kPa, 2.5 kgf/cm2 or bar)

 Spare

60 psi (420 kPa, 4.2 kgf/cm2 or bar)

Wheel size

15  6 1/2J, 17  4T (compact spare)

9

Wheel nut torque

76 ft·lbf (103 N·m, 10.5 kgf·m)

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

530 9-1. Specifications

 Type B

Tire size

195/65R15 91S

 Front

38 psi (260 kPa, 2.6 kgf/cm2 or bar)

Tire inflation pressure (Recommended cold tire

 Rear

inflation pressure)

36 psi (250 kPa, 2.5 kgf/cm2 or bar)

 Spare

None

Wheel size

15  6 1/2J

Wheel nut torque

76 ft·lbf (103 N·m, 10.5 kgf·m)

Light bulbs

Exterior Interior

Light bulbs Front side marker lights Rear side marker lights Rear turn signal lights Back-up lights Front interior lights/personal lights Vanity lights Rear interior light Trunk light

A: Wedge base bulbs (clear) B: Wedge base bulbs (amber) C: Double end bulbs

Bulb No. W

--

5

--

5

--

21

--

16

--

5

--

8

--

8

--

5

Type A A B A
A
A C A

COROLLA HV_U

Fuel information
You must only use unleaded gasoline. Select octane rating of 87 (Research Octane Number 91) or higher. Use of unleaded gasoline with an octane rating lower than 87 may result in engine knocking. Persistent knocking can lead to engine damage.
At minimum, the gasoline you use should meet the specifications of ASTM D4814 in the U.S.A.
 Gasoline quality In very few cases, driveability problems may be caused by the brand of gasoline you are using. If driveability problems persist, try changing the brand of gasoline. If this does not correct the problem, consult your Toyota dealer.  Recommendation of the use of
gasoline containing detergent additives  Toyota recommends the use of gasoline that contains detergent additives to avoid the build-up of engine deposits.  All gasoline sold in the U.S.A. contains minimum detergent additives to clean and/or keep clean intake systems, per EPA's lowest additives concentration program.  Toyota strongly recommends the use of Top Tier Detergent Gasoline. For more information on Top Tier Detergent Gasoline and a list of marketers, please go to the official website www.toptiergas.com.

9-1. Specifications 531
 Recommendation of the use of low emissions gasoline
Gasolines containing oxygenates such as ethers and ethanol, as well as reformulated gasolines, are available in some cities. These fuels are typically acceptable for use, providing they meet other fuel requirements. Toyota recommends these fuels, since the formulations allow for reduced vehicle emissions.  Non-recommendation of the
use of blended gasoline  Use only gasoline containing up to
15% ethanol. DO NOT use any flex-fuel or gasoline that could contain more than 15% ethanol, including from any pump labeled E30 (30% ethanol [ ]), E50 (50% ethanol [ ]), E85 (85% ethanol [ ]) (which are only some examples of fuel containing more than 15% ethanol).

 If you use gasohol in your vehicle, be sure that it has an octane rating no lower than 87.

 Toyota does not recommend the use of gasoline containing metha-

9

nol.

 Non-recommendation of the use of gasoline containing MMT

Some gasoline contains an octane enhancing additive called MMT (Methylcyclopentadienyl Manganese Tricarbonyl).

Toyota does not recommend the use of gasoline that contains MMT. If fuel containing MMT is used, your emission control system may be

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

532 9-1. Specifications
adversely affected. The malfunction indicator lamp on the instrument cluster may come on. If this happens, contact your Toyota dealer for service.  If your engine knocks  Consult your Toyota dealer.  You may occasionally notice light
knocking for a short time while accelerating or driving uphill. This is normal and there is no need for concern.
NOTICE  Notice on fuel quality Do not use improper fuels. If
improper fuels are used, the engine will be damaged. Do not use leaded gasoline. Leaded gasoline can cause damage to your vehicle's three-way catalytic converters causing the emission control system to malfunction. Do not use gasohol other than the type previously stated. Other gasohol may cause fuel system damage or vehicle performance problems. Using unleaded gasoline with an octane number or rating lower than the level previously stated will cause persistent heavy knocking. At worst, this will lead to engine damage.  Fuel-related poor driveability If poor driveability (poor hot starting, vaporization, engine knocking, etc.) is encountered after using a different type of fuel, discontinue the use of that type of fuel.

 When refueling with gasohol Take care not to spill gasohol. It can damage your vehicle's paint.

COROLLA HV_U

Tire information Typical tire symbols
 Full-size tire

9-1. Specifications 533

Vehicle specifications

Tire size (P.535)

DOT and Tire Identification Number (TIN) (P.535)

Uniform tire quality grading

For details, see "Uniform Tire Quality Grading" that follows.

Location of treadwear indicators (P.441)

Tire ply composition and materials

Plies are layers of rubber-coated parallel cords. Cords are the strands which form the plies in a tire.

Radial tires or bias-ply tires

A radial tire has "RADIAL" on the sidewall. A tire not marked "RADIAL" is a

bias-ply tire.

9

TUBELESS or TUBE TYPE

A tubeless tire does not have a tube and air is directly put into the tire. A tube type tire has a tube inside the tire and the tube maintains the air pressure.

Load limit at maximum cold tire inflation pressure (P.442)

Maximum cold tire inflation pressure (P.529)

This means the pressure to which a tire may be inflated.

Summer tires or all season tires (P.442)

COROLLA HV_U

534 9-1. Specifications
An all season tire has "M+S" on the sidewall. A tire not marked "M+S" is a summer tire.
 Compact spare tire
"TEMPORARY USE ONLY"
A compact spare tire is identified by the phrase "TEMPORARY USE ONLY" molded on its sidewall. This tire is designed for temporary emergency use only.
Tire size (P.535) DOT and Tire Identification Number (TIN) (P.535) Load limit at maximum cold tire inflation pressure (P.442) Location of treadwear indicators (P.441) Maximum cold tire inflation pressure (P.529)
This means the pressure to which a tire may be inflated.
Tire ply composition and materials
Plies are layers of rubber-coated parallel cords. Cords are the strands which form the plies in a tire.
TUBELESS or TUBE TYPE
A tubeless tire does not have a tube and air is directly put into the tire. A tube type tire has a tube inside the tire and the tube maintains the air pressure.
Radial tires or bias-ply tires
A radial tire has "RADIAL" on the sidewall. A tire not marked "RADIAL" is a bias-ply tire.
COROLLA HV_U

Typical DOT and Tire Identification Number (TIN)
 Type A
DOT symbol* Tire Identification Number (TIN) Tire manufacturer's identification mark Tire size code Manufacturer's optional tire type code (3 or 4 letters) Manufacturing week Manufacturing year
*: The DOT symbol certifies that the tire conforms to applicable Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards.
 Type B

9-1. Specifications 535
DOT symbol* Tire Identification Number (TIN) Tire manufacturer's identification mark Manufacturer's code Manufacturing week Manufacturing year
*: The DOT symbol certifies that the tire conforms to applicable Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards.
Tire size
 Typical tire size information The illustration indicates typical tire size.

Tire use (P = Passenger car,

T = Temporary use)

9

Section width (millimeters)

Aspect ratio (tire height to section width)

Tire construction code (R = Radial, D = Diagonal)

Wheel diameter (inches)

Load index (2 digits or 3 digits)

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

536 9-1. Specifications
Speed symbol (alphabet with one letter)  Tire dimensions
Section width Tire height Wheel diameter
Tire section names
Bead Sidewall Shoulder Tread Belt Inner liner Reinforcing rubber Carcass Rim lines Bead wires

Chafer
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
This information has been prepared in accordance with regulations issued by the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration of the U.S. Department of Transportation.
It provides the purchasers and/or prospective purchasers of Toyota vehicles with information on uniform tire quality grading.
Your Toyota dealer will help answer any questions you may have as you read this information.
 DOT quality grades
All passenger vehicle tires must conform to Federal Safety Requirements in addition to these grades. Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and maximum section width.
For example: Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A
 Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified government test course.
For example, a tire graded 150

COROLLA HV_U

would wear one and a half (1 - 1/2) times as well on the government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use. Performance may differ significantly from the norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices and differences in road characteristics and climate.
 Traction AA, A, B, C
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B and C, and they represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete.
A tire marked C may have poor traction performance.
Warning: The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on braking (straight ahead) traction tests and does not include cornering (turning) traction.
 Temperature A, B, C
The temperature grades are A

9-1. Specifications 537
(the highest), B, and C, representing the tire's resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel.
Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire failure.
Grade C corresponds to a level of performance which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard No. 109.
Grades B and A represent higher levels of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.
Warning: The temperature grades of a tire assume that it is properly inflated and not overloaded.
Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.

Glossary of tire terminology

9

Tire related term Cold tire inflation pressure Maximum inflation pressure

Meaning
Tire pressure when the vehicle has been parked for three hours or more, or has not been driven more than 1 mile or 1.5 km under that condition
The maximum cold inflated pressure to which a tire may be inflated, shown on the sidewall of the tire

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

538 9-1. Specifications

Tire related term Recommended inflation pressure
Accessory weight
Curb weight
Maximum loaded vehicle weight Normal occupant weight Occupant distribution
Production options weight
Rim

Meaning
Cold tire inflation pressure recommended by a manufacturer
The combined weight (in excess of those standard items which may be replaced) of automatic transmission, power steering, power brakes, power windows, power seats, radio and heater, to the extent that these items are available as factory-installed equipment (whether installed or not)
The weight of a motor vehicle with standard equipment, including the maximum capacity of fuel, oil and coolant, and if so equipped, air conditioning and additional weight optional engine
The sum of:
(a) Curb weight
(b) Accessory weight
(c) Vehicle capacity weight
(d) Production options weight
150 lb. (68 kg) times the number of occupants specified in the second column of Table 1* that follows
Distribution of occupants in a vehicle as specified in the third column of Table 1* below
The combined weight of installed regular production options weighing over 5 lb. (2.3 kg) in excess of the standard items which they replace, not previously considered in curb weight or accessory weight, including heavy duty brakes, ride levelers, roof rack, heavy duty battery, and special trim
A metal support for a tire or a tire and tube assembly upon which the tire beads are seated

COROLLA HV_U

9-1. Specifications 539

Tire related term

Meaning

Rim diameter (Wheel diameter)

Nominal diameter of the bead seat

Rim size designation

Rim diameter and width

Rim type designation

The industry manufacturer's designation for a rim by style or code

Rim width

Nominal distance between rim flanges

Vehicle capacity weight (Total load capacity)

The rated cargo and luggage load plus 150 lb. (68 kg) times the vehicle's designated seating capacity

Vehicle maximum load on the tire

The load on an individual tire that is determined by distributing to each axle its share of the maximum loaded vehicle weight, and dividing by two

The load on an individual tire that is deter-

mined by distributing to each axle its share

Vehicle normal load on the tire

of curb weight, accessory weight, and normal occupant weight (distributed in accor-

dance with Table 1* below), and dividing by

two

Weather side

The surface area of the rim not covered by the inflated tire

Bead

The part of the tire that is made of steel wires, wrapped or reinforced by ply cords and that is shaped to fit the rim

Bead separation

A breakdown of the bond between components in the bead

Bias ply tire

A pneumatic tire in which the ply cords that 9 extend to the beads are laid at alternate angles substantially less than 90 degrees to the centerline of the tread

Carcass

The tire structure, except tread and sidewall rubber which, when inflated, bears the load

Chunking

The breaking away of pieces of the tread or sidewall

Cord

The strands forming the plies in the tire

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

540 9-1. Specifications

Tire related term Cord separation Cracking
CT
Extra load tire Groove Innerliner Innerliner separation
Intended outboard sidewall
Light truck (LT) tire Load rating Maximum load rating

Meaning
The parting of cords from adjacent rubber compounds
Any parting within the tread, sidewall, or innerliner of the tire extending to cord material
A pneumatic tire with an inverted flange tire and rim system in which the rim is designed with rim flanges pointed radially inward and the tire is designed to fit on the underside of the rim in a manner that encloses the rim flanges inside the air cavity of the tire
A tire designed to operate at higher loads and at higher inflation pressures than the corresponding standard tire
The space between two adjacent tread ribs
The layer(s) forming the inside surface of a tubeless tire that contains the inflating medium within the tire
The parting of the innerliner from cord material in the carcass
(a) The sidewall that contains a whitewall, bears white lettering, or bears manufacturer, brand, and/or model name molding that is higher or deeper than the same molding on the other sidewall of the tire, or
(b) The outward facing sidewall of an asymmetrical tire that has a particular side that must always face outward when mounted on a vehicle
A tire designated by its manufacturer as primarily intended for use on lightweight trucks or multipurpose passenger vehicles
The maximum load that a tire is rated to carry for a given inflation pressure
The load rating for a tire at the maximum permissible inflation pressure for that tire

COROLLA HV_U

9-1. Specifications 541

Tire related term

Meaning

Maximum permissible inflation The maximum cold inflation pressure to

pressure

which a tire may be inflated

Measuring rim

The rim on which a tire is fitted for physical dimension requirements

Open splice

Any parting at any junction of tread, sidewall, or innerliner that extends to cord material

Outer diameter

The overall diameter of an inflated new tire

Overall width

The linear distance between the exteriors of the sidewalls of an inflated tire, including elevations due to labeling, decorations, or protective bands or ribs

Passenger car tire

A tire intended for use on passenger cars, multipurpose passenger vehicles, and trucks, that have a gross vehicle weight rating (GVWR) of 10,000 lb. or less.

Ply

A layer of rubber-coated parallel cords

Ply separation

A parting of rubber compound between adjacent plies

Pneumatic tire

A mechanical device made of rubber, chemicals, fabric and steel or other materials, that, when mounted on an automotive wheel, provides the traction and contains the gas or fluid that sustains the load

Radial ply tire

A pneumatic tire in which the ply cords that

extend to the beads are laid at substan-

tially 90 degrees to the centerline of the

tread

9

Reinforced tire

A tire designed to operate at higher loads and at higher inflation pressures than the corresponding standard tire

Section width

The linear distance between the exteriors of the sidewalls of an inflated tire, excluding elevations due to labeling, decoration, or protective bands

Sidewall

That portion of a tire between the tread and bead

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

542 9-1. Specifications

Tire related term

Meaning

Sidewall separation

The parting of the rubber compound from the cord material in the sidewall

Snow tire

A tire that attains a traction index equal to or greater than 110, compared to the ASTM E-1136 Standard Reference Test Tire, when using the snow traction test as described in ASTM F-1805-00, Standard Test Method for Single Wheel Driving Traction in a Straight Line on Snow-and Ice-Covered Surfaces, and which is

marked with an Alpine Symbol ( least one sidewall

) on at

Test rim

The rim on which a tire is fitted for testing, and may be any rim listed as appropriate for use with that tire

Tread

That portion of a tire that comes into contact with the road

Tread rib

A tread section running circumferentially around a tire

Tread separation

Pulling away of the tread from the tire carcass

Treadwear indicators (TWI)

The projections within the principal grooves designed to give a visual indication of the degrees of wear of the tread

Wheel-holding fixture

The fixture used to hold the wheel and tire assembly securely during testing

*: Table 1 -Occupant loading and distribution for vehicle normal load for various designated seating capacities

Designated seating capacity, Number of
occupants
2 through 4
5 through 10

Vehicle normal load, Number of occupants
2
3

Occupant distribution in a normally loaded vehi-
cle
2 in front
2 in front, 1 in second seat

COROLLA HV_U

Designated seating capacity, Number of
occupants
11 through 15
16 through 20

9-1. Specifications 543

Vehicle normal load, Number of occupants
5
7

Occupant distribution in a normally loaded vehi-
cle
2 in front, 1 in second seat, 1 in third seat, 1 in
fourth seat
2 in front, 2 in second seat, 2 in third seat, 1 in
fourth seat

Vehicle specifications

9 COROLLA HV_U

544 9-2. Customization
9-2.Customization
Customizable features
Your vehicle includes a variety of electronic features that can be personalized to suit your preferences. The settings of these features can be changed using the multi-information display, the audio system screen, or at your Toyota dealer.
Customizing vehicle features
 Changing by using the audio system screen
1 Press the "MENU" button. 2 Select "Setup" on the "Menu"
screen.
3 Select "General" or "Vehicle" on the "Setup" screen.
Various setting can be changed. Refer to the list of settings that can be changed for details.
 Changing by using the meter control switches
1 Press or of the meter control switch to select .

2 Press or of the meter control switch to select the desired item to be customized.
3 Press or press and hold .
The available settings will differ depending on if is pressed or pressed and held. Follow the instructions on the display.
WARNING  During customization As the hybrid system needs to be operating during customization, ensure that the vehicle is parked in a place with adequate ventilation. In a closed area such as a garage, exhaust gases including harmful carbon monoxide (CO) may collect and enter the vehicle. This may lead to death or a serious health hazard.
NOTICE  During customization To prevent 12-volt battery discharge, ensure that the hybrid system is operating while customizing features.

Customizable features
Some function settings are changed simultaneously with other functions being customized. Contact your Toyota dealer for further details.
Settings that can be changed using the audio system screen Settings that can be changed using the meter control switches

COROLLA HV_U

9-2. Customization 545

Settings that can be changed by your Toyota dealer
Definition of symbols: O = Available, -- = Not available
 Gauges, meters and multi-information display (P.94, 98, 103)

Function*1

Default setting Customized setting

Language

English

French Spanish

O O--

km (km/L)

Units*2

miles (MPG)

km (L/100 km) -- O -- miles (MPG Impe-
rial)

Speedometer display

Analog

Digital

--O--

EV indicator

On

Off

--O--

Eco Accelerator Guidance

On

Off

--O--

Fuel economy display

Trip average (Aver-

age fuel consump-

Total average tion [after start])

(Average fuel consumption

Tank average

--O--

[after reset]) (Average fuel con-

sumption [after

refuel])

Audio system linked display

On

Off

--O--

Energy monitor Drive information type

On After start

Off After reset

--O-- --O-- 9

Drive information items (First item)

Distance

Average vehicle speed
Elapsed time

--O--

Drive information items (Second item)

Elapsed time

Average vehicle speed
Distance

--O--

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

546 9-2. Customization

Function*1

Default setting Customized setting

Current trip result display

Drive information

Eco score

--O--

Pop-up display

On

Off

--O--

*1: For details about each function: P.108 *2: The default setting varies according to country.
 Door lock (P.119, 123, 511)

Function

Default setting Customized setting

Unlocking using a mechanical key

Driver's door

unlocked in

one step, all doors

All doors unlocked in one step

--

--

O

unlocked in

two step

Automatic door locking function

Shift position

Off

linked door locking opera- Speed linked door

O

--

O

tion

locking operation

Automatic door unlocking function

Shift position

Off

linked door unlocking operation

Driver's door linked O -- O door unlocking operation

Locking/unlocking of the

trunk when all doors are

On

locked/unlocked

Off

---- O

 Smart key system and wireless remote control (P.119, 125)

Function

Default setting Customized setting

Operating signal (Buzzers)

5

Operation signal (Emergency flashers)

On

Off 1 to 7
Off

O--O O--O

COROLLA HV_U

9-2. Customization 547

Function

Default setting Customized setting

Time elapsed before automatic door lock function is activated if door is not opened after being unlocked

60 seconds

Open door warning buzzer

On

 Smart key system (P.119, 125)

Off 30 seconds
120 seconds

O--O

Off

---- O

Function

Default setting Customized setting

Smart key system

On

Off

---- O

Smart door unlocking Driver's door All the doors O -- O

Time elapsed before unlocking all the door when gripping and holding the driver's door handle

2.0 seconds

Off 1.5 seconds
2.5 seconds

---- O

Number of consecutive door lock operations

2 times

As many as desired

---- O

 Wireless remote control (P.117, 119, 123)

Function

Default setting Customized setting

Wireless remote control

On

Off

---- O

Unlocking operation

Driver's door

unlocked in

one step, all doors

All doors unlocked in one step

O

--

O

9

unlocked in

two step

One short press

Trunk unlocking opera- Press and hold

tion

(short)

Push twice
Press and hold (long)

---- O

Off

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

548 9-2. Customization

Function

Default setting Customized setting

Theft deterrent panic mode

On

Locking operation when door opened

On

 Power windows (P.142)

Off

---- O

Off

O--O

Function

Default setting Customized setting

Mechanical key linked operation

Off

On

---- O

Wireless remote control linked operation

Off

On (open only) -- -- O

Wireless remote control

linked operation signal

On

(buzzer)

Off

---- O

 Automatic light control system (P.173)

Function

Default setting Customized setting

Light sensor sensitivity

Standard

-2 to 2

O--O

Time elapsed before headlights automatically turn off after doors are closed

30 seconds

Off 60 seconds 90 seconds

O--O

Windshield wiper linked headlight illumination

On

Off

---- O

 Lights (P.173)

Function
Daytime running light system
*: Except for Canada

Default setting Customized setting

On

Off*

O--O

COROLLA HV_U

9-2. Customization 549

 PCS (Pre-Collision System) (P.189)

Function

Default setting Customized setting

PCS (Pre-Collision System)
Adjust alert timing

On Middle

Off
Far Near

--O-- --O--

 LTA (Lane Tracing Assist) (P.197)

Function

Default setting Customized setting

Lane centering function
Steering assist function
Alert sensitivity
Vehicle sway warning function
Vehicle sway warning sensitivity

On On High On
Standard

Off Off Standard
Off
High Low

--O-- --O-- --O-- --O--
--O--

 RSA (Road Sign Assist)* (P.218)

Function

Default setting Customized setting

RSA (Road Sign Assist)

On

Off

--O--

Excess speed notification method

No notification

Display only

--O--

Display and buzzer

Excess speed notification level

3 mph (5 km/h) 1 mph (2 km/h)
5 mph (10 km/h)

--O--

9

Other notifications method (No-entry notification)

No notification

Display only

--O--

Display and buzzer

*: If equipped

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

550 9-2. Customization

 BSM (Blind Spot Monitor)* (P.221)

Function

Default setting Customized setting

BSM (Blind Spot Monitor)

On

Off

--O--

Outside rear view mirror indicator brightness

Bright

Dim

--O--

Early

Alert timing for presence of approaching vehicle (sensitivity)

Late Intermediate Only when vehicle -- O --
detected in blind spot

*: If equipped
 RCTA (Rear Cross Traffic Alert) function* (P.226)

Function

Default setting Customized setting

RCTA (Rear Cross Traffic Alert) function

On

Off

Buzzer volume

Level 2

Level 1 Level 3

*: If equipped
 Automatic air conditioning system (P.386)

--O-- ---- O

Function

Default setting Customized setting

A/C auto switch operation

On

Off

O--O

 Illumination (P.395)

Function

Default setting Customized setting

Time elapsed before the interior lights turn off

15 seconds

Operation after the

power switch is turned

On

off

Off 7.5 seconds 30 seconds
Off

O--O ---- O

COROLLA HV_U

9-2. Customization 551

Function
Operation when the doors are unlocked
Operation when you approach the vehicle with the electronic key on your person
Cup holder lights* and center tray light*
Door trim lights*
*: If equipped

Default setting Customized setting

On

Off

---- O

On

Off

---- O

On

Off

---- O

On

Off

---- O

 Vehicle customization

 When the smart key system is off, Smart door unlocking cannot be customized.

 When the doors remain closed after unlocking the doors and the automatic door lock function is activated, the signals will be generated in accordance with the operation signal (buzzer) and the operation signal (emergency flashers) settings.

 In the following situations, customize mode in which the settings can be changed through the multi-information display will automatically be turned off

 The power switch is turned off.

 The vehicle begins to move while the customize mode screen is dis-

9

played.

Vehicle specifications

COROLLA HV_U

552 9-3. Initialization
9-3.Initialization
Items to initialize
The following items must be initialized for normal system operation after such cases as the 12-volt battery being reconnected, or maintenance being performed on the vehicle:

List of items to initialize

Item

When to initialize

Message indicating maintenance is · After maintenance is performed required

· When rotating front and rear

tires which have different tire

inflation pressures

· When changing the tire size

Tire pressure warn- · When the tire inflation pressure

ing system*

is changed such as when

changing traveling speed or load

weight

· When changing between two

registered wheel sets

*: If equipped

Reference P.426
P.447

COROLLA HV_U

For owners 10
.10-1.For owners Reporting safety defects for U.S. owners............... 554 Seat belt instructions for Canadian owners (in French)...................... 554 SRS airbag instructions for Canadian owners (in French)...................... 556

553

For owners

10 COROLLA HV_U

554 10-1. For owners
10-1.For owners
Reporting safety defects for U.S. owners
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Toyota Motor Sales, U.S.A., Inc. (Toll-free: 1-800-331-4331).
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Toyota Motor Sales, U.S.A., Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov ; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Ave, S.E., Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.

Seat belt instructions for Canadian owners (in French)
The following is a French explanation of seat belt instructions extracted from the seat belt section in this manual. See the seat belt section for more detailed seat belt instructions in English.
Utilisation correcte des ceintures de sécurité
 Déroulez la sangle diagonale de telle sorte qu'elle passe bien sur l'épaule, sans pour autant être en contact avec le cou ou glisser de l'épaule.
 Placez la sangle abdominale le plus bas possible sur les hanches.
 Réglez la position du dossier de siège. Asseyez-vous le dos droit et calez-vous bien dans le siège.
 Ne vrillez pas la ceinture de

COROLLA HV_U

sécurité.
Entretien et soin
 Traitement des ceintures de sécurité
Nettoyez avec un chiffon ou une éponge humidifiés avec de l'eau savonneuse tiède. Vérifiez régulièrement que les ceintures ne sont pas usées, effilochées ou entaillées excessivement.
WARNING  Détérioration et usure des
ceintures de sécurité Inspectez le système de ceintures de sécurité régulièrement. Contrôlez l'absence de coupures, d'effilochages et de pièces desserrées. N'utilisez pas une ceinture de sécurité endommagée avant qu'elle ne soit remplacée. Une ceinture de sécurité endommagée ne permet pas de protéger un occupant de blessures graves ou mortelles.

10-1. For owners 555

10

For owners

COROLLA HV_U

556 10-1. For owners SRS airbag instructions for Canadian owners (in French)
The following is a French explanation of SRS airbag instructions extracted from the SRS airbag section in this manual. See the SRS airbag section for more detailed SRS airbag instructions in English.
Système de coussins gonflables SRS
 Emplacement des coussins gonflables SRS
 Coussins gonflables frontaux SRS Coussin gonflable conducteur/coussin gonflable du passager avant SRS
Participe à la protection de la tête et du thorax du conducteur et du passager avant contre les chocs contre les éléments de l'habitacle
Coussin gonflable de genoux SRS
Participe à la protection du conducteur
Coussin gonflable de coussin de siège SRS
Contribue à retenir le passager avant
COROLLA HV_U

10-1. For owners 557
 Coussins gonflables latéraux et rideaux SRS
Coussins gonflables latéraux avant SRS
Participent à la protection du torse des occupants de siège avant
Coussins gonflables latéraux arrière SRS
Participent à la protection du torse des occupants des sièges latéraux arrière
Coussins gonflables rideaux SRS
· Participent principalement à la protection de la tête des occupants des sièges latéraux
· Peut contribuer à empêcher les occupants d'être éjectés du véhicule en cas de tonneau
 Composants du système de coussins gonflables SRS

Coussin gonflable de coussin de siège

Système de classification de l'occupant du siège passager avant (ECU et capteurs)

Témoins indicateurs "AIR BAG ON" et "AIR BAG OFF"

Coussin gonflable passager avant

Coussins gonflables rideaux

10

Capteurs d'impact latéral (portes avant)

For owners

Coussins gonflables latéraux avant

Prétensionneurs de ceintures de sécurité et limiteurs de force

Coussins gonflables latéraux arrière

Capteurs d'impact latéral (arrière)

COROLLA HV_U

558 10-1. For owners
Capteurs d'impact latéral (avant) Coussin gonflable conducteur Contact de boucle de ceinture de sécurité conducteur Capteur de position du siège conducteur Coussin gonflable de genoux du conducteur Témoin d'avertissement SRS Capteurs d'impact avant Ensemble de capteurs de coussins gonflables Votre véhicule est équipé de COUSSINS GONFLABLES INTELLIGENTS conçus selon les normes de sécurité américaines applicables aux véhicules à moteur (FMVSS208). L'ensemble de capteurs de coussins gonflables (ECU) régule le déploiement des coussins gonflables sur la base des informations qu'il reçoit des capteurs, etc., indiqués ci-dessus dans le schéma illustrant les composants du système. Parmi ces informations figurent la gravité du choc et l'occupation du véhicule par les passagers. Le déploiement rapide des coussins gonflables est obtenu au moyen d'une réaction chimique dans les dispositifs pyrotechniques, qui produit un gaz inoffensif permettant d'amortir le mouvement des occupants.
WARNING  Précautions relatives aux
coussins gonflables SRS Respectez les précautions suivantes concernant les coussins gonflables SRS. Le non-respect de ces précautions peut occasionner des blessures graves, voire mortelles. Le conducteur et tous les pas-
sagers du véhicule doivent porter correctement leur ceinture de sécurité. Les coussins gonflables SRS sont des dispositifs supplémentaires à utiliser avec les ceintures de sécurité.
COROLLA HV_U

WARNING Le coussin gonflable conduc-
teur SRS se déploie avec une force considérable, pouvant occasionner des blessures graves, voire mortelles, si le conducteur se trouve très près du coussin gonflable. L'autorité fédérale chargée de la sécurité routière aux États-Unis (NHTSA) conseille: La zone à risque du coussin gonflable conducteur se situant dans les premiers 2 à 3 in. (50 à 75 mm) de déploiement, vous placer à 10 in. (250 mm) de votre coussin gonflable conducteur vous garantit une marge de sécurité. Cette distance est à mesurer entre le centre du volant et le sternum. Si vous êtes assis à moins de 10 in. (250 mm), vous pouvez changer votre position de conduite de plusieurs façons: · Reculez votre siège le plus possible, de manière à pouvoir encore atteindre confortablement les pédales.
· Inclinez légèrement le dossier du siège. Bien que les véhicules aient une conception différente, un grand nombre de conducteurs peuvent s'asseoir à une distance de 10 in. (250 mm), même avec le siège conducteur complètement avancé, simplement en inclinant un peu le dossier de siège. Si vous avez des difficultés à voir la route après avoir incliné le dossier de votre siège, utilisez un coussin ferme et antidérapant pour vous rehausser ou remontez le siège si votre véhicule est équipé de cette fonction.

10-1. For owners 559
· Si votre volant est réglable, inclinez-le vers le bas. Cela a pour effet d'orienter le coussin gonflable en direction de votre poitrine plutôt que de votre tête et de votre cou.
Réglez votre siège selon les recommandations de la NHTSA ci-dessus, tout en conservant le contrôle des pédales, du volant et la vue des commandes du tableau de bord.  Si vous attachez une rallonge
de ceinture de sécurité aux boucles de ceinture de sécurité avant, sans l'attacher au pêne de la ceinture de sécurité, les coussins gonflables frontaux SRS déterminent que le conducteur et le passager avant ont attaché leur ceinture de sécurité, bien que la ceinture de sécurité ne soit pas attachée. Dans ce cas, les coussins gonflables frontaux SRS peuvent ne pas se déployer correctement en cas de collision, pouvant occasionner des blessures graves, voire mortelles. Veillez à porter la ceinture de sécurité avec la rallonge de ceinture de sécurité.
10

For owners

COROLLA HV_U

560 10-1. For owners
WARNING Le coussin gonflable passager
avant SRS se déploie également avec une force considérable, pouvant occasionner des blessures graves, voire mortelles, si le passager avant se trouve très près du coussin gonflable. Le siège du passager avant doit être éloigné le plus possible du coussin gonflable en réglant le dossier de siège de façon à ce que le passager avant soit assis bien droit dans le siège. Les nourrissons et les enfants qui ne sont pas correctement assis et/ou attachés peuvent être grièvement blessés ou tués par le déploiement d'un coussin gonflable. Un nourrisson ou un enfant trop petit pour utiliser une ceinture de sécurité doit être correctement attaché au moyen d'un siège de sécurité enfant. Toyota recommande vivement d'installer tous les nourrissons et enfants sur les sièges arrière du véhicule et de prévoir pour eux des systèmes de retenue adaptés. Les sièges arrière sont plus sûrs pour les nourrissons et les enfants que le siège du passager avant. Ne vous asseyez pas sur le bord du siège et ne vous appuyez pas contre la planche de bord.

 Ne laissez pas un enfant rester debout devant le coussin gonflable passager avant SRS ou s'asseoir sur les genoux du passager avant.
 Ne laissez pas les occupants des sièges avant voyager avec un objet sur les genoux.
 Ne vous appuyez pas contre la porte, le rail latéral de toit ou les montants avant, latéraux et arrière.
 Ne laissez personne s'agenouiller sur les sièges passagers en appui contre la porte ou sortir la tête ou les mains à l'extérieur du véhicule.

COROLLA HV_U

WARNING Ne fixez rien et ne posez rien
sur des emplacements tels que la planche de bord, la garniture du volant et la partie inférieure du tableau de bord. Ces éléments peuvent se transformer en projectiles lorsque les coussins gonflables conducteur, passager avant et genoux SRS se déploient.
Ne fixez rien aux portes, à la vitre du pare-brise, aux vitres latérales, aux montants avant et arrière, au rail latéral de toit et à la poignée de maintien. (Sauf pour l'étiquette de limitation de vitesse)
Ne suspendez aucun cintre ou objet dur aux crochets à vêtements. Tous ces objets pourraient se transformer en projectiles et causer des blessures graves, voire mortelles en cas de déploiement des coussins gonflables rideaux SRS.
Si un cache en vinyle est placé sur la zone où le coussin gonflable de genoux du conducteur SRS se déploie, assurez-vous de le retirer.

10-1. For owners 561

 N'utilisez aucun accessoire de siège recouvrant les zones de déploiement des coussins gonflables latéraux SRS et du coussin gonflable de coussin de siège SRS, car il risque de gêner le déploiement des coussins gonflables SRS. De tels accessoires peuvent empêcher les coussins gonflables latéraux et le coussin gonflable de coussin de siège de s'activer correctement, désactiver le système ou entraîner le déploiement accidentel des coussins gonflables latéraux et du coussin gonflable de coussin de siège, occasionnant des blessures graves, voire mortelles.

 Évitez de faire subir des chocs ou des pressions excessives aux parties renfermant les composants de coussins gonflables SRS ou aux portes avant. En effet, cela pourrait entraîner un dysfonctionnement des coussins gonflables SRS.

 Ne touchez aucun composant immédiatement après le déploiement (gonflage) des coussins gonflables SRS, car ils peuvent être chauds.

 Si vous avez des difficultés à

respirer après le déploiement

des coussins gonflables SRS,

ouvrez une porte ou une vitre

pour faire entrer de l'air frais, ou

bien descendez du véhicule si

cela ne présente pas de danger.

Essuyez tout résidu dès que

possible afin d'éviter d'éventu-

elles irritations de la peau.

10

For owners

 Si les parties renfermant les coussins gonflables SRS, comme les garnitures du volant et des montants avant et arrière, sont endommagées ou craquelées, faites-les remplacer par votre concessionnaire Toyota.

COROLLA HV_U

562 10-1. For owners
WARNING Ne placez rien sur le siège du
passager avant, comme un coussin par exemple. Cela a pour conséquence de répartir le poids du passager sur toute la surface du siège, ce qui empêche le capteur de détecter correctement le poids du passager. En conséquence, les coussins gonflables frontaux SRS du passager avant risquent de ne pas se déployer en cas de collision.  Modification et mise au rebut des composants du système de coussins gonflables SRS Ne mettez pas votre véhicule au rebut et ne procédez à aucune des modifications suivantes sans consulter votre concessionnaire Toyota. Les coussins gonflables SRS peuvent ne pas fonctionner correctement ou se déployer (se gonfler) accidentellement, provoquant la mort ou de graves blessures. Installation, dépose, démontage et réparation des coussins gonflables SRS Réparations, modifications, démontage ou remplacement du volant, du tableau de bord, de la planche de bord, des sièges ou de leur garnissage, des montants avant, latéraux et arrière, des rails latéraux de toit, des panneaux de porte avant, des garnitures de porte avant ou des haut-parleurs de porte avant Modifications du panneau de porte avant (par exemple, perçage d'un trou dans le panneau)

 Réparations ou modifications des ailes avant, du pare-chocs avant ou des flancs de l'habitacle
 Installation d'un protège-calandre (pare-buffle, pare-kangourou, etc.), de chasse-neige, de treuils ou d'un porte-bagages de toit
 Modifications du système de suspension du véhicule
 Installation d'appareils électroniques tels que les émetteurs/récepteurs radios mobiles et les lecteurs CD
 Modifications de votre véhicule pour une personne atteinte d'un handicap physique

COROLLA HV_U

Index
. What to do if... (Troubleshooting) ................... 564
Alphabetical Index....... 567

563

COROLLA HV_U

564 What to do if... (Troubleshooting)

What to do if... (Troubleshooting) 1-1.Whattodoif...(Troubleshooting)

If you have a problem, check the following before contacting your Toyota dealer.

properly due to the condition of the radio wave. (P.127)
The rear door cannot be opened

The doors cannot be locked, unlocked, opened or closed
You lose your keys

 Is the child-protector lock set?
The rear door cannot be opened from inside the vehicle when the lock is set. Open the rear door from outside and then unlock the child-protector lock. (P.122)

 If you lose your mechanical keys, new genuine mechanical keys can be made by your Toyota dealer. (P.510)
 If you lose your electronic keys, the risk of vehicle theft increases significantly. Contact your Toyota dealer immediately. (P.510)
The doors cannot be locked or unlocked
 Is the electronic key battery weak or depleted? (P.459)
 Is the power switch in ON?
When locking the doors, turn the power switch off. (P.159)
 Is the electronic key left inside the vehicle?
When locking the doors, make sure that you have the electronic key on your person.
 The function may not operate

If you think something is wrong
The hybrid system does not start
 Did you press the power switch while firmly depressing the brake pedal? (P.157)
 Is the shift lever in P? (P.157)
 Is the electronic key anywhere detectable inside the vehicle? (P.126)
 Is the steering wheel unlocked? (P.158)
 Is the electronic key battery weak or depleted?
In this case, the hybrid system can be started in a temporary way. (P.512)
 Is the 12-volt battery discharged? (P.513)

COROLLA HV_U

What to do if... (Troubleshooting) 565

The shift lever cannot be shifted from P even if you depress the brake pedal
 Is the power switch in ON?
If you cannot release the shift lever by depressing the brake pedal with the power switch in ON. (P.165)
The steering wheel cannot be turned after the hybrid system is stopped
 It is locked automatically to prevent theft of the vehicle. (P.158)
The windows do not open or close by operating the power window switches
 Is the window lock switch pressed?
The power window except for the one at the driver's seat cannot be operated if the window lock switch is pressed. (P.144)
The power switch is turned off automatically
 The auto power off function will be operated if the vehicle is left in ACC or ON (the hybrid system is not operating) for a period of time. (P.160)
A warning buzzer sounds during driving
 The seat belt reminder light is

flashing
Are the driver and the passenger wearing the seat belts? (P.481)
 The parking brake indicator is on
Is the parking brake released? (P.167)
Depending on the situation, other types of warning buzzer may also sound. (P.478, 487)
An alarm is activated and the horn sounds
 Did anyone inside the vehicle open a door during setting the alarm?
The sensor detects it and the alarm sounds. (P.90)
Do one of the following to deactivate or stop the alarms:
 Unlock the doors.
 Turn the power switch to ACC or ON, or start the hybrid system. (The alarm will be deactivated or stopped after a few seconds.)
A warning buzzer sounds when leaving the vehicle
 Is the electronic key left inside the vehicle?
Check the message on the multi-information display. (P.487)

COROLLA HV_U

566 What to do if... (Troubleshooting)
A warning light turns on or a warning message is displayed
 When a warning light turns on or a warning message is displayed, refer to P.478, 487.
When a problem has occurred
If you have a flat tire
 Vehicles with an emergency tire puncture repair kit: Stop the vehicle in a safe place and repair the flat tire temporarily with the emergency tire puncture repair kit. (P.490)
 Vehicles with a spare tire: Stop the vehicle in a safe place and replace the flat tire with the spare tire. (P.501)
The vehicle becomes stuck
 Try the procedure for when the vehicle becomes stuck in mud, dirt, or snow. (P.520)
COROLLA HV_U

Alphabetical Index 567

Alphabetical Index

A
A/C Air conditioning filter.............454 Automatic air conditioning system .....................................386
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System) ............................................... 240 Warning light ........................480
ACA (Active Cornering Assist) ............................................... 240
Active Cornering Assist (ACA) ............................................... 240
Air conditioning filter .............454 Air conditioning system
Air conditioning filter.............454 Automatic air conditioning sys-
tem .....................................386 Airbags
Airbag operating conditions....33 Airbag precautions for your child
............................................. 36 Correct driving posture...........25 Curtain shield airbag operating
conditions .............................34 Curtain shield airbag precautions
............................................. 36 Front passenger occupant clas-
sification system...................41 General airbag precautions....36 Locations of airbags ...............31 Modification and disposal of air-
bags .....................................39 Side airbag operating conditions
............................................. 34 Side airbag precautions .........36 Side and curtain shield airbags
operating conditions .............34 Side and curtain shield airbags
precautions........................... 36 SRS airbags ...........................31 SRS warning light.................480

Alarm Alarm ......................................90 Warning buzzer ....................478
AM ............................................303 Anchor brackets .................50, 68 Android Auto...........................314 Antennas (smart key system)125 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
...............................................240 Warning light.........................480 Apple CarPlay/Android Auto .284 Troubleshooting ....................287 Approach warning ..................214 Apps button (Menu screen) ...255 Armrest ....................................410 Assist grips .............................410 Audio .......................................298 Audio source ........................299 Operating information ...........322 Reordering the audio source 299 Screen adjustment ...............301 Some basics .........................299 Sound settings......................300 Turning the system on and off
...........................................299 USB port ...............................300 Voice command system .......302 AUDIO button..........................253 Audio button (Menu screen)..255 Audio buttons overview.........253 Audio settings.........................321 Common settings .................321 Radio settings.......................321 Audio source...........................299 Audio system-linked display .107 Automatic air conditioning system .........................................386 Automatic High Beam ............175 Automatic light control system ...............................................174 Average fuel economy ...........104 Average vehicle speed ...........107

COROLLA HV_U

568 Alphabetical Index

B
Back-up lights Replacing light bulbs ............466 Wattage ................................530
Battery (12-volt battery) Battery checking...................439 If the 12-volt battery is discharged ..............................513 Preparing and checking before winter.................................. 247 Warning light ........................479
Battery (traction battery) .........83 Blind Spot Monitor (BSM)......221 Bluetooth® audio....................315
Registering/Connecting a Bluetooth® device......................317
Bluetooth® button (Setup screen) ..................................258
Bluetooth® details settings ...272 Bluetooth® setup screen ......273 Connecting a Bluetooth® device ........................................... 273 Deleting a Bluetooth® device275 Detailed settings screen.......277 Displaying the Bluetooth® setup screen ................................272 Editing the Bluetooth® device information .........................276 Registering a Bluetooth® device ........................................... 275
Bluetooth® device information ............................................... 276
Bluetooth® hands-free system ............................................... 343
Bluetooth® phone message function......................................... 354 Calling the message sender.357 Checking received messages ........................................... 355 Displaying the message screen ........................................... 354

Receiving a message ...........354 Replying to a message (dicta-
tion reply)............................356 Replying to a message (quick
reply) ..................................356 Bottle holders .........................398 Brake
Brake hold ............................170 Fluid..............................438, 528 Parking brake .......................167 Regenerative braking .............81 Warning light.........................478 Brake assist ............................240 Break-in tips............................147 Brightness control Instrument panel light control101 BSM (Blind Spot Monitor) ......221
C
Care Exterior .................................420 Interior ..................................422 Seat belts .............................422 Wheels and wheel ornaments ...........................................420
Cargo capacity........................155 Chains......................................248 Child restraint system
Fixed with a LATCH system ...64 Fixed with a seat belt..............59 Front passenger occupant clas-
sification system ...................41 Points to remember ................48 Riding with children ................47 Types of child restraint system
installation method ...............50 Using an anchor bracket ........68 Child safety 12-volt battery precautions .439,
516 Airbag precautions .................36 Child restraint system .............50

COROLLA HV_U

Alphabetical Index 569

Heated steering wheel and seat heater precautions .............393
How your child should wear the seat belt................................28
Power window lock switch....144 Power window precautions ..143 Rear door child-protectors....122 Removed electronic key battery
precautions......................... 460 Seat belt extender precautions
............................................. 28 Seat belt precautions .............47 Trunk precautions.................123 Child-protectors .....................122 Cleaning Exterior ................................. 420 Interior ..................................422 Radar sensor........................184 Seat belts .............................422 Wheels and wheel ornaments
........................................... 420 Clock .........................98, 101, 292 Coat hooks..............................410 Command list .........................337 Condenser ..............................437 Console box............................399 Cooling system ......................436
Engine overheating ..............517 Hybrid system overheating...518 Cruise control Dynamic radar cruise control
with full-speed range ..........207 Cup holders ............................398 Current fuel consumption .....104 Curtain shield airbags .............31 Customizable features ...........544
D
Daytime running light system173 DCM .................................376, 377 Defogger
Outside rear view mirrors .....387

Rear window.........................387 Windshield ............................387 Dimensions .............................524 Dinghy towing.........................156 Display Dynamic radar cruise control
with full-speed range ..........207 Energy monitor .....................109 LTA (Lane Tracing Assist) .....202 Multi-information display.......103 RCTA ....................................226 Warning message.................487 Display change button ...........100 Do-it-yourself maintenance ...426 Door lock Doors ....................................119 Smart key system .................125 Wireless remote control........117 Doors Automatic door locking and
unlocking system................122 Door glasses ........................142 Door lock ..............................119 Open door warning buzzer .120,
122 Outside rear view mirrors .....140 Rear door child-protectors ....122 Side doors ............................119 Drive distance .........................107 Drive information....................107 Drive-start control ..................147 Driving Break-in tips .........................147 Correct driving posture ...........25 Driving mode select switch ...239 Hybrid vehicle driving tips.....245 Procedures ...........................146 Winter drive tips....................247 Driving information display ...104 Driving range ..........................104 Driving support system information display............................107

COROLLA HV_U

570 Alphabetical Index

Dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range ...........207 Warning message ................216
E
ECB (Electronically Controlled Brake System) ......................240
ECO Accelerator Guidance ...105 Eco score ................................105 EDR (Event data recorder).........8 Elapsed time ...........................107 Electric motor (traction motor)80 Electric Power Steering (EPS)
............................................... 240 Warning light ........................481 Electronic key ......................... 116 Battery-saving function.........126 If the electronic key does not
operate properly ................. 511 Replacing the battery ...........459 Electronically Controlled Brake System (ECB) .......................240 Emergency flashers ...............470 Emergency tire puncture repair kit ...........................................490 Emergency, in case of If a warning buzzer sounds ..478 If a warning light turns on .....478 If a warning message is dis-
played................................. 487 If the 12-volt battery is dis-
charged ..............................513 If the electronic key does not
operate properly ................. 511 If the fuel filler door cannot be
opened ............................... 511 If the hybrid system will not start
........................................... 509 If the vehicle is trapped in rising
water ..................................472 If you have a flat tire.....490, 501 If you lose your keys ............510

If you think something is wrong ...........................................476
If your vehicle becomes stuck ...........................................520
If your vehicle has to be stopped in an emergency.................471
If your vehicle needs to be towed ...........................................473
If your vehicle overheats ......517 Energy monitor .......................109 Engine
ACCESSORY mode .............160 Compartment........................434 Engine switch .......................157 Hood .....................................432 How to start the hybrid system
...........................................157 Identification number ............525 If the hybrid system will not start
...........................................509 If your vehicle has to be stopped
in an emergency.................471 Ignition switch (power switch)
...........................................157 Overheating ..........................517 Power switch ........................157 Tachometer.............................98 Engine coolant Capacity ...............................527 Checking ..............................436 Preparing and checking before
winter ..................................247 Engine coolant temperature
gauge .......................................98 Engine oil
Capacity ...............................526 Checking ..............................434 Preparing and checking before
winter ..................................247 Warning light.........................479

COROLLA HV_U

Alphabetical Index 571

Engine switch (power switch)157 If your vehicle has to be stopped in an emergency.................471
Enhanced VSC........................240 Entering letters and num-
bers/list screen operation ...263 Entering letters and numbers263 List screen............................264
EPS (Electric Power Steering) ............................................... 240 Warning light ........................481
Establishing an Android Auto connection ............................285
Establishing an Apple CarPlay connection ............................284
EV drive mode ........................162 EV indicator ..............................81 Event data recorder (EDR).........8
F
Flat tire Tire pressure warning system ........................................... 443 Vehicles with a spare tire .....501 Vehicles without a spare tire 490
Floor mats .................................24 Fluid
Brake .................................... 528 Hybrid transmission..............528 Washer .................................440 FM ............................................303 Front passenger occupant classification system ....................41 Front seats Adjustment ...........................133 Cleaning ...............................422 Correct driving posture...........25 Head restraints.....................136 Seat heaters.........................393 Front side marker lights Light switch ..........................173 Replacing light bulbs ............464

Wattage ................................530 Front turn signal lights
Replacing light bulbs ............464 Turn signal lever ...................166 Fuel Capacity ...............................525 Fuel gauge .............................98 Information ...........................531 Refueling ..............................180 Type......................................525 Warning light.........................481 Fuel consumption Average fuel economy..........104 Current fuel consumption .....104 Fuel economy .........................104 Fuel filler door If the fuel filler door cannot be
opened ...............................511 Refueling ..............................180 Fuel gauge.................................98 Functional overview ...............372 Fuses .......................................461
G
Garage door opener ...............411 Gauges ......................................98 General button (Setup screen)
.......................................258, 291 General settings .....................291
Displaying the general settings screen.................................291
General settings screen .......291 Glove box ................................398
H
Hands-free system .................343 Head restraints .......................136 Headlights
Automatic High Beam system ...........................................175
Light switch...........................173

COROLLA HV_U

572 Alphabetical Index

Headlights/daytime running lights Replacing light bulbs ............464
Heated steering wheel ...........393 Heaters
Automatic air conditioning system .....................................386
Heated steering wheel .........393 Outside rear view mirrors .....387 Seat heaters.........................393 High mounted stoplight Replacing light bulbs ............464 High-voltage components .......83 Hill-start assist control ..........240 HOME button ..........................262 Home screen...........................262 Hood Open ....................................432 Hooks Coat hooks ...........................410 Retaining hooks (floor mat) ....24 Horn .........................................138 Hybrid battery (traction battery) Location.................................. 83 Specification ......................... 526 Warning message ..................87 Hybrid battery (traction battery) air intake vent .......................455 Hybrid battery (traction battery) air vents ..................................86 Hybrid system ..........................80 Emergency shut off system ....87 Energy monitor/consumption
screen ................................109 EV drive mode......................162 High voltage components.......83 Hybrid system precautions.....83 If the hybrid system will not start
........................................... 509 Overheating.......................... 518 Power (ignition) switch .........157 Regenerative braking .............81

Starting the hybrid system ....157 Hybrid System Indicator ........105 Hybrid transmission...............164 Hybrid vehicle driving tips.....245
I
I/M test .....................................429 Identification
Engine ..................................525 Vehicle ..................................524 Ignition switch (power switch) ...............................................157 Auto power off function.........160 Changing the power switch
modes.................................160 If your vehicle has to be stopped
in an emergency.................471 Illuminated entry system .......396 Immobilizer system ..................88 Indicators ..................................96 Info button (Menu screen) .....255 Initial screen............................259
Caution screen .....................259 Restarting the system...........259 Initialization Items to initialize ...................552 Maintenance .........................426 Power windows ....................142 Tire pressure warning system
...........................................447 Inside rear view mirror ...........139 Instrument panel light control
...............................................101 Interior lights...........................395
Front interior light .................395 Rear interior light ..................395 Wattage ................................530 Internet radio...........................308 iPod/iPhone(Apple Carplay) ..311

COROLLA HV_U

Alphabetical Index 573

J
Jack Positioning a floor jack .........433 Vehicle-equipped jack ..492, 502
Jack handle.....................492, 502 Jam protection function
Power windows ....................142
K
Keyless entry Smart key system.................125 Wireless remote control ....... 117
Keys Battery-saving function.........126 Electronic key....................... 116 If the electronic key does not operate properly ................. 511 If you lose your keys ............510 Key number plate ................. 116 Keyless entry................ 119, 125 Mechanical key .................... 116 Power switch ........................157 Replacing the battery ...........459 Warning buzzer ....................126 Wireless remote control ....... 117
Knee airbags.............................31
L
Lane Tracing Assist (LTA) Operation .............................197 Warning messages...............206
Language (multi-information display) .......................................108
LATCH anchors ........................64 LED accent lights
Light switch ..........................173 Replacing light bulbs ............464 Lever Auxiliary catch lever .............432 Hood lock release lever........432

Internal trunk release lever ...125 Shift lever .............................164 Turn signal lever ...................166 Wiper lever ...........................178 License plate lights Light switch...........................173 Replacing light bulbs ............464 Wattage ................................530 Light bulbs Replacing .............................463 Lights Automatic High Beam system
...........................................175 Front interior lights................395 Headlight switch ...................173 Interior lights .........................395 Interior lights list ...................395 Personal lights ......................396 Rear interior lights ................395 Replacing light bulbs ............464 Trunk light.............................124 Turn signal lever ...................166 Vanity lights ..........................409 Wattage ................................530 Linking multi-information display and the system .....................267 Lock steering column ............158 LTA (Lane Tracing Assist) Operation..............................197 Warning messages...............206
M
Maintenance Do-it-yourself maintenance ..430 General maintenance ...........426 Maintenance data .................524 Maintenance requirements ...425
Malfunction indicator lamp....479 Media button (Menu screen)..255 Menu icons..............................103 Menu screen............................255
Menu screen operation.........255

COROLLA HV_U

574 Alphabetical Index

Meter Clock ......................................98 Indicators................................ 96 Instrument panel light control101 Meter control switches .........103 Meters ....................................98 Multi-information display ......103 Settings ................................108 Warning lights.......................478 Warning message ................487
Microphone .............................346 Mirrors
Inside rear view mirror..........139 Outside rear view mirror defog-
gers ....................................387 Outside rear view mirrors .....140 Vanity mirrors .......................409 Mobile Assistant.....................341 Connectable devices and avail-
able functions .....................341 Mobile Assistant operation ...341 Multi-information display Audio system-linked display.107 Clock ....................................101 Driving information display ...104 Driving support system informa-
tion display .........................107 Dynamic radar cruise control
with full-speed range ..........207 ECO Accelerator Guidance ..105 Eco score .............................105 Energy monitor.....................109 Fuel economy.......................104 Hybrid System Indicator .......105 LTA (Lane Tracing Assist).....202 Menu icons...........................103 Meter control switches .........103 Settings ................................108 Tire pressure ........................443 Vehicle information display...107 Warning message ................487

N
Noise from under vehicle...........6
O
Odometer.................................100 Odometer and trip meter display
Display change button ..........100 Display items ........................100 Oil Engine oil..............................526 Open trays...............................399 Opener Fuel filler door.......................180 Hood .....................................432 Trunk ....................................124 Outside rear view mirrors Adjustment ...........................140 BSM (Blind Spot Monitor) .....221 Folding..................................141 Outside rear view mirror defog-
gers ....................................387 RCTA function.......................226 Outside temperature ................98 Overheating.............................517
P
Panic mode .............................118 Parking brake
Operation..............................167 Parking brake engaged warning
buzzer.................................169 Warning light.........................484 Warning message.................169 Parking lights Light switch...........................173 Replacing light bulbs ............464 PCS (Pre-Collision System) Function................................189 Warning light.........................483

COROLLA HV_U

Alphabetical Index 575

Personal lights .......................395 Wattage ................................530
Phone ......................................343 About the contacts in the contact list ....................................... 347 Phone screen operation .......343 Registering/Connecting a Bluetooth® phone ......................345 Some basics.........................344 Troubleshooting.................... 368 Voice command system .......347 When selling or disposing of the vehicle ................................347
Phone button ..........................343 Phone button (Menu screen).255 Phone button (Setup screen) 258 Phone settings .......................358
Contacts/Call history settings360 Message settings .................366 Notifications settings ............359 Sounds settings....................358 Placing a call using the Bluetooth® hands-free system ...348 By call history .......................348 By contacts list .....................349 By favorites list .....................348 By home screen ...................350 By keypad ............................350 Power control unit....................83 Power control unit coolant Capacity ...............................527 Checking ..............................436 Preparing and checking before
winter.................................. 247 Power outlet............................402 Power steering (Electric power
steering system)...................240 Warning light ........................481
Power switch ..........................157 Auto power off function ........160 Changing the power switch modes ................................160

Power switch (engine switch) If your vehicle has to be stopped in an emergency.................471
POWER VOLUME knob ..........299 Power windows
Door lock linked window operation......................................143
Jam protection function ........142 Operation..............................142 Window lock switch ..............144 Pre-Collision System (PCS) Function................................189 Warning light.........................483
R
Radar cruise control (dynamic radar cruise control with full-speed range)...................207
Radiator ...................................437 Radio........................................303
Displaying the radio ID .........306 How to subscribe to SiriusXM
Radio Services ...................305 Presetting a station...............303 Radio broadcast data system304 Refer to the table below to iden-
tify the problem and take the suggested corrective action306 RCTA Function................................226 Warning message.................227 RCTA function.........................228 Rear Cross Traffic Alert (RCTA) ...............................................226 Rear seats ...............................134 Head restraints .....................136 Rear side marker lights Light switch...........................173 Replacing light bulbs ....464, 465 Wattage ................................530 Rear turn signal lights Replacing light bulbs ............465

COROLLA HV_U

576 Alphabetical Index

Turn signal lever...................166 Wattage ................................530 Rear view mirror Inside rear view mirror..........139 Outside rear view mirrors .....140 Rear view monitor system.....231 If you notice any symptoms..236 Rear window defogger...........387 Receiving a call using the Bluetooth® hands-free system ...351 Refueling Capacity ...............................525 Fuel types.............................525 If the fuel filler door cannot be
opened ............................... 511 Opening the fuel tank cap ....180 Regenerative braking...............81 Registering/Connecting a Bluetooth® device ........................268 Profiles .................................271 Registering a Bluetooth® audio
player for the first time........271 Registering a Bluetooth® phone
for the first time ..................268 Replacing
Electronic key battery...........459 Fuses ...................................461 Light bulbs............................463 Tires .....................................501 Reporting safety defects for U.S. owners................................... 554 Resetting the message indicating maintenance is required426 Road Sign Assist....................218 RSA (Road Sign Assist) .........218
S
Safety Connect .........................73 Screen adjustment .................266 Seat belt reminder light .481, 482 Seat belts ..................................27
Adjusting the seat belt............29

Automatic Locking Retractor ..29 Child restraint system installation
.............................................50 Cleaning and maintaining the
seat belt..............................422 Emergency Locking Retractor 29 How to wear your seat belt .....28 How your child should wear the
seat belt................................28 Pregnant women, proper seat
belt use.................................27 Reminder light and buzzer .481,
482 Seat belt extender ..................28 Seat belt pretensioners ..........30 SRS warning light .................480 Seat heaters ............................393 Seating capacity .............155, 524 Seats Adjustment ...........................133 Adjustment precautions ........133 Child seats/child restraint system
installation ............................48 Cleaning ...............................422 Head restraints .....................136 Properly sitting in the seat ......25 Seat heaters .........................393 Secondary Collision Brake ....241 Sensor Automatic headlight system .174 Automatic High Beam system
...........................................175 BSM (Blind Spot Monitor) .....221 Inside rear view mirror ..........140 LTA (Lane Tracing Assist) .....197 Radar sensor ................183, 223 RCTA ....................................227 Service Connect .....................377 Service plug ..............................83 Service reminder message ....426 Setup button (Menu screen) 255, 258

COROLLA HV_U

Alphabetical Index 577

Setup screen...........................258 Shift lever
Hybrid transmission..............164 If the shift lever cannot be shifted
from P.................................165 Shift lock system....................165 Side airbags ..............................31 Side marker lights
Light switch ..........................173 Replacing light bulbs ....464, 465 Wattage ................................530 Side mirrors Adjustment ...........................140 BSM (Blind Spot Monitor).....221 Folding .................................141 RCTA function ......................226 Side turn signal lights Replacing light bulbs ............464 Turn signal lever...................166 Side windows .........................142 SiriusXM (SXM).......................303 Smart key system Antenna location ..................125 Entry functions ..................... 119 Starting the hybrid system....157 Snow tires ...............................247 Spare tire.................................501 Inflation pressure..................529 Storage location ...................502 Spark plug...............................527 Specifications .........................524 Speedometer ............................98 Status icon ..............................256 Status icon explanation ........256 Steering lock Column lock release.............158 Steering lock system warning
message............................. 158 Steering switch...............319, 334
Audio switch .........................319 Talk switch............................334

Steering wheel Adjustment ...........................138 Heated steering wheel..........393 Meter control switches..........103
Stop lights Replacing light bulbs ............464
Storage features .....................397 Stuck
If the vehicle becomes stuck 520 Sun visors ...............................409 Switches
Automatic High Beam system ...........................................175
Brake Hold switch.................170 Display change button ..........100 Door lock switches ...............121 Driving mode select switch ...239 Dynamic radar cruise control
with full-speed range switch207 Emergency flashers switch...470 EV drive mode switch ...........162 Garage door opener switches
........................................... 411 Heated steering wheel switch
...........................................393 Ignition switch .......................157 Instrument panel light control
switches..............................101 Light switches .......................173 LTA (Lane Tracing Assist) switch
...........................................202 Meter control switches..........103 Outside rear view mirror
switches..............................140 Parking brake switch ............167 Power door lock switch.........121 Power switch ........................157 Power window switches .......142 Rear window and outside rear
view mirror defoggers switch ...........................................386 Seat heater switches ............393

COROLLA HV_U

578 Alphabetical Index

"SOS" button ..........................73 Vehicle-to-vehicle distance
switch .................................207 VSC OFF switch...................241 Window lock switch ..............144 Windshield wiper and washer
switch .................................178 SXM (SiriusXM).......................303
T
Tachometer ...............................98 Tail lights
Light switch ..........................173 Replacing light bulbs ............464 Talking on the Bluetooth® hands-free system ...............352 Call screen operation ...........352 Incoming call waiting ............353 Sending tones ......................352 Transmit volume setting .......353 Theft deterrent system Alarm ...................................... 90 Immobilizer system ................88 Tire inflation pressure............450 Maintenance data.................529 Warning light ........................482 Tire information ......................533 Glossary ...............................537 Size ......................................535 Tire identification number .....535 Uniform Tire Quality Grading 536 Tire pressure warning system Function ...............................443 Initializing .............................447 Installing tire pressure warning
valves and transmitters ......446 Registering ID codes............449 Warning light ........................482 Tires Chains ..................................248 Checking ..............................441

Emergency tire puncture repair kit ........................................490
If you have a flat tire .....490, 501 Inflation pressure ..................450 Information ...........................533 Replacing .............................501 Rotating tires ........................443 Size ......................................529 Snow tires.............................247 Spare tire ..............................501 Tire pressure warning system
...........................................443 Warning light.........................482 Tools ................................492, 502 Top tether strap ........................68 Total load capacity .................524 Touch screen ..........................260 Touch screen gestures .........260 Touch screen operation ........260 Towing Dinghy towing .......................156 Emergency towing................473 Towing eyelet........................475 Trailer towing ........................155 Toyota apps.............................379 Toyota apps Entering keyword..................381 Toyota apps button (Setup screen)...................................258 Toyota apps settings..............383 Toyota Safety Sense 2.0 Automatic High Beam...........175 Dynamic radar cruise control
with full-speed range ..........207 LTA (Lane Tracing Assist) .....197 PCS (Pre-Collision System) .189 RSA (Road Sign Assist)........218 TRAC (Traction Control) ........240 Traction battery (hybrid battery) Hybrid battery (traction battery)
air vents................................86 Location ..................................83

COROLLA HV_U

Alphabetical Index 579

Specification ......................... 526 Warning message ..................87 Traction Control (TRAC) ........240 Traction motor (electric motor)80 Trailer towing ..........................155 Transmission Driving mode select switch...239 Hybrid transmission..............164 If the shift lever cannot be shifted
from P.................................165 Trip meters ..............................100 Trunk .......................................123
Internal trunk release lever...125 Smart key system.................124 Trunk light.............................124 Trunk opener ........................124 Wireless remote control .......124 Trunk features ........................400 Trunk light ...............................124 Wattage ................................530 Turn signal lights Replacing light bulbs ............464 Turn signal lever...................166 Wattage ................................530
U
USB charging port..................401 USB memory...........................309 USB port..................................300
V
Vanity lights ............................409 Wattage ................................530
Vanity mirrors .........................409 Vehicle button (Setup screen)
.......................................258, 296 Vehicle data recording ...............7 Vehicle identification number524 Vehicle information display...107

Vehicle settings ......................296 Displaying the vehicle settings screen.................................296 Valet mode setting ................296 Vehicle settings screen.........296
Vehicle Stability Control (VSC) ...............................................240
Voice button (Setup screen) 258, 295
Voice command system.........334 Using the voice command system .....................................334 Voice command system operation......................................335
Voice settings .........................295 Displaying the voice settings screen.................................295 Voice settings screen ...........295
VSC (Vehicle Stability Control) ...............................................240
W
Warning buzzers ABS ......................................480 Airbags .................................480 Approach warning ................214 Brake hold ............................484 Brake Override System ........480 Brake system........................478 Charging system ..................479 Drive-Start Control................480 Electric power steering .........481 Engine ..................................479 High coolant temperature .....478 Hybrid system.......................479 Hybrid system overheat........479 Low engine oil pressure .......479 LTA (Lane Tracing Assist) ...197, 482 Open door ....................120, 122 RCTA (Rear Cross Traffic Alert) ...........................................483

COROLLA HV_U

580 Alphabetical Index

Seat belt .......................481, 482 Warning label............................83 Warning lights ........................478
ABS ......................................480 Brake hold operated indicator
........................................... 484 Brake Override System ........480 Brake system .......................478 Charging system ..................479 Drive-Start Control ...............480 Electric power steering.........481 High coolant temperature.....478 Hybrid system overheat .......479 Low engine oil pressure .......479 Low fuel level .......................481 LTA indicator.........................482 Malfunction indicator lamp ...479 Parking brake indicator ........484 Pre-collision system .............483 RCTA OFF indicator .............483 Seat belt reminder light 481, 482 Slip indicator.........................483 SRS ...................................... 480 Tire pressure ........................482 Warning messages.................487 Washer Checking ..............................440 Preparing and checking before
winter.................................. 247 Switch................................... 178 Washing and waxing..............420 Weight Cargo capacity .....................155 Load limits ............................155 Wheels ..................................... 452 Replacing .............................452 Size ......................................529 Wi-Fi® ......................................280 Connecting a device to the
in-vehicle access point .......280 Operating hints.....................283 Wi-Fi® button (Setup screen) 258

Wi-Fi® Hotspot ........................280 Window lock switch ...............144 Windows
Power windows ....................142 Rear window defogger .........387 Washer .................................178 Windshield wiper de-icer .......390 Windshield wipers ..................178 Winter driving tips ..................247 Wireless charger.....................402 Wireless remote control Battery-Saving Function .......126 Locking/Unlocking ................117 Replacing the battery ...........459
For vehicles with Audio Plus, refer to "NAVIGATION AND MULTIMEDIA SYSTEM OWNER'S MANUAL" for information regarding the equipment listed below. · Audio/visual system · Rear view monitor system

COROLLA HV_U

Alphabetical Index 581
COROLLA HV_U

582 Alphabetical Index
COROLLA HV_U

Alphabetical Index 583
COROLLA HV_U

584 GAS STATION INFORMATION

Auxiliary catch lever (P.432) Fuel filler door opener (P.181) Fuel filler door (P.181) Hood lock release lever (P.432) Trunk opener (P.124) Tire inflation pressure (P.529)

Fuel tank capacity (Reference)

11.4 gal. (43.0 L, 9.5 Imp. gal.)

Fuel type

Cold tire inflation pressure

Engine oil capacity
(Drain and refill  reference)

Engine oil type

"Toyota Genuine Motor Oil" or equivalent

P.525 P.531 P.529
P.526 P.526

COROLLA HV_U